AI Terminal

MODULE: AI_ANALYST
Interactive Q&A, Risk Assessment, Summarization
MODULE: DATA_EXTRACT
Excel Export, XBRL Parsing, Table Digitization
MODULE: PEER_COMP
Sector Benchmarking, Sentiment Analysis
SYSTEM ACCESS LOCKED
Authenticate / Register Log In

NEWRIVER REIT PLC

Annual Report Jun 27, 2025

4954_10-k_2025-06-27_84f13bee-fc0d-4dae-b256-8bb5a2d8b1db.pdf

Annual Report

Open in Viewer

Opens in native device viewer

NewRiver REIT plc Annual Report and Accounts 2025

Transformation and growth

Annual Report & Accounts 2025

NewRiver REIT plc Annual Report and Accounts 2025 Strategic Report Governance Report Financial Statements ESG Data Sets
& Appendix
Glossary &
Company Information

2025 performance

Highlights

Significant earnings growth with increased scale, a strong financial position and continued operational performance

A leading specialist retail Real Estate Investment Trust

Our purpose is to own, manage and develop a portfolio of retail assets across the UK that provide essential goods and services to local people, help support thriving communities and deliver long-term premium returns for our shareholders.

Significant growth – successful
acquisition of Capital & Regional
Strong
financial position
High-quality,
affordable portfolio3
Increase in NewRiver
balance sheet assets
Increase in UFFO Underlying Funds From
Operations (UFFO)
UFFO
per share
Occupancy Retention
+65%
+25%
£30.5m 8.1p 96.1%2 90%
Expanding Capital Partnerships FY24: £24.4m
FY23: £25.8m
FY24: 7.8p
FY23: 8.3p
FY24: 98.0%
FY23: 96.7%
FY24: 94%
FY23: 92%
Capital Partnership
assets under management
Capital
Partnership assets
IFRS profit / (loss) Dividend per share Total
Property Return
In-store sales growth
(Lloyds Bank data)5
£1.5 billion 39 £23.7m 6.5p 7.8% +4.9%
FY24: £0.8bn
+88% vs FY24
FY24: 23
+70% vs FY24
FY24: £3.0m
FY23: £(16.8)m
FY24: 6.6p
FY23: 6.7p
FY24: +4.8%
FY23: +2.3%
year-on-year
Capital Partnership
fee income
Portfolio valuation
performance
EPRA4 NTA
per share
Average rent Occupational Cost Ratio
(OCR)
£2.9 million +0.6%6 102p1 £12.93 8.3%
FY24: £2.5m
+16% growth vs FY24
FY24: -2.3%
FY23: -5.9%
FY24: 115p
FY23: 121p
per sq ft
FY24: £11.82
FY23: £11.98
FY24: 8.8%
FY23: n/a
Acquisition of Ellandi, expanding our Capital Loan to Value Total accounting return Good leasing
Partnership portfolio, together with appointment
on three further asset management mandates
42.3% -5.9%1 performance
Delivering sustainable growth FY24: 30.8% FY24: +0.5% Long-term Long-term transactions
Net-zero pathway progress FY23: 33.9% FY23: -4.6% transactions
Reduction of 13% in Scope 1 & reduction of 12% in
Scope 2 emissions in FY25 vs FY24
Capital & Regional and Ellandi 1. Including impact of 19.9% equity placing and acquisition of
2. Group occupancy has reduced following the acquisition of
Capital & Regional; NewRiver like-for-like occupancy is 97.5%
+17.5% +8.8%
GRESB score improved from 72 to 80 3. Refer to Notes in the Financial Statements for further vs previous rent vs ERV
Gained additional green star context in addition to standard GAAP measures information; Non-GAAP measures have been used in the
highlights to provide additional performance insight and
FY24: +1.8%
FY23: +9.7%
FY24: +3.6%
FY23: +1.1%
Maintained our 'B' rating in the CDP 4. The European Public Real Estate Association (EPRA)
previously spent in store.
6. See Glossary, like-for-like valuation growth.
5. Includes online spend contribution where a customer had

Front cover: A shopper in Broadway Square, Bexleyheath

Contents

& Appendix

Strategic Report

Glossary & Company Information

Strategic Report

Highlights 1
Our transformational growth 3
Our business model 4
Our investment case 5
Our people 6
Our portfolio 7
Our partnerships 8
Chair's statement 9
Chief Executive's review 11
Key performance indicators 15
Case studies 18
Portfolio review 26
Market review 37
Chief Financial Officer's review 51
Stakeholder engagement 58
ESG report 68
Task Force on Climate-related
Financial Disclosures
89
Principal risks and uncertainties 98
Viability statement 109
Non-financial and sustainability
information statement
111
Governance Report 112
Financial Statements 161
ESG Data Sets Appendix 210
NewRiver team Glossary and Company Information 214

member using the Royal Mail locker at the Exchange, IIford

Transformational growth

has created increased scale and delivered significant earnings growth

In December 2024 we completed a major corporate transaction to acquire listed retail real estate company Capital & Regional plc for £151 million, funded through a combination of cash and shares, following a successful and oversubscribed equity raise.

The acquisition increased the scale of our portfolio through the combination of six complementary shopping centres with a similarly low-risk tenant profile and strong income growth potential.

The Capital & Regional assets are performing well, with integration and synergies on track following the acquisition.

NewRiver balance sheet UFFO Annualised
assets increased increased gross rent
+65% 25% +70%
vs FY24 vs FY24 vs FY24
Cost Robust capital Expected
synergies structure maintained to deliver
£6.21
million
expected to be fully
unlocked on an annualised
basis within 12 months
of completion
3.5%
average cost of debt with
improved maturity profile
mid-to-high
teens
accretion to UFFO per share
  1. Refer to page 54

Enhanced equity profile

with greater share liquidity, a broader shareholder base and larger weightings in key indices

NewRiver REIT plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2025 Governance Report Financial Statements ESG Data Sets 4 & Appendix Glossary & Company Information Strategic Report

A growth-driven business model

Disciplined

capital allocation

We assess the long-term resilience of our assets, with capital allocation decisions made by comparing risk adjusted returns on our assets to those available from other uses of capital. Capital allocation options include investing into our portfolio, acquiring assets in the direct real estate market and share buybacks. Assets can be acquired either on our balance sheet or in capital partnerships.

1 3 2

Flexible Balance Sheet

with a committed ESG strategy embedded across our business

Our operating platform is underpinned by a conservative, predominantly unsecured balance sheet. We are focused on maintaining our prudent covenant headroom position and have access to significant cash reserves which provide us with the flexibility to pursue opportunities which support our strategy for growth.

Leveraging our platform

We leverage our market leading platform to enhance and protect income returns through active asset management across our assets and for assets we manage on behalf of our capital partnerships; the latter provides enhanced returns through asset management fee income and the opportunity to receive promote fees.

Our strategy is delivered by our People, Portfolio, Partnerships and Performance

Our business model is underpinned by a high-quality portfolio, expert team, strong working relationships, data-driven insight, robust systems and a commitment to sustainability to support the delivery of positive performance for the long-term

How we've delivered on our business model this year

1 Disciplined capital allocation

Acquisition of Capital & Regional for £151 million at a significant discount to NTA

+70% +65%

annualised gross rent increase in NewRiver balance sheet assets

2 Leveraging our platform

Acquisition of Ellandi, expanding our Capital Partnership platform, together with expansion of existing Capital Partnerships and appointment on two new local authority mandates

£1.5 billion £3 million

Capital Partnerships assets under management Capital Partnerships fee income

Capital Partnerships assets increase in net fee income

39 +19%

(compound annual growth rate over 5 years)

This combined activity has further enhanced our expertise and scale; extended our capabilities to include destination assets; and increased our fee income

3 Flexible balance sheet

£62.1 million

cash

5.4x Net debt: EBITDA

  • Low-cost debt, predominantly unsecured
  • Successful oversubscribed equity raise • Significant undrawn cash and liquidity
  • Enhanced financial flexibility and scale

Investment case

Why we are the leading real estate company to invest in, partner with and work at

We are the leading listed specialist retail real estate company, focused on delivering long-term, reliable and recurring returns and creating thriving communities

Our team, portfolio and scale mean we have unrivalled expertise and knowledge of the consumer, retail and capital markets.

Why work at NewRiver?

  • Growing portfolio creates career growth
  • High-performing teams across asset management, finance, strategic
  • analysis, development and operations
  • 59% of our team have worked at
  • NewRiver for 5+ years
  • Flexibility and diversity
  • Named one of the Sunday Times Best Places to Work in the UK for two consecutive years

Why NewRiver's portfolio is well-positioned?

  • High-quality portfolio of shopping centres and retail parks diversified across the UK
  • Focused on essential goods and services catering for the everyday household budget of communities nationwide
  • Our shoppers have a high weekly frequency and short travel time
  • Our portfolio outperformed the MSCI Shopping Centre and Retail Warehouse benchmarks over the 3 & 5 year periods
  • Sustainable rental cash flows

People Portfolio Partnerships

Why partner with NewRiver?

  • Partnerships with private equity, local authorities and institutions
  • Ability to co-invest
  • Leverage our market-leading platform & team

Company Information

  • Specialist sector expertise & relationships
  • Consistently strong operational track record
  • Data-driven insight & decision-making
  • Strong listed governance and ESG credentials

Our people, portfolio and partnerships help drive our performance

Performance

How NewRiver's approach is delivering

  • Increased portfolio customer spend
  • Continued operational performance
  • Significant UFFO per share growth
  • Return to capital growth
  • Strong financial position maintained
  • Increased balance sheet scale

NewRiver REIT plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2025 Governance Report Financial Statements ESG Data Sets 6 & Appendix Glossary & Company Information Strategic Report

Our People

Specialist, expert and motivated people drive performance

  • Diverse and talented team across asset management, development, finance, strategic analysis and operations, led by a dynamic Board and Executive team
  • Specialist and passionate team dedicated to delivering results
  • Our growing portfolio provides extensive career progression, focused on developing talent from within the business
  • Diverse, flexible and modern culture and working environment
  • Strong listed governance and ESG credentials

23% Ethnic diversity 50:50 Male:Female ratio

Our people performance

Award winning

named one of the Sunday Times Best Places to Work for two consecutive years

Market leading

scalable platform with expert retail real estate specialist team

Highly experienced

Board and Executive team

2,500 hours

professional training across the company

Low absentee rate of 0%

Our Portfolio

Right assets in the right locations

Our well-positioned portfolio is focused on providing essential goods, services and experiences to local communities. Our assets are hand-picked to provide space for successful and growing retail and leisure operators, including those with a growing omni-channel provision. We provide space at affordable average rents in locations across the UK; and we now have a greater exposure to London assets.

shopping centres

retail parks

annual rent

tenancies

sq foot total area

  1. See Glossary, like-for-like valuation growth.

long-term leasing transactions

+17.5%

vs previous rent

Our Partnerships

We leverage our market leading platform to manage assets on behalf of multiple partners

14 Capital Partners creating well-diversified fee income

Our Capital Partnership portfolio focuses on four core asset types that provide affordable and well-located space for occupiers:

  • • Essential-led shopping centres
  • • Destination-led shopping centres
  • • Retail parks
  • • Regeneration opportunities

39

Capital Partnership assets (FY24: 23)

18

retail parks

shopping centres

21

Our market-leading platform provides:

  • A specialist expert team
  • An ability to co-invest as well as asset manage
  • Data-driven, performance-focused outputs
  • Robust operational track record
  • Extensive sector relationships and geographical scale
  • Town centre and regeneration masterplanning expertise
  • Strong governance and ESG credentials

Our partnership performance Partnership segmentation

Delivered growth in our Capital Partnership portfolio through the acquisition of Ellandi in July 2024, expansion of existing Capital Partnerships and appointment on 2 new local authority mandates

£3 million

£1.5 billion

+16% growth vs FY24 Capital Partnerships total fee income

+88% growth vs FY24 Capital Partnerships assets under management

10.8 million sq ft

+135% growth vs FY24 Capital Partnerships area

Chair's statement

It has been a transformational year for NewRiver with the acquisition of Capital & Regional for £151 million which completed on the 10 December 2024. This has materially increased our scale, with our balance sheet portfolio value increasing by 65%, net assets by 35% and our Underlying Funds From Operations by 25% with further material earnings growth anticipated in the new financial year. We believe that the acquisition has a strong strategic, operational and financial rationale that will deliver significant benefits to all stakeholders.

Lynn Fordham Chair

Strategic Report

& Appendix

Glossary & Company Information

Chair's statement continued

To partly fund the acquisition, we undertook an equity placing and retail offer which was heavily oversubscribed and priced at a modest premium to the prevailing share price. We believe the success of our equity placing is reflective of increased investor confidence in NewRiver, the attractiveness of the Capital & Regional transaction and a recognition that our marketplace has been improving. The placing enabled us to enhance our equity market profile with an expanded and strengthened shareholder register as well as enhanced trading liquidity in our shares. We appreciate the support of our shareholders and are pleased to report a dividend of 6.5 pence per share this year, comfortably fully covered by Underlying Funds From Operations.

The last year has seen another strong operational performance from NewRiver, yet again in sharp contrast to sentiment towards real estate in the equity capital markets. The Chief Executive's Review covers this in detail, but the highlights include: another year of strong leasing performance, despite the challenging consumer market; continued progress on disposing or improving the workout assets leaving a strong core portfolio; progress on the key regeneration schemes; and good revenue growth in capital partnerships. This has all been achieved alongside further progress on our ESG journey with continued improvement in our GRESB score to 80 and for the fourth consecutive year we retained our Gold sBPR award from EPRA. We are also proud to be an Accredited Real Living Wage Employer and also to be recognised as one of the Sunday Times' "Best Places to Work".

In what has been a very busy year, none of this would have been possible without the hard work and support of the team and my colleagues on the Board. We have a fantastic team at NewRiver who are focused on delivering the best returns for shareholders and we are all grateful to our shareholders for your support throughout the year.

"We believe the success of our equity placing as reflective of increased investor confidence in NewRiver, the attractiveness of the Capital & Regional transaction and a recognition that our marketplace has been improving."

NewRiver REIT plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2025 Governance Report Financial Statements ESG Data Sets 11 Strategic Report

& Appendix

Glossary & Company Information

Chief Executive's review

Transformation & Growth

Overview

Reiterating the Chair's statement, the acquisition of Capital & Regional has been transformational for the business and sets a strong platform for further growth. Price paid is critically important in determining future returns and, in that regard, we believe we acquired Capital & Regional at an attractive level. Capital & Regional's assets were valued in June 2024 at £350 million resulting in net assets of £175 million, which compares favourably to the price that we paid of £151 million, based on the middle-market closing price of NewRiver's shares on 10 December 2024, a discount of 14%.

The transaction affords us the opportunity to unlock significant cost synergies that will deliver material earnings accretion. In total we expect to unlock approximately £6.2 million of recurring annual cost synergies, the majority of which are expected to be effective in FY26. These cost savings will arise from the removal of duplicative functions and the rationalisation of listing and other administrative and operational expenses.

Allan Lockhart Chief Executive NewRiver REIT plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2025 Governance Report Financial Statements ESG Data Sets 12 Strategic Report

& Appendix

Glossary & Company Information

Our aim remains to preserve a robust and conservatively leveraged balance sheet in line with our financial policies and guidance. Following completion of the acquisition, we maintained a weighted average cost of 3.5% across drawn debt of £444 million with a diversified debt maturity profile and no maturity on drawn debt until January 2027. We will also benefit from the enhanced financial flexibility and expected cost of capital benefits resulting from increased scale. At the year end, our LTV was 42.3%, in-line with post Capital & Regional acquisition proforma but ahead of guidance of <40%. We were clear at the time of the acquisition that we intended to return LTV to within our guidance level through a modest and achievable level of disposals, and immediately post year end we completed the disposal of the Abbey Centre in Newtownabbey, which reduces our LTV to c.38% meaning we are within guidance with capacity to invest into accretive asset acquisitions.

Whilst our primary focus has been on M&A activity in the year, this did not detract from our operational performance, which has been excellent with another period of good leasing performance both in terms of volume and pricing. Consequently, occupancy and tenant retention rates remained high, demonstrating that we have the right assets in the right locations let to the right occupiers, as well as reflecting the quality of our asset management.

During the 12 months ended 31 March 2025, we delivered £30.5 million of UFFO, equating to 8.1 pence on a per share basis. As a result, we have declared a fully covered final dividend of 3.5 pence per share, and a total dividend for FY25 of 6.5 pence per share, representing a payout equivalent to 80% of UFFO which is in-line with our dividend policy. Our EPRA Net Tangible Assets Per Share at the full year was

102 pence, compared to 106 pence per share at the half year, in-line with the proforma guidance communicated in our half year results and pleasingly our portfolio valuation returned to growth at the full year.

A market place supportive of growth

The UK consumer remains strong, with elevated savings, stable house prices, low levels of unemployment and wages exceeding inflation since June 2023. This has supported retail and supermarket spending which, based on Lloyds Bank data, has delivered year-on-year sales growth of +1.5% for the 12 months to March 2025. This continued growth is a solid result given that retail accounts for 27% of Lloyds Bank's 26 million customers' annual spend and supermarkets account for a further 19% and is despite consumers having to increase their essential spending such as on mortgages +8% year-on-year and council tax +13%.

Whilst the retail, hospitality and leisure sectors have been undoubtedly impacted by the April 2025 increases in national insurance and the minimum wage, other costs for retailers have been reducing. This includes energy, shipping costs and factory gate prices. The benefit of an appreciating Pound versus the US Dollar is also supporting lower prices especially for non-food retailers buying products in Asia, with a potential increased price negotiating power for UK retailers with suppliers as result of the US imposed tariffs on China. For UK food retailers their supply chains are more orientated to European and UK markets and as such US tariffs are unlikely to have a material impact. That said, US tariffs have been impacting consumer confidence and in turn will potentially lead to a slowdown in economic growth. We will monitor our customer spending data carefully.

Our occupational market is in its strongest position for a decade having navigated significant challenges, with vacancy continuing to decline across the sector and rental growth starting to emerge for assets in the right locations. We believe this for three key reasons: firstly, much of the corporate restructuring has already taken place with the weaker retailers removed from the market; secondly, most national retailers have focused on operational efficiency and margin growth, leading to improved financial results; and lastly, pure online retail is going through its own period of disruption with the line between in-store and online sales increasingly blurred and omnichannel retailers gaining market share. This is positive for our sector as the physical store is at the centre of omnichannel retailing, arguably the genuine last mile fulfilment and a business-critical channel for retail today and into the future.

Investment volumes in 2024 rebounded versus 2023 for both shopping centres and retail parks. Shopping centre volumes were up 70% at £2.0 billion reflecting improving investment sentiment as the sector offers one of the highest day one yield spreads to the 10-year Gilt. The first quarter has been relatively muted due to limited supply rather than a lack of demand. Retail park volumes surged by 75% to total £3.3 billion. Investor demand remains broad based, underpinned by strong occupational demand dynamics, very low vacancy and constrained future development limiting new supply of space.

Investor demand for both shopping centres and retail parks is further supported by increasing competition from debt providers, which is resulting in lower margins and higher LTVs.

Our portfolio is well positioned to deliver consistent growth

Total portfolio value increased by 65% to £897 million, principally as a result of the Capital & Regional acquisition, whose portfolio comprised of six community shopping centres predominantly located in London and South East England and principally let to low-risk, essential and value-oriented retailers that are highly complementary to NewRiver's existing portfolio. In addition, through this acquisition, we now own Snozone, the UK's largest indoor ski slope operator with profitable centres in Milton Keynes, Yorkshire and Madrid (Spain).

Our Core Shopping Centres and Retail Parks, which represent 94% of our total portfolio value, continue to perform well as evidenced by high occupancy, high tenant retention rate and another period of strong leasing and customer sales performance. The active demand for space across our Core Portfolio, which is broad based, is reflective of our portfolio positioning towards essential based retail and services, which is the right place to be in a higher interest and cost environment.

"The acquisition of Capital & Regional has been transformational for the business and sets a strong platform for further growth."

Strategic Report

& Appendix

Chief Executive's review continued

Over the past 12 months we have been working with Lloyds Bank, combining high-quality consumer spending data with our retail market expertise. NewRiver's analysis, informed by Lloyds Bank data, has provided greater insight into the profile of our shoppers and performance of our assets and to date, we have detailed customer spending insights on assets representing 85% of our portfolio by value. Our analysis shows that for the year ending 31 March 2025, in-store retail sales increased by +4.3% relative to the prior year, significantly outperforming the wider market, demonstrating that our portfolio is proving consistently popular with consumers. Based on the sales performance of our tenants within our portfolio over the reporting period, our current occupational cost ratio is 8.3% which is highly affordable, and which partly explains our excellent leasing performance.

The success that our assets have had over the year in attracting increased customer spend is clearly good for our tenants and this has translated into another year of strong leasing performance. Over the year within our Core Shopping Centres, we completed 571,600 sq ft of leasing transactions on average +5.4% above valuer's ERV, which was the 5th consecutive financial year of positive leasing spreads, and +17.2% above previous rent. We have also seen a steady improvement over the last three financial years of leasing transactions versus previous passing rent, and aggregating those total leasing transactions, the compound annual growth rate over the last three years is positive +0.7% on a 8.5 year previous lease length. Given the substantial disruption the market has seen, this is an excellent result. The stability that we have in our Core Shopping Centres is also reflected in the vacancy rate which is only 4% and where we have a retention rate of 89%.

Our Retail Parks are also delivering excellent operational performance with leasing transactions completed at +20.6% versus the valuer's ERV and +19.1% versus the previous passing rent. The depth of demand is demonstrated by the vacancy rate which sits at only 3%, a tenant retention rate at 100% and the average compound annual growth rate over the last three years versus previous passing rent of +0.9% on a 15.5 year previous lease length.

Our Regeneration and Work Out assets represent only 6% of our total portfolio by value reflecting the good progress made in reducing our exposure through disposals particularly in relation to Work Out. Over the year we have made good progress with the remaining few assets. In Burgess Hill, we are close to exchanging a conditional contract to form a joint venture with Mid Sussex Council to deliver our regeneration project. Importantly no further equity is required from NewRiver as the project is expected to benefit from grant funding and an attractive facility from Homes England. Terms on pre-lets have been agreed with a major food discounter and budget hotel operator and a sale of part to a residential developer. We are targeting to commence project works at the end of 2025.

In Cardiff, our remaining key Work Out asset, planning consent was received to repurpose this shopping centre into an 80,000 sq ft multi-entertainment centre that will include numerous social competitive offerings as well as a range of food and beverage provisions. We are now in the final stages of agreeing a long-term indexed lease to one of the UK's leading leisure operators for the entirety. Project works are due to commence imminently, and upon completion will deliver a significant net operating income increase.

Revenue growth in Capital Partnerships

Capital Partnerships are an important component of our strategy to deliver earnings growth in a capital light way and so we were delighted to acquire Ellandi in July 2024. The acquisition is aligned with NewRiver's strategy to expand our Capital Partnership business over the medium term, leveraging our position as one of the largest specialist retail real estate asset managers in the UK. Investment partners are increasingly recognising the importance of track record and specialism in this highly operational asset class.

Today our Capital Partnership business has genuine scale, with assets under management of £1.5 billion across a portfolio of 21 shopping centres and 18 retail parks, with 14 different partners. Our Partner mandates include private equity, banks, an institution and local authorities. Total annualised revenue net of costs is currently £3.8 million and the compound annual growth rate in our Capital Partnership net revenues over the last five years has been 19%. We see no reason why we cannot maintain that growth rate over the next five years.

"In-store retail sales increased by 4.3% relative to the prior year, significantly outperforming the wider market, demonstrating that our portfolio is proving consistently popular with consumers."

Strategic Report

& Appendix

Glossary & Company Information

People & data drive performance

Retail is a fast moving and dynamic market and as such has become highly operational for both owners and occupiers of retail real estate. For several years now, we have continued to invest in our people, data and systems which we believe allows us to make better decisions, improves our operational efficiency and delivers market leading performance.

We have a fantastic culture at NewRiver with a passionate team of people with considerable experience and expertise in real estate and finance. We do not take our carefully nurtured culture for granted as we continuously invest to ensure that we have the most talented, agile and happy team we possibly can.

We are strong believers that access to high quality data allows us to make better decisions whether that relates to capital deployment, leasing, tenant mix, marketing, car parking pricing or overall risk assessment of assets. We know that many of our occupiers are also using data to enhance their customer experience, and we believe that it is important that we also have a great insight into the millions of customers that visit our assets.

The most important data, in our opinion, is live consumer spending. This is why we have started working with Lloyds Bank to combine high-quality consumer spending data with our retail market expertise and now have access to spending data on 85% of our portfolio by value which is updated quarterly. This data provides us a detailed insight into the health and activity of our consumer base and performance of our retailers. It includes store-by-store sales turnover, the online contribution from that store, where customers are coming from, where else they are spending, frequency of visits, average transaction values, a customer demographic profile and interestingly,

where customers tend to make their first purchase, their second purchase and beyond. The application and analysis of this data touches almost every asset management decision that we make and therefore will significantly enhance our capabilities to make the right decisions in the future to further enhance our asset business plans.

Handling a greater volume of data to inform real-time decision-making processes requires highly organised and increasingly automated systems. Several years ago, we invested in a fully integrated property management and accounting system with highly user-friendly dashboards accessed via both laptop and mobile and we continue to invest in the phased enhancement of this whilst also ensuring that we maintain strong cyber security.

ESG - progress to net zero

Five years on from our original net-zero target baseline year of FY20, we are 93% of the way to achieving our SBTi near-term target to reduce our absolute scope 1 & 2 emissions by 42% by 2030, having achieved a total reduction of 39% at the end of FY25. Throughout our journey so far, we've disclosed our energy and emissions performance on both an absolute and like-for-like basis, to ensure transparency as to emissions reductions that have been achieved through our proactivity in the pursuit of our objective to minimise our environmental impact, vs emissions reductions that have arisen from changes to our portfolio composition.

Between FY24 and FY25, across the existing NewRiver portfolio we saw a 13% reduction in absolute scope 1 emissions and a 12% reduction in absolute scope 2 emissions, whilst on a like-for-like basis, we reduced gas and electricity consumption within the landlordcontrolled areas of our portfolio by 10% and 2%

respectively, owing to energy conservation measures implemented at our assets. Alongside our portfolio emissions reductions, we've now reached the end date of our corporate net-zero target. We've abated our corporate scope 1&2 emissions through our move to a highefficiency, all-electric office, and procuring renewable electricity. We've measured our FY25 corporate scope 3 emissions at 560 tonnes, which we have offset via the Woodland Trust to bring them to a net-zero level.

This year, we improved our GRESB score from 72/100 to 80/100, earning us an additional "green star" representing our improved performance relative to our peer group. We retained our 'B' rating from the CDP and achieved our goal of improving performance within the "Emissions Reduction Initiatives and Low Carbon Products" aspect of the assessment, which was identified as a key improvement opportunity in our FY24 Annual Report and Accounts, and for which we achieved an 'A' rating this year. For a fourth consecutive year, we also retained our Gold sBPR award from EPRA in recognition of the high transparency and comparability of our ESG performance disclosures, which is a key indicator of upholding our core ESG objective of Leading in Governance and Disclosure. Strengthening our fulfilment of this objective, we became an Accredited Real Living Wage Employer and are proud to have retained our recognition as one of the Sunday Times' "Best Places to Work".

Outlook - material earnings growth for the year ahead

The benefits of the Capital & Regional transaction are starting to flow through, with further benefit to be realised in FY26 and FY27 as the cost synergies are fully unlocked.

Our aim is to deliver consistent market leading earnings growth beyond just the benefits of the Capital & Regional acquisition, even taking into account likely higher finance costs in a few years' time. Our key growth drivers are net rental income growth, the signs for which are positive and should lead to valuation growth allowing us to access some of our untapped liquidity for earnings accretive acquisitions, continuing revenue growth from Capital Partnerships, for which our five year track record of growth is supportive, and capital recycling, which offers us the opportunity to deliver further earnings growth.

Our long-held view of the importance of income returns today serves us well. Our portfolio is performing well, supported by a highly experienced and motivated team underpinned by a strong balance sheet, and whilst the macro environment has been volatile, we have a clear pathway to deliver attractive returns for our shareholders.

Delivering growth

Key

How our KPIs align with our business model, strategic objectives, ESG strategy and Executive remuneration

Underlying Funds From Operations1

Underlying Funds From Operations (UFFO) measures underlying operational profits and excludes one-off or non-cash adjustments. We consider this to be the most appropriate measure of the underlying performance of the business, as it reflects our generation of operating profits.

Environmental, Social and Governance

Our performance

£30.5m

Total UFFO for the year was £30.5 million, increased from £24.4 million the previous year principally as result of the acquisition of Capital & Regional plc.

Link to strategy, ESG and Remuneration Link to strategy, ESG and Remuneration Link to strategy, ESG and Remuneration

Loan to Value

Loan to Value (LTV) is the proportion of our properties that are funded by borrowings. The measure is presented on a proportionally consolidated basis. Maintaining an LTV of less than 50% is one of our five key Financial Policies and in addition our medium-term guidance is to maintain an LTV of less than 40%.

17

25

The admin cost ratio is total administrative expenses as a proportion of gross revenue on a proportionally consolidated basis, including our share of administrative expenses and gross revenue from joint ventures and associates. It is a measure of our operational efficiency.

Our performance

42.3%

LTV increased following the acquisition of Capital & Regional plc, however pro forma LTV reduced to c.3.8% following post balance sheet disposal of Abbey Centre, Newtownabbey, now within <40% guidance.

Our performance

14.1%

In recent years our admin cost ratio increased as we waited to deploy the proceeds of the disposal activity completed between FY22 and FY24. In the second half of FY25 we completed the acquisition of Capital & Regional plc, which has reduced the admin cost ratio in FY25.

21 22 23 24 25

15 16

14

Glossary & Company Information

Key performance indicators continued

Key

How our KPIs align with our business model, strategic objectives, ESG strategy and Executive remuneration

F
Financial
C
Corporate
O
Operational
Our Business Model
1
Disciplined capital allocation
2
Leveraging our platform
3
Flexible Balance Sheet
£
Remuneration

Environmental, Social and Governance

Total Property Return

Total Property Return is a measure of the income and capital growth generated across our portfolio. It is calculated by MSCI Real Estate on our behalf, using independent valuers. We assess our performance against the market by comparing our returns to the MSCI All Retail benchmark.

Total Accounting Return F F F

Total Accounting Return (TAR) is the change in EPRA Net Tangible Assets (NTA) per share over the year, plus dividends paid, as a percentage of the EPRA NTA at the start of the year. TAR performance relative to UK-listed Real Estate Investment Trusts is a key metric used in setting the Long-Term Incentive Plan.

Interest cover

Interest cover is the ratio of our operating profit to our net financing costs, on a proportionally consolidated basis, including our share of operating profit and net financing costs from joint ventures and associates. Maintaining interest cover of more than 2.0x is one of our five key Financial Policies.

Our portfolio delivered a Total Return of +7.8%, an improvement on the FY24 Total Return of +4.8%. Our portfolio continues to outperform the MSCI Shopping Centre and Retail Warehouse benchmarks over the three and five year periods. Over a 12-month period, the portfolio's Income Return outperformed the market by +150bps.

Link to strategy, ESG and Remuneration Link to strategy, ESG and Remuneration Link to strategy, ESG and Remuneration

Our performance

+7.8%

Our performance

-5.9%

Although the valuation of the property portfolio and UFFO per share both increased during FY25, Total Accounting Return was significantly impacted by equity issuance and transaction costs associated with the transformational acquisition of Capital & Regional plc.

Our performance

6.0x

Interest cover maintained, significant headroom to our Financial Policy and in line with the prior year position at 6.0x.

Key performance indicators continued

Key

How our KPIs align with our business model, strategic objectives, ESG strategy and Executive remuneration

Our Business Model

Occupancy

Retail occupancy is the estimated rental value of occupied retail units expressed as a percentage of the total estimated rental value of the retail portfolio, excluding development activities.

GRESB is the leading sustainability benchmark for the global real estate sector. Assessments are guided by factors that investors and the industry consider to be material in the sustainability performance of real estate asset investments, resulting in an overall score marked out of 100. Improvements in our GRESB score help measure the effectiveness of our ESG programme.

70

72 80

"Well positioned to deliver significant earnings growth."

Environmental, Social and Governance

Our performance

96.1%

We continue to maintain a high occupancy level with combined retail occupancy at 31 March 2025, including Capital & Regional plc, of 96.1%. Note that NewRiver's standalone occupancy at 31 March 2025 was 97.5%, in line with prior years.

Our performance

80

60 68

We improved our GRESB score from 72 to 80, earning an additional 'green star' signifying improved performance relative to other GRESB participants, and again achieved a perfect score in the Management module (30/30) and retained full marks in Social (18/18) and Governance (20/20).

21 22 23 24 25

Link to strategy, ESG and Remuneration Link to strategy, ESG and Remuneration

NewRiver REIT plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2025 Governance Report Financial Statements ESG Data Sets 18

Our growing portfolio

Owned asset, retail park

Dumfries Cuckoo Bridge Retail Park

Creating value

Why we like Cuckoo Bridge

Acquired in June 2016, Cuckoo Bridge is a leading retail park in Dumfries, Scotland, with a retail catchment of c. 89,000 residents living within a 30-minute drive time.

Our occupiers are a mix of grocery, DIY, discount, homeware and a drive thru coffee pod, providing a well-located and accessible retail offer with a range of affordable goods.

NewRiver ownership 100% 91% occupancy; fully let on completion of new lettings

Occupational cost ratio 7.3%

In-store sales growth accounting for online spend contribution +5.6%

Active asset management

This year we secured a 15-year lease with Sainsbury's on improved rental terms, 60% above previous rent and valuer's ERV.

Sainsbury's will take a 48,100 sq ft supermarket, swiftly re-activating the former Homebase, creating the first Sainsbury's in the local area and new jobs.

Post year end, we secured planning consent for a new 7,500 sq ft Next store, demonstrating the strong demand for the asset and our retail park portfolio.

Since acquisition we have completed a lease extension with Dunelm, introduced a new Food Warehouse and Bensons for Beds, and created a Click & Collect pod for Next.

Strategic Report

Glossary &

Our growing portfolio continued

Owned asset, core shopping centre Newton Mearns The Avenue Shopping Centre

Creating value

Why we like The Avenue

Located in the heart of an affluent suburb of Glasgow, The Avenue is a popular community shopping centre providing a mix of both leading national brands and quality independent local retailers, anchored by ASDA and M&S.

The centre is an immaculate and bright retail destination and benefits from over 900 free car parking spaces, as well as being well-serviced by local bus routes.

NewRiver ownership 100%

Occupational cost ratio 10.9%

Occupancy 100%

In-store sales growth accounting for online spend contribution +2.2%

Active asset management

Strategic Report

Our retailers perform well here, and during the year lease renewals and new lettings collectively generated £909,000 in annualised income, a +2.7% increase above the valuer's ERV, and included Timpson, Boots, Yours Clothing and Santander.

Marks & Spencer's confirmed their longterm commitment to the centre through a major store re-fit and signing of a new 15-year lease.

Activating value on surplus land and helping create new homes for the area, we exchanged on an agreement for sale of land to a housing developer, providing a capital receipt and supporting future spend for the centre.

Our growing portfolio continued

Owned asset, former Capital & Regional shopping centre Walthamstow 17&Central Shopping Centre

Meet the team

Gavin Cockayne, General Manager

Q&A

How did you get into retail?

I genuinely love retail. My first retail job was with Burtons in 1994, part time at university. I remember one early job was as a denim expert, training the team on how to fold and sell denim.

I took the fast-track course in management and spent 20 years working in the West End of London for various companies, including Topshop on Oxford Street. I learnt a lot about what good retail looks like.

I then went into department store management in Oxford Street Debenhams and in Westfield, White City. The natural progression was shopping centre management. I was curious, having been a tenant for all those years, what it would be like from the other side as a centre manager.

I've managed the centre for three years and have been a shopping centre manager for five years. Starting off on the tenant side helps so much because it gives me a better understanding of what our occupiers need to be successful, and I have first-hand experience with operations and deliveries so I can add more value to the tenants. I find the support side of my role rewarding – working with smaller independents as well as larger nationals and helping all of the managers and owners to be part of one successful destination. Everyone should be on the same team – we all want customers to flock to the centre and spend in the shops. We have The Mall app for our tenants and have quarterly tenant meetings to discuss updates on how the previous quarter has been and progress on the development – helping tenants stay enthused and feel included.

clear NewRiver operates similarly and wants the best for every centre. It's been the smoothest transition.

The communications from NewRiver during the whole process were good and I was able to share with the rest of the team, helping everyone to feel informed every step of the way.

How does the centre differentiate from other retail destinations in the region?

Our USP is the bond between the centre and our local community. Over the years, we've built excellent relationships with the local charities, community groups, and the local council. Walthamstow has been through mass gentrification over the last 10/15 years, and it just continues and evolves.

How have you found working with NewRiver since the acquisition? Very positive. I remember meeting NewRiver's Head of Asset Management for the first time, around six months before the acquisition. My first impression was great, she was so personable, knowledgeable and was genuinely excited about the potential acquisition. Since then, every interaction with each member of the NewRiver team has been great. Like Capital & Regional before, it's

Strategic Report

& Appendix

Glossary & Company Information

New residential blocks, part of the phased regeneration strategy

Walthamstow

17&Central Shopping Centre

How do you engage with your local council?

Our local council are brilliant; we've done a lot of great work together. The collaboration between us sets us apart. The community has a significantly strong bond and really pulls together and stands as one.

The council are very forward-thinking and have done a lot of work in the town, for example with the Soho Theatre which they acquired, a Grade II listed landmark building, which hosted the Beatles and the Rolling Stones back in the 60s. We have great relationships with the operators in the town and around the centre, and these kinds of investment are beneficial for the whole town.

We have agreed to work with the council and other key stakeholders for a social investment fund which focuses on how we can make Walthamstow even stronger, and support those who have come out of prison, or need different skills, getting back into work, those who aren't in education, who haven't had any training. This is an exciting new project.

We are a local community shopping centre and have approximately 1,000 staff from across our tenants. A huge number of these are from the borough and were recruited locally.

Portsmouth University has come to Walthamstow and plans to have 3,000 students by 2030. Their campus is just up opposite the station.

What excites you most about the centre's future?

We have completed Phase 1 of the centre's redevelopment – the building of the two residential tower blocks – 495 apartments.

Phase 2 is the station box, which is underway now and will create an additional 80,000 sq ft of retail and 43 residential units. TfL will then build the station, which will improve access and pedestrian flow, and we expect that to increase our footfall.

Phases 3 & 4 will extend the centre onto the square and around the side to Lidl, with some additional retail, some low rise residential and a new public square, to reflect how the centre has transformed over the years.

All of this will make 17&Central even more of a destination and we have various major national brands seeking to come to the centre. We're looking at the transformation being complete in the next five years.

Our market-leading partnerships

Capital Partnership asset, destination shopping centre Milton Keynes Midsummer Place

REVO Awards 2024

Best Asset Management Initiative

Background

When our Capital Partnership team first took on Midsummer Place, it was battling high vacancy, a stalled development and unsustainable leases. The centre, once a hub for high-end fashion, was struggling to adapt to shifting consumer habits. Today the centre is a thriving retail destination offering retail, food & beverage and leisure – and is now a place shoppers want to come, and retailers want to be.

The asset management strategy is delivering – with a well curated and enhanced occupier mix leading to a high occupancy, including the reactivation of former vacant space; together with the successful redevelopment of The Boulevard into a vibrant F&B quarter and quality upgrades to the physical environment.

Key achievements

  • Income stabilised: Leases renewed on market terms, much improved occupancy and enhanced service charge management – delivering immediate financial stability.
  • Curated occupier mix: Attracted new operators including Apple, upsized existing brands, and secured new anchors including Sports Direct, Flannels and Lane7, all contributing to driving a £2 million net operating income uplift.
  • Strategic investments: Re-let 126,000 sq ft of former Debenhams and re-energised The Boulevard into a vibrant food & beverage hub with eight new pods offering artisan and international cuisine – generating healthy turnovers. By leveraging the space's horseshoe shape, high ceilings and natural light, the team created a welcoming environment with street furniture, providing a place for visitors to relax and ultimately increase dwell time.
  • Community & social impact: Supported local businesses through pop-ups, free table tennis initiatives with Table Tennis England, and social enterprise schemes. Moreover, over 70 new jobs were created following The Boulevard's transformation.

Strategic Report

Developing our people

Growing talent

Megan Ruffell, Junior Asset Manager, NewRiver's first apprentice in 2017

Q&A

Why did you choose an apprenticeship?

My journey at NewRiver began in 2017, joining as a school leaver as the business's first apprentice through WhiteHat, a programme run by Multiverse. I was really drawn to the idea of an apprenticeship, learning on the job while gaining hands on experience felt like a valuable and practical way to build skills. During my two years as Business Administration Apprentice, I was fortunate to gain a breadth of exposure into the real estate sector, working closely with the property and finance teams, and with the support of NewRiver, I embarked on my second apprenticeship specialising in the real estate sector, going on to gain my associate RICS qualification.

What did you value most about

your apprenticeship?

An apprenticeship provides a student with hands on experience allowing them to apply their learnings to everyday tasks and projects, its an intense but highly practical learning path. The team at NewRiver made a huge impact to this – taking time to explain and giving me autonomy to grow – and the culture is fun and collaborative too which makes a big difference.

The opportunities and support NewRiver have provided me with have helped me carve out a career path I didn't know existed at school, and the career progression within the business has been exceptional.

Where do you see your future career?

With the support of NewRiver, I am currently in my third year of a four-year BSc (Hons) Real Estate Management degree at the University of the Built Environment, which includes the opportunity to complete my APC. I aspire to build a career in commercial real estate asset management, a field I find particularly compelling due to its dynamic nature, the diversity of stakeholders involved, the evolving landscape of retail, and the strategic challenges presented by managing retail assets.

What has been the most challenging aspect of your apprenticeship?

Strategic Report

The apprenticeship programmes I have completed have all been online which can feel isolating however we have a collegiate team, and I was also encouraged to engage with NewRiver's key stakeholders as there are a number of apprentices across the business's network, that has been beneficial.

What advice would you give to someone considering applying for an apprenticeship?

Grab the opportunity with both hands!

Summary of programme:

• Level 3 Diploma in Business Administration

October 2017 – April 2019 (18 months) Completed foundational training in business operations and administration.

• Level 3 Commercial Property Surveying Technician Apprenticeship

September 2019 – September 2021 (2 years) Gained practical and technical knowledge of commercial property surveying, leading to eligibility for Associate RICS (AssocRICS) designation.

• BSc (Hons) Real Estate Management

Currently studying (4-year undergraduate programme) This accredited degree provides a pathway to completing the RICS Assessment of Professional Competence (APC), enabling progression toward full Chartered Surveyor (MRICS) status and a career in commercial real estate asset management.

Investing in our platform

Data-driven performance

Lawrence Fisher, Head of Strategy and Investment Analysis

How our data-driven approach drives our decision-making

Insight from our Lloyds Bank Customer Spend Data platform

NewRiver portfolio in store sales growth accounting for online spend continuation (y-o-y)

+4.3%

This was a significant outperformance relative to the UK average growth in retail and supermarket spend of

+1.5%

Accounting for online spend contribution where the customer had previously spent in store, the year-on-year growth figure rises to

+4.9%

Q&A

How does NewRiver use data across the business?

Robust data from across our entire business underpins our strategic decision-making.

Strategic Report

The combination of our market-leading platform, extensive geographical retail footprint and investment into data, including our partnership with Lloyds Bank, provides us with an unparalleled insight into how the UK consumer spends across the country.

How does NewRiver use data to improve operational efficiencies and capital allocation?

Access to high-quality data allows us to make better decisions, from capital deployment to leasing, tenant mix, marketing, car park pricing and an overall asset risk assessment.

We have access to multiple data streams including:

  • Market-leading customer transactional data from Lloyds Bank, at portfolio level as well as national and regional macro data
  • Yardi, a fully integrated property management and accounting system, which is our single source of portfolio and financial data. We continue to develop additional insight that can be derived from this, including the creation of an interactive dashboard for our real estate and finance teams through a system called Data Freedom, our comprehensive data lake which provides real time leasing metrics including rent collection and arrears, as well as valuations.

& Appendix

Glossary & Company Information

NewRiver REIT plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2025 Governance Report Financial Statements ESG Data Sets 25

Investing in our platform continued

  • National metrics (e.g. inflation, changes in house prices, private rents, employment rate, household savings, population projections) inform our understanding of macro-economic factors
  • Portfolio-wide footfall data including regional and national benchmarks, complemented by car park usage data
  • High-quality mobility data from Visitor Insights
  • Demographic and retailer performance data from CACI
  • MSCI Real Estate Index data allows us to benchmark portfolio performance for key metrics such as capital growth, income return, total return, net initial yields and equivalent yields
  • Income Analytics allows us to proactively measure, quantify and manage the degree of retailer risk at a corporate level
  • Co-Star supplements our research and analysis by providing information around property records, ownership, transactions, leases, news, trends and analytics
  • ESG metrics including electricity usage and EPC information

We continue to invest in our systems and team skill-sets to carefully manage the increasing data volume we have access to whilst ensuring that we maintain strong cyber security.

What does the Lloyds Bank Customer Spend Data tell you?

We receive quarterly spend data from Lloyds Bank across 85% of our portfolio by value. This data provides us with:

  • Store-by-store sales turnover, including the online contribution from that store
  • Where customers come from and where they do not
  • Frequency of visits
  • Average transaction values
  • Demographic profiling of customers Where customers typically make their first purchase, their second purchase and beyond

Strategic Report

• Which neighbouring stores are attracting spend from our customers

As well as receiving this data for our portfolio, we also use it to inform investment decisions for potential acquisitions.

We feed this data into granular bespoke models facilitating our understanding of current profitability and rental affordability as well as forecasting future leasing events, ensuring that any rental variance assumptions within our business plans are based on robust evidence.

The application and analysis of this data touches almost every asset management decision that we make and significantly can enhance our ability to make astute decisions in the future, to further enhance our asset business plans.

How does all this data help predict future performance and investment?

We combine detailed knowledge of current performance with contributing external elements to model future behaviour and performance. We assess factors including neighbouring developments, both commercial and residential, to model the predicted profile of new residents, to understand the quantum of potential future spend available to a location. This informs what the optimum mix of retail, F&B and leisure would be to meet the needs of both consumers and occupiers, to ensure we create space that will be relevant for the medium and long term.

This in-depth analysis also informs our risk analysis to determine whether an asset should be held as a long-term investment.

& Appendix

Glossary & Company Information

Portfolio review

Well-positioned portfolio, operational strength and market-leading platform

Our retail portfolio, primarily centred on essential goods and services, continues to demonstrate strong operational metrics, with sustained demand across the portfolio for both new lettings and renewals. This reinforces our belief that we possess the right assets in the right locations, catering to occupiers for whom a physical store is essential.

Portfolio metrics as at 31 March 2025

Occupancy: 96.1% (FY24: 98.0%)

Affordable average rent: £12.93 per sq ft (FY24: £11.82 per sq ft)

Gross to Net Rent Ratio: 85%

(FY24: 88%)

Rent collection:

Retention rate: 90% (FY24: 94%)

98% (FY24: 99%) Leasing volume: 939,700 sq ft (FY24: 785,100 sq ft)

Leasing activity vs valuer ERV: +8.8%

(FY24: +3.6%)

Leasing activity vs previous passing rent:

+17.5% (FY24: +1.8%)

Average WALE on long-term leasing transactions:

4.7 months

8.6 years (FY24: 7.5 years)

Average rent free tenant incentive:

(FY24: 2.1 months)

Portfolio NIY:

7.1% (FY24: 7.6%) Capital growth:

+0.6% (FY24: -2.3%)

% of total rent:

80% (FY24: 84%)

+4.9%

yoy in the 12 months to March 2025 (accounting for online spend contribution) Average CAGR FY23-FY25:

+0.7% on 9.7 year average previous lease period

National retailer as (FY24: -0.3% over 9.9 years)

Occupational Cost Ratio (OCR):

Sales growth: 8.3%

Well-positioned portfolio, market-leading platform

Strategic Report

During this period, our asset team has been proactive, completing a total of 939,700 sq ft in leasing transactions, which has secured £9.6 million in annualised income. Long-term leasing transactions, which represent 76% of the total rent secured, were finalised at rents +8.8% above the valuer's estimated rental value (ERV) and +17.5% higher than the previous passing rent. Occupancy has slightly decreased to 96.1% following the acquisition of Capital & Regional which on acquisition had a lower occupancy rate than the existing NewRiver portfolio. This is temporary with new lettings in advanced legals which will return our occupancy rate to March 2024 levels.

Long-term leasing continues to outperform ERVs across Core Shopping Centres and Retail Parks, which accounted for 99% of long-term rent secured, transacting at +5.4% and +20.6% above the valuer's ERVs respectively. Our long-term leasing transactions have achieved a weighted average lease expiry ("WALE") of 8.6 years, reflecting an improvement from FY24 7.5 years, and maintaining the positive momentum observed since FY22, which recorded a WALE of 6.4 years. In terms of tenant incentives, the competitive tension in the occupational market has resulted in an average rent free period of just 4.7 months for long-term leasing transactions. This average has increased from 2.1 months in FY24 due to the longer lease terms secured.

For total portfolio lease events in FY25, achieved rents showed a positive compound annual growth rate ("CAGR") compared to the previous passing rent of +1.3% over an average previous lease period of 9.6 years. Over the past three years, this reflects a modest increase of +0.7% based on an average previous lease period of 9.7 years, highlighting the sustainability of current rental levels. We anticipate continued rental growth from this highly affordable rental base.

The NewRiver portfolio is well-located across the UK, with a focus on essential goods and services, which comprises 82% of the portfolio by rent, and spaces compatible for omnichannel businesses. Prioritising convenience-led, community-focused retail, the portfolio supports local communities and society at large whilst benefiting from a depth of demand from Discount, Value Fashion and Grocery retailers to Home, Health & Beauty, Jewellery, and Food & Beverage offerings.

& Appendix

Glossary & Company Information

As at 31 March 2025 Occupancy Retention
Rate
Affordable Average Rent Gross to Net
Rent Ratio
Leasing
Volume
Leasing Activity Average CAGR FY23-FY25
(%) (%) (£ psf) (Ave. pa) (%) (sq ft) % vs valuer
ERV
% vs
previous
passing rent
(%) (Ave. Lease
Length)
Retail Parks 97.4% 100% £12.68 £136,000 98% 160,400 +20.6% +19.1% +0.9% 15.5
Shopping Centres– Core 95.9% 89% £13.74 £53,000 82% 571,600 +5.4% +17.2% +0.7% 8.5
Shopping Centres – Regeneration 99.0% 72% £5.61 £16,000 n/a -0.9% 5.4
Shopping Centres – Work Out 93.7% 92% £8.12 £14,000 n/a 116,600 -8.4% +5.1% -1.4% 6.4
Total1 96.1% 90% £12.93 £55,000 85%2 939,700 +8.8% +17.5% +0.7% 9.7
  1. Total includes Other representing <1% of total portfolio by value

  2. Gross to net ratio includes Retail Parks and Shopping Centres - Core only

Portfolio review continued

Retail Parks as at 31 March 2025

As at 31 March 2025, our Retail Parks, which are strategically located near major supermarkets, comprised 21% of the portfolio's overall value. They play a crucial role in the evolving landscape of omnichannel retail with features such as free, surface-level parking, large standardised units and convenient access on key arterial routes, making these assets ideal for local fulfilment centres including click and collect, catering to consumers' preference for flexibility and ease.

Key occupiers

At a glance

Portfolio weighting: 21%

No. assets: 13

Net initial yield: 6.1%

Capital growth: +3.5%

Average value: £17.9

million

Occupancy:

Retention rate: 100%

Affordable average rent: £12.68

per sq ft

97.4% £136,000 per annum

Gross to Net Rent Ratio: 98%

Leasing volume: 160,400 sq ft

Leasing activity: +20.6% ahead of valuer's ERV Leasing activity vs previous passing rent: +19.1%

Average rent free tenant incentive: 6.1 months

Average WALE on long-term leasing transactions:

11.1 years

Average CAGR FY23-FY25:

+0.9%

on 15.5 year average previous lease period

Sales growth: +7.4%

in store sales growth accounting for online spend contribution (y-o-y)

Retail Parks continued as at 31 March 2025

Selected highlights include:

  • Barrow-in-Furness, Hollywood Retail Park: serves as the town's primary destination for retail and leisure. Strategically positioned opposite Tesco Extra, it accommodates key retailers including Aldi, TK Maxx, Smyths Toys, Currys, and Dunelm. Overall, the retail park experienced year-on-year sales growth of +3.2%. There was strong online sales growth where there has been a connected store visit highlighting the halo impact of physical stores. It also features essential services including a veterinary practice and F&B such as McDonald's and KFC, whose rent reviews have collectively increased the passing rent by 16.0%. Furthermore, a new gym operator has committed to the park, securing a long-term 15 year lease at a rate consistent with the valuer's ERV, enhancing the mix of amenities available to local consumers.
  • Bexleyheath, Broadway Square Retail Park: stands as one of the area's key retail destinations, over 140,000 sq ft of space. Anchored by Sainsbury's and hosting tenants including JD Sports, B&M which occupies the former Wilko unit and TK Maxx, overall sales were up +16.6% in the 12 months to March 2025. The park benefits from a broad tenant mix including leisure and we have successfully renewed JD Wetherspoon's lease for an additional 10 years.
  • Blackburn, Blackburn Retail Park: spans 115,000 sq ft and is anchored by B&M and adjacent to Asda. Recent additions include Jollyes pet store, which has signed a 10-year lease, and JYSK, which has extended its tenancy for another 10 years and undertaken a store refurbishment, both at rental rates aligned with the valuer's ERV. This consistent demand for space is supported by all tenants experiencing year on year sales growth and demonstrate the park's ability to both attract and retain high quality tenants.
  • Bradford, Enterprise 5 Retail Park: at our retail park anchored by Morrison's foodstore, our retailers continue to benefit from strong sales performance with sales growth of +2.6% year-on-year and as such, we have completed a number of renewals including Poundland and Specsavers. These have been on new five year terms and aligned with the valuer's ERV. We have also completed a renewal with Idle Travel which resulted in a significant rent increase of +21% versus the previous passing rent and exceeding the valuer's ERV.
  • Dumfries, Cuckoo Bridge Retail Park: continues to thrive with its supermarket, DIY, and discount retail offering and overall sales growth of +5.6% year on year. A major highlight is the addition of Sainsbury's, marking its first presence in the area, securing a 15 year lease on a former Homebase unit. The rental terms for this agreement are +60.0% higher than the previous passing rent, a clear illustration of the rental growth potential within this sector. Post period, we have secured planning consent for a new 7,500 sq ft Next store, demonstrating the strong demand for the area and our retail park portfolio.

Sprucefield Retail Park, Lisburn, Northern Ireland

  • Leeds, Kirkstall Retail Park: is set to introduce a new Burger King drive-thru, which will operate under a market-leading 20 year lease agreement. The construction of the new facility is well underway, with an expected completion date of this summer 2025. The project will deliver an IRR of 14% with a yield on cost of 9%. This addition is predicted to significantly enhance footfall, dwell time, and overall consumer spending at the park, which benefits from a Morrisons supermarket.
  • Lisburn, Sprucefield Retail Park: we have recently achieved practical completion for three new drive-thru/restaurant units leased to Nando's, Starbucks and Slim Chickens, each on a 15 year term. The projected IRR for this development is 10% with a yield on cost of 8%. Building on this progress, an application has been submitted to further expand the park, including plans for 90,000 sq ft of additional retail space, a hotel, and another restaurant unit. Situated in a prime location off the M1 between Belfast and Dublin, the park boasts a diverse tenant mix including Sainsbury's, B&Q, The Range and B&M.

100% retention rate Retail Parks

98% gross to net rent ratio Retail Parks

Portfolio review continued

Core Shopping Centres as at 31 March 2025

As at 31 March 2025, our Core Shopping Centre portfolio accounted for 73% of the total portfolio value across 23 community shopping centres. These centres serve as pivotal hubs within their local communities, fostering social cohesion and driving economic prosperity by providing essential goods and services. Designed with accessibility in mind, they are easily reachable with short travel times, aligning with broader climate action and well-being objectives.

Key occupiers

At a glance

Portfolio weighting: 73%

No. assets:

23

7.8%

Capital growth: +0.2%

Average value: £30.4

Occupancy:

million

Retention rate: 89%

Affordable average rent: £13.74

per sq ft

95.9% £53,000 per annum

Gross to Net Rent Ratio: 82%

Leasing volume: 571,600 sq ft

Leasing activity: +5.4% ahead of valuer's ERV Leasing activity vs previous passing rent: +17.2%

Average rent free tenant incentive:

4.1 months

Net initial yield: contribution (y-o-y) Average WALE on long-term leasing transactions:

7.7 years

Average CAGR FY23-FY25:

+0.7%

on 8.5 year average previous lease period

Sales growth:

+4.3%

in store sales growth accounting for online spend

Company Information

Portfolio review continued

Core Shopping Centres continued as at 31 March 2025

Selected highlights include:

Bexleyheath, Broadway Shopping Centre: this Greater London asset serves as a hub for commuters and local residents. Anchored by retailers such as Marks & Spencer and Boots, the centre continues to sustain robust occupational momentum supported by overall year on year sales growth of +6.3%. Key achievements this year include new leases to Move South, exceeding the valuer's ERV by +36.6%, and Auntie Anne's, which successfully revitalised a long-term vacant unit. Additionally, lease renewals with established tenants such as Steads, River Island, Krispy Kreme, and Deichmann Shoes reflected significant growth, averaging +26.8% above previous passing rent.

  • Bridlington, The Promenades Shopping Centre: located in this popular coastal town, it remains the area's only shopping centre, offering a diverse range of retailers, including Sports Direct, Poundland, and Heron Foods. Recently, Greggs expanded into a 3,400 sq ft unit under a 10 year lease agreement, aligning with the valuer's ERV. The centre saw strong spend growth of +3.2% year-on-year.
  • Edinburgh, Gyle Shopping Centre: serves a wide catchment area, positioned in West Edinburgh, offering excellent connectivity with free parking, tram access, and a bus interchange. Anchored by Marks & Spencer and Morrisons, it also includes popular brands like Next, Costa Coffee, and Waterstones, with overall year-on-year sales growth of +6.0%. Recent new

lettings and renewals with tenants such as Bodycare, Greggs, and Watch Lab have driven a +8.9% increase above valuer's ERV. The F&B offering has been improved post period end with the completion of a new letting to Nando's on a 15 year term at the valuer's ERV which will further enhance the dwell time at the centre.

  • Newton Mearns, The Avenue: this community-centred shopping venue in Glasgow's affluent suburbs is anchored by Marks & Spencer and Asda, hosts a mix of national and local retailers which overall experienced year-on-year sales growth of +2.2%. Lease renewals and new lettings, including Timpson, Boots, Yours Clothing, and Santander, have collectively generated £909,000 in annualised income, a +2.7% increase above the valuer's ERV. Following the completion of their store fit out, Marks & Spencer signed a new 15 year lease at the centre thereby reinforcing their commitment to the location. In addition, we have exchanged on an agreement for sale on surplus land to a housing developer, providing a capital receipt and will support future spend at the centre with the delivery of new housing.
  • Walthamstow, 17&Central: situated just 20 minutes from Central London, 17&Central is a vibrant shopping destination that boasts 65 units across 260,000 sq ft anchored by Lidl and Asda supermarkets. Sales have been broadly flat, reflective of the high base set in the 12 months to March 2024. Recent leasing

activity has been strong, with agreements for Addax, Dmart, and Shah's Halal Food exceeding the valuer's ERV by +7.9%. We also finalised an open market rent review with Asda at +8.5% above the previous passing rent. The centre is set to benefit from an adjacent new residential development comprising 495 flats across two modern buildings due to complete imminently. Phase 2 of the development will further increase the centre's local dominance with an additional 80,000 sq ft of retail space and 43 residential units.

Wood Green, The Mall: a dominant shopping destination in London's Wood Green area, spanning 656,000 sq ft and anchored by a top performing Primark, TK Maxx, Lidl, NHS Diagnostics Centre, a Travelodge hotel and a market hall. High demand at this this location is reflected by recent lettings to tenants such as Wendy's, Ebebek, and The Perfume Shop, which surpassed the valuer's ERV by +3.7%, with existing tenants continuing to experience strong sales performance with spend growth of +4.3% year-on-year.

89% retention rate Core Shopping Centres

82% gross to net rent ratio Core Shopping Centres

Company Information

Portfolio review continued

Regeneration

Work Out

Strategic Report

We have two regeneration assets, representing only 3% of the total portfolio value, where the strategy is to deliver capital growth through redeveloping surplus retail space predominantly for residential. Our objective is to crystallise the profit from these projects in the short to medium term via sales post the receipt of a planning permission or delivery within a joint venture.

3% portfolio weighting Regeneration

The projects include:

  • Burgess Hill, The Martlets: located in the prosperous southeast, this site already has planning consent for a mixed-use redevelopment. The project includes pre-letting agreements with a food discount retailer as the anchor, an 89 room hotel operator, and residential developers for parts of the site. A partnership with Mid Sussex District Council is in advanced stages, with construction planned to commence in 2025.
  • Grays Shopping Centre: this site, just 35 minutes by train from Central London, is intended for a high-density residential redevelopment featuring 850+ homes. The planning application has been submitted, with approval expected in 2025.

& Appendix

Glossary & Company Information

The Work Out portfolio, which we identified during a review of the portfolio in 2020, represents only 3% of the total portfolio. The portfolio saw two disposals in FY25 yielding £3.9 million in gross proceeds. With only one sale left in the pipeline, the remaining focus ison executing two turnaround strategies.

3% portfolio weighting Work Out

The key strategy being:

Cardiff, Capitol Centre: which accounts for 69% of the Work Out portfolio is set to revitalise the area and become a key leisure and retail destination. It occupies a strategic location on Queen Street, in the heart of Cardiff's bustling shopping district, and serves as the gateway to Cardiff City Council's Canal Quarter redevelopment. Planning permission has been granted for an ambitious transformation project, which includes the creation of an 80,000 sq ft Family Entertainment Centre (FEC) and the development of a new prominent entrance for The Gym, an existing tenant. We are currently finalising legals with a national operator which is expected to significantly increase annualised net income by over £1 million per year.

Capital Partnerships

At a glance

14 Capital Partners

21 shopping centres

18 retail parks

19% pa1 Net Fee Income Increase

10.8m sq ft Capital Partnerships portfolio area Following the acquisitions of Capital & Regional and Ellandi, NewRiver now manages £2.4 billion worth of assets, including 48 Shopping Centres and 30 Retail Parks. NewRiver collects over £225 million in annual rent from 3,500 tenants, overseeing properties both independently and for its Capital Partners using a leading asset management platform.

Capital Partnerships are a key driver of growth, providing income through asset management fees, rental shares, and potential financial incentives. The acquisition of Ellandi on 3 July 2024 supports NewRiver's strategy to expand this aspect of its business, further strengthening its role as a major retail real estate asset manager in the UK.

Key Capital Partnerships

We continue to strengthen our Capital Partnerships across three key sectors, driving significant leasing activity and strategic developments.

NewRiver is positioned to continue growing its Capital Partnership initiatives by working with new and existing retail property owners. This includes destination shopping centres, convenience-led retail spaces, retail parks, and regeneration projects with local authorities. The increasing demand for expert retail asset management highlights the value of NewRiver's approach, combining a strong geographic presence with deep market insights to enhance performance and create lasting value.

Diverse range of partners and fees

Institutions Asset Management
Private Equity +
Development Management
Debt Funds +
Financial Management
Banks & Administrators +
Loan Servicing
Local Authorities +
Acquisition & Sale Fees

Portfolio review continued

& Appendix

A shopper in the Broadway Shopping Centre, Bexleyheath

Local Authorities

Across our seven council mandates, including Canterbury City Council, Blackpool Council, and Sefton Council, we have completed 50 long-term leasing events, covering 239,000 sq ft and securing £2.2 million in annualised rent.

Key Highlights:

  • Chatham, The Pentagon Shopping Centre: construction is underway on a 40,000 sq ft Healthy Living Centre and an innovation hub with 16,000 sq ft of flexible office space.
  • Bootle, Strand Shopping Centre: planning permission has been obtained for the first phase of a broader redevelopment, introducing a mixed-use offering spanning retail, leisure, hospitality, healthcare, and education services.
  • Canterbury, Whitefriars Shopping Centre: seven new long-term lettings secured for FY25 across 15,800 sq ft, with an annualised rent of £377,000—bringing new retailers such as Oliver Bonas, Lucy & Yak, and Kesson Pilates, diversifying Canterbury's tenant mix. A major new deal has been exchanged with Canterbury City Council for their new offices, set to open in summer 2025.
  • Canterbury, Riverside: two long-term deals completed with Community Health & Eyecare and Escape Hunt, covering 8,800 sq ft.
  • Wythenshawe, Wythenshawe town centre: NewRiver has been appointed to asset manage Wythenshawe town centre, supporting a significant regeneration project led by Muse and Manchester City Council.
  • Tamworth, Ankerside Shopping Centre: NewRiver has recently been appointed by Tamworth Borough Council to provide both asset management and strategic advice on Ankerside, the 180,000 sq ft shopping centre acquired by the local authority in 2024.

Private Equity Sector and Banks

Across our six mandates, including BRAVO where we operate a joint venture on one retail park in Lisburn and one shopping centre in Sheffield—we have completed 90 long-term leasing events, covering 431,400 sq ft and securing £6.5 million in annualised rent.

Key Highlights:

  • Milton Keynes, Midsummer Place: multiple long-term deals completed, including a new flagship Apple Store and openings of Sports Direct, Flannels, and Lane 7. Additionally, our F&B offering has been revitalised with Wingstop, Nacho'd and Flying Panda.
  • Bradford, Broadway Shopping Centre: new openings include Primark in the former Debenhams, South Asian fashion brand Saphire's first UK store and Rituals. The F&B mix has been refreshed with Popeyes and Wingstop enhancing the centre's tenant mix.
  • Leicester, Highcross Shopping Centre: multiple long-term deals agreed including H&M, Skechers, Foot Locker and new openings for Castore and Butterwick. Lease agreements exchanged with Mango, Rituals, and Maki and Ramen, all set to open in H1 2026.

Institutional Sector

For M&G Real Estate, we currently manage 17 retail parks and two shopping centres. In FY25, 24 long-term leasing events were completed, covering 233,700 sq ft, securing £4.6 million in annualised rent. Furthermore, we expanded the mandate having been appointed to manage Plough Lane Retail Park in Wimbledon.

NewRiver REIT plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2025 Governance Report Financial Statements ESG Data Sets 35 Strategic Report

& Appendix

Glossary & Company Information

Portfolio review continued

Valuation

As at 31 March 2025, our portfolio was valued at £897.5 million (31 March 2024 £543.8 million). Movements from the previous year were the acquisition of Capital & Regional, the disposal of two Work Out assets; and like-for-like valuation movement of +0.6% for the 12 months to March 2025. This was driven by ERV growth of +1.1% and stability in yields.

Our portfolio has experienced greater stability in value over the longer term compared to the wider retail market and continues to outperform the MSCI All Retail, Shopping Centre and Retail Warehouse total return benchmarks over the 3-year and 5-year period. Over a 12 month period, the portfolio grew in value by +0.6% and Income Returns outperformed the wider market by +150bps. We consider income return to be the key driver of total returns over the long-term and outperformance in income return is therefore indicative of the health of the underlying portfolio.

Growth in valuations is indicative of the portfolio's attractive yield premium relative to the market. The portfolio Net Initial Yield stands at 7.1% and has a Net Equivalent Yield of 8.4%, providing an attractive risk premium compared to the wider real estate sector and the 10-year Government Gilt rate. The yield premium relative to the MSCI All Retail benchmark, at a 5.7% Net Initial Yield and 6.6% Equivalent Yield, represents significant headroom of +140bps and +180bps respectively.

The Core Shopping Centre portfolio, accounting for 73% of the portfolio, delivered capital growth of +0.6% in the 6 months to March 2025 and +0.2% in the 12 months to March 2025. This was largely driven by ERV growth of +0.8% in the 12 months to March 2025, with yields stable. The Core Shopping Centre Net Equivalent Yield now stands at 8.8% with the movement in the period due to the acquisition of Capital & Regional, predominantly situated in London and the South East.

The Retail Park Portfolio, which represents 21% of the portfolio saw capital growth of +1.7% in the 6 months to March 2025 and +3.5% in the 12 months to March 2025. This was largely driven by ERV growth in the 12 months of +3.2% and Net Equivalent Yield movement of -30bps reflecting continued investor confidence in the sector.

The Regeneration and Work Out Portfolios experienced decline over the full year, predominantly due to movements in the first half of the year, however they now account for only 6% of the total portfolio.

"Our portfolio has experienced greater stability in value over the longer term compared to the wider retail market and continues to outperform the MSCI indexes."

Team at COOK in Locks Heath, Fareham

Portfolio review continued

Valuation continued

Portfolio Valuation Valuation Topped LFL EY LFL ERV
Movement
(£m) (%) (%) (%) (%) (%) (%) (%) (%)
656.8 73% -0.6% +0.6% +0.2% 7.8% 8.8% +0.1% +0.8%
+3.2%
+0.0%
+1.4%
-4.1%
897.5 100% -0.4% +0.6% +0.6% 7.1% 8.4% -0.1% +1.1%
185.9
24.7
867.4
30.1
Weighting
21%
3%
97%
3%
Movement H1
+1.8%
-1.7%
+0.1%
-8.4%
Movement H2
+1.7%
-1.8%
+0.7%
-2.9%
Movement FY
+3.5%
-3.5%
+0.8%
-4.5%
Valuation
up NIY
6.1%
4.0%
7.4%
1.1%
NEY
6.5%
11.5%
8.3%
10.4%
Movement
-0.3%
+0.0%
-0.1%
-0.3%
  1. Work out and Other includes Other representing a value of £2.1 million

As set out in the table below, our portfolio continues to outperform the MSCI Shopping Centre and Retail Warehouse benchmarks over the 3 and 5-year periods. Over a 12 month period, the portfolio Income Return outperformed the market by +150bps.

12 months to 31 March 2025 Total Return Capital Growth Income Return
NRR Portfolio 7.8% 0.3% 7.4%
MSCI All Retail Benchmark 9.4% 3.3% 6.0%
Relative performance -160 bps -290 bps +150 bps
Shopping Centres Retail Parks
Total Return: 6 months to 31 March 2025
NewRiver 3.6% 6.1%
MSCI Benchmark 5.4% 5.7%
Relative Performance -170 bps +40 bps
Total Return: 12 months to 31 March 2025
NewRiver 6.4% 11.8%
MSCI Benchmark 10.2% 12.0%
Relative Performance -380 bps -20 bps
Total Return: Annualised 3 years to 31 March 2025
NewRiver 4.4% 7.0%
MSCI Benchmark 2.0% 2.0%
Relative Performance +240 bps +50 bps
Total Return: Annualised 5 years to 31 March 2025
NewRiver 0.7% 8.1%
MSCI Benchmark -3.9% 5.9%
Relative Performance +460 bps +220 bps

Total Return: Annualised 5 years to 31 March 2025

Total Return: Annualised 3 years

Market review

Our well positioned marketplace

Consumer Retailer NewRiver
Confidence The UK continues to be more resilient than the
financial market expects.
The occupational market is in its strongest
position in a decade.
We have the right assets in the right locations
that are let to the right occupiers to serve both
the wants and needs of our local communities.
Locations
are evolving
The evolving population of the UK, including
demographic shifts, an ageing population, urban
migration and changing consumer preferences,
is driving demand for a more diverse mix of
retailers and services.
Changing requirements of consumers requires
retailers to be agile and responsive to maintain
their market position.
Our data driven approach and deep sector
knowledge means we are ideally placed to
understand the evolving needs of both
shoppers and retailers.
The True Value
of the Store
The consumer does not differentiate between
purchase channels, convenience is key no matter
the route to purchase.
Physical stores continue to be essential to
facilitating sales from other channels.
Our portfolio is made up of well-located and
easily accessible locations which dominate their
retail catchment and are occupied by successful
operators who rely on a physical store network.
Influence of
AI on markets
Increasing use of AI and its rapidly advancing
capabilities have huge implications for how
people work and how they live their lives.
Retailers continue to have a laser focus on
profitability: AI will assist them in improving
cost efficiencies.
Consumers having more time for leisure activities,
creating increased profitability can be beneficial
to NewRiver's portfolio. In addition, use of AI will
allow us to make better, faster decisions, and
improve our operational efficiency and ability
to deliver market leading performance.

Investment market

Increased conviction in shopping centres due to the underlying strength of the occupational market.

Shopping Centres Retail Warehouses NewRiver

Retail parks are increasingly recognised as being highly compatible with online fulfilment, in turn driving prospects of significant rental growth.

Within our Core Shopping Centres and Retail Parks portfolios, which combined account for 94% of our owned assets, the year ending March 2025 was the second consecutive year of positive revaluation growth.

Company Information

NewRiver REIT plc Annual Report and Accounts 2025 Strategic Report Governance Report Financial Statements ESG Data Sets
& Appendix
Glossary &
Company Information
38
Market review continued

The retail real estate market has continued to evolve, and notwithstanding shifting consumer behaviour, macroeconomic volatility and ongoing structural changes within the sector, our marketplace is in the best position it has been for over 5-10 years.

Our business is driven by data-led insight, providing expert perspectives across the consumer, occupier, technological and capital markets. This section provides an overview of the key market trends, economic indicators and evolving sector dynamics that shaped the operating environment during our reporting period, and outlines how these external factors have influenced demand for retail space, tenant performance, investment activity and capital markets relevant to our business.

Confidence

The retail sector is supported by a strong consumer and occupational market

Consumer

The UK consumer continues to be more resilient than the financial markets expect

The job market continues to be strong: unemployment remains stable at 4.5%; the Lloyds Bank business barometer reports that 55% of companies plan to increase their workforce in the next 12 months; and although job vacancies have declined in the last few months, 781,000 for January-March 2025 vs 806,000 for October-December 2024, they continue to be substantially higher than pre-pandemic levels.

Wages have continued to increase at a higher rate than inflation since June 2023 (+5.5% vs +2.8% as of February 2025), assisting in offsetting recent increases in household bills, albeit the total spent on utilities by Lloyds Bank customers between April 2024 and March 2025 declined by -7.7% vs the previous year. As a result, households have experienced an increase in disposable income, with the March 2025 Asda Income tracker reporting family spending power up by +10% vs the prior year.

The housing market had a strong start to 2025; although growth in house prices slowed in the run up to the end of the stamp duty holiday, the annual growth remained strong at +2.8%, based on the Halifax House Price Index. The growth in rent has slowed down to +7.7% in March 2025, vs +9.1% the previous year. Expected cuts in interest rates will give hope to the holders of the 1.8 million 2025 fixed rate mortgages (out of a total of 12.5 million active mortgages as of December 2024) that are due to end, because new mortgage deals are expected to be lower than they might have anticipated.

Wages continue to outstrip inflation

NewRiver REIT plc Annual Report and Accounts 2025 Strategic Report Governance Report Financial Statements ESG Data Sets Glossary & 39
----------------------------------------------------- ------------------ ------------------- ---------------------- --------------- ------------ ----

Consumer Credit / Savings

Market review continued

Mar-22 Jun-22 Sep-22 Dec-22 Mar-23 Jun-23 Sep-23 Dec-23 Mar-24 Jun-24 Sep-24 Dec-24

Key

Debt to Income ratio

Household savings ratio

Source: Bank of England, ONS March 2025 Source: Research carried out by GfK, March 2025

Although there are risks around personal debt, household debt has declined as a ratio of income, aided by increased wages, while the rate of growth of consumer credit has declined over the last 12 months. In addition, increased disposable income has contributed to an increase in the household savings rate, up from a low of 4.5% at the end of June 2022 to 12.0% of income at the end of 2024.

& Appendix

XX

Glossary & Company Information

Key

24 months to March 2025 Household savings ratio

Although consumer confidence dipped towards the end of 2024, reflecting the impact of the Autumn Budget, as of March 2025 it remains two points ahead of March 2024 and 17 points ahead of 2023, reflecting a cautious optimism among households despite economic pressures and the impact of US tariffs on confidence.

Headlines based on data from the BRC or the ONS about a slowdown in retail sales are potentially misleading. According to high quality transactional data provided by Lloyds Bank, both retail and supermarket spending delivered annual sales growth of +1.5% and +1.6% respectively. Across the same period, in store sales growth across the NewRiver portfolio was +4.3%, a significant outperformance relative to the overall UK performance.

Retailer

The occupational market is in its strongest position in a decade

Although the retail sector is being impacted by increases in the National Minimum Wage (NMW) and National Insurance Contributions (NIC) following the Autumn Budget, the expected combined financial impact of an additional £5.56 billion (as predicted by Retail Economics) equates to just 1.2% of the total annual value of UK retail sales. The majority of this is expected to be either passed on to customers through price increases or absorbed by the retailers. The remainder of the increased costs will be addressed through strategies to improve efficiency and productivity, with labour optimisation one of the main areas of focus, including using technology to take over tasks such as electronic shelf price labels, returns machines and more self-service tills, reducing the requirement for staff interventions. Although portfolio rationalisation is a potential way of offsetting increased costs, the degree to which rents have already been rebased means that they account for a small proportion of overall retailer costs; as a result, Retail Economics view this as having a low impact with potential to offset the increased costs of NMW, NICs and increased business rates by just £84.4 million, 1.5% of the projected £5.56 billion impact, mitigating the risk to our income.

The biggest priority to assist in mitigating the remaining cost is supply chain optimisation, reflecting an ongoing focus on maximising profit margins across the sector, while improving resilience.

Countering increased employment costs, retailers are now benefiting from reduced freight and energy costs as well as the strength of Sterling vs US Dollars. In addition, UK retailers that source a high proportion of goods from China may be able to benefit from the excess capacity caused by the recent slowdown in trade between the USA and China.

Business confidence

Overall confidence (% net balance)

Business confidence

Mar-25

Source: Lloyds Bank Business Barometer, March 2025

Respectively, we see this reflected in increased confidence; the Lloyds Bank Business Barometer reports a double digit increase in overall confidence, with retail confidence reaching a post-pandemic high of +58.

NewRiver REIT plc Annual Report and Accounts 2025 Strategic Report Governance Report Financial Statements ESG Data Sets
& Appendix
Glossary &
Company Information
41
Market review continued

Retail failures

Vacancy rate

Source: Centre for Retail Research / Knight Frank, April 2025

Where there have been retailer failures, this has created opportunities for rent increases, especially in the retail park sector. In addition, it creates opportunities for other occupiers to emerge and to expand. A diverse range of occupiers including Aldi, Iceland, B&M, The Range, Sketchers, Flannels, Pure Gym and Costa have all continued to expand their portfolios, whilst the competitive leisure sector continues to expand; for example Lane7 opened its first venue in 2013 and now has 17 venues across the UK (including two within our managed portfolio), with a further 3 due to be opening soon. Reflecting the growth in this sector, we have received planning permission to create an 80,000 sq ft Family Entertainment Centre at the Capitol Centre in Cardiff.

The greatest risk of retailer failure is for pureplay online retailers, which has created opportunities for physical retailers such as Frasers to improve their omnichannel offering through buying brands such as Missguided and increasing its stake in Asos.

Although there is a perception that retailers are continuing to fail; retailer failures remain below the long-term average and 2024 was the fourth quietest year for retailer distress since 2007 according to Knight Frank.

Source: Savills / Green Street, April 2025

Vacancy within the sector continues to decline, aided by the expansion of a diverse range of occupiers across retail, F&B and leisure as well as continued efforts to re-purpose redundant space. Based on data from Green Street, 75% of former Debenhams have been re-purposed for new retailers or for alternative uses, including residential, workspaces and leisure uses. This includes the former Debenhams in Midsummer Place, Milton Keynes, one of our Capital Partnerships portfolio assets, which has been re-purposed to include new flagship stores for Sports Direct and Flannels, and for Lane7 in the basement. NewRiver has always deliberately avoided exposure to department stores, with no exposure to this sub-sector.

Vacancy across the NewRiver portfolio is far lower than the UK average, with a NewRiver occupancy of 96.1%. In addition retailers continue to focus on margins, however we are beginning to see evidence of rental growth for retailers with the right stores in the right locations.

NewRiver

We have the right assets in the right locations that are let to the right occupiers to serve both the wants and needs of our local communities.

Transactional data from Lloyds Bank Market Intelligence provides us with an unrivalled understanding of our shoppers.

The disparity between the relative values of each of these groups and their overall contribution to UK retail spend reflects both the nature and location of our centres, which are focused on essential goods services, together contributing 82% of retail rental income. This is reflected in the extent of our centres' catchments, with 55% of spend derived from those living within three miles of our centres, demonstrating the relevance of our centres to their local communities.

The strength of the occupational market is reflected in our leasing and occupancy statistics, with portfolio occupancy of 96.1% and 939,700 sq ft of leasing in FY25.

Our shoppers visit frequently, with an average transaction value of £16.5, reflecting our continued focus on essential retailers which serve the local community. This means our portfolio is more resilient to the potential impacts of supply chain disruption on occupier performance and consumer spend.

Considering the continued geo-political instability, it's too early to be able to understand the potential impact of the Trump tariffs on our shoppers and our occupiers, but our usage of mobility and live spending data across the portfolio means we are extremely well positioned to identify and to react to any changes in behaviour from our key shopper groups.

The implications of the Trump tariffs are still unclear, however, the consensus is that the grocery sector should be relatively unaffected. Countering the potential risk faced by non-food retailers with a bigger exposure to the USA, the slowdown in trade between the USA and China may have benefits to UK retailers which source heavily from China (such as B&M, Dunelm and Halfords), as manufacturers seek to sell excess stock at a discounted rate.

Across the portfolio our key shopper groups are:

High Spending Professionals 25% of spend

These shoppers are high earners, with a lower frequency of visit to our centres albeit with above average spend. This group commit their highest proportion of their spend to housing costs (23% vs UK average of 13%).

Bargain Hunters 22% of spend

These are typically younger, budget conscious shoppers, with lower incomes. They visit often but have a below average spend per visit. Across the UK, a higher proportion of their spend is on retail and supermarket spend (32% and 25% respectively, vs UK average of 27% and 19%).

Customer Demographics

National Spend

NewRiver portfolio

Source: Lloyds Bank Market Intelligence, March and April 2025

Essential Spenders 21% of spend

Middle income earners, with a large proportion of spend on essential purchases (58% vs UK average of 48%). This is reflected by this group providing the highest average visit frequency to our portfolio, with spend per visit just 4% below average.

Lifestyle Enthusiasts 20% of spend

Higher income consumers with a higher proportion of spend on non-essential purchases (69% vs UK average of 52%). Visit frequency to our centres is in line with average but above average spend per visit.

The True Value of the Store

One supply chain, one platform, used by all participants in the retail journey to provide a seamless and effortless shopping experience across sales and media channels.

Strategic Report

Consumer

The consumer does not differentiate between purchase channels, convenience is key no matter the route to purchase.

The line between in-store and online sales is increasingly blurred and the route to purchase can include multiple channels. Consumers do, however, expect the different channels to be well-executed with seamless integration with each channel. Consumers want the freedom and ability to browse online, visit local stores and place orders when and where they want.

Different generations have their own preferences for shopping channels, but there is a clear trend across all generations for the customer journey starting in-store. Despite being digital natives, research from Retail Economics cites that Gen Z (born between 1995 and 2009) value the instant gratification of in-store purchases as well as the opportunity for socialising with friends. Millennials (born between 1980 and 1994) are the most likely to favour 'online first' purchases due to the time constraints of busy lifestyles. In contrast, Baby Boomers (born between 1946 and 1964) are the most likely to shop in store, valuing both the touch and feel of products and the social aspect of shopping.

Generational Preference in Shopping Channel

Online First Store First Net in-store
Gen Z (1995-2009) 36% 63% 27%
Millennials (1980-1994) 45% 55% 10%
Gen X (1965-1979) 39% 62% 23%
Baby Boomers (1946-1964) 31% 69% 38%

Source: Retail Economics 2023

A further attraction of physical stores is the perception of in-store purchases, the absence of delivery and return timeframes and the ability to use cash as a budgeting tool.

Retailer

Physical stores continue to be essential to facilitating sales from other channels.

In-store accounts for 73% of retail sales, increasing to 91% of food store sales; however an omnichannel offer is key to retaining relevance to shoppers and physical stores are a key component of this: 13 of the UK's top 20 online retailers primarily have stores.

Click & Collect plays a prominent role within omnichannel for both retailers and consumers. Demonstrating the value of this, £733 million of additional online sales were made between April 2024 and March 2025 by shoppers who had also made a purchase in store across our portfolio, based on transactional data from Lloyds.

With a continuing focus on margins, reducing the cost of online deliveries and returns is key. Although in the future last mile deliveries will be made more efficient and cost effective through innovations such as fully autonomous drones (already being used by Walmart and DoorDash in the USA), stores continue to be essential to facilitating online store fulfilment; Marks & Spencer report that click and collect orders cost 20% less to serve than a home delivery, 45% of those collecting womenswear and menswear orders make another purchase on their trip. Meanwhile, charging for returns is encouraging shoppers to return directly to the store; this is not only cost effective but also encourages incremental purchases.

A key solution to lower costs includes leveraging pre-existing bricks and mortar: physical stores are therefore essential to facilitating sales from other channels; they have adequate stock to meet demand and replenish quickly, while stock available in locations as close as possible to customers' delivery addresses minimises the cost of logistics.

The increased cost of online marketing, with the cost per click rate on platforms such as Google and social media increasing by double digit percentages each year, also contributes to the role of stores. They provide a tangible experience that online shopping cannot replicate, while raising brand awareness: Marks and Spencer report that omnichannel sales increase by 22% in locations with a store nearby.

Glossary & Company Information

Retailer

Changing requirements of consumers requires retailers to be agile and responsive to maintain their market position.

UK retailers demonstrate adaptability, a strong foundation for continued growth and innovation. Marks and Spencer, one of our top occupiers in terms of rental contribution, is an exemplary example of how adapting to changing requirements can drive performance. Several years ago, Marks and Spencer sales and profits were falling due to weak clothing sales. Between 2022 and 2024 it has increased its market share in grocery, clothing and home, and has reduced its average customer age by five years, through improving range, store format and adapting how it engages with shoppers. NewRiver has 13 Marks and Spencer stores across the portfolio, benefiting from and helping support the retailer's omni-channel strategy.

Food & Beverage continues to be a growth sector and a key driver of visits. However, the impact of inflation is changing consumer preferences, with an increased requirement for lower price options. Drive-thru units continue to be a focus for retailer expansion; the creation of three new drive-thru units at our asset, Sprucefield Retail Park, Lisburn in Northern Ireland is testament to this, with Nando's, Starbucks and Slim Chickens opening in the new purpose-built units built on surplus land adjacent to the retail parade. New entrants such as Wingstop continue to expand, and have opened at three of our assets – in The Mall in Wood Green, Midsummer Place in Milton Keynes and The Broadway in Bradford over the last few months. Greggs continues to perform well and is a key tenant with 29 stores across our portfolio, and its confidence in our locations is reflected in its decision to upsize in a number of locations, including The Moor in Sheffield.

The UK population is expected to increase by +7% by 2032, with the biggest increase being in the over 65's (+21%), driving demand for a broad mix of retailers and services. Our centres are easily accessible and are focused on the needs of the local community. Additional health facilities can help boost retail performance; the BBC has reported that users of an NHS town centre scanning centre spent an average of £17 in local businesses when they visit.

It's increasingly important that town and shopping centres provide more than purely shopping to maintain their relevance to all generations. One example of this is through the provision of health services; to date we have 82 health and dental services across the portfolio, including NHS centres in The Exchange, Ilford and The Mall, Wood Green, accounting for 705,000 sq ft of space, and we continue to assess opportunities for further provision.

Across all generations there is an increasing awareness of the need to reduce our carbon footprint. Our centres are ideally placed to support this, being easily accessible on foot and well connected by public transport, putting them firmly at the heart of their communities.

NewRiver

Our data driven approach and deep sector knowledge means we are ideally placed to understand the evolving needs of both shoppers and retailers.

Lloyds Bank transactional data not only helps us to understand the performance of occupiers within our centres, but also the contribution that different customer groups make and how this is evolving over time. We apply this data to the business plans of each assets to ensure that our tenant mix remains relevant, supporting the sustainability of our rental cashflows, as well as informing how our centres engage with their customers, through a better understanding of their profiles, their journey to our centres, the order in which they visit retailers, which other neighbouring stores they visit and which brands they engage with online.

A shopper in M&S in Broadway Shopping Centre, Bexleyheath

NewRiver

Our portfolio is made up of well-located and easily accessible locations which dominate their retail catchment and are occupied by successful operators who rely on a physical store network.

XX In-store vs online sales for top 10 tenants

Offline / Online (%)

Online In-store

Source: CACI Brand Dimensions, April 2025

The Lloyds Bank transactional data allows us to have a detailed understanding of the role our portfolio plays in facilitating online sales.

For FY25 shoppers across the NewRiver portfolio generated an additional

£733 million

of online sales for occupiers within their local centres.

Of our top 10 retailers, sales within physical stores account for more than

+80% of sales

confirming their ongoing requirement for physical stores.

NewRiver REIT plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2025 Governance Report Financial Statements ESG Data Sets 46

Strategic Report

& Appendix

Glossary & Company Information

Market review continued

Influence of technology, data and AI on markets

As usage and capabilities of AI increase, the impact on how we work and live will be profound, with significant opportunities and risks associated with this

Consumer

Increasing use of AI and its rapidly advancing capabilities has huge implications for how people work and how they live their lives.

The evolution of the capabilities of AI is faster than anything we have seen before and is impacting all aspects of our lives.

One major element that consumers are already starting to benefit from is the additional time they have available through using AI to make daily routine tasks more efficient, giving more time for leisure activities.

CACI research shows that 48% of consumers are comfortable with AI supporting their day to day life while 42% feel optimistic about AI saving time and making things easy.

Increasing use of AI and its rapidly advancing capabilities has huge implications for how people work and how they live their lives. KPMG report that it is expected to significantly reshape the UK job market, potentially displacing jobs in certain sectors while creating new opportunities in AI-related fields, potentially leading to a net neutral or even positive impact on overall employment levels.

The British Medical Association believes that AI will also have a significant impact on healthcare and health outcomes. Enhanced diagnostic accuracy, through early detection and using predictive analytics to proactively manage potential health risks, alongside personalised treatment plans and accelerated research to develop new treatments will not only enhance quality of life but will also contribute to longer life expectancy and reduced healthcare costs. Our centres are ideally placed to assist in this through curating health focused businesses and collaborating with healthcare providers to offer wellness programmes, health screening and diagnostic centres, such as the NHS Diagnostic Centre at our centre, The Mall in Wood Green.

Retailer

Retailers continue to have a laser focus on profitability: AI will assist them in improving cost efficiencies.

In 2023, Knight Frank noted that retail had lagged behind more 'AI mature' industries such as finance but it is now set to be amongst the top industry beneficiaries, and is forecasted to achieve above average increases to profitability.

More accurate AI based forecasting allows retailers to bridge gaps in supply chain. It is also possible to determine inventory for individual stores, better accommodating the wants and needs of shoppers and boosting sales, as well as scheduling staff to meet peak demands.

Use of AI and associated technology aids efficiencies in all areas of retail operations including fulfilment of deliveries, both to end customers and to stores – the introduction of Kiva Robots at an Amazon warehouse reduced the time required to fulfil items by 78%. Online customer support is largely provided through AI chatbots, reducing the need for human input.

As AI has evolved from Generative (creating content) to Agentic (able to think and reason like humans), its capabilities are increasing exponentially, accelerating the impact on bottom lines. For example, product development is easier and quicker, while marketing materials are quicker and cheaper to create. Through use of AI, retailers can provide better personalisation, using behaviour and purchase history.

NewRiver

The use of AI will allow us to make better, faster decisions and improve our operational efficiency and our ability to deliver market leading performance. The use of AI by our occupiers to improve profitability will also prove beneficial to NewRiver's portfolio. Our AI working group is focused on understanding existing and future AI uses across the business to shape recommendations on how AI can be used, with appropriate safeguards in place, to improve decision making and to drive efficiencies.

Retail is a fast moving and dynamic market and is more operational for both owners and occupiers of retail real estate. For several years we have invested in our systems, including Data Freedom, our interactive dashboard containing live comprehensive asset information, to carefully manage the increasing volume of data that we are accessing.

However the power and value of any data set comes from the interpretation and application of the findings. We use the insight derived from our data on the millions of customers who visit our assets to inform and improve our strategy across all aspects of the business, including capital deployment, leasing, tenant mix, marketing, car park pricing and the overall risk assessment of an asset.

Using AI will build on our existing strengths and expertise, and will help us make faster decisions based on the insight it generates.

The Gym at Broadway Square in Bexleyheath

Investment market

Transaction volumes across the commercial real estate investment market rebounded in 2024, +21% versus 2023 as the prospect of rates reductions stimulated activity.

The MSCI March 2025 Quarterly Index reported growth across all sectors, with the All Property index at +1.4%, Industrial at +4.7%, Supermarkets at +1.9%, Retail Warehouses at +5.5% and Shopping Centres at +3.2%, save for Offices which reported negative capital growth of -2.5% over the period. The current volatile macro environment has impacted volumes in the first quarter of 2025, however, the consensus is that Retail's outperformance in 2024 was not a one off and is set to continue through 2025.

According to the IPF consensus forecast (Autumn 2024), Shopping Centres and Retail Warehouses are set to deliver a total return outperformance over the next five years versus the All-Property average of 7.7%. This is reflective of the attractive risk adjusted returns the sector offers, driven by the day 1 income return and prospects of future rental growth.

MSCI UK Sector 12-Months Returns (%)

Capital Growth

Income Return

NewRiver REIT plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2025 Governance Report Financial Statements ESG Data Sets 49

Market review continued

Shopping Centre Market: Increased liquidity, improving cost and availability of debt, and broader base of investor demand

Shopping Centre investment reached £2.0 billion in 2024, a +70% increase in volumes on the previous year and the highest annual total since 2016.

The Shopping Centre investment market has seen the return of the institutional investor for centres serving the destination shopping journey, predominately at a larger lot size. This is a result of the increased conviction in the subsector, due to the underlying strength of the occupational market and rebased, stable capital values, in addition to the high income return component.

The availability of credit has also returned due to these factors, with lenders also providing higher LTVs at lower margins, driving further liquidity in the market and broader depth of buyer.

Shopping Centres

Increased conviction in shopping centres due to the underlying strength of the occupational market.

Shopping Centre Transaction Volumes

Retail Warehouse Market: Investor demand underpinned by occupational demand

There were £3.3 billion of total transactions recorded in 2024, a +75% increase relative to the previous year and aligned to 2021 which was the second highest year in the past decade.

& Appendix

Investors, especially UK funds, REITs and international investors who have been the key buyers, remain attracted by the favourable supply/demand imbalance and increasing recognition that retail parks are highly compatible with online fulfilment which is driving the prospects of significant rental growth. Recent retail failures impacting the sub-sector, including Carpetright, Homebase and Hobbycraft, have presented opportunities to realise rental growth on new lettings due to the limited available space nationally, according to MSCI this currently sits at only 3.1%.

Retailer

Strategic Report

Retail parks are increasingly recognised as being highly compatible with online fulfilment, in turn driving prospects of significant rental growth.

Retail Warehouse Transaction Volumes

Source: Savills until 2023 & Knight Frank there after Source: Savills until 2023 & Knight Frank there after

Glossary &

Market review continued

NewRiver

Within our Core Shopping Centres and Retail Parks portfolios, which combined accounts for 94% of our owned assets, the year ending March 2025 was the second consecutive year of positive revaluation growth.

  • NewRiver's portfolio recorded like-for-like valuation growth of +0.6%1 in the second half of the year. A healthy income return component meant that total return reached 4.2% in the half year and 7.8% in the full year, which was an outperformance relative to the All Property Index which experienced Total Return of 6.3% for the 12 month period.
  • Our Core Shopping Centre and Retail Park portfolios saw the strongest valuation growth over the period. Core Shopping Centres experienced like-for-like valuation growth of +0.6%1 in the half year to 31 March 2025 and retail parks experienced like-for-like valuation growth of +1.7%. As a result of the acquisition of Capital & Regional, the Core Shopping Centre portfolio has increased to 73% of the total portfolio, with Retail Parks making up the second highest proportion at 21%.
  • Our Core Shopping Centre portfolio now has a Net Initial Yield of 7.8% which is a decrease relative to September's 8.4% and reflects the acquisition of lower yielding assets as part of the Capital & Regional portfolio. Regardless, this still sits at a considerable 80 bps premium relative to the MSCI benchmark, providing an attractive risk premium relative to the wider real estate market.
  • Our Retail Park portfolio now sits at a lower yield of 6.1%, following 12 months of yield compression that followed the market. This is a slight premium relative to the MSCI benchmark of +20 bps.
  • An attractive risk premium, coupled with continued low and liquid average lot sizes of £17.9 million on the Retail Park assets and £30.4 million on the Shopping Centre assets, healthy occupational performance within the portfolio, and a degree of fair value within the sector, has ensured investor appetite for the centres has endured, creating resilience in valuation performance throughout the portfolio.
    1. See Glossary, like-for-like valuation growth

Company Information

NewRiver REIT plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2025 Governance Report Financial Statements ESG Data Sets 51 Glossary & Strategic Report

& Appendix

Chief Financial Officer's review

Increased scale & earnings growth

It has been an active and transformational year for the business, during which we have completed two strategically important transactions, the most significant of which was the acquisition of Capital & Regional, which materially increased our scale and has already benefitted UFFO per share and our dividend, without sacrificing the strength of our financial position.

Will Hobman Chief Financial Officer

Company Information

Our property portfolio has increased in size from £543.8 million at 31 March 2024 to £897.5 million at 31 March 2025, due partly to a 0.6% increase in property valuation but principally due to the acquisition of Capital & Regional which completed on 10 December 2024. The acquisition also increased our EPRA Net Tangible Assets from £361.8 million at 31 March 2024 to £487.5 million at 31 March 2025. EPRA NTA per share reduced from 115 pence at 31 March 2024 to 106 pence at 30 September 2024, predominantly as a result of the dilution from the equity placing in September 2024 which was used to part fund the acquisition and was conducted at a discount to 31 March 2024 NTA per share but importantly at a slight premium to closing price prior to launch. NTA per share reduced to 102 pence at 31 March 2025, in-line with post transaction proforma guidance, due mainly to acquisition costs.

Maintaining the strength of the financial position of the enlarged business was a key priority when structuring the acquisition, and as a consequence we ended the year with significant cash reserves of £62 million and in compliance with our financial policies with LTV of 42.3%, net debt to EBITDA of 5.4x and an interest cover ratio of 6.0x. While LTV at the year end was comfortably within policy of <50% and in-line with post transaction proforma communicated in our half year results materials, it was marginally ahead of our guidance of <40%. At the time of the Capital & Regional acquisition we were clear we intended to reduce to within guidance through a modest and achievable level of disposals, and immediately post year end we completed the disposal of the Abbey Centre in Newtownabbey, which reduced our LTV to c.38% meaning we are within guidance with capacity to invest into accretive asset acquisitions.

UFFO for the year ended 31 March 2025 was £30.5 million, up from £24.4 million for the year ended 31 March 2024, reflecting the benefit of acquisition activity completed during the second half of the financial year in which UFFO of £19.0 million accelerated from £11.5 million for the six months ended 30 September 2024, including the seasonality in the Snozone business acquired as part of the Capital & Regional transaction. On a per share basis, UFFO increased from 3.7 pence for the six months ended 30 September 2024 to 4.4 pence in the second half, an increase of 19% as the earnings accretion from the Capital & Regional transaction, including the seasonality in the Snozone business, has taken effect. Our dividends are linked directly to UFFO per share, which means that as our UFFO per share has increased in the second half of the year, so too has our dividend. Having declared an interim dividend of 3.0 pence per share in December 2024, the Board is pleased to declare a final dividend relating to the second half of the financial year of 3.5 pence per share. This brings the total FY25 dividend declared to 6.5 pence per share, representing 80% of UFFO and in-line with our dividend policy. The dividend is payable on 8 August 2025 and goes ex-dividend on 19 June 2025.

"The acquisition of Capital & Regional materially increased our scale and has already benefitted UFFO per share and our dividend."

Key performance measures

The Group financial statements are prepared under IFRS, where the Group's interests in joint ventures and associates are shown as a single line item on the income statement and balance sheet. Management reviews the performance of the business principally on a proportionally consolidated basis which includes the Group's share of joint ventures and associates on a line-by-line basis. The Group's financial key performance indicators are presented on this basis.

In addition to information contained in the Group financial statements, Alternative Performance Measures ('APMs'), being financial measures that are not specified under IFRS, are also used by management to assess the Group's performance. These include a number of the financial statistics included in this document being UFFO, LTV, occupancy, admin cost ratio, ICR, GRESB score, Total Property Return and Total Accounting Return. These APMs include a number of EPRA measures, prepared in accordance with the EPRA Best Practice Recommendations reporting framework, which are summarised in the 'Alternative Performance Measures' section at the end of this document. We report these measures because management considers them to improve the transparency and relevance of our published results as well as the comparability with other listed European real estate companies. Definitions for APMs are included in the Glossary and the most directly comparable IFRS measure is also identified. The measures used in the review below are all APMs presented on a proportionally consolidated basis unless otherwise stated.

The APM on which management places most focus, reflecting the Company's commitment to driving income returns, is UFFO. UFFO measures

the Company's operational profits, which includes other income and excludes one off or non-cash adjustments, such as portfolio valuation movements, profits or losses on the disposal of investment properties, fair value movements on derivatives and share-based payment expense. We consider this metric to be the most appropriate for measuring the underlying performance of the business as it is familiar to non-property investors, and better reflects the Company's generation of profits. It is for this reason that UFFO is used to measure dividend cover.

In our half year results, we presented LTV, Cash, ICR and net debt to EBITDA on a pro forma basis to give readers of the accounts more information on what the Group would look like on completion of the acquisition of Capital & Regional. This was especially important because as at 30 September 2024, NewRiver had raised net equity proceeds of £48.9 million to part fund the transaction, which was not deployed until the transaction completed on 10 December 2024, immediately prior to the publication of the half year results on 12 December 2024. For example, LTV was 21.6% at 30 September 2024, reflecting the beneficial impact of the undeployed net equity proceeds, but LTV was expected to be c.42% proforma for the transaction completion, which was disclosed within our half year results materials and is in-line with the LTV of 42.3% at 31 March 2025. Now that the transaction has completed, we have not produced proformas again in this set of results as there is no need to produce cash and LTV measures and we do not believe it is necessary to produce net debt to EBITDA or ICR.

The relevant sections of this Finance Review contain supporting information, including reconciliations to the financial statements and IFRS measures. The 'Alternative Performance Measures' section also provides references to where reconciliations can be found between APMs and IFRS measures.

NewRiver REIT plc Annual Report and Accounts 2025 Strategic Report Governance Report Financial Statements ESG Data Sets
& Appendix
Glossary &
Company Information
53
Chief Financial Officer's review continued

Underlying Funds From Operations

The following table reconciles IFRS profit after taxation to UFFO, which is the Company's measure of underlying operational profits.

Reconciliation of profit after taxation to UFFO

31 March 2025
£m
31 March 2024
£m
Profit for the year after taxation 23.7 3.0
Adjustments
Net property valuation movement (2.1) 13.9
Net property valuation movement – joint ventures' and associates' 0.1
Loss on disposal of investment properties 0.7 3.8
Changes in fair value of financial instruments (0.1)
Exceptional costs1 0.7
Amortisation of intangibles2 0.3
Write off of unamortised debt costs3 0.9
Costs to unlock transaction synergies4 1.1
Loss on disposal of joint venture 2.3
Deferred tax5 3.0
EPRA Earnings 28.4 22.9
Forward looking element of IFRS 96 0.1
Snozone depreciation, amortisation and lease liability interest7 0.5
Share-based payments charge 1.5 1.5
Underlying Funds From Operations 30.5 24.4
  1. Exceptional costs comprise expenses relating to the acquisition of Ellandi

  2. Amortisation of intangibles relates to the amortisation of the intangible asset recognised on the acquisition of Ellandi

  3. Write off of unamortised costs following repayment of three Capital & Regional secured debt facilities totalling £59 million immediately post transaction completion

  4. Costs to unlock comprise net costs in relation to unlocking expected net cost synergies following the acquisition of Capital & Regional e.g. redundancy and head office costs

  5. Deferred tax adjustment acquired with the acquisition of Capital & Regional, since written off

  6. Forward looking element of IFRS 9 relates to a provision against debtor balances in relation to invoices in advance for future rental income. These balances are not due in the current year and therefore no income has been recognised in relation to these debtors.

  7. Adjustment to remove depreciation and the profiling impact of IFRS 16

Underlying Funds From Operations is presented on a proportionally consolidated basis in the following table.

Underlying Funds From Operations

31 March 2025 31 March 2024
Group
£m
JVs &
Associates
£m
Adjustments1
£m
Proportionally
consolidated
£m
Proportionally
consolidated
£m
Revenue 90.5 0.8 (11.7) 79.6 66.5
Property operating expenses (34.3) (0.2) 5.3 (29.2) (20.9)
Net property income 56.2 0.6 (6.4) 50.4 45.6
Administrative expenses (18.5) 6.9 (11.6) (11.0)
Other income 3.7 3.7 0.4
Operating profit 37.7 0.6 4.2 42.5 35.0
Net finance costs (12.3) (0.5) 0.9 (11.9) (10.6)
Taxation (0.1) (0.1)
Underlying Funds From Operations 30.5 24.4
UFFO per share (pence) 8.1 7.8
Ordinary dividend per share
(pence)
6.5 6.6
Ordinary dividend cover 125% 118%
Admin cost ratio 14.1% 15.7%
Weighted average # shares (m) 376.3 311.4
  1. Adjustments to Group and JV & Associates figures to remove non-cash and non-recurring items, principally: Revenue – segmental reporting re-allocations comprising £(8.4) million Snozone revenue reallocated to Other income and £(3.1) million Capital Partnerships costs reallocated from Administrative expenses, and an adjustment to exclude £(0.2) million of non-recurring property management fee income in relation to unlocking expected net cost synergies following the acquisition of Capital & Regional; Property operating expenses – segmental reporting re-allocation of £4.7 million Snozone expenses reallocated to Other income and other adjustments to exclude £0.5 million Snozone depreciation, amortisation and lease liability interest and the £0.1 million forward looking element of IFRS 9; Administrative expenses – segmental reporting re-allocations comprising £3.1 million Capital Partnerships costs reallocated to Revenue and other adjustments to exclude £1.3 million costs in relation to unlocking expected net cost synergies following the acquisition of Capital & Regional, £0.7 million exceptional acquisition costs relating to and £0.3 million amortisation of intangibles recognised on the acquisition of Ellandi and £1.5 million share-based payment charge; Other income – segmental reporting re-allocations comprising £8.4 million Snozone revenue reallocated from Revenue and £(4.7) million Snozone expenses reallocated from Property operating expenses; Net finance costs – adjustment to exclude £0.9 million write off of unamortised costs following repayment of three Capital & Regional secured debt facilities totalling £59 million immediately post transaction completion

Company Information

Net property income

Analysis of net property income (£m)
Net property income for the year ended 31 March 2024 45.6
NPI Core 6.8
NPI Work Out and Other (2.4)
Asset management fees 0.4
Net property income for the year ended 31 March 2025 50.4

On a proportionally consolidated basis, net property income was £50.4 million in FY25, compared to £45.6 million in FY24. This was predominantly due to the impact of the acquisition of Capital & Regional which completed on 10 December 2024, offset slightly by disposals completed, principally from the Work Out portfolio.

Through the Capital & Regional transaction in December 2024 we acquired six community shopping centres which are now included in our Core portfolio and have contributed to an increase in net property income of £6.8 million.

Net property income within Work Out and Other has decreased by £2.4 million, predominately due to the disposal of four Work Out assets during the second half of FY24 and during FY25. Following these disposals, Work Out only represents 3% of our total portfolio.

Asset management fees increased by £0.4 million, or 16%, to £2.9 million during the year, principally due to the acquisition of Ellandi, an established asset and development management business focused on UK retail and regeneration, in July 2024. We have now unlocked the operational cost synergies identified within Ellandi and expect that, having made a modest contribution to UFFO in the second half of FY25, the business will make an increased contribution in FY26 and beyond.

Administrative expenses

Administrative expenses have increased from £11.0 million in FY24 to £11.6 million in FY25, primarily due to inflationary pressures on pay rises, averaging 3% across our workforce, which constitute the majority of our overheads. We have mitigated the effects of the inflationary rises in payroll related costs by achieving targeted savings across the remainder of our administrative costs. The acquisition of Capital & Regional contributed a modest £0.2 million to the increase in administrative costs during FY25.

We have made good progress in unlocking the £6.2 million of annual net cost synergies identified as part of the Capital & Regional acquisition, which were based on administrative expenses net of property management income of £6.9 million reported by Capital & Regional in the year ended 30 December 2023 and which we expect to have fully unlocked within 12 months of completion on an annualised basis.

Details of any material related party transactions that occurred during the current year are provided in Note 27 of the Notes to the Interim Financial Statements.

Other income

Other income of £3.7 million recognised in FY25 relates to Snozone EBITDA. We acquired Snozone, the largest indoor ski slope operator in the UK, as part of the Capital & Regional transaction on 10 December 2024. This contribution exceeds Snozone's annual EBITDA, as our period of ownership since acquisition encompasses Snozone's peak trading season, without its period of controlled loss (i.e. May – September), such that we have benefitted from the seasonality of income within the Snozone business during FY25.

& Appendix

In the prior year, other income of £0.4 million related to a settlement of an income disruption insurance claim in relation to loss of earnings on our commercialisation and turnover rent income during the period impacted by Covid. All historical claims relating to Covid have now been settled and as such no other income has been recognised in FY25.

Net finance costs

Net finance costs increased from £10.6 million in FY24 to £11.9 million in FY25. Through our acquisition of Capital & Regional, we acquired four secured debt facilities totalling £199 million of gross debt. We repaid three of these facilities immediately following transaction completion, totalling £59 million and with a blended coupon of 6.1%, and retained the £140 million Mall facility which has a coupon of 3.45%. This means that following the completion of the acquisition in December 2024, our gross debt increased to £444 million from £304 million at the start of FY25, increasing our net finance costs.

Taxation

As a REIT, we are exempt from UK corporation tax in respect of our qualifying UK property rental income and gains arising from direct and indirect disposals of exempt property assets. The majority of the Group's income is therefore tax free as a result of its REIT status, albeit this exemption does not extend to other sources of income such as interest or asset management fees.

Company Information

Dividends

Under our dividend policy, we declare dividends equivalent to 80% of UFFO twice annually at the Company's half and full year results, calculated with reference to the most recently completed six-month period.

The Company is a member of the REIT regime whereby profits from its UK property rental business are tax exempt. The REIT regime only applies to certain property-related profits and has several criteria which have to be met, including that at least 90% of our profit from the property rental business must be paid as dividends. We intend to continue as a REIT for the foreseeable future, and therefore our policy allows the final dividend to be "topped-up", including where required to ensure REIT compliance, such that the payout in any financial year may be higher than our base policy position of 80% of UFFO.

In-line with this policy, in December 2024 the Board declared an interim dividend of 3.0 pence per share in respect of the six months ended 30 September 2024, based on 80% of UFFO per share of 3.7 pence. The Board has today declared a final dividend of 3.5 pence per share in respect of the year ended 31 March 2025, taking the total FY25 dividend declared to 6.5 pence, equivalent to 80% of UFFO per share of 8.1 pence. The final dividend of 3.5 pence per share in respect of the year ended 31 March 2025 will, subject to shareholder approval at the 2025 AGM, be paid on 8 August 2025. The ex-dividend date will be 19 June 2025 with an associated record date of 20 June 2025. The dividend will be payable as a REIT Property Income Distribution (PID).

Balance Sheet

EPRA NTA includes a number of adjustments to the IFRS reported net assets and both measures are presented below on a proportionally consolidated basis.

& Appendix

As at
31 March 2025
As at
31 March 2024
Group
£m
JVs &
Associates
£m
Proportionally
consolidated
£m
Proportionally
consolidated
£m
Properties at valuation1 887.5 10.0 897.5 543.8
Right of use asset 69.6 69.6 75.6
Investment in JVs & associates 5.3 (5.3)
Other non-current assets 8.3 8.3 0.3
Cash 61.3 0.8 62.1 133.2
Other current assets 22.1 0.1 22.2 11.8
Total assets 1,054.1 5.6 1,059.7 764.7
Other current liabilities (53.4) (0.4) (53.8) (26.7)
Lease liability (73.6) (73.6) (75.6)
Borrowings2 (437.0) (4.3) (441.3) (300.5)
Other non-current liabilities (0.9) (0.9) (0.8)
Total liabilities (564.0) (5.6) (569.6) (403.6)
IFRS net assets 490.1 490.1 361.1
EPRA adjustments:
Goodwill3 (3.6)
Intangible asset3 (0.9)
Deferred tax 0.9 0.8
Fair value financial instruments (0.1)
EPRA NTA 486.5 361.8
EPRA NTA per share4 102p 115p
IFRS net assets per share5 103p 116p
LTV 42.3%6 30.8%
  1. See Note 14 for a reconciliation between Properties at valuation and categorisation per Consolidated balance sheet

  2. Principal value of gross debt, less unamortised fees

  3. Goodwill and intangible assets recognised on the acquisition of Ellandi are removed from the EPRA NTA calculation as per EPRA guidelines

  4. Calculated with reference to 478.9 million shares (2024: 313.3 million shares), see Note 12

  5. Calculated with reference to 475.5 million shares (2024: 310.4 million shares), see Note 12

  6. Proforma for £59m post year end disposal of the Abbey Centre, Newtownabbey, in-line with March-2025 book value, LTV reduces to c.38%

& Appendix

Net assets

As at 31 March 2025, IFRS net assets were £490.1 million, increasing from £361.1 million at 31 March 2024, primarily due to the acquisition of Capital & Regional, which was funded by a combination of cash and shares. EPRA NTA is calculated by adjusting net assets to reflect the potential impact of dilutive ordinary shares, and to remove the fair value of any derivatives, deferred tax, goodwill and intangible assets held on the balance sheet. These adjustments are made with the aim of improving comparability with other European real estate companies. EPRA NTA increased by 34.5%, from £361.8 million to £486.5 million, again due to the acquisition of Capital & Regional.

EPRA NTA per share reduced from 115 pence at 31 March 2024 to 106 pence at 30 September 2024, predominantly as a result of the dilution from the equity placing in September 2024, which was used to part fund the acquisition and was conducted at a discount to 31 March 2024 NTA per share but importantly at a slight premium to the closing price prior to launch, and also due to the acquisition of Ellandi which generated goodwill and an intangible asset of £4.8 million which is excluded from the EPRA NTA calculation. NTA per share reduced to 102 pence at 31 March 2025, in–line with post transaction proforma guidance, due mainly to acquisition costs.

Properties at valuation

Properties at valuation increased from £543.8 million as at 31 March 2024 to £897.5 million as at 31 March 2025, due partly to a 0.6% increase in property valuation but principally due to the Capital & Regional transaction through which we acquired six community shopping centres, predominantly located in London and the South East of England and now included within our Core Shopping Centre portfolio.

Debt & financing

Proportionally consolidated
31 March 2025 30 September 2024 31 March 2024
Weighted average cost of debt – drawn only1 3.5% 3.5% 3.5%
Weighted average debt maturity – drawn only1 2.6 yrs 3.4 yrs 3.9 yrs
Weighted average debt maturity – total2 2.4 yrs 3.1 yrs 3.6 yrs
  1. Weighted average cost of debt and weighted average debt maturity on drawn debt only

  2. Average debt maturity excludes two one–year extension options on the RCF and a one–year extension option on The Mall facility. Assuming these options are exercised and lender approved, weighted average debt maturity on total debt at 31 March 2025 increases to 3.0 years

Proportionally consolidated 31 March 2025
£m
30 September 2024
£m
31 March 2024
£m
Cash 62.1 184.8 133.2
Principal value of gross debt (444.3) (304.3) (304.0)
Net debt1 (379.2) (116.6) (167.3)
Drawn RCF
Total liquidity2 162.1 284.8 233.2
Gross debt (drawn/acquired) /
repaid in the year / period
(199.3) / 59.0 (0.3) 12.0
Loan to Value 42.3% 21.6% 30.8%
  1. Including unamortised arrangement fees

  2. Cash and undrawn RCF

  3. Proforma for £59m post year end disposal of the Abbey Centre, Newtownabbey, in-line with March-2025 book value, LTV reduces to c.38%

As at 31 March 2024, cost of debt and weighted average debt maturity were closely aligned to the profile of our unsecured corporate bond, because it accounted for £300 million of total gross debt of £304 million. Immediately following the completion of the acquisition of Capital & Regional we repaid the three more expensive of its four secured debt facilities, totalling £59 million with a blended coupon of 6.1%, and retained the Mall facility, which at £140 million with a coupon of 3.45% was the largest and cheapest of the Capital & Regional facilities. Gross debt increased to £444 million at 31 March 2025, due entirely to the Mall facility. Our weighted average cost remained unchanged during FY25, because the coupon on the Mall facility is aligned with that of our existing unsecured corporate bond, and our weighted average debt maturity reduced to 2.6 years from 3.9 years 31 March 2024 because the Mall facility matures in January 2027, compared to the existing unsecured corporate bond which matures in March 2028.

Our balance sheet remains 68% unsecured as at 31 March 2025, reduced from 100% at 31 March 2024 because the Mall facility is secured. Looking forward, and with our increased scale following the acquisition of Capital & Regional and investment grade credit ratings reaffirmed by Fitch Ratings in September 2024, we expect to be active in the debt markets over the next twelve months in order to manage our debt maturity profile.

Chief Financial Officer's review continued

  • & Appendix
  • Company Information

Financial policies

We have five financial policies in total, including LTV and Interest cover which also appear as debt covenants on our unsecured RCF and our bond. These form a key component of our financial risk management strategy which remains as important as ever given the macro-economic climate.

We are in compliance with all financial policies as at 31 March 2025.

Measure Financial policy Proportionally consolidated
31 March 2025 30 September 2024 31 March 2024
Loan to Value Guidance <40%
Policy <50% 42.3%1 21.6% 30.8%
Group
31 March 2025 30 September 2024 31 March 2024
Balance sheet gearing <100% 76.7% 27.5% 45.4%
Proportionally consolidated
31 March 2025 HY25 FY24
Net debt: EBITDA2 <10x 5.4x / 8.9x 4.7x / 3.5x 4.8x / 4.8x
Interest cover3 >2.0x 6.0x 7.4x 6.5x
Ordinary dividend cover4 >100% 125% 125% 118%
  1. Proforma for £59m post year end disposal of the Abbey Centre, Newtownabbey, in-line with March-2025 book value, LTV reduces to c.38%

  2. Net debt: EBITDA calculated using the average net debt over the last 12 months is 5.4x (HY25: 4.7x) (FY24: 4.8x). Net debt: EBITDA calculated using year end net debt at 31 March 2025 was 8.9x due to the completion of the acquisition of Capital & Regional on 10 December 2024 so only received 112 days of EBITDA in FY25. Net debt: EBITDA calculated using period end net debt at 30 September 2024 was 3.5x due to the completion of equity placing and retail offer in September

  3. Interest cover calculated on a 12 month look-back basis, consistent with debt covenant

  4. Ordinary dividend cover calculated with reference to UFFO

LTV reduced from 30.8% at 31 March 2024 to 21.6% at 30 September 2024, predominantly due to the successful equity placing and retail offer in September 2024 which raised net proceeds of £48.9 million to part fund the acquisition of Capital & Regional, before increasing to 42.3% at 31 March 2025 following the transaction, which remained comfortably within policy (<50%). At this level, LTV was in-line with the expected post transaction proforma position but slightly above our guidance of <40%. At the time of the Capital & Regional acquisition we were clear we intended to reduce LTV to within guidance through a modest and achievable level of disposals, and immediately post year end we completed the disposal of the Abbey Centre in Newtownabbey, which reduced our LTV to c.38% meaning we are within guidance with capacity to invest into accretive asset acquisitions. Considering LTV alongside our net debt to EBITDA (5.4x) and Interest Cover ratios (6.0x), our financial position remains strong and we are comfortably in compliance with all financial policies.

Additional guidelines

Alongside our financial policies we have a number of additional guidelines used by management to analyse operational and financial risk, which we disclose in the following table:

Guideline 31 March 2025
Single retailer concentration <5% of gross income 3.6% (Boots)
Development expenditure <10% of GAV <1%
>70% pre-let or pre-sold
Risk-controlled development on committed N/A, no developments on site

Conclusion

We are pleased with continued operational performance of the underlying NewRiver business, the growth embedded within the business following our acquisition activity and the strength of our financial position.

Looking forward, we are focused on continuing to unlock the cost synergies identified as part of the Capital & Regional acquisition, delivering further UFFO per share accretion, and achieving our medium-term target of a consistent 10% total accounting return.

Will Hobman Chief Financial Officer

Stakeholder engagement

Our Stakeholders

In what has been a transformational year for NewRiver, we have continuously focused on the impact and outcome for each of the various stakeholders across our business. We recognise that our long-term success is founded on strong and transparent two-way relationships with our stakeholders, and understanding the evolving needs and expectations of each.

Board engagement

Critical to effective Corporate Governance is how the Board aligns strategic decisions with the Company's purpose, values, strategy and stakeholders. The NewRiver Board has a clear stakeholder engagement plan, regularly consulting with the NewRiver Executive Directors and wider team, who in turn manage and foster the relationships with core stakeholders.

Our Stakeholders include

Section 172(1) Statement

The Directors, both individually and collectively, believe that they have acted in good faith in a manner they consider most likely to promote the success of the Company for the benefit of its members as a whole (having regard to the stakeholders and matters set out in section 172(1)(a-f) of the Companies Act 2006) in the decisions taken during the year ended 31 March 2025.

Details of our key stakeholders and how the Board engages with them can be found here in our Stakeholder Engagement Report. Further details of the Board activities and principal decisions are set out on page 120 providing insight into how the Board makes decisions and their link to strategy. Other disclosures relating to our consideration of the matters set out in s172(1) (a-f) of Act can be found as follows:

S172 factor Our approach
the likely consequence of any
decision in the long term
As a Board of a REIT owning assets which also include a risk-controlled development pipeline, the Board is always
conscious of the long term. Looking to the future the Board and Executive Committee regularly assess the overall
corporate strategy and acquisition, asset management and disposal decisions in the context of current and future
long-term trends and markets. We closely assess the latest trends reported by our research providers, to ensure
we are aligned with evolving trends. These insights and the Board's own extensive experience steer the long-term
strategic direction.
the interests of the
company's employees
Our small workforce facilitates close proximity between staff and the Board, making it easy for the Board to engage
directly with employees, especially since the Directors regularly visit the London office and other sites. This year
Directors have visited assets, spent time in the London office and attended an enhanced programme of social
events with staff.
the need to foster the The Board is committed to fostering the Company's business relationships with occupiers, local authorities and
company's business other stakeholders. These stakeholders are key to our business model and therefore the Executive Directors (including
relationships with suppliers, Board members) have direct responsibilities for managing and developing these relationships. Board site visits during
customers and others the year have helped in developing these relationships and understanding the needs of these stakeholders.
the impact of the company's The Board is committed to our communities and our assets are integral to the communities they serve. We aim
operations on the community to enhance the lives of consumers and minimise our impact on the environment. These matters are therefore
and the environment considered in all strategic decisions and embedded into the business model.
the desirability of the Our values mirror our culture, and as a team, we aim to be trusted and respected. These values are embedded in the
company maintaining a decisions made by the Board. Staff receive regular training on our anti-corruption policies to ensure that they are
reputation for high standards entrenched in all staff decisions and conduct. Once again, the size and proximity of the workforce allows our values
of business conduct to be communicated, embedded and monitored easily and less formally.
the need to act fairly as The Board recognises the importance of treating all members fairly and monitors the views of the Company's
between members of shareholders through reports on investor and analyst communications, ensuring their views and opinions can be
the company considered when setting strategy.

Company Information

Our Team

Why they are important

The success of our Company comes from the people within our team. During a period of transformation and growth it has been critical to engage, listen to and empower our existing team as well as welcome and integrate our new colleagues to position our newly enlarged business for continued growth.

How we have engaged

Our people are what make the success of NewRiver possible and we continue to invest in our team, systems, culture and working environment. We are proud of the excellent culture we have fostered, supported by a passionate team of people with considerable experience and expertise in real estate and finance. We are committed to developing talent from within the business and continuously invest to ensure that we have the most talented, agile and fulfilled team we possibly can. The result is a high retention of a committed and expert team who drive our performance and manage our relationships and partnerships.

We have a collegiate and well-balanced team, with a 50:50 gender split. Our team continue to focus on helping drive the business forward whilst also advancing their own career development. We foster strong working relationships with our wider stakeholders who collectively help us deliver on our strategy, business model and ongoing success. We recognise that our stakeholders have a range of priorities and concerns, and we endeavour to incorporate these into our strategic decision-making.

Communication, collaboration and respect continue to sit at the heart of our people strategy which harnesses the power of the team to drive our business forward.

Outcomes

  • Attractive working policies to foster a positive working environment to suit the different lifestyles of our team including:
  • flexible hybrid working with 3:2 days across office:at home
  • full private medical cover
  • 'gender-agnostic' shared parental leave fully paid six-week sabbatical following 10 years of service
  • opt-in salary sacrifice for electric cars
  • staff volunteering policy
  • mental and physical health resources and training
  • Training and development is key to empowering our loyal team and ensuring that every employee has a chance to unlock their full potential and develop skills, capability and performance – we continue to support and fund professional qualifications including RICS and ACCA with 10% undertaking professional training across 2,500 hours
  • Annual appraisal process and performance reviews to create professional development plans and set objectives, track progress and fulfil potential
  • Regular weekly and monthly team meetings We continue to be part of the UK Government's Apprenticeships Scheme, with three apprentices now part of the NewRiver team full time
  • Annual staff survey independently managed and analysed by The Sunday Times in 2024 for their Best Places to Work awards, for which we were recognised following 96% response rate to the survey, with over 80% of staff identifying that they
  • Have confidence in our management and a good working relationship with their direct manager
  • Are paid fairly and being developed

Company Information

Stakeholder engagement continued

Key metrics:

59%

of team have worked at NewRiver for +5 years

Low absentee rate of 0%

23% ethnic diversity

50:50

Company Male:Female ratio

71:29

Board Male:Female ratio

2,500 total hours of training this year

46 hours of training per

employee this year

10%

of our team undertook professional training during the year

105

hours of volunteer support dedicated to Trussell

  • Are happy with their working hours and work/life balance
  • Feel that their views are heard, and they are trusted to make decisions
  • Feel happy at work and safe in their working environment
  • Annual team engagement led by NewRiver Board Director, Alastair Miller, our designated Non-Executive Director responsible for engaging with the NewRiver team, this year covering
    • macro-economic and geopolitical themes
    • NewRiver's M&A transaction to acquire Capital & Regional
    • risks and opportunities
    • role of the Board
    • strategic growth of the business
    • impact of AI to the business
    • working environment and culture
  • Regular Non-Executive Director office visits to allow the Board to interact with and listen to the wider team
  • Reward and recognition through generous remuneration policies including bonus entitlements to reward excellent performance, and Long-Term Incentive Plan to promote talent retention
  • Invested in data and systems, including portfolio wide Lloyds Bank data, to facilitate our asset team and analysts with greater insights to inform capital deployment, leasing, tenant mix, marketing, car parking pricing or overall risk assessment of assets
  • We have an active Wellness & Representation committee who provide a programme of events and initiatives to engage and support the team to promote positive diversity, inclusion, well-being and effective work/life balance

• Well balanced gender and ethnicity representation with a 50:50 male:female split and 23% ethnic representation

Company Information

• We have mental health ambassadors within the NewRiver team and an ongoing partnership with mental health charity, Chasing The Stigma.

Our Environment

Our comprehensive ESG Strategic Report provides a detailed review of our ongoing commitment and progress to this important stakeholder group.

Our Shareholders

Why they are important

Our shareholders, both institutional and retail, are the ultimate owners of our business. In order to deliver on all our ambitions for the communities we are invested in and grow the business, develop our team and deliver sector leading returns, it is essential that our shareholders understand and support the Company's strategy, business model, investment case and progress.

How we have engaged

We have an active engagement strategy, supported by our three corporate brokers (Panmure Liberum, Jefferies and Shore Capital) to provide our shareholders with regular business updates, frequent meetings, both in person and online, and on-site asset tours. Where appropriate, our Board and members of the Executive Committee engaged with shareholders.

Outcomes

This year has been a transformational year for NewRiver following the acquisition of Capital & Regional for £151 million, funded through a combination of cash and shares. The cash proportion of the transaction was part funded through a significantly oversubscribed equity placing and retail offer, reflecting investor confidence in NewRiver and our compelling investment case, together with the attraction of the Capital & Regional transaction and our improving market place. The equity placing enabled us to enhance our equity market profile creating an expanded and strengthened shareholder register and greater trading liquidity of our shares.

Alongside the Capital & Regional acquisition, our regular programme of investor engagement continued including the AGM, regulatory announcements and non-regulatory news flow, conference calls and shareholder roadshows. With appropriate safeguards in place,

we engaged with financial analysts, as well as with financial media, investors, private client fund managers, retail investors and equity sales teams. Regular and targeted engagement ensures that our strategy, business model and investment case are well understood by shareholders and the wider market.

  • Programme of virtual and face-to-face investor meetings with the CEO and CFO
  • Management engaged with 64 investors during the year, including shareholders and non-holders, both institutional and retail
  • As well as institutional investors, we engaged with retail investors via direct communications, our website, media, Annual General Meetings (AGM) and platforms including Investor Meet, participating in a spotlight event on REITs for Investor Meet members
  • Results presentation for FY24 in June 2024 and HY25 Results in December 2024 following the completion of the acquisition of Capital & Regional – a live audio webcast with Q&A was available with a replay function on our website
  • The 2024 AGM was held as a physical meeting, attended by all of the Board
  • The Board reviews and approves material and communications with investors, namely trading updates, results announcements, the Annual Report and Accounts, and significant business events and transactions.
  • The respective Committee Chairs engage with shareholders on significant matters related to their specific areas of responsibility
  • The Board receives regular updates on market sentiment, investor relations activity and share price performance to inform Company's strategy, financial and operational performance drivers, capital allocation, sustainability and occupational market challenges and opportunities.

Capital & Regional acquisition

The acquisition of Capital & Regional plc included an equity raise requiring careful and regulated shareholder engagement.

The £151 million acquisition was completed through a combination of cash, part funded by an oversubscribed retail equity placing and retail offer, and shares.

The successful acquisition resulted in an enhanced equity profile with a larger and broader shareholder register which positions our business well for continued growth.

Highlights

  • Capital & Regional acquisition shareholder engagement programme, supported by brokers Panmure Liberum, Jefferies and Shore Capital
  • Successful equity placing and retail offer completed to part fund Capital & Regional acquisition, which was heavily oversubscribed and priced at a modest premium to the prevailing share price, reflecting the increased confidence in NewRiver and a recognition of our improving marketplace
  • The equity placing enabled us to expand and strengthen our shareholder register and the trading liquidity of our shares by permitting new investors to join and existing shareholders to increase their positions in the Company.

Stakeholder engagement continued

Our Capital Partnerships

Why they are important

Capital Partnerships are an important part of our strategy and future growth, with the objective of delivering increased earnings in a capital light way through co-investment, asset management fees, a share of rent and the potential to receive financial promotes.

Our Capital Partnerships include:

"Today our Capital Partnership business has genuine scale"

How we have engaged

Today our Capital Partnership business has genuine scale, with assets under management of £1.5 billion across a portfolio of 21 shopping centres and 18 retail parks, with 14 different partners. Our partner mandates include private equity, banks, institutions and local authorities. Investment partners are increasingly recognising the importance of track record and specialism in this highly operational asset class.

We were pleased to grow our Capital Partnerships business through the acquisition of Ellandi in July 2024 for £5 million. The acquisition is aligned with NewRiver's strategy to expand our Capital Partnership business over the medium term, leveraging our position as one of the largest specialist retail real estate asset managers in the UK. At the time of acquisition, the Ellandi business brought with it a portfolio of 16 shopping centre asset management mandates, covering over 6.3 million sq ft, with 10 different partners.

In FY25 our asset management fees increased by £0.4 million, or 16%, to £2.9 million, principally due to the acquisition of Ellandi. We have now unlocked the operational cost synergies identified within Ellandi, and having made a modest contribution to UFFO in the second half of FY25, we expect that the business will make an increased contribution in FY26 and beyond. The compound annual growth rate in our Capital Partnership revenues over the last five years has been 19% and we expect to continue growing this over the next five years.

Outcomes

  • We have expanded our Capital Partnerships portfolio this year through the acquisition of Ellandi in July 2024, the extension of mandates for one of our existing Capital Partners and through the appointment of two new local authority mandates
  • Executive Directors and the respective asset managers for each asset within our Capital Partnerships provide weekly, monthly and quarterly reports to the senior teams of our Capital Partners to share updates on the strategic progress of each asset managed within the partnership through in-person and online meetings.
  • Ongoing business plan setting and progress reports tracking performance, risk and opportunities, budget and Capex planning together with project delivery and financial returns
  • Tracking trends within the capital markets and occupational markets, together with valuation performance, ESG, Marketing, resourcing and IT
  • The Board receives regular reports on the progress, opportunities and challenges within our Capital Partnerships to consider the performance and longer-term growth potential for our Capital Partnerships.
  • Awarded the REVO Awards 2024: Best Asset Management Initiative for Midsummer Place, Milton Keynes, one of our Capital Partnership assets.

Glossary & Company Information

"We are delighted that our asset management strategy is delivering at Midsummer Place. The enhanced occupier mix and physical upgrades align with our vision of establishing a leading retail and leisure destination. The transformation of a derelict area into a thriving F&B and event space has been particularly successful. We are proud of what the team has delivered to date to transform Midsummer Place, and we have a few more exciting things to come next year; I'd like to thank the whole team for their part in this successful turnaround."

Simon Anderson, Asset Management Director

& Appendix

Our Communities

Why they are important

Our assets are located in the heart of communities throughout the UK and play an integral role in the lives of our local customers.

How we have engaged

In many of our asset locations we are one of the largest real estate owners and we take this responsibility very seriously. Our asset team and Board Directors visit assets regularly to see the assets in action day to day and understand how our assets provide for the local community and wider town. We aim to strengthen the communities we operate in providing for the everyday needs of locals through our shops and services and supporting the causes that matter to them.

  • Regular reporting to the Board through the quarterly CEO report, quarterly ESG reporting and Asset and Development teams present business plan progress reports and Community Investment Plans
  • Board Directors visited assets across the portfolio meeting with local teams alongside the asset and development managers
  • The Board considers potential impacts to local residential areas where regeneration and broader developments are under discussion, including during the planning process relating to key developments across our portfolio
  • Requests for capital expenditure approval require consideration of how the projects could benefit the local community including improvement of the retail and services offer, creation of new jobs and homes, public realm enhancement and environmental impact.
  • Directors volunteered at Trussell food banks
  • TARA: We continue our partnership with The Academy of Real Assets, a charity whose mission is to engage students from underserved UK state schools and introduce them to a career in the world of real estate by providing them with insight into, and contacts within, the industry.
  • Regular consultation with local community groups, through our regeneration work, to enable us to understand their requirements and establish our priorities as a result
  • NewRiver representatives sit on the Board of several Town Funds to help steer the direction of local economic and social growth
  • Our shopping centre managers organise regular events and fundraising activities which bring people together, encourage dialogue and support the development of thriving communities
  • Sixth year of partnership with Trussell, raising almost £600,000 since its inception. We continue to support this initiative by providing physical space at our assets and volunteering time from our team
  • Our centre teams undertake regular training to equip them with appropriate skills and qualifications to help ensure the smooth running of on-site teams, our occupiers and the centre in general
  • Enhanced digital and social media use for community engagement

Stopping UK Hunger: Our 6-year partnership with Trussell

Since the inception of our partnership with Trussell in June 2019, we have raised almost £600,000 in support of their mission to stop UK hunger.

This year, non-monetary support included 2.13 tonnes of food donations; digital advertising; over 105 volunteering hours; and support for their Essentials Guarantee campaign.

Almost

NewRiver REIT plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2025 Governance Report Financial Statements ESG Data Sets 65 Strategic Report

& Appendix

Glossary & Company Information

Stakeholder engagement continued

Our Occupiers

Why they are important

When our occupiers succeed, we succeed too.

How we have engaged

We continuously nurture our working relationships with our occupiers, so we can better understand their needs and potential challenges or opportunities. We have handpicked our portfolio to focus on occupiers that provide essential goods and services, supporting the development of vibrant communities across the UK. Following our acquisition of Ellandi and the expansion of our Capital Partnerships portfolio, we have also developed expertise in managing destination and leisure assets.

We are proud that our portfolio offers excellent affordability of rents with low occupational costs, demonstrated through our consistently strong retailer retention rate and an affordable average rent. Our on-site teams work hard to ensure that our assets are clean, safe and welcoming environments for all ages.

Outcomes

  • Regular retailer engagement underpins our asset management strategy. Regular meetings are held between Board Directors, Executive Committee members and our asset teams, with our key occupiers at retailer head offices and on-site, listening to challenges, risks and opportunities arising which feed into our business plans and informs our strategy. This includes discussing future occupier needs, market sentiment, performance, growth/contraction plans
  • Building on last year, we have further invested in our partnership with Lloyds Bank, accessing high-quality quarterly consumer spending data on 85% of our portfolio by value. This data provides store-by-store sales turnover, including the online contribution from that

store, where customers are coming from, frequency of visits, average transaction values, a demographic profile of customers and which consecutive stores customers purchases from. The application and analysis of this data touches almost every asset management decision that we make and we believe will significantly enhance our capabilities to make better future decisions to further enhance our asset business plans

  • We discuss environmental and sustainability strategies with our occupiers, including green leases, MEES compliance, enhanced data collection and on-site energy consumption; we engage with our occupiers regarding our Pathway to Net Zero to help align with the occupiers' net zero ambitions
  • Supporting our occupiers with Business Rate reductions
  • Continuing to collect energy data from our occupiers and assets
  • The Board receives regular reports on occupier activity through the Executive Directors, our research and insight teams, and ESG reporting, to inform future strategy
  • The asset management team attend an annual event called Completely Retail Marketplace in London twice a year, where the retail real estate industry come together to discuss new opportunities as well as expand and consolidate existing leasing plans and asset management initiatives
  • Board Directors actively participate in various industry committees to help shape policy and identify opportunities for the retail real estate sector, thereby unlocking investment in the industry. For example, members of the NewRiver team serve on several committees of the British Property Federation (BPF), including the Finance Committee, where our CFO sits, as well as the Development and Sustainability Committees. This year, Executive Director Morgan Garfield was appointed chair of the BPF Retail Committee, succeeding former chair and NewRiver CEO, Allan Lockhart.

Sainsbury's team in the Broadway Shopping Centre, Bexleyheath

Our Lenders

Why they are important

Our lenders play a critical role in supporting our operations and growth aspirations, and we are proactive in maintaining strong working relationships with our bank lenders, bondholders and rating agency who in turn help provide funding to facilitate our strategy.

How we have engaged

  • Proactive dialogue, transparent disclosure and prudent financial management to ensure that our lenders understand and remain confident in our strategy and capabilities. These relationships help ensure that the business remains in a strong and flexible financial position with a predominantly unsecured balance sheet. Our debt structure is highly efficient and covenant-light, affording us significant operational flexibility
  • The CFO and finance team held regular meetings with our relationship banks, bondholders and rating agency to ensure that they are kept up to date with business strategy, developments and performance; this was particularly important throughout the offer period and completion of the acquisition of Capital & Regional plc during FY25
  • Meetings with bondholders alongside shareholders as part of FY24 and HY25 results roadshow.

Outcomes

  • The CFO and Board consider factors that could impact the business and our lenders on a regular basis including: macro-economic environment, specifically interest rates; geopolitical environment; debt structure; current and future debt requirements; performance of retail operations including occupier trading, rent collection, leasing and occupancy; retail property valuations; impact of potential transactions; wider activity within the retail investment market
  • Prior to the acquisition of Capital & Regional we had positioned the business to grow, with elevated headroom across all Financial Policies, no maturity on drawn debt until March 2028 and no exposure to interest rate rises on our drawn Group debt facility. However, despite the strength of our financial position, we were a smaller business, having completed Work Out asset disposals in order to improve the quality of our underlying portfolio, with a portfolio valuation of £544 million at 31 March 2024, and only one drawn debt maturity (our £300 million unsecured bond).
  • The acquisition of Capital & Regional not only replenished our scale, increasing our portfolio valuation to £0.9 billion with a complementary and high quality portfolio of assets, it also diversified our debt maturity profile because we were able to port across the £140 million Mall facility, secured on three of the six shopping centres acquired, with a coupon of 3.45% and maturity in January 2027
  • One of our key priorities when contemplating the acquisition of Capital & Regional was maintaining the strength of our financial position post-acquisition. Following completion of the transaction, we have maintained significant headroom across all Financial Policies, and although our Loan to Value at 31 March 2025 at 42.3% is above our guidance of <40%, it is within policy and in-line with the proforma communicated to stakeholders during the transaction process, and to reduce to within guidance levels would require a modest and achievable level of disposals
  • In September 2024, following the announcement of NewRiver's possible cash and share offer for Capital & Regional and the announcement of our significantly oversubscribed equity placing and retail offer to part fund the possible offer, Fitch Ratings affirmed NewRiver's Long-Term Issuer Default Rating (IDR) at 'BBB' with Stable Outlook, our senior unsecured rating at 'BBB+' and Short-Term IDR at 'F2'. Fitch reaffirmed these ratings in February 2025.

Fitch Affirmed NewRiver's Investment Grade Credit Ratings

In September 2024 Fitch Ratings affirmed our Long-Term Issuer Default Rating (IDR) at 'BBB' with a Stable Outlook, senior unsecured rating at 'BBB+' and Short-Term IDR at 'F2'. The senior unsecured rating applies to NewRiver's £300 million unsecured bond dated 2028.

"Following the announcement of the transformational acquisition of Capital & Regional, we were delighted to have our investment grade credit ratings affirmed by Fitch once again, endorsing NewRiver's newly expanded business and our differentiated position in the UK retail market.

Our focus on retail assets that provide essential goods and services to consumers on rental terms affordable to retailers, together with our marketleading operating platform, data-led decision making and the strength of our balance sheet means we feel well positioned to continue our growth trajectory."

Will Hobman Chief Financial Officer

& Appendix Glossary & Company Information

Our Local Authorities

Why they are important

Following the expansion of our business, including the acquisition of Ellandi in July 2024 – which added 16 new mandates – and the acquisition of Capital & Regional's six shopping centres, we now work with a broad range of local authorities across the UK, at town, district and county level.

Our efforts focus on regenerating and protecting the towns in which we invest and operate in, creating long-term social and economic growth.

How we have engaged

  • Throughout the year, our asset and development teams, along with Non-Executive and Executive Directors, attend various senior-level meetings with local authorities and public sector focused organisations. These engagements involve discussions with Chief Executives, the wider cabinet members, Planning Officers, Regeneration Officers, and local Councillors. The aim is to steer the regional strategies that will impact the long-term social and economic viability of towns, which in turn directly impact our assets
  • Understanding the priorities of the Council across the borough is critical, as is recognising the significance of private sector-led regeneration and the allocation of resources to the local authority's planning team
  • Local authority support for smaller regeneration projects that bring a positive Benefit:Cost Ratio (BCR)
  • Working across a number of new local authority mandates through our Capital Partnerships portfolio

Outcome

  • We are now working across a number of new local authority mandates through our enlarged Capital Partnerships portfolio following the acquisition of Ellandi, in addition to ongoing engagement with local authorities across our existing portfolio
  • During the year we were appointed on two new local authority mandates in Tamworth and Wythenshawe: firstly, to asset manage Ankerside Shopping Centre, Tamworth on behalf of Tamworth Borough Council as well as provide strategic advice for the 160,000 sq ft shopping centre acquired by the local authority in 2024; and secondly to asset manage Wythenshawe town centre, supporting a significant regeneration project led by Muse and Manchester City Council
  • Our Capital Partnerships team's work and engagement with Blackpool Council was recognised through the award of the Estates Gazette Public/Private Partnership award for the team's regeneration work following the transformation of Blackpool town centre
  • We are in advanced stages of developing a partnership with Mid Sussex District Council to deliver the major regeneration of Burgess Hill town centre where we have planning consent for a mixed-use redevelopment. The project includes pre-letting agreements with a food discount retailer as the anchor, a hotel operator and residential developers for parts of the site
  • We secured a total of six planning consents during the year for our owned assets, helping advance asset business plans and contributing to improving the offer for our communities
  • For our Capital Partnerships portfolio, we secured planning permission in Bootle for the Strand Shopping Centre, to commence the first phase of a broader redevelopment, introducing a mixed-use offering spanning retail, leisure, hospitality, healthcare and education services.

Awarded Estates Gazette Public/Private Partnership award for the team's regeneration

True public/private partnerships at its best – contributing toward the regeneration of Blackpool town centre, underpinned by data-driven decision-making, tailored to meet the needs of residents and visitors alike, to achieve genuine social and economic impact.

work in Blackpool

Background

The quantifiable transformation of Blackpool town centre is a fantastic example of public/ private collaboration. The team drew upon best practice from private sector projects in one of the UK's most deprived towns.

The collaboration has delivered (and continues to deliver) new F&B, a cinema, a market, enhanced retail, as well as improvements to the public realm.

This social value focused partnership with Blackpool Council leveraged the transformation of the retail to help drive the wider regeneration of Blackpool town centre. The research-centric asset management ethos aligns with Blackpool Council's innovative approach which ensures that every step is grounded in evidence, and tailored to meet the evolving needs of its residents and visitors alike.

Strategic Report

ESG report

Delivering sustainable growth

Progress towards our objectives is measured annually against our ESG targets and external benchmarks, and the outcomes are used to enhance our ESG activities for the following year. This approach generates a feedback loop whereby our ESG programme adapts to the findings and the evolution of best practice.

"I am delighted to report the following achievements of this year's ESG programme, alongside our ambitions for making further progress against our objectives over the coming year."

2024 was a

transformational year for our business, with our acquisitions of Ellandi and Capital & Regional expanding our platform and potential to make a positive impact in more communities through the pursuit of our ESG objectives. Aligned with our corporate strategy, our objectives are built around four focus areas which reflect the issues that are important to our stakeholders and our business: minimising our environmental impact; engaging our team and occupiers; supporting our communities; and leading in governance and disclosure.

1. Minimising our Environmental Impact1

Minimising our environmental impact requires action at the corporate, portfolio, and asset level. We have policies in place to guide corporate-level activity which engage our staff on principles of collective environmental responsibility that can be applied across our business. Our net-zero pathway and interim targets guide our initiatives, supported by our asset-level Environmental & Social Implementation Plans, which allow us to monitor our progress and accelerate action where required.

Top 3 Achievements in FY25

    1. 13% reduction in absolute Scope 1 emissions vs FY24
    1. 12% reduction in absolute Scope 2 emissions vs FY24
    1. 39% reduction in total Scope 1 & 2 location-based emissions from our baseline year of FY20, bringing us 93% of the way to our SBTi-approved 2030 target

2. Supporting our Communities

We are committed to ensuring that we are responsible partners in our communities, supporting and championing local causes and providing an affordable choice of goods and services to address the needs of local people, whilst minimising our impact on the environment.

Top 3 Achievements in FY25

    1. £579,802 of cumulative donations to Trussell since our partnership began in June 2019 2. 361 community initiatives
  • supported at our centres
    1. 670 hours volunteered by NewRiver and Centre Teams to support local causes

3. Engaging our Team and Occupiers We are committed to engaging with

and listening to our team, occupiers and communities, working together to bring about positive progress for each and addressing the issues that are important to them.

Top 3 Achievements in FY25

    1. Retained our recognition as one of the Sunday Times' Best Places to Work
    1. Became an Accredited Real Living Wage Employer and established a Wellness & Representation Committee
    1. Engaged with occupiers at three of our assets to undertake Real Estate Social Value Index assessments, to understand our collective social impact and key opportunities to enhance our approach

4. Leading in Governance and Disclosure

Being a leader in governance and disclosure means surpassing industry minimum standards and demonstrating our commitment to providing transparent, informative and accurate accounts of our ESG performance and risk management processes. We use various disclosure frameworks to ensure we align our reports with the best available guidance on the ESG issues that our stakeholders value.

Top 3 Achievements in FY25

    1. Improved our GRESB score to 80/100 and gained an additional "green star"
    1. Maintained our 'B' rating in the CDP
    1. We published our employee Code of Conduct and commissioned updated climaterelated risk assessments incorporating biodiversity

ESG report continued

Our ambitions for FY26

In our FY24 report, we shared our ambition to re-model and re-baseline our Net-Zero targets using the SBTi's Buildings Criteria. Whilst we modelled new targets in FY25 (using FY24 data), our acquisition of Capital & Regional represents a material change to our business, portfolio and emissions profile. As a result, we are now reconsidering the most suitable baseline year from which to measure meaningful progress. As part of this process of evolving our strategy to the latest industry best practice, we will also transition back to financial year emissions reporting to align our ESG and financial disclosures as required by IFRS S1&S2, which we will begin reporting to in FY26.

With the addition of six new shopping centres and three Snozones to our portfolio, we are enthusiastic about the increased scale of the opportunity we have to make a difference in the communities in which we operate. We are grateful to our devoted centre teams and property managers for their commitment to delivering our vision for sustainable growth and thank them wholeheartedly for their continued support. We warmly welcome our new colleagues and embrace working together to generate tangible social impact in our communities.

Yours sincerely,

Emma Mackenzie

Head of Asset Management and ESG

16 June 2025

Sustainability accreditations and commitments

Strategic Report

We use industry-recognised indices to track our sustainability performance:

Accreditation or
commitment
score or equivalent
Observations
Global Real Estate
Sustainability
Benchmark
Score: 80/100
We have improved our score from 72/100 to 80/100, earning ourselves an additional "green star" signifying improved
performance relative to other GRESB participants, and once again achieved a perfect score in the Management module
(30/30). We also retained full marks in the Social (18/18) and Governance (20/20) aspects of the assessment. This means
our score increase was driven by achieving our goal of enhancing our performance in the Environmental aspect of the
assessment, which was a result of improved occupier data collection rates and gaining green building certifications
across 10 of our core assets.
CDP (formerly Carbon
Disclosure Project)
Score: B
We are pleased to have maintained our 'B' score in FY25, continuing to be recognised by the CDP for "taking coordinated
action on climate issues". Although our overall rating remained the same, we achieved an 'A' rating for Emissions Reduction
Initiatives and Low Carbon Products, which was a key improvement opportunity identified in our FY24 ESG report.
United Nations The SDGs to which we are committed are:
Sustainable
Development Goals
We are committed to 11
SDGs addressing issues we
can meaningfully impact
Various case studies are provided throughout this report, demonstrating actions we have taken this year to deliver on
these goals.
Task Force on
Climate-related
Financial Disclosures
7th consecutive
year reporting
NewRiver publicly supports the TCFD Recommendations and is in its 7th consecutive year of reporting in alignment with
them. Following our acquisition of Capital & Regional, we commissioned a new climate scenario analysis of our larger
portfolio to provide an up-to-date assessment of the climate-related risks most relevant to our business. This will be
the last reporting year that we leverage the TCFD framework, with this taskforce having been disbanded. From FY26,
we will report to IFRS S1&S2.
European Real Estate
Association (EPRA) sBPR
Sustainability Best Practices Recommendations (sBPR) Awards are given to listed real estate companies in recognition
of excellence in the transparency and comparability of their ESG disclosures and we are proud to have maintained the
Award: Gold top award status.
EPCs The EPC profile of our portfolio continues to improve with re-assessment upon expiry of previous certificates, with
72% of registered ratings already consistent with the previously proposed 2027 MEES milestone in England & Wales.
72% rated 'C' and above This figure is for the full, post-Capital & Regional acquisition NewRiver operational control portfolio.
WELL Health-Safety
Rating
The rating is designed to empower workplace leaders, owners and operators across large and small businesses alike to
prioritise the health and safety of their employees, staff, visitors and other stakeholders. The WELL Health-Safety seal
10 assets certified is a visible mark of our organisation's commitment to ensuring health and safety best practice at our centres.
Real Estate Social Value
Index (RESVI)
3 assets certified
We undertook RESVI assessments on two of our shopping centres and one of our retail parks, to understand and seek
to quantify the positive impact our assets have on their local communities. Across the sample, we found that £6.25 per
sqft was generated on average, suggesting over £41 million could have been generated across our entire portfolio
(pre-Capital & Regional acquisition).

About our ESG performance reporting

Each year, our ESG reporting continues to evolve as our ESG programme matures. We stay abreast of emerging market and ESG disclosure trends and proactively manage our data collection processes to ensure our stakeholders are provided with valuable insight into our ESG performance. It is important to NewRiver that key ESG information on our business is accessible, and so whilst we adopt an integrated annual reporting approach, we also make the ESG content of this report and our TCFD disclosures available in standalone documents on our website to provide greater accessibility.

Scope and boundaries

In order to facilitate the ISO 14064-3:2019 verification1 of our environmental data, we altered our ESG reporting period to the calendar year in FY23. We previously reported in direct alignment with our financial reporting year, however the resource requirements of the ISO 14064-3:2019 standard necessitated that we make this change in order to continue with our integrated reporting approach.

This report therefore relates to our ESG performance during the calendar year of 1 January 2024 – 31 December 2024 which includes Q4 FY24 and Q1, Q2 and Q3 in FY25. Throughout this report, this reporting period is referred to as FY25. The preceding calendar year is utilised for year-on-year performance comparisons, and is referred to throughout as FY24.

In disclosing our ESG performance, we adopt the Operational Control boundary, in recognition of this boundary being reflective of our ability to implement our operating policies and influence ESG performance. Our Operational Control boundary excludes JV assets in which we have a minority ownership stake, and assets where we act only in an advisory capacity.

Reflecting the growth of our business

On 10 December 2024, NewRiver acquired Capital & Regional, representing a significant change to our business. The acquisition added six new shopping centres to our portfolio, as well as Snozone – the UK's largest indoor real snow centres - creating a material shift in our emissions profile.

As our ESG reporting period is calendar year, as was Capital & Regional's, and the acquisition completed with only three weeks of the reporting period remaining, we have maintained separate full calendar year environmental disclosures for NewRiver and Capital & Regional, which are presented alongside one another in this report. We made this decision to ensure that year-on-year performance comparisons remain useful and directly comparable. However, in order to provide environmental insights which align with and fully reflect our financial performance, we have also provided an additional SECR disclosure for the FY25 period of 1 April 2024 – 31 March 2025. This disclosure is an estimate based on an extrapolation of the 2024 calendar year data for both businesses. It therefore represents 36

weeks of emissions data for NewRiver only, combined with 16 weeks of NewRiver and Capital & Regional emissions data, to represent a 12 month period in which the acquisition took place during week 37, consistent with our financial reporting. This is provided to ensure that meaningful insights can be generated as to the relationship between our financial and environmental performance.

Please note that all commentary in relation to performance against our ESG targets relates to the pre-acquisition NewRiver portfolio only, as we did not have sufficient time remaining in the reporting year to re-baseline any targets and/or incorporate new assets into the processes that enable us to make progress against these targets2. We look forward to establishing new targets that reflect the opportunities presented by our larger portfolio.

Structure and materiality

Our disclosures are structured to provide stakeholders with an overview of our ESG programme, our approach to realising our ESG objectives, and details of our activities within – and performance against – these objectives.

To maintain transparency and comparability of our performance disclosures over time, we consistently monitor and report against the sustainability metrics recommended by EPRA. As such, performance insights are provided on both a "like-for-like" and "absolute" basis. Like-for-like disclosures remove properties that were acquired or sold during the reporting year from the comparison, to evidence how our portfolio performed without increases or decreases in energy/water consumption and waste generation associated with owning more or fewer properties than in the previous year. Absolute disclosures disregard the impact of property sales and acquisitions, providing a complete picture of our overall impact as a business. We believe both metrics are important for transparently communicating our environmental impact and how we are progressing against our target to minimise it.

We assess the materiality of ESG issues relevant to our business by considering their potential impact on our portfolio, our stakeholders, and our communities. The UN Sustainable Development Goals to which we have committed support guided action on issues that we have the opportunity to meaningfully contribute to, by nature of our business model, purpose, and mission. Embedding the recommendations of the Task Force on Climate-Related Financial Disclosures allows us to identify risks and opportunities associated with external factors, and develop an informed and strategic approach to their management.

    1. Limited assurance based on a data sample of 60% of each emissions category
    1. This relates to performance disclosures that are calculated over a 12-month period or draw comparisons between two 12-month periods only. Disclosures that relate to a single point in time, e.g., building certifications/ EPCs have been provided as up-to-date, post-C&R acquisition insights. All disclosures include statements clarifying their scope.

Company Information

Reporting frameworks

Our ESG reporting is guided by relevant global reporting frameworks including the EPRA Sustainability Best Practices Recommendations (sBPR), and the Recommendations of the Task Force for Climate-related Financial Disclosures (TCFD). Having integrated our ESG reporting into our Annual Report & Accounts, we also adopt the recommendations of the International Integrated Reporting Council (IIRC).

Planned evolution of our reporting

Following the disbandment of the TCFD and in anticipation of legislation to mandate listed companies to report sustainability and climate-related risks and opportunities in accordance with the International Sustainability Standards Board's (ISSB) Sustainability Disclosure Standards (SDS: IFRS S1&S2) as part of the UK Sustainability Reporting Standards (UK SRS), we are transitioning our ESG reporting year back to full alignment with our financial year. This poses some practical challenges for our GHG data verification processes, however we are trialling quarterly verification with our consultants to address this challenge. We therefore anticipate that our FY26 disclosure will relate to the period of 1 Apr 2025 – 31 Mar 2026, and that our sustainability and climate-related risk disclosures will be provided in accordance with IFRS S1&S2. As such, this will be the last report in which these disclosures are referred to as "TCFD Disclosures".

Disciplined capital allocation

We assess the long-term resilience of our assets, with capital allocation decisions made by comparing risk adjusted returns on our assets to those available from other uses of capital. Capital allocation options include investing into our portfolio, acquiring assets in the direct real estate market and share buybacks. Assets can be acquired either on our balance sheet or in capital partnerships.

1 3 2

Flexible

with a committed ESG strategy embedded across our business

Balance Sheet

Our operating platform is underpinned by a conservative, predominantly unsecured balance sheet. We are focused on maintaining our prudent covenant headroom position and have access to significant cash reserves which provide us with the flexibility to pursue opportunities which support our strategy for growth.

Leveraging our platform

We leverage our market leading platform to enhance and protect income returns through active asset management across our assets and for assets we manage on behalf of our capital partnerships; the latter provides enhanced returns through asset management fee income and the opportunity to receive promote fees.

Our strategy is delivered by our People, Portfolio, Partnerships and Performance

Our business model is underpinned by a high-quality portfolio, expert team, strong working relationships, data-driven insight, robust systems and a commitment to sustainability to support the delivery of positive performance for the long-term

Our ESG Objectives

1. Minimising our

Environmental Impact

Our net-zero strategy is embedded in every stage of our asset management approach and collaboration with our Capital Partners. We seek to provide future-proofed developments which minimise lifecycle carbon.

1 2 3

2. Supporting our Communities

Our assets play a critical role in communities and our on-site teams support local charities and community groups. We work closely with councils and local stakeholders to ensure developments address community needs.

1 2

3. Engaging our Team and Occupiers

We raise awareness of evolving ESG issues and create opportunities for positive impact. We engage our existing occupiers in our sustainability strategy and work with new occupiers to deliver on mutual sustainability goals.

1 2

4. Leading in Governance

and Disclosure

We recognise our responsibility to ensure long-term resilience against societal, regulatory and climate change. We adopt industry-leading frameworks, performance benchmarks and certifications to align our governance and disclosure processes with best practice.

1 2 3

ESG report continued

& Appendix

Our targets

N Publicly commit to net-zero and set FY20 carbon emissions baseline

2023

  • N Receive target validation from the Science-Based Targets Initiative (SBTi) for aligning our net-zero pathway with a 1.5-degree global warming trajectory
  • E 100% of waste generated at our managed properties is diverted from landfill. 100% of landlord electricity is procured from renewable sources
  • S Support a minimum of 5 industry/career engagement activities for young people per year and; Achieve a 90% response rate to our annual staff survey, with at least 80% confirming that they feel NewRiver cares about their wellbeing

All enclosed shopping centres to participate in our Quiet Hour initiative and have a community engagement in place. 50% of NewRiver staff to participate in our volunteering programme

2022 2025 2030

N Achieve net-zero for all corporate-related carbon emissions (Scope 1-3)

85% recycling rate at our managed properties

E Electric vehicle charging points installed across all retail properties with a surface level car park

50% improvement (from 2020 baseline) in landlord on-site renewable energy generation

Building certifications targeted, and lifecycle carbon assessments undertaken, for

100% of our new construction and major renovation projects

S Achieve a 75% response rate to our occupier satisfaction survey. Biodiversity plans to be in place for at least 15% of our assets

Key

  • N Net-zero targets
  • E UN SDG aligned Environmental targets
  • S UN SDG aligned Social targets
  • N Achieve a 42% reduction (against baseline) in carbon emissions across our corporate activities and operational real estate, as required by the SBTi
  • E 75% of occupiers transitioned to renewable energy suppliers

2040

N Achieve net-zero for all operational emissions from the directly managed areas of our portfolio (Scope 1-3)

2050

  • N Achieve net-zero in terms of operational and embodied emissions (Scope 1-3) across our portfolio, whether space is directly managed, or managed by third parties
  • E Over 25% of landlord energy is generated on-site from renewable sources

ESG report continued

Progress towards our near-term targets

Target year % complete FY25 Progress Report
Environmental
100% of waste generated at our managed
properties is diverted from landfill
2022 100% We are pleased to have achieved our target of zero waste to landfill in FY22 and maintained this policy throughout FY25.
100% of landlord electricity is procured from
renewable sources
2022 100% We transitioned all landlord electricity supplies across our portfolio to Renewable Energy Guarantees of Origin (REGO)
backed tariffs in 2020.
85% recycling rate at our managed properties 2025 57% Considering only non-organic waste, our FY25 recycling rate was 48%. Please see page 80 for a detailed explanation
and our plans to address this going forward.
Electric vehicle charging points installed
across all retail properties with a surface-level
car park
2025 80% We currently have EV charging installations or contracts in motion to deliver installations at 12/15 of our surface-level
car parks, bringing our progress rate to 80%. We previously reported a progress rate of 88%, however this has shifted
due to feasibility challenges at two of our sites. Where feasibility challenges are commercial rather than technical, we
will continue to explore alternative delivery routes. In addition to this target however, we also have EV chargers
available at 60% of our multi-storey car parks. Together, this means that EV charging infrastructure is, or will shortly
be, available at 72% of our sites.
50% improvement (from a 2020 baseline) in
landlord on-site renewable energy generation
2025 0% Whilst renewable energy generation at our sites increased 7% between 2023 and 2024, primarily due to maintenance
works to our solar installations, overall renewable energy generation has decreased 32% between 2020 and 2024
(though two sites have seen increases of 30-32%). This is because existing installations are aging, and because we
have not commissioned any new installations during the last few years. We have plans to replace inverters at our site
in Hastings to boost generation there, and are exploring a large additional installation at one of our newly acquired
sites, the Exchange in Ilford. We recognise that this target has not been achieved and that this year's significant
growth of our portfolio requires it to be revisited.
Building certifications targeted, and lifecycle
carbon assessments undertaken, for 100%
of our new construction and major
renovation projects
2025 N/A There were no relevant projects in relation to this target during the 12-month period to 31 December 2024.

Company Information

ESG report continued

Target year % complete FY24 Progress Report
Social
Support a minimum of 5 industry/ career
engagement activities for young people
per year
Annual 100%
(1-3) Our Broadway Centre in Bexleyheath hosted three site visits in partnership with the Palace for Life Foundation
(find out more on page 86) and Townley Grammar School, between February and December 2024.

(4) We supported an interview workshop with students of Gaynes School, Upminster, in June 2024.

(5-6) We supported two Palace for Life Foundation Career Fairs in March and April 2024.

(7) We supported a Harris Academy, Greenwich Career Fair in July 2024.

(8) We supported a year 12 interview workshop with Southfields Academy in November 2024.

(9) Through our relationship with the Academy of Real Assets, we continue to have representation on their youth
board which meets regularly throughout the year.
Achieve a 90% response rate to our annual
staff survey, with at least 80% confirming that
they feel NewRiver cares about their wellbeing
Annual 100% We received a 96% response rate to our most recent staff survey (March 24), with 88% of respondents confirming that
they feel NewRiver cares about their wellbeing (up from 85% in the previous year). The survey is conducted as part of the
Times Best Places to Work initiative, so is fully independent. We were rated "excellent" in all aspects assessed.
All enclosed shopping centres to participate
in our Quiet Hour Initiative and have a
community engagement plan in place
Ongoing 100% The introduction of asset-level Environmental & Social Implementation Plans across our portfolio means that all centres
have an action plan in place for ongoing community engagement activities, with the Quiet Hour initiative forming a key
component of these plans.
50% of NewRiver staff to participate in
our volunteering programme
Annual 100% In FY25, NewRiver staff provided 90 hours of volunteer support to Trussell, with volunteering sessions typically lasting
around five hours each. Staff also provided a further 206 hours of volunteering time to their own chosen causes,
including homelessness and health charities. This equates to a total of 59 volunteering sessions for 62 staff members
(average headcount for the year), meaning we have more than fulfilled our target.
Achieve a 75% response rate to our occupier
satisfaction survey
2025 100% We are pleased to have achieved this target with our most recent Occupier Satisfaction & Sustainability survey (FY24), which
achieved a response rate of 78%. Our centre teams played a pivotal role in the achievement of this target, aided by our
introduction of a £10 charity donation incentive for each response given.
Biodiversity plans to be in place for at least
15% of our assets
2025 100% This year, we commissioned a portfolio-wide biodiversity risk assessment to be undertaken, to evaluate the
biodiversity-related impacts and dependencies relevant to our assets. The assessment looked at a variety of metrics
such as water condition and scarcity, air condition, tree cover loss, pollution, invasives and ecosystem condition.
The results of the assessment are now being leveraged to incorporate measures into our Environmental & Social
Implementation plans, tailored to the specific biodiversity risks relevant to each centre's location.

ESG report continued

Objective 1: Minimising our environmental impact

Energy and GHG emissions performance

On Earth Day, 22nd April 2022, we became a signatory to the Better Buildings Partnership's Climate Commitment, joining other responsible organisations across the industry in pursuing a 1.5°C future for our planet. In becoming a signatory, we have committed to publishing our net-zero carbon pathway and delivery plan, disclosing the energy performance of our assets, and developing a comprehensive climate resilience strategy. The initiative has an overreaching objective of delivering net-zero buildings by 2050, incorporating both operational and embodied carbon. The scope of the commitment makes it one of the most ambitious commitments that property owners can adopt.

The key milestones on our journey to becoming a net-zero business are:

  • 2025: all corporate emissions (Scopes 1-3) will be brought to net-zero
  • 2030: we will achieve a 42% reduction in absolute emissions from our 2020 baseline
  • 2040: all emissions arising from the landlordcontrolled areas of our portfolio (Scopes 1-3) will be brought to net-zero
  • 2050: all emissions arising from the tenantcontrolled areas of our portfolio, and from our development activities, will be brought to net-zero, making us a fully net-zero business.

As of FY25, we have achieved a 39% reduction in total Scope 1 & 2 emissions from our baseline year of FY20, bringing us 93% of the way to our SBTi-approved 2030 target to reduce absolute emissions by 42%.

Considering our corporate emissions only, and our target to bring these to net-zero by 2025, we have achieved a 47% reduction in location-based Scope 1 & 2 emissions, and fully eliminated our market-based Scope 1 & 2 emissions. Whilst our expanded dataset and improved accounting methodologies between our baseline year and now have seen our calculated corporate Scope 3 emissions increase, we have offset our residual emissions of 560 tCO2e via a validated Woodland Carbon Code project at Loch Ness, to bring them to a net-zero level.

In-line with the Companies Act 2006 (Strategic & Directors' Reports) Regulations 2013, we disclose our annual global GHG emissions in terms of our total energy use, intensity ratio, and a narrative on the energy management and efficiency measures we implement. Tables presenting a breakdown of this information for the NewRiver business (Jan-Dec 2024), Capital & Regional business (Jan-Dec 2024), and combined business (Apr 2024 – Mar 2025) can be found on the following two pages.

NewRiver emissions

performance summary

  • 13% reduction in absolute Scope 1 emissions from the combustion of gas & other fuels (7% reduction on a like-for-like basis)
  • 12% reduction in absolute Scope 2 emissions from the consumption of electricity (location-based)
  • Whilst total like-for-like electricity consumption increased by 1% across the portfolio due to fluctuations arising from vacant and rates mitigation units, like-for-like common area electricity consumption reduced by 2%
  • Improved data collection across the category of Downstream Leased Assets, alongside significant asset disposals, has contributed to a 40% calculated reduction in NewRiver's scope 3 emissions. It should be noted that the vast majority of this reduction is due to improved data quality as opposed to representing a real-terms reduction. Both sets of disclosures are prepared using the best data available to us relating to each of the relevant periods, and both have been verified to ISO14064-3:2019.
  • On-site renewable energy generation was boosted 7% FY24-25 to 203,328 kWh through maintenance/ upgrade works. We are also evaluating opportunities for new installations, with the acquisition of Capital & Regional re-setting the criteria used to prioritise sites.

Energy management and efficiency measures

Environmental & Social Implementation Plans are in place across NewRiver's managed shopping centres. The plans specify four mandatory energy management and efficiency measures which must be reviewed, on a quarterly basis, for implementation at all centres where relevant and feasible. These measures are: routine reviews of the installation of smart meters (AMR) for all relevant utility types; installation of LEDs in all landlordcontrolled areas; implementing a Building Management System optimisation programme; and reviewing plant equipment run times and controls at least quarterly and ensuring optimum settings are in place for day/night, seasons and occupancy levels.

A key driver of our reduced common area electricity consumption this year has been the implementation of the above initiatives, such as at our Hillstreet Centre in Middlesbrough which is now 100% LED throughout landlordcontrolled areas and adopts a phased lighting programme in the lead up to all store opening times. A key saving was the installation of motion sensor lights within the customer staircase to the malls. The number of old fluorescent tube lights was reduced from 28 lights at 158w each, to 7 LEDs. Similarly, at Three Horseshoes Walk in Warminster, lighting replacements and adjustments to lighting schedules contributed to a 44% saving in FY25. We have also invested in LED lighting replacement projects at our Horsefair Shopping Centre in Wisbech, Hildreds Shopping Centre in Skegness, and Cuckoo Bridge Retail Park in Dumfries. These are landlord-funded projects which will serve to generate energy and cost savings for our service charges.

  1. Read more about our commitment and delivery strategy in our Pathway to Net-Zero, which can be found in the Sustainability section of our website.
NewRiver REIT plc Annual Report and Accounts 2025

NewRiver REIT plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2025 Governance Report Financial Statements ESG Data Sets 76 & Appendix Glossary & Company Information Strategic Report

ESG report continued

Tables below present total energy use (including electricity on both a location and market basis), carbon footprint across Scope 1, 2 and 3 emissions, as well as an appropriate carbon intensity metric. The performance data presented below relates to the 2024 calendar year, 1st January 2024 – 31st December 2024, but consistent with the rest of this report, is referred to as FY25. For the avoidance of doubt, FY24 figures relate to the calendar year of 2023.

FY25 SECR Disclosure (NewRiver Jan-Dec 2024) % Change FY25 SECR Disclosure (Capital & Regional Jan-Dec 2024) FY24 FY25 % Change
FY24 FY25 % Change Greenhouse Gas Emissions by Scope (tCO2e)
Greenhouse Gas Emissions by Scope (tCO2e) Scope 1 Emissions from combustion of gas & other fuels 410 408 0%
Scope 2 Location-based emissions from electricity
Scope 1 Emissions from combustion of gas & other fuels 495 431 -13% purchased for own use 3,686 3,253 -12%
Scope 2 Location-based emissions from electricity Scope 2 Market-based emissions from electricity purchased
purchased for own use 1,702 1,501 -12% for own use 8 1 -90%
Scope 2 Market-based emissions from electricity purchased Scope 3 Emissions from fuel & energy-related activities,
for own use waste (including water), and downstream leased assets 6,499 8,326 28%
Scope 3 Emissions from purchased goods & services, capital
goods, fuel & energy-related activities, waste (including
water), business travel & employee commuting, and
downstream leased assets
22,060 13,170 -40% Total Scope 1, 2 & 3 location-based emissions 10,595 11,988 13%
Total Scope 1, 2 & 3 location-based emissions 24,256 15,102 -38% UK only Scope 1, 2 & 3 location-based emissions 9,428 10,854 15%
Total Scope 1, 2 & 3 market-based emissions 22,178 13,269 -40% Total Scope 1, 2 & 3 market-based emissions 6,917 8,735 26%
Intensity Scope 1 & 2 (location-based) tCO2e/m2 0.013 0.014 3% UK only Scope 1, 2 & 3 market-based emissions 6,625 8,451 28%
Energy Consumption (kWh) Total Intensity Scope 1 & 2 (location-based) tCO2e/m2 0.013 0.014 9%
Energy use from the combustion of gas and other fuels 2,708,120 2,355,619 -13% UK only intensity Scope 1 &2 (location-based) tCO2e/m2 0.010 0.011 7%
Energy use from consumption of electricity purchased for
own use 8,217,064 7,247,261 -12% Energy Consumption (kWh)
Energy use from business travel 31,963 22,874 -28% Total energy use from the combustion of gas and other fuels 2,240,988 2,232,847 0%
UK only energy use from the combustion of gas and other fuels 2,240,988 2,232,847 0%
Total energy use from consumption of electricity purchased
for own use 17,799,048 15,713,094 -12%
UK only energy use from the consumption of electricity
purchased for own use 13,571,733 11,609,569 -14%

In order to provide environmental insights which align with and fully reflect our financial performance, we have provided an additional SECR disclosure for the FY25 period of 1 April 2024 – 31 March 2025. This disclosure is an estimate based on an extrapolation of the 2024 calendar year data for both businesses presented above. It therefore represents 36 weeks of emissions data for NewRiver only, combined with 16 weeks of NewRiver and Capital & Regional emissions data, to represent a 12 month period in which NewRiver's acquisition of Capital & Regional took place during week 37, consistent with our financial reporting. The comparison data is drawn from NewRiver's FY24 SECR disclosure (calendar year 2023) data. This is provided to ensure that meaningful insights can be generated as to the relationship between our financial and environmental performance. The data below has not been seasonally-adjusted and therefore represents an equal division and multiplication of relevant weeks from the calendar year period by number only, i.e. the 16 weeks of combined data does not represent 16 weeks from the winter quarter, but 16 average weeks.

Additional FY25 SECR Disclosure: NewRiver and Capital & Regional

1 April 2024 – 31 March 2025 FY24 FY25 %
Change
Greenhouse Gas Emissions by Scope (tCO2e)
Scope 1 emissions from combustion of gas & other fuels 495 557 12%
UK only Scope 1 emissions from combustion of gas & other fuels 495 557 12%
Scope 2 location-based emissions from electricity purchased for
own use
1,702 2,502 47%
UK only Scope 2 location-based emissions from electricity
purchased for own use
1,702 2,240 32%
Scope 2 market-based emissions from electricity purchased for
own use
0 0
UK only Scope 2 market-based emissions from electricity
purchased for own use
0 0
Scope 3 Emissions from & energy-related activities, waste
(including water) and downstream leased assets
21,035 15,174 -28%
UK only Scope 3 Emissions from & energy-related activities,
waste (including water) and downstream leased assets
21,035 15,087 -28%
Total Scope 1, 2 & 3 location-based emissions 23,232 18,233 -22%
UK only total Scope 1, 2 & 3 location-based emissions 23,232 17,884 -23%
Total Scope 1, 2 & 3 market-based emissions 21,531 15,731 -27%
UK only total Scope 1, 2 & 3 market-based emissions 21,531 15,644 -27%
Intensity Scope 1 & 2 (location-based) tCO2e/m2 0.013 0.013 -2%
UK only intensity Scope 1 & 2 (location-based) tCO2e/m2
Energy Consumption (kWh)
0.013 0.012 -10%
Energy use from the combustion of gas and other fuels 2,708,120 3,042,649 12%
UK only energy use from the combustion of gas and other fuels 2,708,120 3,042,649 12%
Energy use from consumption of electricity purchased for own use 8,217,604 12,082,059 47%
UK only energy use from consumption of electricity purchased
for own use
8,217,604 10,819,436 32%

Data notes

Reporting Period Our GHG emissions performance disclosures relate to the calendar year of 2024 (referred to as FY25). Emissions data from the calendar year of 2023 (referred to as FY24) has also been included. Boundary We have used the Operational Control method to outline our carbon footprint boundary. Emissions arising from occupiers' energy usage are not included in our Scope 1 and 2 reporting boundaries, but are reported in Scope 3 as downstream leased assets. Our Operational Control boundary excludes assets owned by JV

partnerships, as well as assets where we act only in an advisory capacity.

Data notes continued

Strategic Report

Reporting
Method
We have measured emissions based on the GHG Protocol Corporate Accounting
Standard (revised edition) and guidance provided by the UK's Department for
Energy Security and Net Zero (DESNZ) and the Department for Environment, Food
and Rural Affairs (DEFRA) on Streamlined Energy and Carbon Reporting and
greenhouse gas reporting.
Emissions
Factor
The emissions factors and conversions used for 2024 (FY25) reporting are from the
DESNZ/DEFRA greenhouse gas reporting tool 2024 and the factors and conversions
used for 2023 (FY24) reporting are from the 2023 reporting tool.
Scope 3
Emissions
For the NewRiver only disclosure, we used the GHG Protocol Scope 3 Standard to
collate and report on our Scope 3 emissions in the form of emissions from
purchased goods and services, capital goods, fuel and energy-related activities,
waste and water, business travel, employee commuting and downstream leased
assets. Data relating to all of these categories were unavailable for the Capital &
Regional business for the same period, so the Capital & Regional disclosure includes
the categories of fuel and energy-related activities, waste and water, and
downstream leased assets only. For consistency, the extrapolated disclosure for the
combined business includes only those scope 3 emissions categories that are
available for both businesses: fuel and energy-related activities, waste and water,
and downstream leased assets.
Intensity
Level
For intensity level reporting, we have used the directly controlled area of our portfolio
as the denominator. Vacant units have been excluded in the intensity measure due to
the year-on-year variability. Note for NewRiver disclosure: Whilst this approach does
not typically impact performance trends, in that emissions intensities usually increase
or decrease in-line with absolute emissions, in the case of the FY25 reporting year,
fluctuations in energy consumption arising from the vacant and rates mitigation units
across our portfolio have led to an increase in emissions intensity, despite like-for-like
common area energy consumption reducing.
Changes in
Methodology
As part of our ISO14064-3:2019 data verification process, we receive
recommendations from our data verifiers to improve the accuracy of our disclosures
on our environmental impact. This year, we received a recommendation to adopt
alternative emissions factors in the quantification of our Purchased Goods &
Services and Capital Goods emissions. We accepted this recommendation and
considered whether its impact was significant enough to necessitate a restatement
of the previous year's disclosures adopting the same methodology. This category
of emissions represents less than 5% of our overall emissions, and if it were to be
removed from the disclosure, scope 3 emissions would still be reported to have
reduced by 40%. Hence, we have concluded that this change is immaterial and
does not necessitate a restatement of FY24's disclosure. Also acting on the
recommendations of our data verifiers, we excluded occupied units on 1,000 year
leases from our downstream leased assets emissions calculations. This resulted in
only a 3% reduction in like-for-like floor area and so has also been deemed an
immaterial change in our accounting methodology.

& Appendix

Company Information

ESG report continued

NewRiver energy & GHG emissions performance explained

10,000,000

Portfolio Scope 1&2 GHG Emissions (Absolute) tCO2e

Portfolio Electricity Consumption (Absolute) kWh

XX

XX

Like-for-like electricity consumption increased by 1% in FY25 due to fluctuations arising from vacant and rates mitigation units. In contrast, like-for-like common area consumption showed an alternative pattern, with electricity consumption reducing by 2%.

Lighting replacement projects including the installation of motion sensors, as well as manual adjustments to lighting schedules, achieved more impact at site level than is evident from the overall reduction in common area electricity consumption (2%). Unfortunately, three sites

experienced re-invoicing for previously under-estimated consumption by suppliers, which has diminished the net reduction in electricity consumption.

Overall, our absolute electricity consumption was down by 12%, driven by asset disposals which took place during the year. This was also a key driver of the overall reduction in Scope 3 emissions, alongside improved data collection via our partnership with Arbnco, as downstream leased assets make up the vast majority of this emissions category.

Like-for-like gas consumption reduced by 7%, largely driven by our Broadway shopping centre in Bexleyheath, which experienced a 27% reduction in gas usage, predominantly owing to the IBOS system we installed last year.

Some sites did however experience increases in gas consumption, arising from changes in heating requirements to maintain comfortable temperatures in mall spaces, ageing plant, and re-invoicing.

Plans to reduce gas consumption in the coming year include the replacement of the calorifier at our shopping centre in Hastings. We are also exploring the opportunity to replace the gas fired system in Newton Mearns with an electric alternative, which would represent the full decarbonisation of the centre.

Our remaining gas supplies are procured on a carbon offset tariff, to support with further reducing our environmental impact ahead of our target to bring these emissions to net-zero.

For the avoidance of doubt, these offsets are not reflected in our emissions disclosures.

ESG report continued

Capital & Regional energy & GHG emissions performance explained

Portfolio Scope 1&2 GHG Emissions (Absolute) tCO2e

Portfolio Electricity Consumption (Absolute) kWh

XX

XX

& Appendix

Company Information

Absolute electricity consumption decreased by 19% across Capital & Regional's shopping centre portfolio in 2024, as a result of the disposal of two centres during 2023. On a like-for-like basis, electricity consumption reduced by 3%. This reduction was achieved through the following energy efficiency measures:

  • LED lighting upgrades in Walthamstow, Hemel Hempstead and Maidstone.
  • PIR motion sensors installed in Hemel Hempstead and Maidstone.
  • Walthamstow and Hemel Hempstead shopping centres have implemented timers for the centres' digital screens, gaming zones and mall rides to ensure these are powered only during trading hours.
  • Circuit level monitoring has also been implemented in Walthamstow to improve consumption monitoring and enable timely management action.

The shopping centres' like-for-like gas consumption increased by 3% in 2024 is due to a new strategy agreed by the site team and tenants at Maidstone, where instead of gas distribution being controlled manually, the site now operates an automatic system with a set-point of 8°C so that the heating systems run automatically if outside temperatures drop below this. In winter months in Kent, there were lows of 2-7°C, meaning that the automatic set-point system activated more frequently in 2024.

The centre's water consumption decreased by 10% due to the availability of more accurate data in 2024, while waste generation increased by 4% on an absolute basis (3% like-for-like).

Energy performance certificates

Since October 2008, an Energy Performance Certificate (EPC) has been legally required when a building is sold, rented, or constructed. A certificate is valid for a period of 10 years; on expiry there is no legal requirement to replace an EPC unless the property is to be sold or let. In England & Wales, the Minimum Energy Efficiency Standards (MEES) require that all properties, where valid EPCs exist, must have an asset rating of "E" or above to be lawfully let. Previously this requirement only applied to new tenancies, however it was extended to cover existing (non-domestic) tenancies on 1 April 2023.

The below chart shows NewRiver EPCs for the England & Wales retail portfolio (post-Capital & Regional acquisition) in comparison to the national EPC register, comparing against other non-domestic certificates. Our data shows that the NewRiver portfolio out-performs the EPC profile of the national database, having a higher proportion of certificates providing a minimum rating of "C", and no "F" or "G" ratings. Our programme of EPC assessments and Minimum Energy Efficiency Standards (MEES) risk reduction has helped to ensure we can continue to let properties lawfully. Through continued management of non-compliant and expiring EPCs in accordance with the MEES, the NewRiver portfolio is well defended against potential compliance-related risks to value.

Water & waste performance summary

NewRiver FY25 water

performance

Absolute water consumption reduced by 11% in FY25, driven by asset disposals. On a like-for-like basis, common area water consumption increased marginally, by 2%. The increase has arisen from two locations; one where we refurbished the onsite sprinkler storage tanks which required that we empty and refill two tanks amounting to 1 million litres of water usage. The same site also experienced increased occupancy as we welcomed new F&B retailers. The second site that experienced a significant increase in water usage is one where the supplier had been billing to estimated consumption levels as access to the meter requires a hydraulic lift. Access to the meter has since been enabled and so the increase is a result of correcting previously underestimated usage. As these are non-routine events, we have not identified any required remediation actions to address this increase. We continue to consider water reduction opportunities more generally as a standard part of our management approach.

Glossary &

EPC Performance in England & Wales

Percentage of properties

* National database figures are correct as of December 2024

For a full breakdown of our portfolio EPC profile including Northern Ireland & Scotland, please see page 212 (Appendix).

Disposal Route

Waste to anaerobic digestion

Waste Type

Food waste

ESG report continued

In FY251 , the total volume of waste generated across our portfolio reduced by 4%, however on a like-for-like basis increased by 3% (76 tonnes). Approximately a third of this increase was general waste generation, which is a lower proportion than the waste stream accounts for as a whole (65%). We saw notable increases in glass waste volume (73%), cans & plastics (156%), and wood (108%), which together represent 86% of the increase in waste volume and for which relevant waste segregation opportunities were available to ensure that these streams could be recycled. 8% of the increase was a result of non-routine waste generation of furniture, tube lights and hard plastics associated with a refurbishment, all of which was sent to a dedicated recycling facility.

Despite the improved waste segregation opportunities, our analysis shows a reduction in recycling rates. Although the overall proportion of general waste remained static at 65%, incineration rates are shown to have increased due to improved visibility of how the general waste generated at our centre in Newtownabbey is processed once it reaches the mixed recycling facility. Because this centre is one of our largest and therefore generates a significant proportion of our overall waste, this has had a considerable impact on our performance analysis. Whilst it is disappointing to learn that our recycling rates are not as high as we had previously thought, good quality data is essential to making and measuring progress. This does however mean that we have not achieved our target recycling rate of 85%, with 52% of total waste volume being recycled (including organic waste diverted from general waste).

We will continue to champion and enable retailers and customers to practice effective waste management by providing appropriate facilities, clear signposting, and educational materials as we remain in pursuit of our target 85% recycling rate. To ensure that we make progress over the coming year, we have initiated the following improvements:

  • New segregated customer waste bins have been installed in Locks Heath, Fareham
  • Food waste segregation has been introduced, or facilities have been increased, at seven centres
  • Additional waste streams have been introduced at four centres
  • At our Hillstreet Centre in Middlesbrough, we have replaced the front end load skips with mixed recycling containers and 1100 litre general waste bins. The centre has also appointed two onsite waste champions and increased engagement within the mall and on social media
  • We have introduced additional signage and quarterly recycling performance reporting at all centres with landlord managed waste

Sustainable summer fun in Hastings

Priory Meadow Shopping Centre hosted a variety of free events for kids, running every Saturday throughout July and August, at a giant sand beach at the shopping centre. Families were invited to take place in a Recycling Race – a fun, educational game in which children had one minute to race across the sand and sort the giant foam props into the correct recycling bins! Footfall to the event was 375. Feedback: "it's a great little event for the kids. Brilliant that it's free"; "Really important topic. It's great, keep it up!".

Providing free access to books for children

The Hildreds Centre has introduced a "magic bookcase", which makes free books accessible to local children. The aim is for children to choose a book to take home and enjoy, then, once they have read it, either keep it, pass it onto a friend, or return the book and select a new, starting the process again.

ESG report continued

Objective 2: Engaging our team and occupiers

Listening is at the core of our approach to engaging our team. We strive to understand and respond to the diverse needs of our team at all levels, enabling us to develop our policies and process to better support needs and goals. We work hard to engender a positive culture which provides the support and flexibility to ensure staff wellbeing. Our retention record and our approval ratings in staff surveys is testament to the effectiveness of this approach.

Monitoring and needs assessment take place both through the employee appraisal process and anonymously via our annual staff survey. Our 2024 staff survey was independently managed and analysed by The Sunday Times, and as a result, we were recognised as one of the "Sunday Times Best Places to Work 2024".

The survey questions are designed to gain insights into staff opinion and identify beneficial actions in respect of NewRiver's policies, procedures and cultural norms in the areas of: reward & recognition, information sharing, empowerment, wellbeing, instilling pride, and job satisfaction. We were rated "excellent" in all six of the survey's focus areas.

We received a 96% response rate to the survey, with over 80% of staff identifying that they:

  • Have confidence in our management and a good working relationship with their direct manager
  • Are paid fairly and being developed
  • Are recognised when they do something well and are treated with respect
  • Are happy with their working hours and work/ life balance
  • Feel that their views are heard, and they are trusted to make decisions
  • Feel happy at work and safe in their working environment
  • Know that NewRiver cares about their wellbeing
  • Are proud of the organisation and feel that their work is worthwhile
  • Are encouraged that NewRiver treats environmental and social (DEI) responsibility as a priority and backs this with action

ESG training is delivered to our team on an annual basis. Training sessions cover a range of topics including industry initiatives and trends, updates on our performance, and support for implementing any newly introduced policies and processes. Annual training sessions extend to our on-site teams, who receive training specific to the nature of their roles.

We continue to include personal ESG targets in employee goal setting and performance appraisals. We encourage employees to include targets which support our corporate objectives, but also provide the flexibility to set personal targets that address issues which are important to them or their role. Achievement of the ESG targets feeds directly into the rewards process with all other employee objectives. Members of senior management have specific ESG performance goals connected to a pre-defined bonus potential.

Resourcing team engagement

In January 2025, we welcomed a new ESG Strategy Lead, who is working closely with our Head of Asset Management & ESG, Emma Mackenzie, as we continue to evolve and integrate our ESG strategy across our operations and portfolio. Having dedicated internal resource ensures visibility of our ESG priorities for our wider team, helping to keep them front and centre of our approach to our core business activities.

We have also established a Wellness & Representation Committee, chaired by our Customer Experience and Social Impact Manager, Erin Thorne. The committee is tasked with implementing initiatives that promote social engagement, awareness, and wellbeing amongst our team, incorporating their ideas and feedback. Initiatives include fitness classes, a book club, desk assessments and massages via Workplace Bliss, knowledge sharing sessions and fun activities to celebrate special interest days.

How we listen to & engage our team

Engaging our occupiers

Occupier satisfaction is a core priority of our business; as such, we undertake routine surveys to gain insight into occupier opinions on material topics such as the service-mindedness of our centre management teams and our sustainability programme.

The opportunity to respond to our most recent survey (FY24) was offered to 100% of our occupiers, and we received a response rate of 78% exceeding our 75% target. Key insights from this survey were shared in our FY24 report, and we were delighted with the high levels of overall satisfaction. We also received some helpful, constructive feedback which we took the opportunity to respond to last year, and are pleased to provide an update on the actions we have taken in consideration of this feedback as follows:

Feedback Item FY25 Update
Over half of retailers would
be interested to hear more
from us on the overall
sustainability performance
of their individual centre
We've partnered with Arbnco to collect energy performance
data on our centres via the national database. Through the
collection of this data, Arbnco will generate 120 "bite size
reports" to provide actionable insights directly to our retailers.
We have also generated engagement materials on effective
waste management and introduced quarterly recycling rate
reporting within the centre common parts.
Our retailers advised us that
they would welcome
additional waste
segregation/ recycling
opportunities
New waste streams have been introduced at 7 of our centres
so far. Centres have also improved engagement efforts, such
as at our Hillstreet shopping centre where waste champions
have been appointed to ensure that the waste management
infrastructure provided is being used effectively.
A top suggestion for
environmental/social
initiatives to introduce was
"more greenery/ plants"
Live trees have been introduced alongside new seating
installations at the Broadway shopping centre, Bexleyheath. We
have also commissioned new planting schemes for the Piazza
shopping centre, Paisley and Priory Meadow shopping centre,
Hastings. We also intend to add new external planting at the
Townley Road entrance to the Broadway shopping centre.

Carving a collective pathway to Net-Zero with our occupiers

Following the acquisition of Capital & Regional, we updated our review of our occupiers' sustainability commitments and emissions reduction ambitions, to understand the proportion of our new Scope 3 emissions profile captured by commitments consistent with our own.

As of February 2025, 66% of our occupied portfolio floor area is covered by emissions reduction commitments, with a further 5% occupied by retailers whose commitments are in development. Of this 66%, 60% is occupied by retailers who are signatories to the BRC's Climate Action Roadmap.

Focusing on our top 100 retailers (who occupy 51% of our portfolio floor area), 82% of the floor area they occupy is covered by emissions reduction commitments, with a further 4% occupied by retailers who have communicated they are developing their targets. We continue

to be encouraged by the ambition levels of our retailer base and reassured that we are on a collective pathway to achieving net-zero.

We incorporate green clauses into all our standard form leases, which engage our occupiers in key areas of our net-zero strategy, such as the procurement of renewable energy. Of the new leases (of >1 year) we agreed in FY25, 50% included at least one priority green clause.

Having partnered with Arbnco to collect our energy data, we've also received insight into the impact of our occupiers' energy purchasing decisions on our scope 3 emissions. Based on the emissions factors submitted to the national database by the relevant suppliers, our occupiers' purchasing decisions mean that market-based emissions associated with their electricity consumption are 52% lower than location-based (average national grid) emissions. Whilst we do not reflect this in our SECR disclosure due to the limited granularity of the data available to us, it is a positive indication of sustainable procurement decisions being made by our occupiers.

Occupier carbon emission reduction targets

ESG report continued

Snozone's transition to Net-Zero

When we acquired Capital & Regional, we became owners of Snozone, the UK's largest indoor real snow centres. The business has a mature ESG programme and shares our ambitions to align our net-zero transition with a 1.5-degree future, with progress so far including:

& Appendix

  • 100% renewable and traceable electricity. The UK venues source electricity from Hornsea North Sea wind farm, ~90 miles from the Yorkshire venue. In Madrid, 65% of power is sourced from a mixture of wind and nuclear, with 35% supplied by 1,600 solar panels, purchased in 2022.
  • £250,000 was invested in three new blast cooler units at our Milton Keynes venue, which are not only more efficient, but also regulate temperature outflows to a superior standard. This means consuming less power to maintain temperatures. This installation was the third phase of a 4-year plan to improve the efficiency of key plant output, with the planned replacement of the original coolers.

• Following the success of voltage optimiser installations at our Yorkshire and Madrid venues, we installed a unit at our Milton Keynes venue in April 2024. The optimisers ensure that the plant and machinery is only supplied with the power they need, thus eliminating wastage.

• We improved the insulation of our ski slopes throughout 2024, using 3D scanners to pinpoint areas where heat could escape, and renewing or replacing insulating materials. The UK venues installed 4 sets of new airlock doors to the slopes which further insulates slope-side operations. We also installed a new AHU unit at Milton Keynes which is estimated to achieve a saving of 90,000 kWh per year.

Company Information

• All Snozone venues are fully fitted with LED lighting and in 2024, Madrid undertook a de-lamping project to remove unnecessary lighting. This completed the 2-year project for the group in further reducing consumption. Our UK venues are now rated EPC 'B', with Madrid having recently achieved an EPC 'A' rating.

ESG report continued

Objective 3: Supporting our communities

Supporting impactful local causes through the position we hold in our communities has always been central to our culture and strategy of creating shared value for our stakeholders. As such, we provide NewRiver-funded time for our staff to support causes which matter most to them, and to share team bonding opportunities in doing so.

Our support for Trussell

Staff are able to participate in monthly volunteering opportunities with our corporate charity partner, Trussell, or elect to utilise their gifted volunteering time to support any cause that's particularly close to their hearts. In FY25, our support for Trussell provided:

2.13 tonnes

of food donations, equating to approximately 28,459 portions or £4,269 worth of pasta, enough dinners for

20 families of 4 for a whole year

£579,802 of cumulative direct monetary donations raised since the beginning of our partnership in 2019

£72,280 of direct monetary donations during the year

105 hours of volunteered support, with a total value of

£1,6891

  1. Based on the national TOMs Framework proxy value for voluntary hours donated to support VCSEs (excluding expert business advice) of £16.09 per hour

The ongoing impact of our partnership with Trussell

Speaking with Niall Pickup, Chair of Trustees, about the ongoing project at Merlin's Walk in Carmarthen, he advised "the new kitchen (donated by NewRiver) is a great resource. It allows us to cater when agencies book the space for area conferences and we hope to use it to provide cooking lessons for clients, dependent in part on getting volunteers for this. If we see fuel crises again next winter, we may use the space to provide a warm space for students to do their homework and have plans to provide them with soup as they study and are looking at the practicalities of providing breakfasts, perhaps once a week".

Company Information

Creating safer communities in Middlesbrough

Following the riots in Middlesbrough, the Hill Street shopping centre team partnered with the local authority, Police and Crime Commissioners office, Safer Communities, and Say no to Racism, to hold a combined event within the shopping centre. During the event, all partners were able to engage with the community and provide information and advice. There was an opportunity to listen to the community in a space that feels familiar and safe. The event was busy, and all partners will be looking at other dates so that they can continue this important work.

At our centres

561 hours spent by on-site staff supporting community initiatives

£152,801

monetary donations raised by aggregate charity fundraising activities

361

social, community or charitable initiatives supported

ESG report continued

Kick off to construction with TARA

The Broadway Shopping Centre was delighted to support the Academy of Real Assets and the Palace for Life Foundation, in partnership with Derwent London and O'Shea construction, to host a week-long programme providing insight to young people looking to pursue a career in real estate. Participants were welcomed on a site tour of the centre, accessing all front and back of house areas to understand how we operate, including commercial considerations, security, and health & safety. The programme also included a CV and mock interview workshop hosted at Selhurst Park, which our centre manager Rai Holdstock supported.

How Capital & Regional contributed to Objective 3

The site teams across the Capital & Regional portfolio each developed a Community Wheel of Support which outlines the social-value generating actions, tasks, events, activities, and targets for the year ahead, identifying the key stakeholders to be involved with and benefit from the planned initiatives. Over the course of 2024, these action plans delivered:

At a glance

772 hours spent by on-site staff in support of the BID

193 community groups supported

982 volunteering hours spent

881 hours spent interacting with community groups

256 community events hosted

£374,154 of community investment made

£363,403

of "Capital & Regional Cares" fundraising

£574,332 of support to community services

183 charities supported

ESG report continued

Objective 4: Leading in governance and disclosure

Our commitment to diversity, equity & inclusion (DEI)

As a company, we are committed to a culture of diversity and inclusion in which everyone is given equal opportunities to progress regardless of gender, race, ethnic origin, nationality, age, religion, sexual orientation or disability. We continue to strive to provide the most flexible employment policies to enable all of our employees to combine a fulfilling career with an active home life. Disclosures provided in this section of our ESG report relate to the calendar year, for NewRiver only.

Diversity at a glance* 21% Ethnic diversity

51:49 Company Male:Female ratio

71:29 ExCo Male:Female ratio

71:29 Board Male:Female ratio

* ESG diversity statistics relate to the calendar year, for NewRiver only

Equal opportunities

We have recently updated our Equal Opportunities policy to provide a comprehensive standalone policy statement which clearly communicates:

  • What we regard as acceptable and unacceptable behaviour at work;
  • The rights and responsibilities of those to whom the policy applies;
  • The procedure for dealing with concerns or complaints;
  • How we will deal with any breach of our policy;
  • Who is responsible for the policy; and
  • How it will be implemented, monitored, and reviewed.

All staff have received externally delivered training to ensure full understanding of this policy, including types of discrimination and unconscious biases, to support its effective implementation

Board diversity

As part of the policy review process which produced our updated Equal Opportunities Policy, we also developed a Board Diversity Policy, which includes the following objectives:

  • At least two members of the Board are female, with a long-term aspiration to achieve no less than 40% female representation on the Board; and
  • In the longer-term, at least one director will be from a non-white ethnic minority background.

Whilst recognising that:

  • This balance may not be achieved until further Directors are replaced at the end of their tenure;
  • On an ongoing basis, periods of change in Board composition may result in temporary periods when this balance is not achieved;
  • All appointments must continue to be made on merit;
  • And new appointees embody the core values of the Group.

Gender pay gap

In FY22, we took the decision to begin publishing our gender pay gap information. As we have fewer than 250 employees, we are not obliged by The Equality Act 2010 (Gender Pay Gap Information Regulations 2017) to disclose our gender pay gap, however we are pleased to provide our disclosure below in support of our commitment to DEI.

34% Mean gender pay gap

31% Median gender pay gap

This represents a 5% decrease in our mean gender pay gap since FY24, and a 6% decrease in our median gender pay gap. These fluctuations are driven by differences in the roles and seniority levels of male and female leavers and joiners to NewRiver over this period, including those that joined us from Ellandi following our acquisition of the business in July 2024.

In interpreting this gender pay gap disclosure, it is important to note that this is not a calculation of equal pay for equal work. The gender pay gap is the difference between the average annual salaries of men and women across all levels of the company, excluding any bonuses or other benefits received. The comparison is drawn across all departments of the business, spanning all levels of seniority. We adopt a strict equal pay for equal work policy, ensuring that all remuneration is managed in compliance with equality legislation.

Our governance of sustainability and climate-related matters

Our purpose is to buy, manage and develop retail assets across the UK which provide essential goods and services, supporting the development of thriving communities. Our Board recognises our responsibility to ensure our portfolio can weather the physical and transitional risks created by a changing climate to ensure the long-term resilience of our business and the returns we achieve for our investors, as well as the all-important communities we serve.

Governance performance measures calendar year 2024

EPRA Code Performance Measure Unit(s) of Measure FY24 FY25
Gov-Board
Composition of the highest governance body
Number of executive board members 2 2
Number of independent/non-executive
board members
4 4
Average tenure on the governance body 4.6 4.3
Number of independent/ non-executive
board members with competencies relating
to environmental and social impacts
3 3
Gov-Selec Process for nominating and selecting the
highest governance body
Narrative on process code to have a Nomination Committee which is responsible for identifying and nominating
candidates to the Board. Please refer to page 126 for the latest report from the NewRiver
Nomination Committee.
As a Stock-Exchange-Listed business, NewRiver is required under the UK Corporate Governance
Gov-Col
Process for managing conflicts of interest
Narrative on process As a Stock-Exchange-Listed business, NewRiver is required under the UK Corporate Governance
Code to identify and manage conflicts of interest. Directors also have duties under the Companies
Act 2006. To manage this process, the Company Secretary keeps a register of all Directors' interests.
The register sets out details of situations in which each Director's interest may conflict with those of
the Company (situational conflicts). The register is reviewed at each Board meeting so that the Board
may consider and authorise any new situational conflicts identified. At the beginning of each Board
meeting, the Chair reminds the Directors of their duties under sections 175, 177 and 182 of the
Companies Act 2006, which relate to the disclosure of any conflicts of interest prior to any matter
that may be discussed by the Board.
six-monthly basis. There is also a staff conflicts of interest policy in place which requires any potential conflicts
to be kept on a register and regularly updated. This is reviewed by the Audit Committee on a
Board oversight of code of conduct Narrative on process reviewed by the audit committee. There have been no instances of non-compliance. The Company has a code of conduct that is included in the staff handbook. Non-compliance
would be a staff disciplinary matter. The Board, through its Audit Committee, has oversight of
non-compliance. The Company also has a whistleblowing policy and process which is regularly
Due diligence of partner organisations Narrative on process a supplier's code of conduct. The Company also has a Modern Slavery policy. Suppliers are
required to confirm that they agree to this Modern Slavery policy amongst other policies as
part of the on-boarding process.
The Company has implemented and Enhanced Supplier vetting process for suppliers and has
Anti-corruption measures Narrative on process The Company has an Anti-bribery and anti-corruption policy. As part of this policy, there is a gifts
policy and process. More information is available on pages 6&7 and 11&2 of our Code of Conduct.
and hospitality approval process and register. The Gifts and Hospitality register is reviewed by the Audit
Committee on a regular basis. A conflicts of Interest policy is also in place, as well as a whistle-blowing
Fines and settlements in connection with
non-compliance with environmental, anti-bribery/
corruption, or other ESG-related regulation
Total GBP of fines in past three years,
type of non-compliance
£0, no incidences of non-compliance.

Company Information

TCFD report

Embedding the recommendations of the TCFD

NewRiver is committed to embedding the recommendations of the Financial Stability Board's Task Force on Climate-related Financial Disclosures (TCFD) within our approach to climate-related risk management. This disclosure aims to present a transparent account of our processes designed to support our journey towards a low-carbon business model, structured around the TCFD's four recommendation pillars: Governance, Strategy, Risk Management, and Metrics and Targets.

Glossary & Company Information

TCFD report continued

Our journey to climate resilience

Dr Karen Miller Independent Non-Executive Director

As part of our membership of the Better Buildings Partnership (BBP) Climate Commitment, we adopt the BBP's definition of a climate resilient business in formulating our strategy. This definition considers that a climate resilient business: has a plan to mitigate the worst impacts of climate change by reducing its carbon emissions impact to net-zero; can adapt to operating in a world in which climate-driven disruption is more frequent and severe; and provides climaterelated information to investors, regulators, and other stakeholders in a useful and timely way.

Our FY25 disclosures represent our seventh consecutive TCFD report. We consider that the following report is consistent with the TCFD's Recommendations and supporting disclosures; these being the four pillars referenced above, and the eleven disclosures within, which are signposted throughout this report. The TCFD's Guidance for All Sectors has been considered in order to achieve consistency with the recommendations.

Governance

TCFD governance recommendation 'a': describe the board's oversight of climate-related risks and opportunities

Our Board takes ultimate responsibility for our business' resilience against climate issues and the transition of our portfolio and Snozones to a low-carbon operating model. Material climate issues are considered by the Board when reviewing NewRiver's strategic approach to managing associated impacts on the day-today operation of our assets, to preserve our ability to create value for our investors and communities. Allan Lockhart, our Chief Executive and senior Board Director, retains overall accountability for our ESG programme and approach to climate matters.

The Board's oversight is supported by the ESG Committee, led by our Head of Asset Management and ESG, Emma Mackenzie. The Committee meets quarterly to oversee NewRiver's approach, which is guided by our Pathway to Net-Zero, whilst reviewing and ensuring that appropriate resources are mobilised to enable proactivity; for example, each asset receives an annual ESG budget to implement selected items from the Environmental & Social Plans. The Committee provides quarterly briefings to the Board, updating its members on key milestones achieved by the ESG programme.

The Board and the Audit Committee adopts an integrated risk management approach, in which ESG and climate issues are embedded. The Committee regularly evaluates NewRiver's risk appetite, together with emerging and principal risks which are captured in the risk register maintained by the Company. The Committee considers a range of risks across six risk categories, linked to our business model, strategic priorities, and external environment. Climate-related risk represents one of the principal risk categories. The Committee regularly evaluates changes to identified risks and ensures that appropriate controls are applied in alignment with the Board's risk appetite.

NewRiver's Board benefits from the climaterelated expertise of Dr Karen Miller, appointed in Q1 FY23. Karen supports the Board's consideration of all climate-related issues escalated by the ESG Committee. The Board's training requirements in respect of climaterelated issues are reviewed annually. The most recent session delivered to the Board was on the findings of the net-zero audits we undertook across a sample of our assets, and how these findings relate to our broader strategy (FY24). Following the re-baselining of our net-zero targets, as discussed earlier in our ESG report, the Board will receive training on the SBTi's Building Sector Guidance and will be key to formulating our updated delivery plan.

TCFD governance recommendation 'b': describe management's role in assessing and managing climate-related risks and opportunities

Senior management is closely involved in our day-to-day approach to climate issues. Through her dual role as Head of Asset Management and ESG, Executive Committee member Emma Mackenzie regularly engages with asset and property management teams to ensure appropriate energy and carbon management processes and policies are integrated within all management activities and the operation of our Snozones. In addition, asset and property management teams interact with centre management to ensure that policies are implemented across the portfolio and that performance is tracked through our ESG programme.

Our internal teams and centre managers have all received ESG training during the year, delivered by our external consultants. We invest in these sessions to ensure that management personnel are kept abreast of the latest developments in sustainability best practice and evolving climate-related issues.

The Remuneration Committee includes ESG objectives as part of the bonus objectives for both the Board and Executive Management. This is a pre-defined percentage of bonus with a high degree of measurability, and forms part of the overall performance assessment.

NewRiver REIT plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2025 Governance Report Financial Statements ESG Data Sets 91 & Appendix Glossary & Company Information Strategic Report

TCFD report continued

Strategy

TCFD strategy recommendations 'a' and 'c': describe the climate-related risks and opportunities the organisation has identified over the short, medium, and long term; and describe the resilience of the organisation's strategy, taking into consideration different climate-related scenarios, including a 2ºC or lower scenario

Risk identification

NewRiver considers climate-related risks, as well as opportunities, that may arise from both the physical impacts of climate change and the transition of our managed assets to a lowcarbon operating model.* We identify climaterelated issues across short (to 2030), medium (to 2040), and long-term (to 2050 and beyond) horizons, appropriately defined to inform our ESG and corporate strategies.

The Relevance Assessment that follows outlines the principal risks and opportunities we have identified and the ways in which they have the potential to impact our business, alongside definitions of low, medium, and high impacts in the context of each of the risks.

Our assessment considers transitional risks and opportunities associated with the international goal of keeping warming to within 1.5-degrees above pre-industrial levels - as our strategy is based on this objective – and therefore assumes that the end date for achieving net-zero is 2050. Our analysis of physical risk exposure, undertaken by an external consultant, was updated in March 2025 to incorporate our new assets following our acquisition of Capital & Regional, including the Snozone operations. The assessment modelled three climate scenarios: SSP1-2.6, SSP2-4.5, and SSP5-8.5.

SSP1-2.6 is a low carbon scenario in which global CO2e emissions are cut severely and societies prioritise more sustainable practices, with focus shifting from economic growth to overall wellbeing. As a result, warming stabilises at approximately 1.8°C by the end of the century. This scenario has been used as the "best case" scenario because climate modellers are no longer optimistic that limiting warming to 1.5-degrees above pre-industrial levels is feasible, and so we consider that SSP1-2.6 reasonably represents a scenario in which meaningful efforts are made to pursue this goal, despite temperatures eventually stabilising at a slightly higher level. SSP2-4.5 is a 'middle of the road' scenario in which global emissions remain at current levels before starting to fall midcentury, but do not reach net-zero by 2100. Socioeconomic factors follow their historic trends and progress towards sustainability is slow. In this scenario, temperatures rise by 2.7°C by the end of the century. SSP5-8.5 is a high carbon scenario in which current CO2e emissions double by 2050 due to the growth of the global economy being fuelled by fossil fuels and energy-intensive practices.

This scenario corresponds to approximately 4.4°C of warming by the end of the century.

The assessment considered eight key climate hazards including temperature-related, wind-related and water-related hazards. Through the analysis, three key hazards have been identified as relevant to our portfolio (see Relevance Assessment).

The Impact Assessment that follows provides our analysis of the relevant level of potential impact of each risk, their probability, and time horizon over which these impacts could manifest. Consistent with our transitional risk analysis, we have presented the baseline potential impacts using a low carbon scenario.

Resilience of our strategy

Our strategy is designed to enable us to build resilience considerations into the acquisition and operation of our assets as an integral part of our overall approach to asset management. As our portfolio consists of assets located in the UK only, there is little variation in exposure levels to both transitional and physical risks and opportunities across our assets. Our net-zero pathway and the interim targets we have set ourselves guide our approach to remaining resilient to principal transition risks. The findings of our physical risk assessment and sensitivity analysis using low and high carbon scenarios show that there is minimal change to the exposure of our portfolio to physical climate risks in the best- and worst-case scenarios.

We have mapped relevant risks and opportunities within our Impact Assessment based on a low carbon scenario, with the direction of the arrows indicating the potential change in our exposure to each risk and opportunity under a high carbon scenario.

In a high carbon scenario, exposure to regulatory and associated asset transition risks has the potential to reduce, as the scenario assumes that society will continue to rely heavily on fossil fuels and energy intensive activities to drive economic growth, and so regulatory and technological tools may not advance in the way they are assumed to in the low-carbon scenario. Despite economic acceptance of fossil fuel reliance in this scenario, we have assumed that reputational and market risk would increase, as demand for carbon offsets could increase further in an attempt to compensate for fossil fuel usage, while customer demand for action may also become further heightened as the effects of climate change become increasingly apparent. Exposure to certain physical risks may also increase, as the higher degree of warming contributes to more extreme weather events and patterns. Across the NewRiver portfolio specifically, this degree of change is modelled to be immaterial, however we recognise that there would be much more significant changes across the globe, including irreversible impacts on fragile ecosystems, that we should collectively strive to avoid.

As our strategy is aligned to the best available scientific recommendations from the SBTi (please see page 72 for details of our targets) and our approach to the sustainable management of our assets strives for continuous environmental performance improvements, whilst physical risk analysis showed no material movements in risk exposure under higher carbon scenarios, we do not envisage that we need to amend our risk management strategy based on different warming scenarios.

NewRiver REIT plc Annual Report and Accounts 2025

NewRiver REIT plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2025 Governance Report Financial Statements ESG Data Sets 92 & Appendix Glossary & Company Information Strategic Report

Relevance assessment

Climate change strategy (Risk 4a1): a failure to implement appropriate climate risk management measures, comply with evolving regulations and meet our ESG targets could impact the operation and value of our assets, leading to a risk of asset obsolescence, reputational damage, and erosion of investor value

Category
& Indicator
Risk
Type
Risk
Description
Relevance
to NewRiver
Low Impact
Definition
Medium Impact
Definition
High Impact
Definition
Policy
& Legal
PL1
Energy efficiency and
carbon regulations relating
to managed assets
Evolving policy designed to support the UK's 2050
net-zero commitment requires capital expenditure to
achieve compliance but also highlights opportunities
to reduce operational costs, support occupier demand,
improve resilience, and implement measures that
ultimately support our own net-zero ambitions.
We have mitigated the short-term MEES risk associated with our portfolio,
however there are proposals to increase the minimum thresholds in future.
72% of our EPCs are currently compliant with the previously proposed
2027 requirements (C+), and 41% already compliant with 2030 proposals
(B+). Whilst there remains uncertainty around these proposals, we have
assessed the probability of an increase to the MEES threshold to be high.
We have undertaken a cost assessment of achieving compliance with the
previously proposed 2030 minimum threshold, assuming that current
feasibility tests will remain relevant.
Costs of
<£2million to
improve asset
performance
in accordance
with regulations
Costs of
£2-10million to
improve asset
performance
in accordance
with regulations
Costs of
>£10million to
improve asset
performance
in accordance
with regulations
Technology
T1
Costs to transition managed
assets to low-carbon model
Opportunities exist to implement a range of
technologies and system improvements designed to
reduce environmental impact and transition our assets
to a decarbonised operational model. These systems
will come at a cost, and require lifecycle carbon
considerations to be factored in. We will engage our
occupiers to ensure our ambitions are aligned and
make sensible system replacements at the time that
current systems reach a point in their useful lives
that the lifecycle carbon and operational cost
implications are beneficial to our occupiers as
well as our net-zero journey, which will support
usual service charge processes.
We are in the assessment phase of most solutions at this stage on our
net-zero pathway, with implementation being focused on opportunities
to reduce the energy demand of our assets ahead of decarbonisation.
We are in the process of assessing the opportunity to remove gas
supplies from The Avenue, Newton Mearns, ensuring that any
electrification solution achieves our decarbonisation goal whilst
delivering value to our retailers. We will continue to take this approach
as and when key systems require replacement - an opportunity that
has already been realised at two of the Capital & Regional centres.
We also commissioned a portfolio-wide desktop review of solar PV
opportunities, including the Capital & Regional sites. From this initial
review, we instructed four detailed assessments and will be progressing
with a minimum of one installation project during FY26.
Costs of
<£2million to
improve asset
performance
in accordance
with regulations
Costs of
£2-10million to
improve asset
performance in
accordance with
regulations
Costs of
>£10million to
improve asset
performance
in accordance
with regulations
Reputation
R1
Reputational damage based
on ineffective response to
climate change
Societal environmental consciousness is continually
on the rise and there is a widespread consensus that
we must strive to keep warming to within 1.5 degrees.
Businesses that fail to keep pace with this moral shift
risk reputational damage. We must continuously work
towards, and monitor our progress against, our
SBTi-approved emissions reduction targets. We
must ensure that our initial targets are reviewed
as and when new scientific recommendations or
sector-specific methodologies emerge.
We have committed to becoming a net-zero business and developed
our pathway to achieving this commitment. We have committed to the
SBTi's recommendations of reducing absolute emissions by 42% by
2030 and achieving net-zero by 2050 in pursuit of a 1.5-degree future.
We are currently reviewing the SBTI's new Buildings Sector guidance
and considering relevant revisions to our targets to align with this
latest sector-specific best practice guidance, including re-baselining.
Limited
reputational
impact if
response to
climate change
is ineffective
Temporary
reputational
impact if
response to
climate change
is ineffective,
with sufficient
time to remedy
Significant
reputational
impact if
response to
climate change
is ineffective or
not operational
by required date
Market
M1
Increased costs to offset
unabated emissions as part
of our net-zero strategy
There has been a significant, recent, increase in
corporate net-zero commitments which may drive
demand for credible carbon offsets, resulting in cost
increases. Potential future regulation may also
contribute to this risk.
We have committed to ensuring that any offsets purchased as part
of our net-zero strategy are additional, not overestimated, lead to
permanent removals, do not support double counting, and do not
cause wider social or environmental harm. We have purchased
offsets, validated by the Woodland Carbon Code, in connection with
our corporate target. The scope of this purchasing requirement will
increase in 2040 when we bring the landlord-controlled areas of our
portfolio to net-zero, and then increase again in 2050 when we
become fully net-zero.
Minimal cost
increase of no
more than 25%
Considerable
cost increase of
50-100%
Significant cost
increase of over
100%
NewRiver REIT plc Annual Report and Accounts 2025 Strategic Report Governance Report Financial Statements ESG Data Sets Glossary & 93

TCFD report continued

Relevance assessment continued

Climate change impacts on our assets (Risk 4b): changes in the way consumers live, work, shop and use technology could have an adverse impact on demand for our assets, whilst the physical impacts of a changing climate could cause damage or disruption to the operation of our assets

Category
& Indicator
Risk
Type
Risk
Description
Relevance
to NewRiver
Low Impact
Definition
Medium Impact
Definition
High Impact
Definition
Market
M2
Changing customer behaviour The nature of this risk is two-fold in that it has
potential impacts from both an occupier and
consumer perspective. Changes in consumer shopping
preferences present an opportunity to leverage our
ESG strategy to demonstrate the ways in which we
actively cater to the evolving needs of our occupiers'
customers, but also present a potential risk if the
perception is that our ESG strategy does not fulfil
their expectations.
We must be able to demonstrate that our centres are environmentally and
socially conscious places for retailers and end customers. Failure to do so
could have a negative impact on demand for our assets.
We are working on ways to better communicate directly with customers
on the environmental action we take, for example, by introducing routine
communication of recycling rates at our centres, and how we can improve
them by working together.
Changes in
customer
behaviour are
well accounted
for by our
existing strategy
& offering, with
impact being
only resource
requirements
to achieve this
There is room
for our strategy
to improve its
alignment
with changing
customer
behaviour,
leading to
some reduction
in demand
Our strategy
falls short of
customer
expectations
and demand
for our assets
is hampered
Physical
PH1
PH2
PH3
Acute Physical Hazards and
Chronic Stressors caused by
a Changing Climate
As average global temperatures rise, so too does
the exposure of real assets to acute climate hazards
and chronic stressors. This risk category has been
assessed under a high (SSP-8.5 representing ~4.4
degrees of warming) and low (SSP1-2.6 representing
~1.8 degrees of warming) carbon scenario up to the
year 2100, considering eight key climate risks including
temperature-related, wind-related and water-related
hazards. Through this assessment, some risks were
discounted as relevant to our portfolio, such as hail
and wild fire. Our risk disclosure includes only those
hazards identified as highly relevant.
Three hazards have been identified to have the potential to pose a
high risk to our portfolio: drought (PH1), flooding (PH2) and heat (PH3).
Whilst NewRiver is not a water-intensive business, drought poses the
highest risk to our portfolio as there are widespread areas of water
stress across England. The data shows this to be the case under
current climate conditions, and so the risk has been categorised as
"short-term". Flood risk is relevant to four of our assets, whilst heat risk
is relevant to our Snozone in Madrid, which is projected to experience
~44 days per year of temperatures exceeding 35-degrees by 2050 in a
low emissions scenario. Impacts have been quantified in financial terms
by costing measures to adapt our assets to the relevant risks, applying
average costs by measure provided by Cushman & Wakefield. Measures
include items such as flood pumps, rainwater harvesting, water saving
devices (aerators and pressure-reducing valves), leak detection
systems, and upgrading air conditioning systems to accommodate
future heat patterns. Through our assessment of these risks under both
a high and low emissions scenario, we were able to establish that there
is no material variation in exposure levels under each scenario.
Costs of
<£2million to
improve asset
performance in
accordance
with regulations
Costs of
£2-10million to
improve asset
performance
in accordance
with regulations
Costs of
>£10million to
improve asset
performance
in accordance
with regulations

Company Information

TCFD report continued

Impact

Impact assessment

TCFD report continued

TCFD strategy recommendation 'b': describe the impact of climate-related risks and opportunities on the organisation's businesses, strategy, and financial planning

Strategic Report

The Board has a low risk tolerance for principal risks affecting our business, including climaterelated issues. Consistent with this appetite, our robust ESG programme guides our actions on our pathway to net-zero and supports our response to climate-related issues through the implementation of asset-level initiatives designed to improve efficiency, reduce environmental impact, and enhance resilience. We have embedded ESG and climate considerations throughout our business processes, departments, and functions. Environmental considerations are embedded into capital allocations and are considered for all future acquisitions. The following diagram depicts the actions and processes we have identified as part of our strategy to deliver on our climate ambitions in the context of our business model and financial planning.

& Appendix

Glossary & Company Information

TCFD report continued

Risk management

TCFD risk management recommendation 'a': describe the organisation's processes for identifying and assessing climate-related risks

Climate-related risks are identified through NewRiver's integrated risk management framework. Our risk management framework considers both emerging and principal risks with the potential to impact our business. We maintain a risk register that considers a range of categories, including environmental and climate change risks. The risk register assesses the impact and likelihood of each identified risk, which is translated into a risk heat map. Where the residual risk does not align with the Board's risk appetite, management actions are recommended with a view to mitigating the relevant risk.

TCFD risk management recommendation 'b': describe the organisation's processes for managing climate-related risks

Strategic Report

Accountability for mitigating actions is assigned to an Asset Management Director and property manager. This approach allows NewRiver to ensure there is a top-down understanding of principal risks across the business, backed by bottom-up mechanisms to support monitoring by management and their ability to address principal risks in a timely manner. With the support of our centre managers, we implement a host of initiatives designed to manage environmental impact and promote the efficient and resilient operation of our assets. This also includes, for example, building safety assessments which review the risk of loose roof/ facade features, which support mitigation of physical risks such as wind and storm damage.

TCFD risk management recommendation 'c': describe how processes for identifying, assessing, and managing climate-related risks are integrated into the organisation's overall risk management

Climate-related risk represents one of the six principal risk categories evaluated by the Board and Audit Committee as part of the business' overall risk management process. This category encompasses the individual risks identified within this TCFD disclosure, grouping them into two categories based on the nature of their potential impact. Risk 4a: "failure to implement appropriate climate risk management measures, comply with evolving regulations and meet our ESG targets could impact the operation and value of our assets, leading to a risk of asset obsolescence, reputational damage, and erosion of investor value" and risk 4b: "changes in the way consumers live, work, shop and use technology could have an adverse impact on demand for our assets, whilst the physical impacts of a changing climate could cause damage or disruption to the operation of our assets".

Please see pages 98-110 for a detailed presentation of how the identification, assessment, and management of climaterelated risks are integrated into NewRiver's overall risk management processes.

Metrics and targets

TCFD metrics and targets recommendation 'a': disclose the metrics used by the organisation to assess climate-related risks and opportunities in line with its strategy and risk management process

Annually, we disclose a suite of climate-related metrics which track our performance towards realising our core objective of minimising our environmental impact. These metrics are aligned with EPRA's best practice recommendations for transparently disclosing sustainability performance. The EPRA performance tables on pages 210-212 present our FY25 performance across these metrics, alongside historical performance.

We also monitor the following metrics associated with each of the principal climate-related risks identified:

Risk Type Risk Description Metrics Monitoring Frequency
Policy & Legal Energy/ carbon
regulations
Portfolio EPC profile
page 212
Continuous
Technology Costs to transition/
decarbonise assets
Energy usage intensity
page 211
Monthly by centre teams
via our energy broker's
management platform
Reputation Reputational damage
based on ineffective
response to
climate change
Scope 1, 2 & 3 GHG
emissions
pages 76-77
Annual quantification with
monthly monitoring
through energy
management
Market Increasing costs of
carbon offset credits
Cost projections from
market sources
Annually
Changing customer
behaviour
Customer engagement
via asset management
and centre
management teams,
alongside wider
consumer / market
research
Continuous
Physical Risk
Exposure
Drought, flooding
and heat
Estimated cost of
implementing
adaptation measures
across "at risk"
properties
The assessment
was updated in
March 2025 and
will be reviewed
as necessitated
by changes to
our portfolio

TCFD metrics and targets recommendation 'b': disclose Scope 1, Scope 2, and, if appropriate, Scope 3 greenhouse gas (GHG) emissions, and the related risks

In accordance with our reporting obligations under the UK's Streamlined Energy and Carbon Reporting regulations, we disclose our annual carbon emissions performance. Please refer to pages 76-77, where we provide further information on our FY25 emissions performance, together with a comparison against our historical performance and the methodologies used to prepare these disclosures.

TCFD metrics and targets recommendation 'c': describe the targets used by the organisation to manage climate-related risks and opportunities and performance against targets

Following the release of the Science Based Targets initiative's (SBTi) Corporate Net-Zero Standard in October 2021 – the world's first framework for corporate net-zero targets consistent with a 1.5°C future – we published our Pathway to Net-Zero and received validation from the SBTi for our Scope 1 and 2 emissions reduction targets. Science-based targets (SBTs) provide companies with a clearly defined pathway to future-proof growth by specifying how much and how quickly they need to reduce their GHG emissions to achieve a net-zero world by no later than 2050. Pragmatic net-zero strategies place the corporate SBT methodology at their heart, prioritising decarbonisation before the use of carbon offsets. This is the approach that we will take in pursuing the following targets from an FY20 baseline:

Target Performance
Our corporate emissions will be brought to
net-zero by 2025
We have fully mitigated our market-based
Scope 1 & 2 emissions (47% location-based)
and offset our unabated Sc3 emissions
(560 tonnes CO2e)
We will achieve a 42% reduction in total
absolute emissions by 2030
We have reduced absolute emissions (Scopes
1-3) by 39% as of FY25
Our landlord-controlled portfolio emissions will
be brought to net-zero by 2040
We have reduced absolute landlord-controlled
portfolio emissions (scopes 1-3) by 37% as of
FY25
Our tenant-controlled portfolio emissions, and
emissions associated with our development
activities, will be brought to net-zero by 2050
We have committed to measuring the lifecycle
carbon impact of major redevelopment
projects, established a process for monitoring
retailers' climate-related commitments, and
improved our scope 3 collection

Glossary & Company Information

Strategic Report

Managing our risks and opportunities

Risk is inherent in all businesses and effective risk management enables us to manage both the threats and the opportunities associated with our strategy and the operation of our business model.

Our relatively small workforce encourages flexibility and collaboration across the business in all areas including risk management. The accessibility and flexibility of the Board and senior staff are particularly pertinent when adapting to evolving risks, emerging risks and external risks such as economic or geopolitical instability. This flexibility enables the business to adjust and respond to fast-changing situations and prove its resilience and adaptability.

The Board has ultimate responsibility for the risk management and internal controls framework of the Group and regularly evaluates appetite for risk, ensuring our exposure to risk is managed effectively. The Audit Committee monitors the adequacy and effectiveness of the Group's risk management and internal controls and supports the Board in assessing the risk mitigation processes and procedures. The Executive Committee is closely involved with day-to-day risk management, ensuring that it is embedded within the Group's culture and values and that there is a delegation of accountability for each risk to senior management.

Risk monitoring and assessment including emerging risks

The identification of risks and their management is a continual and evolving process. This has been underscored more so over recent years in which global macroeconomic and geopolitical events have created uncertainty across all sectors, both economically and socially. Geopolitical events have also impacted supply chains and sentiment.

The Group maintains a risk register in which a range of categories are considered. These risks are linked to the business model and strategic priorities of the Group. The risk register assesses the impact and probability of each identified risk. By identifying all risks on a register and continuously updating this register, principal risks can be identified as those that might threaten the Group's business model, future performance, solvency or liquidity and reputation. Their potential impact and probability will also be a factor in whether they are classed as principal. The risk register also records actions that can be taken to further mitigate the risk and each action is assigned to an individual or group. Mitigation factors and actions are assigned to all risks whether they are principal, non-principal or emerging.

The continuous updating of this risk register allows us to assess how risks are evolving, assists in identifying emerging risks as they develop and ensures that the impact of each identified risk is continually monitored as it emerges and progresses.

Emerging risks by their very nature may 'emerge' and eventually become principal risks or they may reduce as circumstances and strategy changes. During FY23, for instance, we identified an emerging depositor risk as our cash holdings continued to build up. This risk was not a principal risk but by identifying the emerging risk as it has developed, we were able to update our treasury policies to ensure that they were fit for purpose and that cash was spread across various banking institutions. We continued to monitor this in FY24 and FY25 and a Board-approved counterparty list was continuously monitored using S&P and Fitch credit ratings. The treasury policy dictated the maximum exposure to a counterparty based on their rating. The operation of the treasury policy was reported to the Board on a quarterly basis. The emerging risk also created an opportunity as the Group was able to take advantage of favourable deposit opportunities. Since the acquisition of Capital & Regional these deposits have reduced and therefore there is no longer an emerging risk in this area and the risk register has been updated accordingly. Whilst we have not identified any specific emerging risks during FY25, we do continue to monitor AI and its potential impact on technology and consumer habits, regulation and our stakeholders. Like many emerging factors, AI can pose both a risk and an opportunity. To explore the potential opportunities AI has to offer the business, we have set up a working group of representatives from IT, Finance, Asset Management, Regeneration and Research.

Risk appetite and mitigation

The Board has a low-risk appetite for compliance (legal and regulation) related risk. The Board however recognises that the external environment in which it operates is inherently risky. Mitigating actions are therefore agreed for all risks that exceed the Group's risk appetite. Our experienced leadership team continuously works to mitigate the risks arising from the external environment in the following ways:

  • Maintaining the Group's balance sheet strength, with the Group benefitting from a diversified debt structure and gaining access to a larger pool of capital to help achieve our strategic goals
  • A disciplined approach to asset selection with probability risk-adjusted returns
  • Deploying capital in joint ventures and associates, thereby diversifying risk
  • A diverse tenant base in which there is no single tenant exposure of more than 4% of gross income
  • An experienced Board and senior management team

Principal risks and uncertainties continued

Risk, governance and responsibility

Board

Collectively responsible for managing risk, overseeing the internal controls framework and determining risk appetite

  • Regularly reviews risks within strategy discussions, the impact of risk on strategy and levers within the business model that can be adjusted to manage these risks.
  • Conducts formal reviews of principal risks (including emerging risks) at least twice a year - one of which is in connection with consideration of the viability statement.
  • Monitors KPIs which link to risk and strategy through Board reports.

Audit Committee

Oversees the risk management process

  • Conducts formal reviews of the risk management process twice a year one of which is in connection with consideration of the viability statement.
  • Monitors the internal controls framework.
  • Considers the use of external advisers for specific specialist risk impacts and deep-dive reviews.
  • Monitors the need for an internal audit function/team and appoints third parties to test internal controls.
  • Receives reports on the risk management process twice annually.

Executive Committee

Regularly reviews the entire risk register - members are responsible for managing risk within their area of accountability

  • Conducts quarterly reviews of the entire risk register, including emerging risks.
  • Reviews risk topics through regular timetabled presentations or papers.
  • Delegates line responsibility for managing risks within each member's area of accountability.
  • Uses external advisers for specific specialist risk impacts.
  • Monitors KPIs which link to risk and strategy.

Asset Managers

Members are responsible for managing risk within their assets and highlighting risks as they emerge

Company Secretary

Conducts individual risk reviews with ExCo members and individual business areas. Maintains the risk register and presents an update to the ExCo, the Audit Committee and the Board at least twice a year. Has responsibility for training staff on policies and regulations.

NewRiver REIT plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2025 Governance Report Financial Statements ESG Data Sets 100 & Appendix Glossary & Company Information Strategic Report

Principal risks and uncertainties continued

Key

Strategic pillars

Principal risks and uncertainties continued

External risks

operations of our occupiers or the spending

Responsibility Board & ExCo

Strategic alignment 1 2 3

habits of the UK population.

Impact

Probability

Movement

Risk and impact Monitoring and management Change in risk assessment during the period
1. Macroeconomic
Economic conditions in the UK and changes to
fiscal and monetary policy may impact market

The Board regularly assesses the Group's
strategy in the context of the wider

Macroeconomic risk has remained the same
during the year and is considered a medium to
activity, demand for investment assets, the macroeconomic environment. This continued high impact risk with a high probability.

confidence indices.

sufficiently resilient.

cash flow.

• Sentiment has been impacted by interest rates, geopolitical issues and inflation.

  • Overall portfolio valuations slightly increased in the second half of the year and our debt covenant and financial policy headroom remain high.
  • Continued inflation could fuel wage growth and costs leading to rate increases above current forecasts.
  • Inflation has fallen during 2024 and 2025 and the Bank of England continues to work with interest rate adjustments to reduce inflation to its 2% target.
  • The full impact of tariffs on retailers and supply chains is currently uncertain.
  • 1 Disciplined capital allocation 2 Leveraging our platform 3 Flexible balance sheet Environmental, Social and Governance Impact and probability Low Medium High Risk change during FY25

Increased Decreased No change

2. Political and regulatory Changes in UK Government policy and its

adverse effects on strategy and/or our tenants or the impact of political uncertainty on consumers' retail and leisure spend.

Responsibility Board & ExCo
Strategic alignment 1
2
3
Impact
Probability
Movement

• The Board regularly considers political and regulatory developments and the impact they could have on the Group's strategy and operating environment.

• Closely monitoring rent collection and

• Our portfolio is focused on resilient market sub-sectors such as essential retailers. • Through regular stress testing of our portfolio we ensure our financial position is

review of strategy focuses on positioning our portfolio for the evolving economic situation. • The Board and management team consider updates from external advisers, reviewing key indicators such as forecast GDP growth, employment rates, interest rates and Bank of England guidance and consumer

  • External advisers, including legal advisers, provide updates on emerging regulatory changes to ensure the business is prepared and is compliant.
  • We regularly assess market research to gauge the impact of regulatory change on consumer habits.
  • We carry out stress testing on our portfolio in relation to regulatory changes which may impact our operations or financial position.
  • Where appropriate, we participate in industry and other representative bodies to contribute to policy and regulatory debate. Individual ExCo constituents are members of the BPF.
  • Political and regulatory risk has remained the same during the year. This is considered a medium to high impact risk with a high probability.
  • There has been political uncertainty within the UK due to changes in leadership over recent years and a decline in market confidence.
  • There have also been political changes at a local authority level.
  • The full impact of business taxes, minimum wage increases and NI increases has likely not been fully felt and remains under review.
  • There remain uncertainties around the effects of Scottish devolution and the potential disruption that disputes with Government may cause.
Risk and impact Monitoring and management Change in risk assessment during the period
----------------- --------------------------- ---------------------------------------------

3. Catastrophic external event

An external event such as civil unrest or a civil emergency including a large-scale terrorist attack or pandemic, could severely disrupt global markets and cause damage and disruption to our assets.

Responsibility Board & ExCo
Strategic alignment 1
2
3
Impact
Probability
Movement
  • The Board has developed a comprehensive crisis response plan which details actions to be taken at a head office and asset level.
  • The Board regularly monitors the Home Office terrorism threat level and other security guidance.
  • The Board regularly monitors advice from the UK Government regarding pandemic responses and emergency procedures at our assets are regularly tested and enhanced in line with the latest UK Government guidance. • We have robust IT security systems which cover data security, disaster recovery and business continuity plans.
  • The business has comprehensive insurance in place to minimise the cost of damage and disruption to assets.
  • Catastrophic external event risk has remained the same during the year and is considered a high impact risk with a medium to high probability.
  • We need to be alive to risks posed by outages of the UK electricity grid, as recently experienced in Europe, although the UK infrastructure is separate to mainland Europe. There is also a Government policy in place (The Electricity Supply Emergency Code (ESEC)) that outlines a process for ensuring national distribution on a rota basis.
  • The cost-of-living crisis, continued inflation and mortgage rate increases impacted households. Our operational performance has however demonstrated the resilience of our portfolio. The financial squeeze on households may ease with falling interest rates but other taxation and inflationary effects may dent consumer confidence. The Lloyds data is a useful tool to track consumer spending and financial health.
  • The National Terrorism Threat Level is substantial and the full long-term impact from the wars in Ukraine and the Middle East and other geopolitical events remains unclear.
Key
1 Strategic pillars
Disciplined capital allocation
2 Leveraging our platform
3 Flexible balance sheet
Environmental, Social and Governance
Impact and probability
Low
Medium
High
Risk change during FY25
Increased
Decreased
No change

4a. Climate change strategy

A failure to implement appropriate climate risk management measures, comply with evolving regulations or meet our ESG targets could impact the operation and value of our assets, leading to a risk of asset obsolescence, reputational damage and erosion of investor value.

Board & ExCo
1
2
3
  • We have a comprehensive ESG programme which is regularly reviewed by the Board and Executive Committee.
  • One of the key objectives of the programme is to minimise our impact on the environment through reducing energy consumption, sourcing from renewable sources and increased recycling.
  • We have developed our Pathway to Net Zero Carbon and set medium and long-term science-based targets.
  • ESG performance is independently reviewed and verified by our external environmental consultants and is measured against applicable targets and benchmarks.
  • We continue to report in line with TCFD requirements and are developing a plan to align with IFRS S1 and S2 for FY26 reporting.
  • Climate change strategy risk remained the same during the period and is considered a medium to high impact risk with a medium to high probability.
  • ESG has risen up the agenda of many stakeholders and expectations of compliance with best practice have increased.
  • Regulatory requirements have also increased during the period, in addition to the scoring criteria for certain ESG benchmarks such as GRESB.
  • Our ESG Committee pre-empted these changes and our initiatives and disclosure continue to evolve in line with best practice.
  • ESG is embedded into capital allocation decisions and is considered for all future acquisitions.
Risk and impact Monitoring and management Change in risk assessment during the period Key
4b. Climate change impacts on our assets Strategic pillars
Adverse impacts from environmental
incidents such as extreme weather or flooding
could impact the operation of our assets.
A failure to implement appropriate climate
risk management measures at our assets
could lead to erosion of investor value and
increases in insurance premiums.

We regularly assess assets for environmental
risk and ensure sufficient insurance is in
place to minimise the impact of
environmental incidents.

In conjunction with insurers, flood risk
assessments have been carried out at all
of our assets and the risk is considered low.

Climate change impacts on our assets risk has
remained the same during the period and is
considered a medium to high impact risk with a
medium probability. The probability of this risk is
set at medium as governments globally, including
the UK Government, continue to take insufficient
action and temperatures continue to rise.
1 Disciplined capital allocation
2 Leveraging our platform
3 Flexible balance sheet
Environmental, Social and Governance
Responsibility Board & ExCo
Although exposure to extreme weather events is a
near-term risk, other chronic climate stressors Impact and probability
Strategic alignment 1
2
3
such as heat and sea level rises are medium-term
or long-term time horizons. Whilst their impact on
Low
Impact affected assets has the potential to be high, their
probability is medium in the short to medium term.
Medium

• Climate impacts are embedded into capital allocation decisions and considered for all future acquisitions of both equipment installed at our assets and for the assets themselves.

shop and use technology could have an
adverse impact on demand for our assets.
Responsibility Board & ExCo
Strategic alignment 1
2
3
Impact

Changes in the way consumers live, work,

5. Changes in technology and consumer habits and demographics

Probability

Movement

Probability

Movement

  • The Board and Executive Committee regularly assess our overall corporate strategy and acquisition, asset management and disposal decisions in the context of current and future consumer demand. Our strategy is designed to focus on resilient assets that take into account these future changes.
  • We closely assess the latest trends reported by research providers, including cash spent at our assets, to ensure we are aligned with evolving consumer trends.
  • Our retail portfolio is focused on essential spending on goods and services which are resilient to the growth of online retail.
  • Our retail parks are ideally positioned to help retailers with their multi-channel retail strategies.
  • Changes in technology and consumer habits and demographics risk has remained the same during the year and is considered a low to medium impact risk with a high probability.
  • Although the global pandemic lockdown restrictions significantly increased home working and online shopping we have seen evidence that this is unwinding in recent years. This provides opportunities for our portfolio, particularly retail parks and local community shopping centres.
  • Our portfolio is focused on providing essential retail to local communities, which continues to mitigate the impact of online retail on our portfolio.
  • Our portfolio is positioned to ensure that over the longer term we have the most resilient retail portfolio in the UK.
  • AI could pose a risk or an opportunity. To explore this a working group has been set up to review this topic.
Risk and impact
----------------- --

6. Cyber security

A cyber attack could result in the Group being unable to use its IT systems and/or losing data. This could delay reporting and divert management time. This risk could be increased due to employees continuing to work from home following the pandemic and due to geopolitical events.

Responsibility Board & ExCo
Strategic alignment 1
2
3
Impact
Probability
Movement

Risk and impact Monitoring and management Change in risk assessment during the period

• Our servers are cloud based using the latest secure technology.

  • Multiple third-party supplier programmes are used which have their own security systems and are independently audited by Deloitte and ISO2000 accredited.
  • SOC1 and SOC2 reports are obtained and reviewed from our key third-party applications. The SOC1 report audits the financial reporting practices and details controls for keeping accurate financial records. The SOC2 report audits the information security controls in place to protect our user and customer data.
  • ExCo receives quarterly reporting on IT matters.
  • Security protocols are in place to ensure swift changes to data access and authority limit access following staff changes.
  • We have reviewed our IT systems and have enhanced a number of areas during the year.
  • Cyber insurance cover is in place.
  • We carry out annual external reviews of the Group's IT security and systems as part of our internal audit process.
  • We have robust backup systems in place which are tested on a regular basis.
  • Cyber security risk has increased during the year and is considered a high impact risk with a high probability. Global developments have increased cyber security risks with many high-profile organisations being targeted by cyber attacks. We continue to carry out further enhancements to our IT systems and procedures and update, monitor and review our internal control procedures.
  • The Board and ExCo receive regular reports on cyber security.
Strategic pillars
1 Disciplined capital allocation
2 Leveraging our platform
3 Flexible balance sheet
Environmental, Social and Governance
Impact and probability
Low
Medium
High
Risk change during FY25
Increased

Decreased No change

Operational risks

Risk and impact Monitoring and management Change in risk assessment during the period Key
7. People Strategic pillars
The inability to attract, retain and develop
Attracting, retaining and developing talent

The probability of the People risk has increased
1 Disciplined capital allocation
our people and ensure we have the right skills
in place could prevent us from implementing
is core to our HR strategy, which is regularly
reviewed by the Board and Executive
during the year. It is considered a medium to
high impact risk with a medium to high
2 Leveraging our platform
our strategy. Committee. probability. 3 Flexible balance sheet
Responsibility
We undertake an extensive Employee

The integration of another business and
perceived change may cause staff concerns.
Board & ExCo Engagement Survey once a year to gauge Environmental, Social and Governance
Strategic alignment 1
2
3
employee views on leadership, company
culture, health and wellbeing, personal

Although inflation puts pressure on salary costs
and demands, this impact is mitigated by an
growth and benefits and recognition. This active employee engagement programme and Impact and probability
Impact informs any changes to HR policy. the alignment of reward with both individual and
Probability
We regularly benchmark our pay and
benefits against those of peers and the
Group-level performance. The vesting of the
LTIP awards in both August 2023 and September
Low
wider market. 2024 has improved staff perceptions of these Medium
Movement
We regularly review the Group's resourcing
long-term awards and improved their
requirements, performance management, motivational impact. High
talent and succession planning.
We continue to focus on staff wellbeing and

Longer notice periods are in place for key
employees.
actively seek regular feedback from staff. The
Sunday Times Best Places to Work 2024 survey
was strongly positive with NewRiver scoring
Risk change during FY25

Our recruitment policies consider the needs
Increased

"excellent' in all criteria.

• We also offer many forms of flexible working including job share, annualised hours, variation of hours and working from home. Since the pandemic we have implemented a policy of enabling staff to work from home a number of days a week should they choose to do so.

Decreased

No change

of the business today and our aspirations for the future, whilst ensuring our unique corporate culture is maintained.

Decreased

No change

Risk and impact Monitoring and management Change in risk assessment during the period Key
8. Financing Strategic pillars
If gearing levels become higher than our risk
The Board regularly assesses Group financial

Financing risk remained the same during the year
1
Disciplined capital allocation
appetite or lead to breaches in bank
covenants, this would impact our ability to
performance and scenario testing, covering
levels of gearing and headroom to financial
and is considered a low to medium impact risk
with a medium probability.
2
Leveraging our platform
implement our strategy. The business could
also struggle to obtain funding or face
covenants and assessments by external
rating agencies.

Macroeconomic developments, particularly the
increase in inflation, have impacted financial
3
Flexible balance sheet
increased interest rates as a result of
macroeconomic factors.

The Group has a programme of active
engagement with key lenders and
markets. The strength of the Group's
predominantly unsecured balance sheet means
Environmental, Social and Governance
Responsibility
Board & ExCo
shareholders.

The Group has a predominantly unsecured
we have significantly mitigated the risk of not
being able to secure sufficient financing.
balance sheet, which mitigates the risk of a
The Group extended the maturity on its undrawn
Impact and probability
1
2
3
Strategic alignment
covenant breach caused by fluctuations in Revolving Credit Facility to November 2026 Low
Impact individual property valuations.

The Group has long-dated maturity on its
during the prior year. Medium
Probability debt, providing sufficient flexibility for
refinancing.
High
Movement
Working capital and cashflow analysis and
detailed forward assessments of cashflows
are regularly reviewed by the Executive Risk change during FY25
Committee.

Our credit rating is independently assessed
Increased
by Fitch Ratings at least annually.
Risk and impact Monitoring and management Change in risk assessment during the period Key
9. Asset management Strategic pillars
The performance of our assets may not
meet with the expectations outlined in
their business plans, impacting financial

Asset-level business plans are regularly
reviewed by the asset management team
and the Executive Committee and detailed

Asset management risk has remained the same
during the year and is considered a medium to
high impact risk with a medium probability.
1
Disciplined capital allocation
2
Leveraging our platform
performance and the ability to implement
our strategies.
forecasts are updated frequently.

The Executive Committee reviews whole

Our diverse tenant portfolio focuses on essential
retail which reduces the impact of individual
3
Flexible balance sheet
Responsibility
Board & ExCo
portfolio performance on a quarterly basis
to identify any trends that require action.
tenant defaults.

Although we have a low probability of default,
Environmental, Social and Governance
1
2
3
Strategic alignment

Our asset managers are in contact with
centre managers and occupiers on a daily
the continued cost-of-living crisis may impact
the financial health of our occupiers.
Impact and probability
Impact basis to identify potential risks and
improvement areas.

Our operational performance continues to prove
the resilience of our assets.
Low
Probability
Revenue collection is reviewed regularly by
the Executive Committee.

New assets from the Capital & Regional
acquisition have diversified the portfolio further.
Medium
Movement
Retailer concentration risk is monitored,
with a guideline that no retailer will account
for more than 5% of gross income (currently
High
our largest retailer is Boots accounting for
3.6% of gross income).
Risk change during FY25
10. Development Increased
Delays, increased costs and other challenges
could impact our ability to pursue our

We apply a risk-controlled development
strategy through negotiating long-dated

Development risk probability decreased during
the period as the business currently has fewer
Decreased
development pipeline and therefore our ability
to profitably recycle development sites and
achieve returns on development.
pre-lets for the majority of assets.

All development is risk-controlled and forms
only a small element of the portfolio by value.
development projects. It is considered a medium
impact risk with a low to medium probability.

Supply issues and increases in the cost of
No change
building supplies will impact developments,
Responsibility Board & ExCo
Strategic alignment 1
2
3
Impact
Probability
Movement
  • Capital deployed is actively monitored by the Executive Committee, following detailed due diligence modelling and research.
  • An experienced development team monitors on-site development and cost controls.
  • On large-scale developments where construction is more than 12 months, we look to carry out the project in partnership and/or forward sell.
  • building supplies will impact developments, however, as they remain a small part of our portfolio the overall impact is low.
  • A number of our Regeneration assets were sold in prior years which has decreased the proportion of assets focused on development which inherently reduces risk exposure.
Risk and impact Monitoring and management Change in risk assessment during the period Key
Strategic pillars
11. Acquisitions
The performance of asset and corporate
acquisitions might not meet with our
expectations and assumptions, impacting our

We carry out thorough due diligence on all
new acquisitions, using data from external
advisers and our own rigorous in-house

Acquisition risk has remained the same through
the year and is considered a medium impact risk
with a medium probability.
1
Disciplined capital allocation
2
Leveraging our platform
revenue and profitability. modelling before committing to any
transaction. Probability-weighted analysis
takes account of acquisition risks.

The lack of supply and relative price of some
assets may reduce opportunities for acquisition.

We will deploy capital in line with our returns
3
Flexible balance sheet
Responsibility
Board & ExCo
Environmental, Social and Governance
1
2
3
Strategic alignment

Acquisitions are subject to approval by the
Board and Executive Committee, who are
focused approach to capital allocation and
subject to our LTV guidance.
Impact highly experienced in the retail sector.

We have the ability to acquire in joint
Impact and probability
Probability ventures, thereby sharing risk. Low
Medium
Movement High
12. Disposals
We may face difficulty in disposing of assets
Our portfolio is focused on high-quality

Disposal risk has remained the same during the
Risk change during FY25
or realising their fair value, thereby impacting
profitability and our ability to reduce debt
assets with low lot sizes, making them
attractive to a wide pool of buyers.
year and is considered a medium impact risk
with a medium to high probability.
Increased
levels or make further acquisitions.
Assets are valued every six months by
external valuers, enabling informed disposal

National and geopolitical uncertainty, interest
rates, inflation and the cost-of-living crisis mean
Decreased
Responsibility
Board & ExCo
pricing decisions. that markets remain uncertain and are causing
some purchasers to reconsider or delay
acquisition decisions.

We have an active and successful disposal
programme. The average lot size however is
lower than most in the market so our assets
tend to be more liquid.
No change
1
2
3
Strategic alignment

Disposals are subject to approval by the
Board and Executive Committee, who are
Impact highly experienced in the retail sector.

Our portfolio is large and our average asset
Probability lot size is small, meaning that each asset
represents only a small proportion of
Movement revenues and profits, thereby mitigating the
impact of a sale not proceeding.

Viability statement

Period of assessment

The UK Corporate Governance Code requires the Directors to appraise the viability of the Group over what they consider to be an appropriate period of assessment taking into account the Group's current position, its business model (page 4), strategy (page 5) and principal risks and uncertainties (pages 98 to 108).

In making this assessment, the Directors view the Group's focus on its resilient sub-sector of convenience retail, expertise in asset management and risk-controlled development, disposal track record and the strength of the Group's balance sheet as the key aspects supporting the long-term sustainability of the business.

The Directors consider the appropriate period of assessment to be three years from the current financial year end to 31 March 2028. This period of assessment is aligned to performance measurement and management remuneration, and in the opinion of the Directors, this period of assessment strikes the optimal balance of allowing the impact of strategic decisions to be modelled while maintaining the accuracy of underlying forecast inputs.

Principal risks

In making their viability assessment, the Directors assessed the potential impacts, in reasonable worst case scenarios, of the principal risks as set out on pages 98 to 108, together with the likely degree of effectiveness of mitigating actions reasonably expected to be available to the Group. The most relevant of these risks to viability, with the highest potential impact, were considered to be:

  • Macroeconomic Economic conditions in the UK and changes to fiscal and monetary policy may impact market activity, demand for investment assets, the operations of our occupiers or the spending habits of the UK population.
  • Political and regulatory Changes in UK Government policy, the currently elevated level of global conflict and its impact on the UK and on the consumers' retail and leisure spend.
  • Catastrophic external event An external event such as civil unrest, a civil emergency including a large-scale terrorist attack or pandemic, could severely disrupt global markets and cause damage and disruption to our assets.

The Board is encouraged by the consistently strong operational performance of the Group's portfolio in recent years, during a sustained period of macroeconomic instability. While uncertainty around the prospects for the UK economy remains, some of the factors prevalent in the recent past, such as elevated inflation and interest rates have reduced over the last twelve months and importantly the Group retains the features which have allowed it to navigate past uncertainty such as its superior property yields, balance sheet strength, and low and fixed cost of debt.

Process

The Group's annual budget, forecast and business planning process takes place in the final quarter of the financial year, with the final budget signed off by the Board early in the new financial year.

The exercise is completed at a granular level, on a lease-by-lease basis and considers the Group's profitability, capital values, loan to value, cash flows and other key financial metrics over the forecast period.

Following the Group divesting itself of its community pub business in FY22, the Group's clear strategic aim has been to reduce its non-core exposure, including Work Out assets, to ensure that the assets in its portfolio display only the characteristics of resilient retail. The Group considers that such retail assets are located in catchments with long-term growth potential and the right balance between the supply of physical retail space and demand for that space, with an offering that meets the everyday needs of customers while playing a distinct role within their communities.

During FY25, the Group continued to reduce its exposure to Work Out assets, selling a further two non-core assets, and has redeployed the significant firepower accumulated over recent years into the acquisition of Capital & Regional plc for £151 million which was funded through a combination of cash and shares. The acquisition increased the size of NewRiver's portfolio by 65% through the combination of high-quality, complementary assets with similarly low-risk tenant profile, which are now included in NewRiver's Core Shopping Centre portfolio.

The Group has maintained its balance sheet strength following the acquisition of Capital & Regional which is measured by considering Interest Cover Ratio, Net debt: EBITDA and LTV. Although LTV has increased to 42.3% following the transaction, above the Group's guidance for LTV to be below 40%, immediately post year end we completed the disposal of the Abbey Centre in Newtownabbey, which reduces our LTV to c.38% meaning we are within guidance with capacity to invest into accretive asset acquisitions. Interest Cover and Net Debt: EBITDA have maintained significant headroom to Policy following the acquisition.

The Directors believe that, following the reduction in the size of the Work Out portfolio in recent years, to just 3% of the portfolio by valuation, and the acquisition of Capital & Regional, the Group is well positioned to deliver attractive returns to shareholders.

The forecast scenario selected by the Directors to assess the Group's viability is based on the delivery of the individual asset business plans, including planned capital expenditure and planned disposals, and its ability to continue its access to borrowing facilities and operate the Group's debt structure within its financial covenants.

The principal debt currently drawn by the Group is the £300 million unsecured corporate bond which matures in March 2028, at the very end of the Viability Statement period of assessment. We have maintained our investment grade credit rating since the bond was launched in 2018 (most recently affirmed in September 2024 and re-affirmed in February 2025 following the Capital & Regional transaction) and, with the increased scale we now have and the strength of our financial position throughout the period of assessment, we are confident in our ability to refinance the bond when required.

The only other debt currently drawn by the Group is the single facility that we retained following the acquisition of Capital & Regional, the £140 million "Mall" facility secured against three of the assets acquired as part of the Capital & Regional transaction which matures in January 2027. Available cash and liquidity both

& Appendix

NewRiver REIT plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2025 Governance Report Financial Statements ESG Data Sets 110 Strategic Report

& Appendix

Glossary & Company Information

Viability statement continued

currently and throughout the assessment period is such that this secured loan can either be repaid in full and/or any requisite cure funded at any point. Under this scenario, the Group is forecast to maintain sufficient cash and liquidity resources and remain compliant with its financial covenants with significant headroom.

Further sensitivity analysis was performed on this scenario to align it with the assumptions used in the reasonable worst-case scenario for the going concern review (see the Going Concern section of note 1 to the financial statements). This includes removing all uncommitted acquisitions and disposals, assuming further valuation decline and a lower income collection rate. Even applying this sensitivity, the Group maintains sufficient cash and liquidity reserves to continue in operation throughout the assessment period and the drawn debt covenants could absorb a further valuation decline of 26% and a further 48% reduction in annual net rental income before breaching applicable covenant levels.

Conclusion

On the basis of this and other matters considered by the Board during the year, the Board has a reasonable expectation that the Group will be able to continue in operation and meet its liabilities as they fall due over the three-year period of their detailed assessment.

Going concern

The Directors of NewRiver REIT plc have reviewed the current and projected financial position of the Group making reasonable assumptions about future trading and performance. Reasonable worst-case scenarios were applied to the assumptions and the Directors are satisfied that the going concern basis of presentation of the financial statements is appropriate.

Company Information

Non-financial and sustainability information statement

Non-financial and sustainability information statement

As NewRiver has fewer than 500 employees, it is not required to comply with the Non-Financial Reporting requirements contained within the Companies Act 2006. However, due to our commitment to promoting transparency in reporting and business practices, further information is provided on this page on a voluntary basis, to help stakeholders understand our position on key non-financial and sustainability matters.

Topics Key policies and standards1,2 Additional information
Environmental matters
Environmental Social Governance Policy

Net-Zero and Climate Resilience Policy

Social Value Policy

Green Procurement Policy

Biodiversity Position Statement

Sustainability Brief for Development
For more on sustainability and environmental matters see pages 89 to 97
and the Sustainability section of our website: www.nrr.co.uk
Climate-related
financial disclosures

Task Force on Climate-related Financial
Disclosures ("TCFD")
For more on action on climate change see pages 89 and 97 and the
Sustainability section of our website: www.nrr.co.uk
Our people
Code of Conduct covering:
For more on people and culture see pages 6, 20, 23, 59 and 60 to 61

Workplace behaviour

Equal opportunities

Working with NewRiver

Speaking up

Health and Safety

Wellbeing

Electronic communications
For more on diversity and inclusion see pages 61 and 128 to 130 and the
People & Culture section of our website: www.nrr.co.uk
Human rights
Code of Conduct

Modern Slavery and Human
Trafficking Statement
For more on modern slavery see the Modern Slavery Statement on our
website: www.nrr.co.uk
Social matters
Social Value Policy
For more on our stakeholder engagement see pages 58 to 67

Charity partnership with Trussell
For more on the local community see page 64 and the Sustainability
section of our website: www.nrr.co.uk
Anti-bribery and
Whistleblowing Policy
For our Audit Committee report see pages 131 to 135
corruption
Code of Conduct
People & Culture section of our website: www.nrr.co.uk

Gifts and Hospitality Policy

Anti-money Laundering Policy

Supply Chain Policy and Supplier Code of
Conduct

Share Dealing Policy
Modern Slavery Statement on our website: www.nrr.co.uk
Business model For more on our strategy and business model see pages 2 and 111
Principal risks For more on our principal risks and uncertainties see pages 98 to 108
and uncertainties For our viability statement see page 109
Non-financial key
performance indicators
For more on non-financial key performance indicators see pages 15 to 17

The Strategic Report was approved by the Board 16 June 2025

By order of the Board

Allan Lockhart Chief Executive Officer 1. Policies and further information can be found on the website: www.nrr.co.uk.

  1. Certain policies and internal guidelines are not published externally.

Company Information

Governance Report

Strong governance is a strategic enabler for our growth

Governance Report
Chair's letter on governance 114
Our leadership team 115
Board leadership and Company purpose 118
Nomination Committee Report 126
Audit Committee Report 131
Remuneration Committee Report
Directors' Report
136
157

Corporate Governance

The Governance section provides details of the Board's corporate governance structures and work for the financial year to 31 March 2025. Together with the Directors' Remuneration Report on pages 136 to 156, it includes information about how the Company has applied the principles and complied with the provisions of the 2018 UK Corporate Governance Code. The Governance section has been organised to follow the structure and principles (A to R) of the 2018 Code.

Compliance with the 2018 UK Corporate Governance Code

As a Company with an equity shares (commercial companies) listing on the London Stock Exchange, NewRiver is required under the Financial Reporting Council (FRC) Listing Rules to comply with the Code Provisions of the 2018 UK Corporate Governance Code issued in July 2018 (the '2018 Code') which is available on the FRC website (www.frc.org.uk). The Company confirms that for the year ended 31 March 2025, the Company applied the principles and complied with all Provisions of the Code.

The ways in which the Code's principles were applied during FY25 are evidenced in this Governance Report and throughout the Annual Report.

The index on this page sets out a list of page references against the Code principles (A to R).

The Board has reviewed and prepared for the 2024 iteration of the Code (the 'new Code') and notes that it applies to the Company with effect from FY26 that commenced on 1 April 2025. The Company will report against the new Code in its Annual Report for FY26.

Board leadership and Company purpose Found on page
A. An effective Board 115
B. Purpose, values and culture 118
C. Governance framework and Board resources 121
D. Stakeholder engagement 58
E. Workforce policies and practices 111

Division of responsibilities

F. Board roles 122
G. Independence 123
H. External appointments and conflicts of interest 123
I. Key activities of the Board in FY25 119

Composition, succession and evaluation

J. Appointments to the Board 126
K. Board skills, experience and knowledge 128
L. Annual Board and Committee evaluation 125

Audit, risk and internal control

M. Financial reporting, external auditor and internal audit 132
N. Fair, balanced and understandable 135
O. Internal financial controls and risk management 134

Remuneration

P. Linking remuneration with purpose, values and strategy 136
Q. Remuneration Policy development 136
R. Performance outcomes in FY25 and strategic targets 148

Glossary & Company Information

Chair's letter on governance

Dear Shareholders

I have pleasure in introducing NewRiver's Governance Report for the year ended 31 March 2025. In my Chair's statement earlier in this Annual Report I talked about our transformational year. This Governance Report provides detail on how we manage ourselves to support our transformational growth, culture and strategy. The Board has overall responsibility for the leadership of the Company, setting the Company's values and standards and monitoring culture.

Part of the Board's oversight responsibility is to ensure that there is sound management and internal controls. This report outlines our governance structure and processes and the work of the Board and its Committees to ensure the Board responsibilities are fulfilled.

Succession planning and leadership change

Margaret Ford stepped down as Chair on 30 May 2024 following a two-month handover process following my appointment on 20 March 2024 as Chair Designate. The search for a new Chair in FY24 was led by our Senior Independent Non-Executive Director, Alastair Miller. Alastair is now our longest serving Non-Executive Director and will reach nine years of service in June 2025. We have therefore commenced the process to find another Non-Executive Director. We expect however that Alastair will remain with us into 2026 so that we can continue to have access to his extensive experience and guidance as we continue to integrate Ellandi and Capital & Regional during FY26.

Strategic guidance during FY25

FY25 was a strategically busy year with the acquisitions of Ellandi and Capital & Regional plc. The Board has provided strategic counselling and guidance to the executive management before, during and after both transactions. To plan for FY26 and the continued growth plans, both the Board and ExCo spent time together off site in February 2025 for a strategy day and evening to plan for the future of the business. This extremely useful strategy session created action plans and workstreams to progress over FY26. A followup session is already planned in FY26 to work through these actions and workstreams.

Engaging our stakeholders

Our stakeholders remain a key focus as we recognise our long-term successes rely on our relationships with our stakeholders and their evolving needs. All our stakeholder relationships have expanded and evolved this year with the acquisition of Ellandi and Capital & Regional. We have detailed how we engage with these stakeholders in our Stakeholder engagement section on pages 58 to 67. The Board receives regular updates on these relationships and also the Board, including the Non-Executive Directors, makes every effort to connect with stakeholders via asset visits and attending specific meetings. This year we have been particularly active in our engagement with shareholders and potential new investors with a placing of shares, which was over subscribed and a consultation with shareholders regarding the application of our Remuneration Policy. We look forward to welcoming and engaging with all shareholders again at our AGM in July.

Yours sincerely

Lynn Fordham Chair

16 June 2025

Board of Directors

Experienced leadership

Lynn Fordham Non-Executive Chair | Appointed March 2024

Key skills and experience

Lynn joined the Board in March 2024 and is an experienced non-executive director. She was most recently Managing Partner of private investment firm Larchpoint Capital LLP, a position she held from 2017 to 2021. Prior to joining Larchpoint, Lynn was CEO of SVG Capital for eight years having previously served as CFO. Before that she held senior roles at Barratt Developments, BAA, Boots, ED&F Man, BAT and Mobil Oil. She also served as a non-executive director on the board of Fuller, Smith & Turner for seven years until 2018, chairing its Audit Committee. Lynn brings to the Board wide-ranging listed company, private equity and finance and transaction experience across a range of sectors.

External Appointments

Listed Companies: NCC Group plc (Non-Executive Director and Audit Committee Chair); Caledonia Investments plc (Non-Executive Director and Audit Committee Chair); Domino's Pizza Group plc (Senior Independent Director and Audit Committee Chair)

Other: Chair of RMA – The Royal Marines Charity; Enfinium Group Ltd (Non-Executive Director)

Allan Lockhart Chief Executive Officer | Appointed June 2016

Key skills and experience

Allan has over 30 years' experience in the UK retail real estate market. He started his career with Strutt & Parker in 1988 advising major property companies and institutions on retail leasing, investment and development. In 2002, Allan was appointed as Retail Director to Halladale Plc with a remit to acquire value add opportunities in the UK retail real estate market and ensure the successful implementation of asset management strategies. Following the successful sale of Halladale Plc in early 2007, Allan co-founded NewRiver and served as Property Director since its IPO until being appointed Chief Executive Officer in May 2018.

External Appointments None

Will Hobman Chief Financial Officer | Appointed August 2021

Key skills and experience

Will is a Chartered Accountant with over a decade of real estate experience, having qualified at BDO LLP working in its Audit and Corporate Finance departments. Before joining NewRiver in June 2016, Will worked at British Land for five years in a variety of finance roles, latterly in Investor Relations, and formerly within the Financial Reporting and Financial Planning & Analysis teams. Will obtained a BArch (Hons) in Architecture from Nottingham University before obtaining his ACA qualification, becoming an FCA in March 2020.

External Appointments

British Property Federation Finance Committee Member

Alastair Miller Senior Independent Director | Appointed January 2016

Key skills and experience

Alastair is a Chartered Accountant and has significant, recent and relevant financial experience. Throughout his career Alastair has developed skills in risk management, property, systems, company secretariat and investor relations. Having worked for New Look Group for 14 years, Alastair has an in-depth understanding of retailers and the factors that impact their trading and profitability. Alastair was formerly Audit Committee Chair and non-executive Director of Superdry, Chief Financial Officer of New Look Group, Group Finance Director of the RAC and Finance Director of a company within the BTR Group. In addition to being the Senior Independent Director, Alastair has responsibility for ensuring that the Board successfully engages with our workforce.

External Appointments

RNLI (Risk and Audit Committee Member and Council Member)

N

Board of Directors continued

Dr Karen Miller Independent Non-Executive Director | Appointed May 2022

Key skills and experience

Dr Karen Miller is Co-Founder of the Cambridge Net Positive Lab. Karen is a sustainability expert with a proven track record of leading transformation through a collaborative applied approach in large national and international companies. Karen has over 25 years' experience of growing businesses in the retail sector through innovation.

External Appointments

Buckingham Palace Reservicing Programme Challenge Board; Director of Cambridge Net Positive Lab Ltd; Director of Lidwells Ltd

Charlie Parker Independent Non-Executive Director | Appointed September 2020

Key skills and experience

Charlie was previously Chief Executive and Head of the Public Service for the Government of Jersey from January 2018 until his retirement in March 2021. Prior to working in Jersey, Charlie was Chief Executive of Westminster City Council from December 2013 to December 2017 and Chief Executive of Oldham Metropolitan Borough Council from October 2008 to December 2013. During his various roles as a Chief Executive, Charlie oversaw the significant transformation and modernisation of a large number of public services often resulting in reduced costs and improved performance. He was also responsible for a range of large-scale capital infrastructure and regeneration projects in Jersey, Westminster and Oldham. Prior to 2008 he held a number of investment, development and regeneration roles across national and local government bodies for over 20 years.

External Appointments

Buckingham Palace Reservicing Programme Challenge Board; Griffin Investors Ltd; Financial Reporting Council

Colin Rutherford Independent Non-Executive Director | Appointed February 2019

Key skills and experience

Colin is an experienced public and private company chairman and independent director, with relevant sector experience including asset management, leisure and real estate. Colin is a member of the Institute of Chartered Accountants of Scotland.

External Appointments

Listed Companies: Evofem Biosciences Inc (Independent Director and Audit Committee Chairman)

Other: Allstones Sand Gravels Aggregates Trading Co. Ltd (Chairman); Brookgate Limited (Chairman); Donaldson Group Limited (Independent Director and Audit Committee Chairman); Rothley Group Limited (Chairman)

A N R

Kerin Williams Company Secretary | Appointed October 2020

Key skills and experience

Kerin is a Chartered Secretary with over 30 years' experience. Kerin has worked in-house in senior positions within company secretarial departments for a number of FTSE 100 and FTSE 250 companies in real estate, chemicals, banking and printing. Kerin has also worked in professional services as a company secretarial consultant; her most recent role was as Managing Director of Prism Cosec. Kerin graduated in Law, qualified as a Chartered Secretary in 1997 and is a Fellow of the Chartered Governance Institute.

Committee membership
Committee Chair
A Audit Committee
N Nomination Committee
R Remuneration Committee

Executive Committee

Edith Monfries Chief Operating and People Officer

Key skills and experience Edith is a Chartered Accountant having trained with Deloitte, Haskins and Sells.

She has over 30 years' experience in the retail and leisure property sector, combining Finance, Operational and HR roles, specialising in advising on strategic and operational matters.

Edith was appointed Head of HR at NewRiver in October 2018 and in her role as COO brings her expertise in talent development within the sector to the business including overseeing the transition and intergration of Ellandi and Capital & Regional.

Edith served as COO of NewRiver's pub business Hawthorn prior to its sale.

Edith sits on the Board of The Academy of Real Assets, a charitable partner of NewRiver's, and is a Trustee of Sinfonia Smith Square, serving as Chair of Audit & Risk.

Emma Mackenzie Head of Asset Management and ESG

Key skills and experience

Emma has overarching responsibility for the financial and operational performance of the retail portfolio incorporating the delivery of asset management plans and oversight of the property management function, including the asset integration of the Company's acquisition of Capital and Regional and Ellandi. Emma also leads the Company's Environmental, Social and Governance programme ensuring it is embedded in asset management strategies and the wider business.

Emma is a qualified chartered surveyor with over 25 years' experience in the retail property market having previously worked in private practice.

Emma chairs the Commercial Committee of the British Property Federation and was a Board member of the High St Task Force for five years.

Charles Spooner Head of Capital Markets

Key skills and experience

Charles is responsible for Capital Markets and Retail Parks throughout the UK and has 25 years' experience in the real estate investment and asset management sector.

Charles has benefitted from the broad experience as an asset manager at F&C REIT and RREEF, in an advisory capacity at Cushman Wakefield and as a retailer advising Specsavers on its agency and development activity. Charles is responsible for acquisitions, disposals, development and implementation of asset management strategies, with particular focus on the retail warehouse sector.

Morgan Garfield Head of Capital Partnership

Key skills and experience

Morgan is responsible for Capital Partnerships. Morgan joined the company in July 2024 following NewRiver's acquisition of Ellandi, the asset management company he co-founded in 2008.

Having spent 25 years working in real estate and real estate finance, Morgan has significant experience of structuring JV's with third party equity partners to invest in retail property and non-performing loans, including originating c. £1 billion of investments through JV structures for Ellandi.

Prior to founding Ellandi, Morgan was a Managing Director at Deutsche Bank where he led the UK real estate finance business. He built teams that originated more than £3 billion of loans and a servicing platform that managed a loan portfolio of more than €16 billion. Morgan began his banking career at Rothschild having graduated with an MA in Geography from the University of Cambridge.

Morgan chairs the British Property Federation Retail Board.

Mark Robinson Head of Regeneration

Key skills and experience

Mark is responsible for Regeneration projects across the portfolio. Mark joined the company in July 2024 following NewRiver's acquisition of Ellandi, the asset management company he co-founded in 2008.

Mark has over three decades of experience in retail property and placemaking, acting as an adviser, investor, developer and occupier. Mark formerly held the role of Revo President in 2019 and led the government's High Street Task Force in July 2020.

Allan Lockhart

Chief Executive Officer | Appointed June 2016 See page 115 for key skills & experience.

Will Hobman Chief Financial Officer | Appointed August 2021 See page 115 for key skills & experience.

Strategic Report

& Appendix

Glossary & Company Information

Corporate governance continued

Board leadership and company purpose

Purpose, values and strategy

Our purpose is to own, manage and develop a portfolio of retail assets across the UK that provide essential goods and services to local people, help support thriving communities and deliver long-term premium returns for our shareholders.

Generation and preservation of value over the long term

The Board's role is to lead the Group and ensure that it delivers sustainable and growing returns for our shareholders over the longer term. NewRiver's business model and strategy are set out on pages 4 and 5 of the Strategic Report and describes the basis upon which the Group generates and preserves value over the long term.

2 Leveraging our platform

3 Flexible balance sheet

Underpinned by a committed ESG strategy

Read more about our business model on page 4

Our culture

NewRiver's collaborative and supportive culture underpins our purpose and drives business practices. Although our workforce has increased during the year with the acquisitions of Ellandi and Capital & Regional, the workforce of around 80 employees is still relatively small so our culture continues to be able to provide people who work for us with a sense of purpose and an opportunity to thrive and develop as individuals. The proximity between Board and employees makes it easier for the Board to engage with employees and the Directors can monitor the culture in a way not possible for larger companies. The small size of our team also allows for flexibility and adaptability so that we can respond to fast-changing situations.

Board leadership

The Board oversees the Group's active approach to asset management and the strategy of developing and recycling convenience-led, community focused retail assets throughout the UK and this in turn contributes to the local communities and wider society.

The Board has overall authority for the management and conduct of the Group's business, strategy and development and is responsible for ensuring that this aligns with the Group's culture.

The Board, supported by the Company Secretary, ensures the maintenance of a system of internal controls and risk management (including financial, operational and compliance controls) and reviews the overall effectiveness of the systems in place. The Board delegates the day-to-day management of the business to the Executive Committee ("ExCo"). There is a Schedule of Matters reserved for the Board's decision which forms part of a delegated authority framework to ensure that unusual or material transactions are brought to the Board for approval. This Schedule of Matters is reviewed regularly to ensure that it is kept up to date with any regulatory changes and is fit for purpose. The last review was undertaken in May 2025. The Executive Committee also has its own Terms of Reference that fit within the governance framework and are approved by the Board.

Board activities

Workforce engagement mechanism – the role of our designated Non-Executive Director

Alastair Miller, our Senior Independent Director, has responsibility for ensuring that the Board successfully engages with our workforce. As Chair of the Remuneration Committee Alastair, has direct engagement with shareholders on Remuneration Policy and is therefore best placed to answer questions from the workforce on Director remuneration and its alignment to Group-wide remuneration and strategy.

We continue to have a relatively small workforce which allows a natural proximity between the Board and the workforce, making it easy for the Board to engage with staff directly, especially as the Directors regularly visit the London office and also the assets. This remains the case with the addition of Ellandi and Capital & Regional. Staff are invited on a regular basis to attend a group meeting with Alastair in the London office, or online if preferred. This year in March, we had to hold two sessions across the day to fit in all staff. Questions are invited ahead of the meeting as well as taken live on the day. The majority of staff attended this meeting either in person or online. Alastair took the opportunity to explain the role of the Board and its Committees and what it meant to be a public company, the role of governance in a public company and who the stakeholders of the Company were. He also discussed the benefits of the recent acquisitions to the business and the strategy ahead. Alastair then took questions from staff on this. Discussing his time on the Board, Alastair was quizzed on his biggest challenges during his tenure and the changes over the years. Staff discussed flexible working, the office arrangements with the integration of Ellandi and Capital & Regional into the head office and the geopolitical environment that the world and the business now faces.

Staff engagement

Board

(Led by Alastair Miller, our Senior Independent Non-Executive Director and Non-Executive Director, responsible for workforce engagement)

  • NED/Staff engagement sessions
  • Staff survey results
  • NED visits to assets and London office
  • Increased social events with staff
  • Strategy session with ExCo
  • Direct reports attending Board meetings to present

Executive Committee ('ExCo')

  • Direct report engagement and staff appraisals and feedback
  • Monthly all-staff sessions

• Staff survey results • Frequent social events with staff

• Fundraising events with staff

Our staff

  • Monthly all-staff sessions
  • Staff survey results
  • Staff newsletter
  • Frequent social events
  • Various charity events including themed days in the office and external activity-led charity events
NewRiver REIT plc Annual Report and Accounts 2025 Strategic Report Governance Report Financial Statements ESG Data Sets
& Appendix
Glossary &
Company Information
120
Board activities continued
Board activity during the year Link to strategy
Strategy
The Board discusses progress against strategy at most meetings and receives updates on strategy in the CEO's report

Additional strategic papers have been considered by the Board at Board meetings during the year

Papers and presentations including those from advisers were considered by the Board relating to the acquisitions of Ellandi and Capital & Regional plc

Additional ad hoc Board meetings were held during the negotiations relating to the Ellandi and Capital & Regional acquisitions

An additional strategic session was held off site and included all ExCo members as well as the Board
1
3
2
Finance and
financing

The Chief Financial Officer has presented a financial report at each Board meeting

Approval of the Annual Report and interim report and associated financial statements

Presentation and discussion on the draft budget and business plan

Approval of the annual budget

The CFO provided quarterly reporting against the treasury policy
1
3
2
Audit and risk
The Chair of the Audit Committee reported to the Board on the proceedings of each Audit Committee meeting and meetings with valuers

The Board considers the risk register and internal controls at least twice a year

Update to the Board on the whistleblowing procedures

Recommendation to the Board on the re-appointment of the External Auditor
1
3
2
Operational and
investor relations

The CEO presented a report at each Board meeting which also included updates on investor relations

Members of the ExCo were regularly invited to attend the Board meetings to present on various projects

The Board received IR strategy and quarterly corporate communication progress reports
• Members of the senior leadership team were invited to Board meetings to report on specific assets
1
3
2
Stakeholders
Stakeholders including our team, communities, shareholders, capital partners, occupiers, lenders, environment and local authorities are regularly
considered as part of the CEO report to the Board

The Non-Executive Directors visited a number of the Group's assets during FY24 and FY25 and were provided with guided tours from the asset
management teams responsible for the assets

HR reports are either tabled separately or included the CEO's report

The Board received updates from Alastair Miller's attendance at staff sessions
1
3
2
Environmental
and governance

The Board received regular updates on ESG progress in the CEO's report and a quarterly ESG update from the Head of Asset Management and ESG

The Committee Chairs reported on key matters discussed at the Board Committees

The Company Secretary reported on key governance developments and on work carried out to update and review the Group's governance policies
and procedures

The Board updated the Board's Schedule of Matters and reviewed and updated the Terms of Reference of the Board Committees in preparation for
the new Corporate Governance Code
1
3
2

Key

Division of responsibilities

Board

Responsible for leading the Group, establishing the Company purpose and values and setting the strategy and monitoring its progress. It also sets policies and monitors performance.

Reviews and monitors the Group's risk management processes.

Monitors the integrity of the half-year and annual financial statements before submission to the Board.

Monitors the effectiveness of the audit process.

Audit Committee Remuneration Committee Nomination Committee

Implements the Remuneration Policy of the Group, which is to ensure that Directors and senior management are rewarded in a way that attracts, retains and motivates them and aligns the interests of both shareholders and management.

Reviews the succession planning requirements of the Group and operates a formal, rigorous and transparent procedure for the appointment of new Directors to the Board.

Executive Committee ('ExCo')

Assists the Chief Executive with the development and implementation of the Group strategy, the management of the business and the discharge of its responsibilities delegated by the Board.

Supporting Committees

Senior Leadership Team (SLT) ESG Committee Wellbeing Committee

Senior members of the business below ExCo level tasked with assisting ExCo with the progress of the Group strategy.

Led by Emma Mackenzie, Head of Asset Management and ESG, the ESG Committee ensures the appropriate resources are mobilised so the key ESG programme milestones are achieved.

Originally set up during lockdown restrictions to focus on staff wellbeing, the Committee has evolved its brief to provide a collective employee voice and to focus on diversity and inclusion.

NewRiver REIT plc Annual Report and Accounts 2025 Strategic Report Governance Report Financial Statements ESG Data Sets
& Appendix
Glossary &
Company Information
122

There is a clear division of responsibilities between the Chair, CEO and other members of the Board, as follows:

Division of responsibilities continued

Role Responsibilities
Chair Lynn's role is to lead the Board and ensure that it operates effectively.
Lynn Fordham Her responsibilities include:

chairing the Board and general meetings of the Company and the Nomination Committee;

setting clear expectations concerning the Company's culture, values and behaviour;

ensuring effective engagement with shareholders, the workforce, customers and other key
stakeholders and ensuring that the Board listens to their views;

setting the agenda, style and tone of Board meetings to ensure that all matters are given due
consideration;

maintaining a culture of mutual respect, openness, debate and constructive challenge in the
Board room;

ensuring the Board's effectiveness and that it receives timely, accurate and clear information;

ensuring each new Director receives a full, formal and tailored induction on joining the Board;

reviewing and agreeing training and development for the Board; and

ensuring that the performances of the Board, its Committees and individual Directors are
evaluated once a year and acting on the results of the evaluation.
Chief Executive Officer Allan's responsibilities include:
Allan Lockhart
managing the business of the Group;

recommending the Group's strategy to the Board;

ESG strategy;

implementing the strategy agreed by the Board; and

management of the Group's property portfolio, including developments.
Chief Financial Officer Will's responsibilities include:
Will Hobman
implementing the Group's financial strategy, including balance sheet capitalisation;

overseeing financial reporting and internal controls; and

supporting the CEO in the delivery of the Group's strategy and financial performance.
Senior Independent Non-Executive Alastair's responsibilities include:
Director and Non-Executive Director
Responsible for Workforce
Engagement
Alastair Miller

acting as a sounding board for the Chair;

evaluating the Chair's performance as part of the Board's evaluation process;

serving as an intermediary for the other Directors when necessary;

being available to shareholders should an occasion occur when there was a need to convey
concern to the Board other than through the Chair or the Chief Executive; and

ensuring that the Board successfully engages with our workforce.
Independent
Non-Executive Directors
Non-Executive Directors Alastair Miller, Charlie Parker, Colin Rutherford and Karen Miller bring
independent judgement, knowledge and varied commercial experience to the meetings and in
their oversight of the Group's strategy. Alastair and Colin chair the Remuneration and Audit
Committees respectively.

Strategic Report

& Appendix

Glossary & Company Information

Division of responsibilities continued

Conflicts of interest

The Company Secretary keeps a register of all Directors' interests. The register sets out details of situations where each Director's interest may conflict with those of the Company (situational conflicts). The register is considered and reviewed at each Board meeting so that the Board may consider and authorise any new situational conflicts identified. At the beginning of each Board meeting, the Chair reminds the Directors of their duties under sections 175, 177 and 182 of the Companies Act 2006 which relate to the disclosure of any conflicts of interest prior to any matter that may be discussed by the Board.

Director concerns

Directors have the right to raise concerns at Board meetings and can ask for those concerns to be recorded in the Board minutes. The Group has also established a procedure which enables Directors, in relevant circumstances, to obtain independent professional advice at the Company's expense.

Board time commitments

All Directors pre-clear any proposed appointments to listed company boards with the Board prior to committing to them.

The Non-Executive Directors are required, by their letters of appointment, to devote as much of their time, attention, ability and skills as are reasonably required for the performance of their duties. This is anticipated as a minimum of one day a month, and for the Chair, a minimum of two to three days. The Nomination Committee annually reviews the time commitments to ensure that all Board members continue to be able to devote sufficient time and attention to the Company's business.

Whilst a number of the Board have other non-executive directorships and commitments, the Nomination Committee remains satisfied that all of the Directors spend considerably more than this amount of time on Board and Committee activity. This has been especially evident during a year in which there have been two acquisitions necessitating additional Board meetings and calls.

The other listed company directorships of the NewRiver REIT plc Directors are set out on pages 115 to 116. The Board and Committee attendance record of each of the Directors during FY25 is set out on page 124 of this report.

Balance between Independent Non-Executive and Executive Directors

The Board comprises four Independent Non-Executive Directors (excluding the Chair) and two Executive Directors. The Nomination Committee is of the opinion that the Non-Executive Directors remain independent, in line with the definition set out in the Code and are free from any relationship or circumstances that could affect, or appear to affect, their independent judgement. The Chair was independent on appointment and the Board still considers her to be independent. All Directors are subject to re-election at the AGM each year.

Company Secretary

All Directors have access to the advice and services of the Company Secretary. The appointment of the Company Secretary is a matter for the Board.

Executive Committee (ExCo)

The purpose of ExCo is to assist the CEO in the performance of his duties within the bands of the Committee's authority, including:

  • the development and implementation of strategy, operational plans, policies, procedures and budgets;
  • the monitoring of operating and financial performance;
  • the assessment and control of risk;
  • development and implementation of the ESG strategy;
  • the prioritisation and allocation of resources; and
  • monitoring competitive forces in each area of competition.

Composition, succession and evaluation

Induction of new Directors

The Chair, Company Secretary and Chief Operating and People Officer manage an induction process to ensure that new Directors are fully briefed about the Company and its operations. The process usually includes asset visits and meetings with members of the senior management team and other staff, as well as specific briefings with regard to their legal and regulatory obligations as a Director.

Annual General Meeting ("AGM")

The AGM is the annual opportunity for all shareholders to meet with the Directors and to discuss with them the Company's business and strategy. Shareholders are therefore welcome to attend in person at the 2025 AGM and we provide a facility for shareholders to submit questions ahead of the AGM via email. The 2025 AGM is planned to be held on 31 July 2025.

The notice of AGM is posted to all shareholders at least 20 working days before the meeting. Separate resolutions are proposed on all substantive issues and voting is conducted by a poll. The Board believes this method of voting is more democratic than voting via a show of hands since all shares voted at the meeting, including proxy votes submitted in advance of the meeting, are counted. In line with our sustainability commitment, we do not issue hard copy forms of proxy in the post. Instead, we ask shareholders to appoint a proxy online via the Registrar's portal.

For each resolution, shareholders will have the opportunity to vote for or against or to withhold their vote. Following the meeting, the results of votes lodged are announced to the London Stock Exchange and displayed on the Company's website.

Anti-corruption and anti-bribery

We are committed to the highest legal and ethical standards in every aspect of our business. It is our policy to conduct business in a fair, honest and open way, without the use of bribery or corrupt practices to obtain an unfair advantage. We provide clear guidance for suppliers and employees, including policies on anti-corruption and anti-bribery, anti-fraud and a Code of Conduct. All employees have received updates and training on these issues during the year.

Human rights and Modern Slavery

Being mindful of human rights, the Company has a Modern Slavery Policy to ensure that all of its suppliers are acting responsibly and are aware of the risks of slavery, human trafficking and child labour within their own organisation and supply chain. The Modern Slavery Statement is updated and published each year. All suppliers are required to agree to our Modern Slavery Policy requirements before being accepted as suppliers to the business.

Attendance

Strategic Report

Each of the Directors has committed to attend all scheduled Board and relevant Committee meetings and has also committed to make every effort to attend ad hoc meetings, either in person or by telephone/video call. During the Capital & Regional transaction there were a significant number of ad-hoc Board meetings and calls. All members of the Board made themselves available, often at short notice and out of hours. Board papers are circulated to Directors in advance of the scheduled meetings via an electronic board portal. This allows for an efficient and secure circulation of Board papers; if a Director cannot attend a meeting, he or she is able to consider the papers in advance of the meeting as usual and will have the opportunity to discuss them with the Chair or Chief Executive and to provide comments. The Non-Executive Directors meet without the Executive Directors and the Chair present at least once a year.

& Appendix

Glossary & Company Information

Attendance at regular scheduled Board meetings and the Board Committees is shown below:

Board members Board
attendance
Audit
Committee
attendance
Remuneration
Committee
attendance
Nomination
Committee
attendance
Lynn Fordham: Chair 9/9 3/3
Margaret Ford1
: Chair
1/1 0/1 1/1
Executive Directors
Allan Lockhart 9/9
Will Hobman 9/9
Non-Executive
Directors
Alastair Miller 9/9 4/5 4/4 4/4
Charlie Parker 9/9 4/5 4/4 3/4
Colin Rutherford 9/9 5/5 4/4 4/4
Dr Karen Miller 9/9 5/5 4/4 4/4
  1. Margaret Ford stepped down from the Board on 30 May 2024.
NewRiver REIT plc Annual Report and Accounts 2025 Strategic Report Governance Report Financial Statements ESG Data Sets Glossary & 125

Board effectiveness review

In order to evaluate its own effectiveness, the Board undertakes annual effectiveness reviews using a combination of externally facilitated and internally run evaluations usually over a three-year cycle.

Although the Company is not part of the FTSE 350 and therefore not required to carry out external evaluations every three years, the Company generally does use an external evaluator at least once every three years. In FY24, however, due to the search for a new Chair, it was agreed that internal questionnaires would be used again with a view to carrying out a full external Board effectiveness assessment in FY25 when the new Chair was onboarded and had been in post for a number of months.

Accordingly, during FY24 internally facilitated questionnaires were distributed and completed by the Directors on an anonymous basis. All Directors completed the questionnaires and there were high levels of satisfaction in most of the key areas of Board activity.

The following recommendations were made:

Recommendations Progress


There was scope for engaging further with the senior management
and inviting them to some further Board meetings
There was scope for improving the Board's understanding of the
succession plans for the senior management team and the talent
pipeline below senior management
The Board and senior management succession planning remains

The Board has initiated a practice whereby each ExCo member
attends the Board meetings to report on their area of responsibility
rather than the CEO

The strategy session spent time looking at succession planning with
the wider NewRiver team especially in light of the Capital & Regional
integration
a key focus and a potential opportunity to address diversity
There was scope for further Board engagement with the wider
NewRiver team

The Board and Nomination Committee have focused on succession
planning this year with the changes due for the SID

Additional social events have been held and are being planned for
the wider NewRiver team to aid the integration of Ellandi and Capital
& Regional

FY25 process

During FY25, an externally facilitated Board review was conducted by No 4, an independent Board Review advisory business. This involved interviewing all the Directors on a confidential basis. There were high levels of satisfaction and confidence in most of the key areas of Board activity. The following observations and recommendations were made:

Progress on 2024

  • The Board appointed a new Chair in 2024 who is felt by all to be bringing a fresh approach and adding significant value
  • Senior management are now regularly invited to the Board to present

Observations

  • The Board has worked well and effectively over the last year
  • The Board has overseen the successful completion of two acquisitions
  • All of the Board members are comfortable with corporate governance at NewRiver
  • The Board held a successful strategy day involving Non-Executive Directors and key executives. New plans for the future growth of the business are being developed following this
  • In line with the growth plans, new development plans for the senior management team and succession plans for the talent pipeline below senior management are underway
  • Board succession planning is also now a key focus in line with the future growth plans for the business

Company Information

Nomination Committee Report

Ensuring balanced skills

I am pleased to present the Nomination Committee Report for 2025. Monitoring the balance of skills on the Board to match our strategy and succession planning continued to be the key focus for the Committee this year.

During FY26 Alastair Miller will reach his nine-year term so much of the focus for the Committee for FY25 has been planning the search for a new Non-Executive Director and assessing what skills and experience our strategic plans and the Board balance needs. We intend for Alastair to stay on the Board beyond his nine-year term to ensure an orderly handover of his roles as he is the Senior Independent Non-Executive Director, Remuneration Committee Chair and the Director responsible for employee engagement. We therefore intend to appoint a new Non-Executive Director prior to Alastair leaving. During this year we have focussed on the Board skills matrix and we have appointed SA Associates, an independent boutique search agency, to assist in our search for a Non-Executive Director.

The Committee's focus for FY26 will be this succession planning and our diversity priorities.

Lynn Fordham Chair

16 June 2025

Role of the Committee

The role of the Committee is to lead the process for appointments, to ensure plans are in place for orderly succession to both the Board and senior management positions and to review the annual Board Evaluation process.

Nomination Committee membership

Our Committee consists of four Independent Non-Executive Directors and the Chair of the Board.

Biographies are available on pages 115 and 116.

  • Lynn Fordham: Committee Chair
  • Alastair Miller

Strategic Report

  • Colin Rutherford
  • Charlie Parker
  • Karen Miller

The attendance at meetings by the members of the Committee are set out in the table on page 124.

Nomination Committee key responsibilities

  • Regularly review the structure, size and composition of the Board and its Committees and take account of the Company's strategic priorities to make recommendations to the Board on necessary adjustments
  • Review the leadership and succession needs at Board and Executive Committee level
  • Identify and nominate for approval candidates to fill Board vacancies
  • Evaluate the Board's diversity and balance of skills
  • Evaluate the performance of the Board
  • Review the time needed to fulfil the roles of Chair, Senior Independent Director and Non-Executive Directors

How the Committee operates

& Appendix

  • The Committee meets at least twice a year. During the year the Committee met three times
  • Only Committee members attend meetings but we also invite the Chief Executive Officer and the Chief Operating and People Officer to assist with succession discussions and to brief the Committee on the views of the executive management
  • The Committee has formal Terms of Reference and reviews these annually. Copies Dear Shareholders can be found on our website at www.nrr.co.uk

Nomination Committee Report continued

FY25 Nomination Committee activity

May 2024

  • Succession planning discussions
  • Approval of Nomination Committee Report in Annual Report

Nov 2024

  • Succession planning
  • Review of the Board skills matrix
  • Board evaluation review report actions and outcomes
  • Planning for the next Board Evaluation

Feb 2025

  • Annual review of external directorships and time commitments required from Non-Executive Directors prior to re-election
  • Terms of Reference review and updates for the new Corporate Governance Code
  • Annual Board Evaluation Planning
  • Board succession planning

Succession planning

The Committee considers succession planning a key element of its remit. It recognises the importance of creating robust succession plans for both the Board and executive management so that they can fulfil the Company's long-term strategy.

The Committee acknowledges that succession plans should be regularly reviewed to enable employees and Board members to maintain the skills and experience necessary to ensure the continuing success and good governance of the Company.

Having appointed a new Chair at the end of FY24 the need to focus on succession planning continued in FY25 with the requirement to embark on plans to replace a long-standing Non-Executive Director who is not only the Remuneration Committee Chair but also the Senior Independent Non-Executive Director and the Non-Executive Director responsible for staff engagement. To commence the process, the skills matrix has been reviewed so that we could understand the skills any replacement Non-Executive Director needs to possess. This skills matrix was then assessed against our future strategy and a role description was formulated. The next stage was to appoint a suitable executive search consultant to ensure the identification of suitable and exceptional candidates. SA Associates, an independent boutique search agency, has been appointed to assist with the search for a new Non-Executive Director.

Composition of the Board at the date of the Annual Report

Glossary &

Key

  • Chair
  • Executive Directors
  • Non-Executive Directors

During the year, the Committee reviewed the balance of skills on the Board to ensure that they match the Company's strategy and to understand what additional skills may be required.

Board skills matrix Executive
Directors
Chair Non-Executive Directors
Allan
Lockhart
Will
Hobman
Lynn
Fordham
Alastair
Miller
Dr Karen
Miller
Charlie
Parker
Colin
Rutherford
Property asset management
Regeneration and development
Financial and banking
Capital markets
Environmental
Social and Governance
Capital allocation and cost efficiency
Capital partnerships
Commercial leadership
Mergers and acquisitions
Public sector partnerships
Workforce well-being

Independence and time commitment

The Nomination Committee is of the opinion that the Non-Executive Directors remain independent, in line with the definition set out in the 2018 Code and are free from any relationship or circumstances that could affect, or appear to affect, their independent judgement. The Chair was independent on appointment. The balance of Directors (excluding the Chair) is two Executive Directors and four independent Non-Executive Directors. The Committee regularly reviews the time commitments of the Non-Executive Directors and none are considered by the Committee to be overboarded.

Board and Company diversity

Company policy

As a Company, we are committed to a culture of diversity and inclusion in which everyone is given equal opportunities to progress regardless of gender, race, ethnic origin, nationality, age, religion, sexual orientation or disability. When recruiting, the Company has always considered all aspects of diversity. The Company is very mindful of the need to strive to create as diverse a Company as possible, and to create as many opportunities as possible for nurturing emerging female talent.

The Company always ensures there is a selection of candidates who have a good balance of skills, knowledge and experience. The Committee places particular value on experience of operating in a listed company, experience of the real estate and retail sectors, and financial or real estate training. The Company aims to recruit the best candidates on the basis of their merit and ability.

Board policy

The Board Diversity Policy is set out below and sets out the approach to diversity on the Board. Its purpose is to ensure an inclusive and diverse membership of the Board and its Committees, resulting in optimal decision-making and assisting in the development of a strategy which promotes the success of the Company for the benefit of its members as a whole, having regard to the interests of other stakeholders. The Policy applies to the Board and Board Committees, but sits alongside the Group's Equal Opportunities Policy, and other associated Group policies that set out our broader commitment to diversity and inclusion.

The Board acknowledges the benefits of greater diversity, including gender diversity and remains committed to ensuring that the Company's Directors bring a wide range of skills, knowledge, experience, backgrounds and perspectives. The Board supports the recommendations of the Davies Review (Women on Boards), the Hampton-Alexander Review and the Parker Review and continues to consider the recommendations when contemplating future appointments to the Board.

Policy objectives:

The Board aspires to maintain a balance such that:

  • At least two members of the Board are female, with a long-term aspiration to achieve no less than 40% female representation on the Board; and
  • In the longer term, at least one Director will be from a non-white ethnic minority background while recognising that:
  • This balance may not be achieved until further Directors are replaced at the end of their tenure;
  • On an ongoing basis, periods of change in Board composition may result in temporary periods when this balance is not achieved;
  • All appointments must continue to be made on merit; and
  • New appointees embody the culture and values of the Group.

Diversity (including gender and ethnicity) will be taken into consideration when evaluating the skills, knowledge and experience desirable to strengthen the Board and when making appointments. The Board supports and monitors management's actions to increase the proportion of senior leadership roles held by women, people from ethnic minority backgrounds and other under-represented groups across the Company in support of the Hampton-Alexander Review and Parker Review recommendations.

Nomination Committee Report continued

Gender Composition

Board

Key Gender Composition Direct Reports of

Female Male Direct Reports of Executive Committee Executive Committee

Male

Gender Composition

Executive Committee

Key Gender Composition

Female Group

Male

Female

Male

Key

Gender balance at the year end

Female Male
Board 2 29% 5 71%
Executive Committee 2 29% 5 71%
Direct Reports of Executive Committee 20 54% 17 46%
Group 41 50% 41 50%

NewRiver REIT plc Annual Report and Accounts 2025
NewRiver REIT plc Annual Report and Accounts 2025 Strategic Report Governance Report Financial Statements ESG Data Sets
& Appendix
Glossary &
Company Information
130

Number of Board

Percentage of

Number of senior positions on the Board (CEO, CFO, SID,

Number in executive Percentage of executive

Nomination Committee Report continued

Board Diversity Data
-- ---------------------- --

As at 31 March 2025 the Company had not met all of the targets of the Listing Rules diversity and inclusion guidelines as follows:

inclusion guidelines as follows: members the Board Chair) management management
Listing rule requirement Detail Men 5 71% 3 5 71%
Women 2 29% 1 2 29%
At least 40% of the board are women The Board comprises two female Directors and
five male Directors, equivalent to 29% female
representation. The Board's policy is to ensure
Not specified/prefer not to
say
that at least two members of the Board are female
and that the Board has a long-term aspiration to
achieve no less than 40% female representation
Number of Board
members
Percentage of
the Board
Number of senior
positions on the
Board (CEO, CFO, SID,
Chair)
Number in
executive
management
Percentage of
executive
management
on the Board. As the Board has only seven
Directors, Board vacancies are not frequent. The
most recent Board appointment, made in March
2024, was female but this has not increased the
White British or other White
(including minority/
white groups)
7 100% 4 7 100%
female representation as the incoming female
replaced an exiting female.
Mixed/Multiple ethnic groups
Asian/Asian British
At least one of the senior board positions
(Chair, Chief Executive Officer (CEO),
Senior Independent Director (SID) or Chief
Financial Officer (CFO)) is a woman.
The Chair of the Board is female. Black/African/Caribbean/
Black British
Other ethnic group,
including Arab
At least one member of the board is from a
minority ethnic background (which is
There are currently no Board members that are
from a non-white ethnic background. As is the
Not specified/prefer not to
say
defined by reference to categories
recommended by the Office for National
Statistics (ONS)) excluding those listed, by
the ONS, as coming from a white ethnic
background.
case with female representation, with a small
Board with a low turnover of Directors, the targets
set by the Listing Rules will take time to achieve.
The Board aspires that in longer term, at least one
Director will be from a non-white ethnic minority
background.
The information in this table was sourced directly from the individuals concerned. Members of the
Board were provided with the prescribed disclosure categories and asked to complete them based
on their self-identification.

Audit Committee Report

Audit, risk and internal control

Dear Shareholders

I am pleased to present the Audit Committee Report for 2025. The Report provides an outline of the activities carried out by the Committee in accordance with its Terms of Reference as it supports the Board and the Company's governance structure and activities.

In addition to the Committee's regular programme of work, an area of focus of the Committee for the year was monitoring the transition of Forvis Mazars as the group's new external auditor. With the FRC Corporate Governance Code updated in 2024 and due to apply to the Company in FY26, the Committee reviewed its terms of reference during the year to ensure that they aligned with the new Code and applied best practice in governance. A copy of these terms of reference is available on our website at www.nrr.co. uk The Committee has received an update on the new requirements under the Code and will now focus on how it can implement these changes over the coming year.

Our regular programme of meetings and discussions, supported by our interactions with the Company's management, external auditors and property valuers and the quality of the reports and information provided to us, enable the Committee members to effectively discharge our duties and responsibilities.

Colin Rutherford Audit Committee Chair

16 June 2025

Role of the Committee

The role of the Committee is to assist the Board in fulfilling its oversight responsibilities by reviewing the integrity of financial and narrative statements and other financial information provided to shareholders. By also monitoring the company's risk management and internal control framework and its processes for compliance with laws, regulations, ethical codes of practice, the UK Corporate Governance Code, FRC guidance and the FRC Audit Committees and the External Audit Minimum Standard.

Audit Committee membership

Our Committee consists of four Independent Non-Executive Directors.

Biographies are available on pages 115 and 116

  • Colin Rutherford: Committee Chair
  • Alastair Miller
  • Charlie Parker
  • Karen Miller

The attendance at meetings by the members of the Committee is set out in the table on page 124.

Audit Committee responsibilities

  • Oversight of the Group's relationship with its external auditors, including their remuneration
  • Oversee the tender process for the external auditor
  • Monitoring the integrity of the half-year and annual financial statements before submission to the Board

• Discussing any issues arising from the half-year review and year-end audit of the Group

Glossary & Company Information

& Appendix

  • Reviewing significant financial reporting matters and judgements
  • Reviewing the effectiveness of the Group's system of internal controls
  • Reviewing assurance reports from management on the effectiveness of the risk management and internal control framework
  • Reviewing the Group's whistleblowing procedures and reports to the Board
  • Reviewing and monitoring the Group's risk management processes
  • Conducting an annual review of the need to establish an internal audit function
  • Oversight of third-party internal audit workstreams
  • Monitoring and annually reviewing the auditor's independence, objectivity and effectiveness of the audit process

How the Committee operates

  • Each Committee member is independent and has broad commercial experience
  • Colin Rutherford is a CA with significant, recent and relevant financial experience and was previously the Chairman of the Audit Committee of Mitchells & Butlers plc
  • Alastair Miller is a CA and was previously the Chief Financial Officer of New Look Group and has significant, recent and relevant financial experience
  • The Committee as a whole has competence relevant to the sector
  • During the year the Audit Committee held five meetings
  • The Chief Financial Officer and the Group's external auditors are invited to attend the Committee meetings

Strategic Report

Audit Committee Report continued

& Appendix

FY25 Audit Committee activity

May 2024

• Meeting with the Property Valuers

May 2024

  • External Auditors' Report to the Committee
  • Internal Controls Review
  • Gifts and Hospitality register
  • Going Concern assessment
  • Viability statement assessment
  • Risk Review and Principal Risks
  • Preliminary results
  • Fair, Balanced and Understandable review
  • Review Annual Report for recommendation to the Board
  • Approve the Audit Committee Report in Annual Report
  • Meeting with External Auditors without management present

Nov 2024

• Meeting with the Property Valuers

Dec 2024

  • Going Concern Assessment report actions and outcome
  • External Auditor's Plan
  • External Auditor HY Report to the Committee
  • Review of Principal Risks
  • Review auditor independence
  • Review half-year results
  • Meeting with External Auditors without management present

Feb 2025

  • External Auditor Audit Plan update following the acquistion of Capital & Regional
  • Risk Review
  • Consider the requirement for an internal audit function
  • Review Whistleblowing policy
  • Valuer transition planning
  • Annual Review of Terms of Reference
  • Gifts and Hospitality Register
  • UK Corporate Governance update

Relationship with the auditors

The Committee has primary responsibility for managing the relationship with the external auditors, including assessing their performance, effectiveness and independence annually and recommending to the Board their reappointment or removal.

Forvis Mazars LLP (Forvis Mazars) were appointed as the Group's external auditors in 2024. The Committee keeps under review the need for future tenders in accordance with current regulations and subject to the annual assessment of the auditor's effectiveness and independence. Nargis Yunis has been the Forvis Mazars lead audit partner since their appointment in August 2024.

During the year, the members of the Committee have met twice with representatives from Forvis Mazars without management present, to ensure that there are no issues in the relationship between management and the external auditors which it should address. There were none.

External auditor

The Committee considers the nature, scope and results of the external auditors' work and reviews, develops and implements a policy on the supply of any non-audit services that are to be provided by the external auditors. It receives and reviews reports from the Group's external auditors relating to the Group's Annual Report and Accounts and the external audit process.

In respect of the audit for the financial year ended 31 March 2025, Forvis Mazars presented their Audit plan (prepared in consultation with management) to the Committee. The Audit plan included an assessment of audit risks, audit scope, independence, the terms of engagement, fees and robust testing

procedures. The Committee approved the implementation of the plan following discussions with both Forvis Mazars and management.

Audit and non-audit fees

Audit fees for the financial year ended 31 March 2025 were £1.0m. These fees include £0.5m paid by Capital & Regional plc pre-acquisition. The Company has a non-audit services policy in place which limits Forvis Mazars to working on the audit or such other matters where their expertise as the Company's auditor makes them the logical choice for the work. This is to preserve their independence and objectivity. The Company paid £0.1m in non-audit fees to Forvis Mazars for the financial year ended 31 March 2025. The non-audit fees relate solely to Forvis Mazars' review of the interim results for the six months to 30 September 2024.

Effectiveness and independence

The Chair of the Committee speaks regularly to the external audit partner to ascertain if there are any concerns, to discuss the audit reports and to ensure that the external auditors have received the support and information requested from management.

In accordance with the guidance set out in the Financial Reporting Council's 'Practice aid for audit committees', the assessment of the external audit has not been a separate compliance exercise, or an annual one-off exercise, but rather it has formed an integral part of the Committee's activities. This has allowed the Audit Committee to form its own view on audit quality and on the effectiveness of the external audit process, based on the evidence it has obtained throughout the year.

Audit Committee Report continued

Sources of evidence obtained and observations during the year:

By referring to the
FRC's Practice aid on
audit quality
The Committee has looked to this practice aid for guidance
and has ensured that assessment of the external audit is a
continuing and integral part of the Committee's activities.
Observations of, and
interactions with, the
external auditors
The Committee has met with the external audit partner
without management at least twice during the year and has
noted that Forvis Mazars were performing well and the working
relationship was good.
The audit plan, the
audit findings and the
external auditors' report
The Committee scrutinises these documents and reviews them
carefully at meetings and by doing so has been able to assess
the external auditors' ability to explain in clear terms what work
they performed in key areas and also assess whether the
description used is consistent with what they communicated to
the Committee at the audit planning stage. The Committee has
also regularly challenged these reports in the meetings.
Input from those subject
to the external audit.
The Committee has requested the insights from the Chief
Financial Officer and the Finance team during the external
audit process.

Having regard to these matters the Committee has considered the effectiveness of the external audit process and feels that the external auditors demonstrated professional scepticism and challenged management's assumptions where necessary.

Key judgements and estimates

The Committee reviewed the external reporting of the Group including the interim review, and the Annual Report. In assessing the Annual Report, the Committee considered the key judgements and estimates. The significant issues considered by the Committee in respect of the year ended 31 March 2025, which contained a significant degree of estimation uncertainty, is set out in the following table.

Strategic Report

Valuation of properties

Changes in key estimates can have a significant impact on the valuation of properties. The Group has a property portfolio recognised on its Consolidated Balance Sheet valued by external valuers at £887.5 million at 31 March 2025 (excluding RoU assets).

Acquisition of Capital and

On 10 December 2024, the Group acquired the entire issued ordinary share capital of Capital & Regional plc. Where there were judgemental areas, such as in relation to the accounting for Capital & Regional plc acquisition, the Committee specifically reviewed the proposed treatments and ensured that the Annual report and accounts provided appropriate disclosures.

Regional plc

Significant issue How the issue was addressed

The Committee and management met with Colliers, Knight Frank and Kroll (the Group's external valuers) on several occasions to discuss the valuation of the assets and understand the process that was followed, the key estimates used and to ensure a robust and independent valuation had taken place.

The meetings were productive and management and the Committee have confirmed that they continue to adopt the valuations as being the fair valuation of the properties as at the reporting date.

In addition, the external auditors performed additional audit procedures over the valuer judgements and estimates, and presented challenges to the valuers, which were reported to and discussed with the Committee.

The Audit Committee has reviewed the assumptions underlying the accounting for the transaction, discussed these with Management and concluded that the treatment as an asset acquisition during the year is appropriate.

In addition, the external auditors have performed audit procedures over the treatment of the Capital & Regional acquisition which were reported to and discussed with the Committee.

Further details on the Capital & Regional acquisition are disclosed in Note 17 of the Group financial statements.

Audit Committee Report continued

Risk management and internal controls

Internal control structure

The Board oversees the Group's risk management and internal controls and determines the Group's risk appetite. The Board has, however, delegated responsibility for review of the risk management methodology and the effectiveness of internal controls to the Audit Committee.

The Group's system of internal controls includes financial, operational and compliance controls and risk management. Policies and procedures, including clearly defined levels of delegated authority, have been communicated throughout the Group. Internal controls have been implemented in respect of the key operational and financial processes of the business. These policies are designed to ensure the accuracy and reliability of financial reporting and govern the preparation of the Financial Statements. During the year, as part of the C&R acquisition, there has been a review of the Group's internal controls to create the Financial Position and Prospects Procedure (FPPP) required for this size of transaction. This process has provided the Committee with additional comfort that the Group's system of internal controls remains fit for purpose and robust.

The Board is ultimately responsible for the Group's system of internal controls and risk management and discharges its duties in this area by:

  • holding regular Board meetings to consider the matters reserved for its consideration;
  • receiving regular management reports which provide an assessment of key risks and controls;
  • scheduling regular Board reviews of strategy including reviews of the material risks and uncertainties (including emerging risks) facing the business;
  • having access to all ExCo meeting materials on the Board portal including minutes of the ExCo;
  • ensuring there is a clear organisational structure with defined responsibilities and levels of authority;
  • ensuring there are documented policies and procedures in place and reviewing these policies and procedures regularly;
  • reviewing regular reports containing detailed information regarding financial performance, rolling forecasts, actual and forecast covenant compliance, cashflows and financial and non-financial KPIs; and
  • visiting the assets to provide context to the reports received.

The process by which the Audit Committee has monitored and reviewed the effectiveness of the system of internal controls and risk management during the year has included:

  • ongoing analysis and review of the Group's risk register;
  • overseeing further 'deep-dive' discussions of the Group's risk register to reassess each risk on the register and its risk scoring;
  • reviewing the assessment of key risks, the process of reporting these risks and associated mitigating controls, with particular emphasis on emerging risks; and
  • updates from the ExCo's quarterly detailed assessment of the risk register.

The effectiveness of the Company's risk management and internal control systems is reviewed annually and was last reviewed by the Committee in May 2025. The review concluded that:

  • the systems established by management to identify, assess and manage risks, including emerging risks are effective; and
  • the assurance on risk management and internal control is sufficient to enable the Committee and Board to satisfy themselves that they are operating effectively.

The Committee is satisfied that the risk management framework is effective and did not identify any failing in the control systems.

Further details of the Company's risk management process, together with the principal risks, can be found in the Principal Risks and Uncertainties section.

Internal audit function

The Group does not have an internal audit team. The need for this is reviewed annually by the Committee. Due to the relative lack of complexity and the outsourcing of the majority of the day-to-day operational functions, the Committee continues to be satisfied that there is no requirement for such an in-house team but will continue to keep this under review. The Committee does however look to third parties to provide an internal audit review function and commissions internal audit reviews on specific matters each year. During FY25 as part of the Capital & Regional acquisition, there has been a review of the Company's internal controls and structure to create the FPPP required for this class of transaction. The external consultant who assisted in pulling together the FPPP is assisting with the Capital & Regional integration project, which will include integrating NewRiver internal controls into the Capital & Regional processes.

Whistleblowing Policy

The Committee conducts an annual review of the Group's Whistleblowing Policy to ensure it remains up to date and relevant and reports its findings to the Board. Training on whistleblowing is provided to staff annually to capture new staff and to remind existing staff of the procedures. The Committee provides feedback to the Board on the Whistleblowing Policy and procedures and effectiveness of the policy at least every six months. There have never been any concerns raised through the whistleblowing process or through any other process to the Committee.

Other compliance policies

The Committee receives a copy and reviews in detail the Gifts and Hospitality register on a regular basis.

Company Information

Audit Committee Report continued

Statement of compliance

The Company is not a constituent of the FTSE 350, however the Company confirms on a voluntary basis that it has complied with terms of The Statutory Audit Services for Large Companies Market Investigation (Mandatory User of Competitive Tender Processes and Audit Committee Responsibilities) Order 2014 (the "Order") throughout the year. In addition to requiring mandatory audit re-tendering at least every 10 years for FTSE 350 companies, the Order provides that only the Audit Committee, acting collectively or through its Chair, and for and on behalf of the Board, is permitted:

  • to the extent permissible in law and regulation, to negotiate and agree the statutory audit fee and the scope of the statutory audit;
  • to initiate and supervise a competitive tender process;
  • to make recommendations to the Directors as to the auditor appointment pursuant to a competitive tender process;
  • to influence the appointment of the audit engagement partner; and
  • to authorise an auditor to provide any non-audit services to the Group, prior to the commencement of those non-audit services.

Committee review of the viability statement and

going concern

The Committee has reviewed the basis for the Company's viability statement that is drafted with reference to the financial forecasts for the next three years. This period of assessment is aligned to performance measurement and management remuneration and, in the opinion of the Committee, this period of assessment strikes the optimal balance between allowing the impact of strategic decisions to be

modelled while maintaining the accuracy of underlying forecast inputs. The Committee places additional scrutiny on the assumptions used in the forecasts to ensure they are appropriate. The Committee provides advice to the Board on the viability statement.

The Committee ensured sufficient review was undertaken of the adequacy of the financial arrangements, cash flow forecasts and lender covenant compliance. The Committee further tested the Group's performance against its stated strategy and its future plans. Accordingly, the Committee recommended to the Board that the statement be approved.

The Committee further focused on the appropriateness of adopting the going concern basis in preparing the Group's financial statements for the year ended 31 March 2025 and satisfied itself that the going concern basis of presentation of the financial statements and the related disclosure is appropriate. The viability statement is set out on pages 109 to 110.

Fair, balanced and understandable assessment

The Directors are required to confirm that they consider, taken as a whole, that the Annual Report is fair, balanced and understandable and that it provides the information necessary for shareholders to assess the Group's position and performance, business model and strategy.

To ensure this is the case the following process is in place:

Experienced team

A core experienced team is responsible for the co-ordination of Annual Report submissions, verification, review and consistency. The narrative sections are drafted by the members of the team with specific responsibility for each area, such as the Chair, the CEO, the CFO, ESG Strategy Lead, Director of Communications and the Company Secretary.

& Appendix

Senior review

As narrative sections are prepared, they are circulated to Board and ExCo members to review and comment.

Staff review

The draft Annual Report is given to other staff members not involved in the drafting process to read and provide feedback on its fairness, balance and understandability.

Audit Committee oversight and review

The Committee reviews the Annual Report on behalf of the Board, taking into account the comments made by the Board, reports from management and reports issued by the external auditor and makes recommendations to the Board.

Controls and confirmation

The Committee satisfies itself that the controls over the accuracy and consistency of information presented in the Annual Report are robust and that the information is presented fairly (including the calculations and use of alternative performance measures). The Committee confirms to the Board that the processes and controls around the preparation of the Annual Report are appropriate, allowing the Board to make the "fair, balanced and understandable" statement in the Directors' Responsibilities Statement.

Remuneration Committee Report

Dear Shareholders

On behalf of the Board, I am pleased to present the Remuneration Committee Report for the financial year ended 31 March 2025. In this statement I have summarised the link between remuneration and performance and our decisions on remuneration for FY25.

FY25 has been a successful year for NewRiver. During FY25 we have re-shaped the business with the transformational acquisition of Capital & Regional, which has increased the portfolio size by 65% to £0.9bn through the combination of highquality, complementary assets with a similarly low-risk tenant profile and attractive income characteristics. We also acquired Ellandi, an asset and development management business focused on UK retail and regeneration, which provides our existing Capital Partnership business with additional scale, diversification, and skills, consistent with our strategy to deliver earnings growth in a capital-light way.

The benefits of the corporate transactions that we completed in the year, especially the Capital & Regional acquisition, are starting to flow through. Our portfolio has been performing well for some time, which is a reflection of the underlying strength of our retail occupiers, and, together with the benefits of our corporate activity means we are firmly on track to deliver sector leading earnings growth.

Implementation of the Policy in FY25

Our Remuneration Policy was approved by shareholders in July 2023 and implementation of this Policy during FY25 was as follows:

Base salary

Base salaries for both of the Executive Directors were increased by 3% for FY25 in line with the increase for the wider workforce.

Annual bonus

As noted in the 2024 Remuneration Report, the performance measures and targets for the FY25 annual bonus were not finalised at the time of publication due to uncertainty surrounding corporate activity during the year.

Following a review by the Committee, and in light of the M&A activity, the Committee concluded that it was appropriate to introduce additional metrics to support a smooth and efficient acquisition process, while continuing to prioritise financial performance. Accordingly, the weightings of the bonus metrics were rebalanced to reflect these changes.

As a result, the FY25 annual bonus was based on the Total Return vs IPD All Retail (25%), UFFO (25%), LTV (10%), Synergy Savings (15%), Value Add Capital Deployment (5%), Cost Effective Capital Raise (7.5%), Capital Partnerships (5%) and ESG measures (7.5%). Based on the strong corporate, financial and strategic performance over the period, the bonus out-turn was 82.90% of maximum. The Committee is comfortable that the formulaic bonus outcome appropriately reflects the wider business performance of the Company. 30% of the bonus will be deferred in shares for two years.

Long-Term Incentive Plan

The FY23 LTIP Award will vest in July 2025 with performance assessed against relative TAR (50%) and relative Total Shareholder Return ('TSR') (50%) based on performance from 1 April 2022 to 31 March 2025. The TSR performance condition was achieved in full and, accordingly, the 50% element based on TSR will vest in full. Notwithstanding the strong performance over the period, the relative TAR element did not meet the minimum hurdle and therefore lapsed. As a result, the total vesting overall for this award is 50% of maximum. The Committee considered wider business performance over the three-year performance period and is comfortable that the formulaic vesting outcome is appropriate.

The Committee was comfortable that actions taken on pay during the year across the Company were appropriate and balanced the interests of all stakeholders, and that the Remuneration Policy operated as intended.

Implementation of the Policy in FY26

During FY25, we undertook a significant transformation of the business through the strategic acquisitions of Capital & Regional and Ellandi. In response to this reshaping of our operations and priorities, the Remuneration Committee has reviewed the Executive Remuneration framework for FY26 to ensure it remains closely aligned with our long-term business strategy and continues to drive sustained performance.

Following a consultation with shareholders and, with the goal of ensuring that our executive remuneration remains incentivising, motivational and competitive, we are proposing two changes:

  • An increase in the Long-Term Incentive Plan (LTIP) grant level from 100% to 150% of salary; and
  • An adjustment to Executive Director pension contributions to bring them in line with those offered to the wider workforce.

Both changes are consistent with the parameters of our existing Remuneration Policy, and shareholders expressed their support for these proposals which serve as a retention mechanism for our Executives. Further details regarding the changes are set out below.

FY26 LTIP grant level

The current policy (and plan rules) permit us to grant an award worth up to 200% of an Executive Director's salary per annum. Since 2016 we have operated the policy at a lower level, of 100% of salary, and as part of the policy approval at the 2023 AGM we stated that we would engage with our shareholders if the grant level was increased above 100% of salary.

For FY26, we are increasing the grant level to 150% of salary for both Executive Directors, for the following reasons:

  • We believe there is now a strong opportunity for significant growth and that offering a fully market-competitive LTIP will provide the necessary motivation and reward for the expertise and effort required to deliver sustained shareholder value
  • Allan Lockhart has been in post as CEO since May 2018 and in the view of the Board is performing at an exceptional level, navigating the business though significant recent market turbulence and corporate activity with significant skill. Will Hobman has made a significant impact since his promotion to CFO and is adding significant value to Allan and the team.
  • The previous LTIP grant level of 100% of salary is now significantly behind other REITs in each case and a grant level of 150% of salary will ensure that the packages are, overall, at a mid-market level.
  • The annual bonus opportunity will be maintained at 125% of salary. As a result, the overall remuneration package will be more clearly weighted towards long-term performance, supporting our strategic growth ambitions.
  • The Committee has a strong track record of setting stretching performance targets, and the FY26 LTIP grant will continue this approach. Awards will be subject to demanding targets, consistent with those applied in previous years, to ensure continued alignment with long-term shareholder value creation.

Remuneration for FY26

Other than the changes noted above, the implementation of the Remuneration Policy will remain consistent with FY25, and the performance conditions for the incentives will also align with those set for FY25. As part of the policy review to be conducted in FY26, the Committee will evaluate the performance conditions for FY27 incentives to ensure they remain aligned with the evolving strategy, particularly in light of recent M&A activity.

Base salary:

During the year the Committee has reviewed the salary increases for the wider workforce and the Executive Directors. As a result, both the wider workforce and the Executive Directors received a 3% increase in base salary.

Pensions:

Alignment of pension contributions with the wider workforce.

During the year, the Committee oversaw the reward and compensation packages across the Company. As part of this work, we reviewed workforce pension contributions and, as a result, increased the contribution rate for the wider workforce from 4% to 5% for FY26. This 1% increase will also apply to the Executive Directors' pension contribution, in line with the Remuneration Policy.

Annual Bonus:

Executive Directors will have the opportunity to earn a bonus up to a normal maximum of 125% of salary. In line with the FY25 annual bonus, the bonus will be based on financial and corporate measures and personal strategic performance. 30% of any bonus paid will be deferred into shares for two years.

Long-term incentives:

The Executive Directors will receive an LTIP grant of 150% of salary. In line with the FY25 LTIP grants, performance will be assessed against relative TSR (60%) and relative TAR (40%). We will review the performance measures for the LTIP as part of the policy review and ahead of grants in FY27. Awards must be held by Executive Directors for a further two years after vesting.

Other considerations during the year

New Long Term Incentive Plan rules

Our existing Performance Share Plan (PSP) and Deferred Bonus Plan rules have a 10-year life and will expire soon. Accordingly, we will be seeking shareholder approval at the 2025 AGM for a new LTIP which will be used to grant deferred share bonus awards as well as performance shares. The LTIP will be very similar to the existing PSP, with the following key changes:

  • the removal of the provision for awards to be higher than the 200% of salary individual limit in exceptional circumstances (i.e. previously uncapped, now all awards are limited to 200%)
  • the removal of the 5% in ten years dilution limit, which applied to awards to executives, leaving just a single limit restricting dilution to 10% of issued share capital over any 10-year period for awards to all employees. The PSP and LTIP are operated for all employees, and we carefully monitor share usage. Consistent with the latest Investment Association guidance, we believe that the retention of this inner 5% limit is not necessary.

Shareholder engagement

Ahead of the AGM, we have engaged with 12 of our largest investors as well as Institutional Shareholder Services (ISS), the Investment Association (IA) and Glass Lewis, to understand their views on our proposed changes to the implementation of the Policy in FY26 and the new LTIP plan rules. Both our investors and the proxy agencies were supportive of the changes.

Wider workforce engagement

I am the designated Non-Executive Director who has the responsibility of ensuring that the Board successfully engages with the workforce. As a result of being a small team there is naturally proximity between the Board and the workforce which makes it easier for the Board to engage with staff directly. I attend staff forums to ensure that there is an opportunity for staff to raise questions or concerns directly with myself. An element of staff targets mirrors Executive Director targets. We also use our appraisal process to explain and discuss with employees how the policy for Executive Directors aligns with the pay and conditions of the workforce. The operation of the Remuneration Policy was not raised as a material issue during the year. Therefore, no amendments were required to proposed implementation as a result of this engagement.

Closing remarks

We believe that the operation of our Remuneration Policy recognises the experience of shareholders, employees and other stakeholders.

We welcome feedback and if shareholders have any questions about remuneration generally, or the contents of the report, I can be contacted through our investor relations email at [email protected].

My fellow Directors and I intend to attend the AGM and we would be pleased to answer any questions you may have about the Committee's work.

Alastair Miller Committee Chair

16 June 2025

NewRiver REIT plc Annual Report and Accounts 2025 Strategic Report Governance Report Financial Statements ESG Data Sets
& Appendix
Glossary &
Company Information
138

Executive Pay in 24/25

Implementation of Policy in FY26
Base Salaries Allan Lockhart: £513,582
Will Hobman: £355,136
Benefits No change
Pension Allan Lockhart: 5% of salary
Will Hobman: 5% of salary
Annual Bonus Maximum opportunity is 125% of salary
Performance conditions:
Corporate and financial measures and strategic measures
30% deferred into shares for two years
Long-Term Grant levels at 150% of salary
Incentive Plan Performance conditions:
Relative TSR (60%) Relative TAR (40%)
Two-year post-vesting holding period applies
Shareholding
requirements
200% of salary

FY25 Annual Bonus Performance

Corporate and financial measures (60% weighting)

Strategic measures

(40% weighting)

XX

Total bonus payout

FY23-25 Performance Share Plan

0% XX Measure Achievement (% of max) PSP Relative TSR vs Peer Group Outcome Relative Total Accounting return vs Peer Group 100% 50%

NewRiver REIT plc Annual Report and Accounts 2025 Strategic Report Governance Report Financial Statements ESG Data Sets
& Appendix
Glossary &
Company Information
139

Summary Remuneration Policy

The Remuneration Policy was approved by shareholders at the 2023 Annual General Meeting on 26 July 2023. The full Remuneration Policy can be found in the 2023 Annual Report which is available at www.nrr.co.uk.

Executive Directors

Element Purpose and Link to Strategy Operation Maximum Performance
Target
Fixed
Salary Market competitive remuneration
base reflecting role, responsibilities,
skills and experience.
Normally reviewed annually, effective 1 April, although salaries may be
reviewed more frequently or at different times of the year if the
Committee determines this is appropriate.
Salaries are set taking into account the performance of the individual,
the responsibilities and size of the role, salary increases across the
Group and market data for peer companies.
There is no prescribed maximum.
Increases will typically be dependent on
the results of an annual review in the
context of the average increase for the
wider work force, inflation and market
data.
Not applicable.
Paid in cash monthly. Increases will not normally be above the
level implemented across the wider
workforce. Increases may be above this
level, for example if there is an increase in
the scale, scope or responsibility of the
role.
Pension To provide competitive post
retirement benefits.
To assist with recruitment and
The Executive Directors may participate in the Company's defined
contribution plan or receive a cash supplement in lieu of pension
contributions.
A pension contribution is payable in line
with the pension available to the
workforce, currently 5% of salary.
Not applicable.
retention.
Benefits To provide a competitive and
cost-effective benefits package.
The Company provides a range of non-pensionable benefits to
Executive Directors which may include medical insurance, life
Benefits are set at a level which the
Committee considers appropriate when
Not applicable.
To assist with recruitment and
retention.
assurance, permanent health insurance, holiday and sick pay.
Other benefits such as relocation allowances may be offered if
compared to the Company's listed real
estate investment trusts peers.
considered appropriate and reasonable by the Committee. There is no prescribed maximum.
Variable
Bonus To incentivise performance in the
reporting year. Targets are consistent
with the Group's long-term strategy.
The deferral of a proportion of the
bonus in shares aligns Directors'
All measures and targets will be reviewed and set annually by the
Committee at the beginning of the financial year and levels of award
are determined by the Committee after the year end based on
achievement of performance against the stipulated measures and
targets.
The maximum bonus is 125% of salary.
On-target performance would result in a
bonus payment of 50% of maximum
bonus. Threshold performance would
result in bonus payment of up to 25% of
All measures and
targets normally
relate to a financial
year of the
Company and are
reviewed on an
annual basis.
interests with those of shareholders
and to discourage short-term decision
making.
The Committee retains an overriding discretion to adjust pay-outs
from formulaic performance condition outcomes to ensure that
maximum bonus.
overall bonus payments reflect its view of corporate performance
during the year and are fair to both shareholders and participants.
At least 50% of the
bonus will be subject
30% of the bonus must be deferred into shares for two years. Vesting
of the deferred shares will be subject to continued employment.
to financial
performance
conditions.
The value of the bonus does not contribute to the pensionable salary.
Clawback and malus provisions apply.
NewRiver REIT plc Annual Report and Accounts 2025 Strategic Report Governance Report Financial Statements ESG Data Sets
& Appendix
Glossary &
Company Information
140

at cessation for two years. The Committee

requirement in exceptional circumstances (e.g. serious ill-health). Shares that have been purchased voluntarily may be excluded from the post-cessation shareholding requirement.

has the discretion to relax this

Executive Directors continued

Element Purpose and Link to Strategy Operation Maximum Performance
Target
Variable
Performance
Share Plan
To incentivise and reward the delivery
of returns to shareholders and
sustained long-term performance.
Aligns the Executive Directors'
interests with those of shareholders.
Rewards and helps retain/recruit
executives.
Discretionary grant of nil-cost options or conditional awards of
shares. Awards normally vest three years from the date of award.
Vesting of awards is subject to satisfaction of performance targets
normally measured over a three-year period.
The Committee retains an overriding discretion to adjust the vesting
level from formulaic performance condition outcomes to ensure that
the overall level of vesting reflects its view of corporate performance
over the performance period and is fair to both shareholders and
participants.
A holding period of two years will apply following vesting before
participants are entitled to sell their shares. Clawback and malus
provisions apply as described in the notes to this table.
The maximum award level permitted
under the 2016 PSP plan rules and this
Policy is 200% of salary. As summarised
in the Chair's statement on page 136,
following a review of quantum by the
Committee and in consultation with our
investors, the Executive will be granted an
LTIP award of 150% of salary for FY26.
25% of the award is payable at threshold
performance.
Performance targets
will apply over the
performance period.
The Committee will
determine the
applicable
performance targets
and their weightings
to ensure they are
appropriate.
Performance
conditions may be
based on financial
and/or non-financial
measures (including
strategic and ESG
measures). A
majority of the
award will be based
on financial
measures.
Shareholding
Requirement
To encourage long-term share
ownership and support alignment of
interests with shareholders.
At least half of the net shares vested under the deferred annual
bonus and the LTIP must be retained until the shareholding
requirement is met.
During employment, Executive Directors
must build up a shareholding worth 200%
of salary. After employment, Executive
Directors will be required to retain the
lower of the shareholding requirement
during employment or actual shareholding
Not applicable.
NewRiver REIT plc Annual Report and Accounts 2025
-- -----------------------------------------------------
NewRiver REIT plc Annual Report and Accounts 2025 Strategic Report Governance Report Financial Statements ESG Data Sets
& Appendix
Glossary &
Company Information
141

Chair and Non-Executive Directors

Element Purpose and Link to Strategy Operation Maximum Performance
Target
Fixed
Fees To provide market- competitive
Director fees.
Annual fee for the Chair.
Annual base fee for the Non-Executive Directors.
Fee increases are applied in line with the
outcome of the review.
Not applicable.
Additional fees are paid to Non-Executive Directors for additional
responsibilities such as being the Senior Independent Non-Executive
Director or chairing a Board Committee.
Fees are reviewed from time to time taking into account time
commitment, responsibilities and fees paid by companies of a similar
size and complexity.
Payable in cash.
Expenses incurred by Non-Executive Directors in connection with the
fulfilment of their roles are reimbursed (including any personal tax
due on such expenses).
NewRiver REIT plc Annual Report and Accounts 2025 Strategic Report Governance Report Financial Statements ESG Data Sets
& Appendix
Glossary &
Company Information
142
Remuneration Committee Report continued

Considerations in relation to the Policy review

When reviewing the Remuneration Policy, the Committee considered a wide range of factors, including:

  • Where practicable, improving the consistency of the Executive Directors' Remuneration Policy with that of the workforce, for example in relation to the pension provision.
  • Taking into account the latest guidance from our institutional shareholders, investor representative bodies, regulators and statutory requirements.
  • The overall market competitiveness of the senior executives' packages.

The Committee also addressed the following factors when determining the Remuneration Policy and practices, as recommended by the 2018 UK Corporate Governance Code:

Principle Committee approach
Clarity
Remuneration arrangements should be transparent and promote effective
engagement with shareholders and the workforce.
As noted above there is a consistent approach taken, where possible, in relation to the application of the Remuneration
Policy throughout the Company. For instance, all employees participate in an annual bonus plan and the PSP.
We consult with employees to explain how the Policy for Executive Directors aligns with the pay and conditions of the
workforce other than, for instance, where there are more stringent requirements in the Executive Directors' Policy for
corporate governance reasons.
Simplicity The components of our Remuneration Policy are consistent throughout the Company so they are simple to operate and
Remuneration structures should avoid complexity and their rationale and
operation should be easy to understand.
communicate.
Risk We look carefully at the range of likely performance outcomes when setting performance target ranges and use discretion
Remuneration arrangements should ensure reputational and other risks
from excessive rewards and behavioural risks that can arise from
target-based incentive plans are identified and mitigated.
where this leads to an inappropriate pay outcome.
Bonus deferral, holding periods on LTIP awards, shareholding requirement and clawback and malus provisions all help to
mitigate risk.
Predictability Incentive plans are determined based on a proportion of base salary so there is a sensible balance between fixed pay and
performance-linked elements.
The range of possible values of rewards to individual directors and any
other limits or discretions should be identified and explained at the time
of approving the policy.
There are provisions to override the formula driven outcome of incentive plans and deferral and clawbacks to minimise
the likelihood of a poor link between reward and performance.
Proportionality Incentive plans are determined based on a proportion of base salary so there is a sensible balance between fixed pay and
The link between individual awards, the delivery of strategy and the
long-term performance of the company should be clear. Outcomes
should not reward poor performance.
performance-linked elements.
There are provisions to override the formula driven outcome of incentive plans and deferral and clawbacks to ensure that
poor performance is not rewarded.
Alignment to culture All staff are eligible for bonus plans which are approved by the Committee to ensure consistency with Company purpose,
Incentive schemes should drive behaviours consistent with company
purpose, values and strategy.
values and the performance measures are linked to the business strategy.

Service contracts and payments for loss of office

Executive Directors' service contracts are terminable by either party giving the other 12 months' written notice. If notice is served by either party, the Executive Director may continue to receive base salary, benefits and pension for the duration of their notice period during which time the Company may require the individual to fulfil their current role or may place the individual on garden leave. The Committee will seek to minimise the level of payments to a departing Director, having regard to all circumstances, including the Company's contractual obligations to the Director, the reason for departure, and the Company's policy on mitigation.

The Company may elect to make a monthly payment of base salary, plus an amount in lieu of benefits/pension contribution/equivalent or just base salary, in lieu of notice. Any payments in lieu of notice would be phased monthly and subject to offset against earnings elsewhere. Reasonable outplacement and legal costs may be payable.

Where a Director may be entitled to pursue a claim against the Company in respect of his/her statutory employment rights or any other claim arising from the employment or its termination, the Committee will be entitled to negotiate settlement terms with the Director that the Committee considers to be reasonable in the circumstances and is in the best interests of the Company, and to enter into a settlement agreement with the Director.

In addition to the contractual provisions regarding payment on termination set out above, the Group's incentive plans and share plans contain provisions relating to termination of employment. Good leaver provisions relate

to termination of office or employment by reason of death, ill-health, injury, incapacity or disability of the award holder, redundancy or sale or transfer out of the Group or the Company or undertaking employing that employee, or any other circumstances stipulated by the Committee at the date of award.

For any good leaver the approach in relation to the incentive plans will be as follows:

Annual bonus: bonus may be payable at the normal time pro-rata for the portion of the year worked. Outstanding deferred bonus awards would be retained and would vest at the usual time.

PSP awards: awards would vest at the usual time subject to the achievement of the performance conditions and would normally be scaled back pro-rata for the extent of the vesting period completed at cessation of employment (unless in exceptional circumstances the Committee determines that the award should not be scaled back). The two-year post-vesting holding period would usually continue to apply.

If an Executive Director is not deemed to be a good leaver, all bonus entitlements and LTIP awards would normally lapse.

Non-Executive Directors' letters of appointment incorporate a notice period of three months.

No payment for compensation for loss of office will be made to the Chair or any Non-Executive Director other than where the Company determines that fees for the notice period should be paid. The details of the service contracts for Executive Directors and Letters of Appointment for the Non-Executive Directors are summarised as follows:

Director Date of Appointment Expiry date of service agreement
of letter of appointment
Allan Lockhart 18 August 2016 12-month rolling contracts
Will Hobman 20 August 2021
Lynn Fordham 21 March 2024 3-month rolling contracts
Colin Rutherford 5 February 2019
Dr Karen Miller 30 May 2022
Charlie Parker 10 September 2020
Alastair Miller 18 August 2016

& Appendix

The service agreements are available for shareholders to view at the Company's Registered Office on request from the Company Secretary and at the Annual General Meeting.

External directorships and memberships

Executive Directors may take up one external directorship, subject to the prior approval of the Board. In considering the appointment, the Board will consider whether the appointment will have an adverse impact on the Director's role within the Company and whether it will be a conflict of interest. Fees earned may be retained by the Director. At present, no Executive Director has an external directorship.

Executive Directors are encouraged to join, when invited, advisory committees of industries and professional bodies directly related to the Company's business. This helps to keep the Company informed of any future regulations or trends which may affect it in the future, as well as providing the opportunity to influence future decision making.

Company Information

Recruitment arrangements

The Committee will apply the same Remuneration Policy and principles when setting the remuneration package for a new Executive Director. The Committee will take into consideration all relevant factors to ensure that pay arrangements are in the best interests of the Company and its shareholders.

Ongoing benefits, pension provisions, annual bonus participation and awards under both the DBP and the PSP will be in line with those stated in the Policy. In exceptional circumstances, the maximum level of variable pay which may be awarded to a new Executive Director in the first year of appointment under the Policy will be 325% of salary (i.e. 125% annual bonus plus 200% PSP award).

Different performance measures may be set for any initial awards under the DBP and PSP after considering the responsibilities of the individual, the point in the year that they joined and the rules of the applicable plan. The rationale will be clearly explained in the Annual Report following such recruitment. The level of bonus which may be paid will be pro-rated to reflect the time in the year when the Executive Director joins.

The Committee will have discretion to make payments or awards to buy out incentive arrangements forfeited on leaving a previous employer, i.e. over and above the approach outlined in the table above and may exercise the discretion available under Listing Rule 9.3.2R if necessary to do so. In doing so, the Committee will match the fair value of the awards forfeited, taking account of the form, any applicable performance conditions and the likelihood of those conditions being met and the proportion of the applicable vesting period remaining.

Where an Executive Director appointment is an internal candidate, the Committee will honour any pre-existing remuneration obligations or outstanding variable pay arrangements that relate to the individual's previous role. Non-Executive Directors will be recruited on the basis of a Letter of Appointment with a three-month notice period.

Illustrations of the operation of the Remuneration Policy in FY26

Minimum performance:
comprising the minimum remuneration receivable
(being base salary, pension and benefits received in
FY25);
On target performance:
comprising fixed pay, annual bonus payment at 50% of the
maximum opportunity and long-term incentive awards
vesting at 25% of maximum opportunity;
Maximum performance:
comprising fixed pay, 100% of annual bonus and 100%
vesting of long-term incentive awards;
Maximum performance
with share price increase:

comprising fixed pay, 100% of annual bonus and 100%
vesting of long-term incentive awards with the value
increased for share price appreciation of 50%.

Remuneration Report

This section sets out how the Directors' Remuneration Policy was implemented during the financial year ended 31 March 2025. Where stated, disclosures regarding Director's remuneration have been audited by the Company's external auditors, Forvis Mazars. This section, together with the Chair's Statement, is subject to an advisory vote at the 2025 AGM.

Remuneration Committee

The Remuneration Committee comprises all of the Non-Executive Directors. The Remuneration Committee meets regularly throughout the year. It met four times during the year. A Board and Committee attendance chart is contained in the Governance Report on page 124.

FY25 Remuneration Committee activity

May 2024

  • Review outcome of Corporate and personal targets for Executive Director bonuses
  • Review and approve ExCo bonuses
  • Consider salary increases for Executive Directors and ExCo
  • Consider DBS and PSP awards and targets
  • Consider LTIP likely vesting outcome
  • Review the Committee Terms of Reference
  • Note staff survey results
  • Review Remuneration Report and Remuneration Policy

November 2024

  • Consider FY25 bonus targets
  • Consider the process for renewing the share plans
  • Report from Korn Ferry on developments in market practice in remuneration

January 2025

• FY25 targets and objectives

February 2025

  • Review results of benchmarking analysis
  • Consider salary reviews
  • Review wider workforce arrangements and pay policy
  • Preliminary discussions on performance against targets
  • Preliminary performance update for outstanding awards
  • Agree the share plan documentation for approval by the shareholders at the 2025 AGM

Role of the Remuneration Committee

The role of the Remuneration Committee is to establish a formal and transparent procedure for developing and implementing the Remuneration Policy. The Policy should have regard to the risk appetite of the Company and Executive remuneration should be aligned to the Company's purpose and values and be clearly linked to the successful delivery of the Company's long-term strategy. The Committee also reviews the remuneration of the Chair and senior executives below Board level. Terms of reference for the Remuneration Committee can be found on the Company's website.

Other main responsibilities of the Committee are to:

  • ensure that the Directors and executive management are provided with appropriate incentives to encourage enhanced performance and are, in a fair and responsible manner, rewarded for their individual contributions to the success of the Company and to align their interests with those of shareholders;
  • attract, retain and motivate Directors and executive management of the quality required to run the Company successfully without paying more than is necessary, having regard to views of shareholders and other stakeholders;

• review and have regard to workforce remuneration and related policies and the alignment of incentives and rewards with culture, taking these into account when setting remuneration policy for Directors and especially when determining annual salary increases;

Glossary &

  • consider and set the objectives, annual pay and targets for the Directors and executive management; and
  • review the operation of the Group's share incentive schemes and the granting and vesting of the schemes.

Any potential conflicts of interest are managed carefully. No Director is present when their own remuneration is being discussed and Committee papers are redacted where appropriate to avoid individuals seeing proposals before they are discussed by the Committee. Each meeting minutes whether there are any potential conflicts for any members or attendees.

Committee members

  • Alastair Miller: Committee Chair
  • Margaret Ford (until 30 May 2024)
  • Colin Rutherford
  • Charlie Parker
  • Dr Karen Miller

The Chief Executive Officer and Chief Operating and People Officer were invited to attend all or part of the meetings as and when relevant. These individuals were not present when their own remuneration was discussed. The Company Secretary acts as secretary to the Committee.

NewRiver REIT plc Annual Report and Accounts 2025 Strategic Report Governance Report Financial Statements ESG Data Sets
& Appendix
Glossary &
Company Information
146

Statement of voting at the Annual General Meeting

The following table summarises the details of votes cast for and against the Directors' Remuneration Policy at the 2023 AGM and the Directors' Remuneration Report at the 2024 AGM, along with the number of votes withheld.

Votes for % Votes against % Total shares for and against Votes withheld
That the Directors' Remuneration
Report be received and approved
(2024 AGM)
181,087,011 98.71 2,360,864 1.24 183,447,875 89,223
That the Directors' Remuneration
Policy be received and approved
(2023 AGM)
165,701,655 99.11 1,481,211 0.89 167,182,866 56,899

Statement of consideration of shareholders' views

The Company is committed to ongoing shareholder dialogue and takes an active interest in voting outcomes. If there are substantial votes against resolutions in relation to Directors' Remuneration, the Company will seek the reasons for any such vote and will detail any resulting actions in the next Directors' Remuneration Report.

Remuneration Committee adviser

The Committee keeps itself fully informed on developments and best practice in the field of remuneration and it seeks advice from external advisers when appropriate. The Committee appoints its own independent remuneration advisers and appointed Korn Ferry in 2018 following a competitive process. During the year the Committee continued to retain the services of Korn Ferry. Korn Ferry is a member of the Remuneration Consultants Group and signatory to its Code of Conduct which can be found at www.remunerationconsultantsgroup.com. Korn Ferry provided advice on market practice updates and benchmarking and supported management with undertakings such as producing the Directors' remuneration report to the extent this did not impact the independence of its advice. During FY25 Korn Ferry did not provide any other services to the Company. Fees charged by Korn Ferry were on a time and materials basis and totalled £49,826 in the year ended 31 March 2025. The Committee reviews the performance and independence of its advisers on an annual basis and is satisfied that the advice provided is objective and independent.

NewRiver REIT plc Annual Report and Accounts 2025 Strategic Report Governance Report Financial Statements ESG Data Sets
& Appendix
Glossary &
Company Information
147
Remuneration Committee Report continued

Total remuneration payable to Directors for FY25 (audited)

The following tables show a single figure total of remuneration for the year ended 31 March 2025 for each of the Directors and compares this figure to the prior year.

Executive Directors

Financial Year Salary
£
Benefits1
£
Pension2
£
Subtotal for
fixed pay
£
Cash bonus
£
Value of bonus
deferred into
shares
£
Long-Term
Incentive Plans
£
Subtotal for
variable pay
£
Total
£
Allan Lockhart 2025 498,623 5,905 19,945 524,473 361,601 154,972 252,231 768,804 1,293,277
2024 484,100 5,660 41,552 531,312 288,040 123,445 319,962 731,447 1,262,759
Will Hobman 2025 344,793 2,660 13,792 361,245 250,044 107,161 174,415 531,620 892,865
2024 334,750 2,551 13,390 350,691 199,176 85,361 133,945 418,482 769,173
  1. Benefits are the Directors' private medical cover.

  2. Allan Lockhart received a pension contribution of 15% of salary until July 2023 after which his pension contribution reduced to 4%. Will Hobman received a pension contribution of 4% of salary throughout 2024 and 2025 in line with the contribution for the wider workforce during the period.

Non-Executive Directors

Financial Year
Base fee £ Audit Committee Chairman £ Remuneration Committee Chairman £
Senior Independent Non-Executive Director £ Total £
Lynn Fordham1 2025 164,800 164,800
2024 4,437 4,437
Alastair Miller 2025 53,045 7,957 7,957 68,959
2024 51,500 7,725 7,725 66,950
Charlie Parker 2025 53,045 53,045
2024 51,500 51,500
Colin Rutherford 2025 53,045 7,957 61,002
2024 51,500 7,725 59,225
Dr Karen Miller 2025 53,045 53,045
2024 51,500 51,500
Margaret Ford2 2025 27,467 27,467
2024 164,800 164,800
  1. Lynn Fordham was appointed to the Board on 21 March 2024 as Chair Designate. Lynn received a pro-rata fee based on the annualised rate of £164,800 in 2024.

  2. Margaret Ford resigned on 30 May 2024.

NewRiver REIT plc Annual Report and Accounts 2025 Strategic Report Governance Report Financial Statements ESG Data Sets
& Appendix
Glossary &
Company Information
148
Remuneration Committee Report continued

Annual bonus for the year to 31 March 2025

Executive Directors had the opportunity to earn up to a maximum of 125% of salary on the basis of the achievement of the following measures. The performance against measures to 31 March 2025 is set out in the table below.

Weighting Threshold Target Stretch Actual result Achievement % of maximum
available under that element
Pay-out as a percentage of
total bonus
Measure 25% of maximum 50% of maximum 100% of maximum Allan Lockhart Will Hobman Allan Lockhart Will Hobman
Corporate
Total Return vs IPD All Retail 25% At index 10% ahead 20% ahead over 20% ahead 50% 50% 12.5% 12.5%
Earnings (UFFO) 25% £27m £29m £31m £30.5m 87.6% 87.6% 21.9% 21.9%
Financial
LTV 10% <44% <43% <42% 42.30% 85% 85% 8.5% 8.5%
Strategic
Strategic objectives 40% See below 100% 100% 40% 40%

A summary of the strategic objectives are shown below:

Strategic objectives Weighting Assessment of performance by the Committee Achievement
Allan
Lockhart
Will
Hobman
£6.7m synergies unlocked in terms of
Unlocking synergy savings 15% two acquisitions 15% 15%
On track to deliver mid-to high-teens
Value add capital deployment 5% UFFO per share accretion 5% 5%
Significantly oversubscribed equity
Cost effective capital raise and resultant expansion of equity base 7.5% raise at 0.5p premium 7.5% 7.5%
Revenues have increased by 16% at
Capital partnerships 5% net level 5% 5%
ESG Measures as per the below: 7.5% 7.5% 7.5%
Fully eliminated Market Based Scope
Achieve Net Zero for Corporate related Emissions (Scope 1-2) 1&2 emissions
Electric Vehicle charging points across the majority of assets with surface level 72% of all car parks and 80% of
car parks surface car parks
Improvement (from 2020 baseline) in landlord on site renewable energy Following viability assessments a 7%
generation improvement between 2023/24
75% response rate to our occupier satisfaction survey 78% response rate
Total 40% 40% 40%
NewRiver REIT plc Annual Report and Accounts 2025 Strategic Report Governance Report Financial Statements ESG Data Sets Glossary & 149

Based on performance to 31 March 2025, the annual bonus outcome for the Executive Directors during the year is shown below. The Committee is satisfied that no adjustments to the pay-outs is required, and the outcome is reflective of underlying performance.

Executive Assessment of performance by the Committee
% of maximum % of salary Bonus outcome
Allan Lockhart 82.9% 103.6% £516,573
Will Hobman 82.9% 103.6% £357,205

30% of the bonus will be deferred into shares for two years. Deferred shares are subject to continued employment.

Long-Term Incentive Plans (audited)

Vesting of Performance Share Plan awards

The FY23 LTIP Awards were granted to Allan Lockhart and Will Hobman on 6 July 2022. These awards are due to vest on 6 July 2025.

The performance targets for these awards are shown below:

Weighting Threshold Target Stretch Actual result Actual
result
Measure 25% of maximum 75% of maximum 100% of maximum
Total Shareholder
Return vs UK
REITs1
50% Median 62.5
percentile
Upper quartile Above upper
quartile
100%
Total Accounting
Return vs UK
REITs1
50% Median 62.5
percentile
Upper quartile Below
median
0%
Total 50%
  1. The UK REIT peer group consisting of: Segro, Land Securities Group, British Land, Derwent London, Hammerson, Shaftesbury Capital, Unite Group, Tritax Big Box Reit, Great Portland Estates, Workspace Group, Big Yellow Group, Assura, Grainger, Londonmetric Property, Safestore Holdings, Primary Health Properties and CLS Holdings.

The Committee is comfortable that the formulaic outcome of the LTIP reflects wider business performance and so no discretion has been applied. The vesting levels for the FY23 LTIP awards are shown below:

& Appendix

Executive Grant date Vest date Number of
shares granted
Number of
shares vesting
Value of
shares to vest
Dividend
equivalents
in shares
Total value
Allan Lockhart 6 Jul 22 6 Jul 25 532,880 266,440 £189,945 87,370 £252,231
Will Hobman 6 Jul 22 6 Jul 25 368,481 184,240 £131,345 60,415 £174,415

• Both Allan Lockhart's and Will Hobman's FY23 awards remain subject to a two-year post-vesting holding period.

  • The value of the shares to vest are based on a three-month average share price of 71.29p to 31 March 2025. This value will be restated in the single figure table next year based on the actual share price on the date of vesting.
  • Dividend equivalents include the final dividend declared for FY25 to be paid in August 2025 prior to vesting.
  • The share price at grant was 88.2p. Therefore, none of the value of the award is due to share price appreciation.

Company Information

PSP awards granted in the year to 31 March 2025 (audited)

The following Performance Share Plan awards were granted to Executive Directors as nil cost options on 25 September 2024:

Executive Value of awards at
grant date1
(% salary)
Number of shares
comprising award
% of award
vesting at
threshold
Vesting Period
End Date
Holding Period
End Date
Allan Lockhart £484,100 (100%) 587,144 25% 25 Sept 2027 25 Sept 2029
Will Hobman £334,750 (100%) 406,004 25% 25 Sept 2027 25 Sept 2029
  1. The closing price on the day before the grant date has been used to determine the number of shares comprising the award. This was 82.45p.

Performance will be assessed from 1 April 2024 to 31 March 2027. The targets for both performance conditions are as follows:

TSR ranking vs. UK REITs
(60% of award)
Total Accounting Return ranking vs. UK REITs
(40% of award)
Vesting
(% of award)
Below threshold Less than Median (50th percentile) Less than Median (50th percentile) 0%
Threshold Equal to Median (50th percentile) Equal to Median (50th percentile) 25%
Equal to 62.5th percentile Equal to 62.5th percentile 75%
Equal to Upper Quartile Equal to Upper Quartile (75th
Maximum (75th percentile) and above percentile) and above 100%

• 60% of each award may vest based on the Company's TSR compared to a group of UK REITs.

  • 40% of each award may vest based on the Company's Total Accounting Return ("TAR") compared to a group of UK REITs that report their NTA on an EPRA basis.
  • TAR is defined as the annualised return over the performance period based on the change in EPRA NTA per share and the level of dividends paid per share.

The TSR and TAR comparator group was composed of the companies set out in the list below.

Segro Great Portland Shaftesbury Londonmetric Property
Land Securities Estates Capital Safestore Holdings
Group Workspace Group Unite Group Primary Health
British Land Big Yellow Group Tritax Big Box Reit Properties
Derwent London Assura Grainger
Hammerson CLS Holdings

Deferred Shares granted in the year to 31 March 2025 (audited)

Awards of Deferred Bonus Shares over the Company's shares were granted to Executive Directors as nil cost options in FY25 as shown below. The deferred share awards are based on 30% of the bonus awarded for the year to 31 March 2024. Vesting of the awards is normally subject to continued employment at the date of vesting in two years' time.

Face value of the award at grant
Executive Number of shares granted1,2 date Grant date Vest date3
Allan Lockhart 150,930 £123,461 25 Sept 2024 25 Sept 2026
Will Hobman 104,366 £85,371 25 Sept 2024 25 Sept 2026
  1. The 5-day average close price on the day before the grant date has been used to determine the number of shares comprising the award. This was 81.8p.

  2. Awards are not subject to performance conditions.

  3. Vesting of awards is normally subject to continued employment unless an employee leaver is deemed a 'Good Leaver'.

NewRiver REIT plc Annual Report and Accounts 2025 Strategic Report Governance Report Financial Statements ESG Data Sets
& Appendix
Glossary &
Company Information
151
Remuneration Committee Report continued

Summary of Directors' Interests (audited)

The beneficial interests of the Executive Directors in share awards and share options as at 31 March 2025 are shown in the following tables.

Allan Lockhart
Grant Date Plan Vesting by1 Share price at
date of award
£
Exercise
price
£
At 31 March 2024 Granted Dividend equivalent
shares added2
Lapsed Exercised4 At 31 March 2025
Aug 2020 PSP Aug 2023 0.63 nil 314,962 26,106 341,068
Sept 2021 PSP Sept 2024 0.78 nil 729,680 44,464 (379,130) 395,014(3)
July 2022 DBP July 2024 0.88 nil 174,611 6,839 (181,450)
July 2022 PSP July 2025 0.88 nil 624,649 51,663 676,312
June 2023 DBP June 2025 0.89 nil 178,912 - 14,796 193,708
June 2023 PSP June 2026 0.89 nil 568,655 - 47,031 615,686
Sept 2024 DBP Sept 2026 0.82 nil 150,930 6,323 157,253
Sept 2024 PSP Sept 2027 0.82 nil 587,144 24,601 611,745
Total 2,591,469 738,074 221,823 (379,130) (181,450) 2,990,786
Will Hobman
Grant Date Plan Vesting by1 Share price at
date of award
£
Exercise
price
£
At 31 March 2024 Granted Dividend equivalent
shares added2
Lapsed Exercised5 At 31 March 2025
Sept 2021 PSP Sept 2024 0.78 nil 318,263 19,393 (165,364) 172,292(3)
July 2022 DBP July 2024 0.88 nil 128,069 5,016 (133,085)
July 2022 PSP July 2025 0.88 nil 431,938 35,724 467,662
June 2023 DBP June 2025 0.89 nil 123,715 10,231 133,946
June 2023 PSP June 2026 0.89 nil 393,218 32,521 425,739
Sept 2024 DBP Sept 2026 0.82 nil 104,366 4,372 108,738
Sept 2024 PSP Sept 2027 0.82 nil 406,004 17,011 423,015
Total 1,395,203 510,370 124,268 (165,364) (133,085) 1,731,392
  1. A holding period of two years is applied following vesting for the PSP awards.

  2. The right to dividends is accrued and is only payable if and to the extent that the awards vest. Once vested the dividends will continue to accrue on the vested awards during the holding period. The FY25 final dividend declared is not included in this figure.

  3. Dividends continue to accrue on the vested awards during the holding period. For the FY25 interim dividend payment in January 2025 dividends of 15,885 accrued to Allan's vested awards and 6,928 accrued to Will's vested awards.

  4. Allan Lockhart's awards were exercised on 17 December 2024. Some of the shares were sold to cover tax at a share price of 79.16p. The aggregate gain from exercising the awards was £143,636.

  5. Will Hobman's awards were exercised on 17 December 2024. Some of the shares were sold to cover tax at a share price of 79.16p. The aggregate gain from exercising these awards was £105,350.

DBP = Deferred Bonus Plan PSP = Performance Share Plan

NewRiver REIT plc Annual Report and Accounts 2025 Strategic Report Governance Report Financial Statements ESG Data Sets
& Appendix
Glossary &
Company Information
152
Remuneration Committee Report continued

Details of the Directors' shareholdings and rights to shares (audited)

It is the Board's policy that Executive Directors build up and retain a minimum shareholding of 200% of base salary. Beneficially owned shares, vested and unvested DBP awards plus vested but unexercised PSP awards may be counted towards the value of the executives' shareholdings for the purposes of the 200% holding guideline.

The beneficial interests of Directors who served during the year, in the shares of the Company are as follows:

Beneficially
owned shares
held at 31 March
2025
Value of
beneficially
owned shares as
% of salary1
Vested but
unexercised DBP
awards held at
31 March 2025
Vested but
unexercised PSP
awards held at
31 March 2025
Unvested DBP
awards held at
31 March 2025
Value of holdings
including vested
PSP and unvested
DBP2
Unvested PSP
awards held at
31 March 2025
Total held as at
31 March 2025
Shareholding %
of salary
Allan Lockhart 726,280 101% - 736,083 350,961 252% 1,903,743 3,717,067 252%
Will Hobman 495,771 100% 172,292 242,684 183% 1,316,416 2,227,163 183%
Lynn Fordham 187,500 187,500 N/A
Alastair Miller 147,462 147,462 N/A
Colin Rutherford N/A
Charlie Parker 21,454 21,454 N/A
Dr Karen Miller 18,750 18,750 N/A
Margaret Ford6 106,440 106,440 N/A
  1. Based on the closing share price of 69.40p as at 31 March 2025 and salary for FY25.

  2. Includes dividend equivalent shares added to that date. Although vested these awards have not yet been exercised.

  3. All awards are nil cost awards.

  4. Vested but unexercised PSPs are not subject to performance conditions. Unvested PSPs are subject to performance conditions. Outstanding DBP awards are not subject to performance conditions. The details of outstanding scheme interests are included in the table on page 151.

  5. At least half of the net shares vested under the deferred annual bonus and the PSP must be retained until the shareholding requirement is met.

  6. Margaret Ford resigned on 30 May 2024. As such her shareholding is reported as at the date of her resignation.

DBP = Deferred Bonus Plan PSP = Performance Share Plan

There have been no changes in the number of shares held from 31 March 2025 to 5 June 2025, being the latest practicable date before the publication of this Annual Report.

Payments for loss of office and to past Directors (audited)

No payments have been made to past Directors or for loss of office.

NewRiver REIT plc Annual Report and Accounts 2025

Historic Total Shareholder Return performance and Chief Executive Officer remuneration

The following information allows comparison of the Company's TSR (based on share price growth and dividends reinvested) with the remuneration of the CEO over the last ten years, together with bonus and LTIP pay-outs (as a percentage of the maximum).

The chart shows the Company's TSR and that of the FTSE 250 and the FTSE 350 REIT Indices based on an initial investment of £100 on 1 April 2015 and values at intervening financial year ends over a ten-year period to 31 March 2025. These are considered to be appropriate benchmarks for the graph as the Company was a constituent of these indices during the financial years shown and is in line with the approach used historically.

Total remuneration (£) Annual bonus (% of max) Total LTIP vesting (% of max)
2016 David Lockhart 1,792,205 100 50
2017 David Lockhart 1,341,958 66.7 76.3
2018 David Lockhart 1,012,946 77.3 13.1
2019 Allan Lockhart 911,972 64
20201 Allan Lockhart 543,239
2021 Allan Lockhart 637,339 20
2022 Allan Lockhart 984,462 75
2023 Allan Lockhart 1,276,384 82.5 50
2024 Allan Lockhart 1,262,759 68 50
2025 Allan Lockhart 1,293,277 82.9 50
  1. Allan Lockhart received no bonus in 2020.

NewRiver REIT plc Annual Report and Accounts 2025 Strategic Report Governance Report Financial Statements ESG Data Sets
& Appendix
Glossary &
Company Information
154
Remuneration Committee Report continued

CEO pay ratio

The ratio of the CEO's pay to the 25th, 50th and 75th percentile is shown, along with the total pay for the employees at the three quartiles. Prior to FY25 the Group had fewer than 250 employees and so the CEO pay ratio was disclosed on a voluntary basis.

We have based the calculation on the methodology outlined in Option A under the regulations, although, we have chosen not to disclose the three salary levels for the relevant employees to allow a simpler comparison with the total pay of the CEO. This method is, in the Committee's view, the most comprehensive and accurate reflection of the remuneration picture across our employee population.

The ratio calculated by reference to actual pay rates on 31 March 2025 and based on the CEO's full salary.

The CEO ratio has been calculated for all permanent Group employees. Following the acquisition of Capital & Regional, which includes the Snozone business, there are now a significant number of hourly-paid staff which impacts the outcome of the CEO ratio. The Committee has used the ratio as part of the overall review of the implementation of the Remuneration Policy. In addition, the Committee is comfortable that the pay ratio is a fair and accurate reflection of the differences to the level of pay of the CEO compared with the workforce more generally as well as the pay, reward and progression policies.

Year Method 25th percentile pay ratio Median pay ratio 75th percentile pay ratio
FY25 Option A 17.3.1 46.4.1 47.4.1
FY24 Option A 7.6:1 13.2:1 17.7:1
FY23 Option A 6.6:1 12.6:1 19.2:1
FY22 Option A 7:1 12.7:1 17.2:1
FY21 Option A 7:1 9:1 19:1
FY20 Option A 8:1 17:1 34:1

The total pay for the individuals identified at the Lower quartile, Median and Upper quartile positions are set out below:

FY25 FY25
Salaries Total Pay
73,987
27,648
27,040 27,040
67,500
27,070
NewRiver REIT plc Annual Report and Accounts 2025 Strategic Report Governance Report Financial Statements ESG Data Sets
& Appendix
Glossary &
Company Information
155

Annual percentage change in remuneration of Directors and employees

The table below sets out the percentage change in base salary, value of taxable benefits and bonus for all the Directors compared with the average percentage change for employees.

FY24/FY25 FY23/FY24 FY22/FY23 FY21/FY22
Directors Salary/fee Benefits Annual
Bonus
Salary/fee Benefits Annual
Bonus
Salary/fee Benefits Annual
Bonus
Salary/fee Benefits Annual
Bonus
Executive Directors
Allan Lockhart 3% 4% 26% 3% 13% -15% 0% 50% 10% 0% 18% 369%
Will Hobman1 3% 4% 26% 3% 18% -15% 0% 33% 9% N/A N/A N/A
Non-Executive Directors
Lynn Fordham2 0% N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A
Alastair Miller 3% N/A N/A 3% N/A N/A 0% N/A N/A 0% N/A N/A
Charlie Parker 3% N/A N/A 3% N/A N/A 0% N/A N/A 0% N/A N/A
Colin Rutherford 3% N/A N/A 3% N/A N/A 6% N/A N/A 60% N/A N/A
Dr Karen Miller3 3% N/A N/A 3% N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A
Margaret Ford5 N/A N/A N/A 3% N/A N/A 0% N/A N/A 0% N/A N/A
All Employees4 7.22% 15.35% 14.22% 6% 12% -8% 5% 20% 96% 5% 20% 96%
  1. Will Hobman was appointed to the Board on 20 August 2021. For ease of comparison, we have compared his pay on a pro-rated basis.

  2. Lynn Fordham was appointed to the Board on 21 March 2024. For ease of comparison, we have compared her pay on a pro-rated basis

  3. Dr Karen Miller was appointed to the Board on 30 May 2022. For ease of comparison, we have compared her pay on a pro-rated basis

  4. All employees are used as there are no employees of the listed parent company.

  5. Margaret Ford stepped down from the Board on 30 May 2024. For ease of comparison, we have compared her pay on a pro-rated basis

Relative importance of spend on pay

Remuneration Committee Report continued

The table below shows employee pay and distributions to shareholders for FY25 and FY24.

FY25 £'000 FY24 £'000 % difference from prior year
Total spend on employee pay1 10,429 6,645 36.3%
Total distributions to shareholders 24,108 20,272 15.9%
Share Buybacks 0%
  1. Includes salaries, bonuses, social security costs and pension costs as shown in the notes to the Financial Statements.
NewRiver REIT plc Annual Report and Accounts 2025 Strategic Report Governance Report Financial Statements ESG Data Sets
& Appendix
Glossary &
Company Information
156

Implementation of the Policy in FY26

The section below sets out the implementation of the Remuneration Policy in FY26. A summary of changes to the implementation of the policy are set out in the Chair's statement on page 136.

Salaries and fees

The base salaries for FY25 are set out below:

Executive Salary for FY24 Salary for FY25 % increase
Allan Lockhart – Chief Executive Officer £498,628 £513,582 3%
Will Hobman – Chief Financial Officer £344,793 £355,136 3%

The Committee also reviewed the Chair fees and the Board (minus the Non-Executive Directors) reviewed the Non-Executive Director fees. As a result of these reviews, the Chair fee, NED base fee, and senior Independent Director fee were increased by 3%, while the Committee Chair fees were increased by 26%. The fees for the Chair and Non-Executive Directors in FY25 and FY26 are set out below:

Director Fees for FY25 Fees for FY26 % increase
Chair £164,800 £169,744 3%
Basic fee for a Non-Executive Director £53,045 £54,600 3%
Additional fee for serving as Chair of
the Audit and Remuneration Committees
£7,957 £10,000 26%
Additional fee for serving as the Senior Independent
Non-Executive Director £7,957 £8,195 3%

Annual bonus

The annual bonus will operate as laid out in the Remuneration Policy. Executive Directors will have the opportunity to earn a bonus up to a normal maximum of 125% of salary.

In line with FY25, the bonus will be based on financial and corporate measures as well as personal strategic objectives.

Long-term incentives – Performance Share Plan

The Committee intends to grant LTIP awards to Executive Directors of 150% of salary. The extent to which the LTIP awards will vest will be determined by the performance measures listed below.

Threshold Target Stretch
Measure Weighting 25% of maximum 75% of maximum 100% of maximum
Relative TSR vs UK REIT peer group 60% Median 62.5 percentile Upper Quartile
Relative TAR vs UK REIT peer group 40% Median 62.5 percentile Upper Quartile

Awards must be held by Executive Directors for a further two years after vesting.

Signed on behalf of the Board

Alastair Miller

Committee Chair

16 June 2025

Directors' Report

Dear Shareholders

The Directors present their report together with the audited consolidated financial statements and the report of the auditor for the year ended 31 March 2025.

Kerin Williams Company Secretary

16 June 2025

Principal activities and status

NewRiver REIT plc (the 'Company') is an equity shares (commercial companies) listed REIT on the London Stock Exchange. The Company is a specialist real estate investor, asset manager and developer focused solely on the UK retail sector. Details of the Group's principal subsidiary undertakings are set out on pages 200 to 203.

Governance

The Financial Reporting Council published a revised UK Corporate Governance Code in July 2018 (the 'Code'). Further information on the Code can be found on the Financial Reporting Council's website at: www.frc.org.uk. The Company's Statement on Governance can be found on page 113.

Results and dividend

The Directors have proposed a final dividend of 3.5 pence per share. Together with the interim dividend of 3.0 pence, the total dividend for FY25 is 6.5 pence. The final dividend is payable on 8 August 2025 to shareholders on the register as at 20 June 2025. 3.5 pence will be paid as a PID net of withholding tax where appropriate. The Company will be offering a scrip dividend alternative. A dividend of 6.7 pence per share was paid in FY24.

The Board

Strategic Report Governance Report

The Directors, who served throughout the year unless stated otherwise, are detailed below:

Service in the year to 31 March 2025
Margaret Ford Resigned 30 May 2024
Lynn Fordham Served throughout the year
Allan Lockhart Served throughout the year
Will Hobman Served throughout the year
Alastair Miller Served throughout the year
Karen Miller Served throughout the year
Charlie Parker Served throughout the year
Colin
Rutherford
Served throughout the year

Margaret Ford stepped down from the Board on 30 May 2024. Unless stated otherwise the rest of the Directors were in office during the year and up to the date of signing the financial statements. The roles and biographies of the Directors in office as at the date of this report are set out on pages 115 to 116.

& Appendix

Directors' Report continued

Additional information

The Strategic Report is set out on pages 2 to 111 and is incorporated into the Directors' Report by reference. Additional information, which is incorporated by reference into this Directors' Report, including information required in accordance with the Companies Act 2006 and the UK Listing Rules of the Financial Conduct Authority, can be located as follows:

Found on page
s.172 statement Page 59
Staff, culture and employee
involvement
Staff - pages 6, 20, 23, 59 and 60 to 61
Directors' interests Pages 149 to 152 of the Directors' Remuneration
Report
Stakeholder engagement Strategic Report - pages 2 to 111
Statement on business relationships Strategic Report - pages 2 to 111
Environmental policy ESG Report - pages 68 to 97
Greenhouse gas emissions ESG Report - pages 68 to 97
Future business developments Strategic Report - pages 2 to 111
Financial risk management objectives
and policies
Pages 98 to 108 and pages 193 to 195
Going concern Page 110 and 173
Viability statement Page 109
Governance report Pages 112 to 160
Diversity Pages 61 and 128 to 130

Subject to the Company's Articles of Association, UK legislation and any directions given by special resolution, the business of the Company is managed by the Board, which may exercise all the powers of the Company.

The Board's role is to provide entrepreneurial leadership of the Company within a framework of prudent and effective controls which enables risk to be assessed and managed. It also sets the Group's strategic aims, ensuring that the necessary financial and human resources are in place for the Group to meet its objectives and review management performance.

M&G Plc 16,139,931 3.38% Powers of Directors The Board also sets the Group's values, standards and culture. Further details on the Board's role can be found in the Corporate Governance Report on pages 114 to 122.

Directors' interests

Details of the Directors' share interests can be found in the Directors' Remuneration Report on pages 149 to 152. All related party transactions are disclosed in note 27 to the financial statements.

Directors' indemnification and insurance

The Company's Articles of Association provide for the Directors and officers of the Company to be appropriately indemnified, subject to the provisions of the Companies Act 2006. Qualifying third-party indemnity provisions (as defined by section 234 of the Companies Act 2006) were in force during the year ended 31 March 2025 and remain in force at the date of signing this report. The Company purchases and maintains insurance for the Directors and officers of the Company in performing their duties, as permitted by section 233 Companies Act 2006. This insurance has been in place during the year and remains in place at the date of signing this report.

Articles of Association

The Company's latest Articles of Association were adopted at the 2021 AGM. The rules governing the appointment and replacement of Directors are contained in the Company's Articles of Association. Changes to the Articles of Association must be approved by shareholders in accordance with legislation in force from time to time. A copy of the Company's Articles of Association can be found on the Company's website, www.nrr.co.uk.

Significant interests

The tables below show the interests in shares notified to the Company in accordance with Chapter 5 of the Disclosure Guidance and Transparency Rules of the Financial Conduct Authority as at 31 March 2025 and as at 5 June 2025 (being a date not more than one month prior to the date of the Notice of AGM):

As at 31 March 2025

Shareholder Number of
shares
% of issued
share capital
Growthpoint
Properties
(Johannesburg) 67,385,444 14.12%
FIL Limited 52,984,623 11.17%
Premier Miton 24,067,235 5.04%
M&G Plc 16,245,439 3.41%

As at 5 June 2025

Shareholder Number of
shares
% of issued
Share Capital
Growthpoint
Properties
Johannesburg 67,385,444 14.12%
FIL Limited 52,984,623 11.17%
Premier Miton 20,657,616 4.33%

Strategic Report Governance Report

& Appendix

Directors' Report continued

Internal controls review

Taking into account the principal risks, emerging risks and the ongoing work of the Audit Committee in monitoring the risk management and internal control systems on behalf of the Board, the Directors:

  • are satisfied that they have carried out a robust assessment of the principal and emerging risks facing the Group, including those that would threaten its business model, future performance, solvency or liquidity; and
  • have reviewed the effectiveness of the risk management and internal control systems and no significant failings were identified.

Branches outside the UK

The Company has no branches outside the UK.

Financial instruments

The Group's exposure to, and management of, capital risk, market risk and liquidity risk is set out in note 25 to the Group's financial statements.

Share capital structure

As at 31 March 2025, the Company's issued share capital consisted of 477,084,008 ordinary shares of one pence each. No shares are held in treasury. During the year 62,737,200 new ordinary shares of one pence each in the Company were issued on 23 September 2024 in respect of a Placing and REX Retail Offer. 98,321,755 ordinary shares were issued on 10 December 2024 in accordance with the recommended cash and share offer by the Company for Capital and Regional plc. As at 31 March 2025 the EBT held 1,624,929 ordinary shares. Therefore, the total number of voting rights in the Company is 475,459,079. Further details of the share capital, including changes throughout the year are summarised in note 23 of the financial statements.

Ordinary shareholders are entitled to receive notice of, and to attend and speak at, any general meeting of the Company. On a show of hands, every shareholder present in person or by proxy (or being a corporation represented by a duly authorised representative) shall have one vote, and on a poll every shareholder who is present in person or by proxy shall have one vote for every share of which he or she is the holder. The Notice of Annual General Meeting specifies deadlines for exercising voting rights and appointing a proxy or proxies.

There are no restrictions on the transfer of shares except the UK Real Estate Investment Trust restrictions. The Directors are not aware of any agreements between holders of the Company's shares that may result in the restriction of the transfer of securities or of voting rights.

Authority for the Company to purchase its own shares

Subject to authorisation by shareholder resolution, the Company may purchase its own shares in accordance with the Companies Act 2006. Any shares which have been bought back may be held as treasury shares or cancelled immediately upon completion of the purchase. At the Annual General Meeting held in 2024, shareholders authorised the Company to make purchases (within the meaning of section 693 of the Companies Act 2006) of the Company's ordinary shares, up to a maximum of 10% of the issued share capital at that time, as well as the allotment of new shares within certain limits approved by shareholders. The Company has not repurchased any of its ordinary shares under this authority, which is due to expire at the AGM in 2025 and appropriate renewals will be sought. There are no securities of the Company carrying special rights with regards to the control of the Company in issue.

Change of control significant agreements

The Company was not party to any significant contracts that are subject to change of control permissions in the event of a change of control, but other agreements may alter or terminate upon such an event.

Compensation for loss of office in the event of a takeover

The Company does not have any agreements with any Executive Director or employee that would provide compensation for loss of office or employment resulting from a takeover except that the Group's incentive plans and share plans contain provisions relating to termination of employment. Further information is provided in the Summary of the Directors' Remuneration Policy set out on pages 139 to 142.

Auditor

Forvis Mazars LLP were appointed auditors at the last AGM held in 2024 to replace PriceWaterhouseCoopers LLP and have indicated their willingness to continue in office and a resolution seeking to re-appoint Forvis Mazars LLP will be proposed at the forthcoming AGM.

Annual General Meeting

The Annual General Meeting will be held on 31 July 2025. At the meeting, resolutions will be proposed to receive the Annual Report and financial statements, approve the Directors' Remuneration Report, re-elect Directors and appoint an auditor and authorise the Audit Committee to determine the remuneration of the auditor. In addition, it will be proposed that expiring authorities to allot shares and to repurchase shares are extended. An explanation of the resolutions to be put to the shareholders at the 2025 AGM and the recommendations in relation to them will be set out in the 2025 AGM Notice.

Political donations

No political donations were made by the Company or its subsidiaries during the year (2024: Nil).

The Directors' Report was approved by the Board of Directors on 16 June 2025.

By Order of the Board

Kerin Williams Company Secretary

16 June 2025

Strategic Report Governance Report

& Appendix

Glossary & Company Information

Directors' Report continued

Statement of Directors' responsibilities in respect of the financial statements

The Directors are responsible for preparing the Annual Report and Accounts and the financial statements in accordance with applicable law and regulation.

Company law requires the Directors to prepare financial statements for each financial year. Under that law the Directors have prepared the Group financial statements in accordance with UK-adopted international accounting standards and the Company financial statements in accordance with United Kingdom Generally Accepted Accounting Practice (United Kingdom Accounting Standards, comprising FRS 101 'Reduced Disclosure Framework', and applicable law).

Under company law, Directors must not approve the financial statements unless they are satisfied that they give a true and fair view of the state of affairs of the Group and Company and of the profit or loss of the Group for that period. In preparing the financial statements, the Directors are required to:

  • select suitable accounting policies and then apply them consistently;
  • state whether applicable UK-adopted international accounting standards have been followed for the Group financial statements and United Kingdom Accounting Standards comprising FRS 101 have been followed for the Company financial statements, subject to any material departures disclosed and explained in the financial statements;
  • make judgements and accounting estimates that are reasonable and prudent; and
  • prepare the financial statements on the going concern basis unless it is inappropriate to presume that the Group and Company will continue in business.

The Directors are responsible for safeguarding the assets of the Group and Company and hence for taking reasonable steps for the prevention and detection of fraud and other irregularities.

The Directors are also responsible for keeping adequate accounting records that are sufficient to show and explain the Group's and Company's transactions and disclose with reasonable accuracy at any time the financial position of the Group and Company and enable them to ensure that the financial statements and the Directors' Remuneration Report comply with the Companies Act 2006.

The Directors are responsible for the maintenance and integrity of the Company's website. Legislation in the United Kingdom governing the preparation and dissemination of financial statements may differ from legislation in other jurisdictions.

Directors' confirmations

Each of the Directors, whose names and functions are listed in the Governance Report confirm that, to the best of their knowledge:

  • the Group financial statements, which have been prepared in accordance with UKadopted international accounting standards, give a true and fair view of the assets, liabilities, financial position and profit of the Group;
  • the Company financial statements, which have been prepared in accordance with United Kingdom Accounting Standards, comprising FRS 101, give a true and fair view of the assets, liabilities and financial position of the Company; and
  • the Strategic Report includes a fair review of the development and performance of the business and the position of the Group and Company, together with a description of the principal risks and uncertainties that it faces.

In the case of each Director in office at the date the Directors' report is approved:

  • so far as the Director is aware, there is no relevant audit information of which the Group's and Company's auditors are unaware; and
  • they have taken all the steps that they ought to have taken as a Director in order to make themselves aware of any relevant audit information and to establish that the Group's and Company's auditors are aware of that information.

The confirmation is given and should be interpreted in accordance with the provisions of section 418 of the Companies Act 2006.

By Order of the Board

Lynn Fordham Non-Executive Chair

16 June 2025

Auditor's report

Independent auditor's report to the members of NewRiver REIT plc

Opinion

We have audited the financial statements of NewRiver REIT plc (the 'Parent Company') and its subsidiaries (the 'Group') for the year ended 31 March 2025 which comprise the Consolidated Statement of Comprehensive Income, the Consolidated Balance Sheet, the Consolidated Cash Flow Statement, the Consolidated Statement of Changes in Equity, the Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements, including material accounting policy information, the Company Balance Sheet, the Company Statement of Changes in Equity and the Notes to the Company Financial Statements, including material accounting policy information.

The financial reporting framework that has been applied in the preparation of the Group financial statements is applicable law and UK-adopted international accounting standards. The financial reporting framework that has been applied in the preparation of the Parent Company financial statements is applicable law and UK Accounting Standards, including FRS 101 "Reduced Disclosure Framework" (UK Generally Accepted Accounting Practice) and as applied in accordance with the provisions of the Companies Act 2006.

In our opinion, the financial statements:

  • give a true and fair view of the state of the Group's and of the Parent Company's affairs as at 31 March 2025 and of the Group's profit for the year then ended;
  • have been properly prepared in accordance with UK-adopted international accounting standards and, as regards the Parent Company financial statements, as applied in accordance with the provisions of the Companies Act 2006; and
  • have been prepared in accordance with the requirements of the Companies Act 2006.

Basis for opinion

We conducted our audit in accordance with International Standards on Auditing (UK) (ISAs (UK)) and applicable law. Our responsibilities under those standards are further described in the "Auditor's responsibilities for the audit of the financial statements" section of our report. We are independent of the Group and the Parent Company in accordance with the ethical requirements that are relevant to our audit of the financial statements in the UK, including the FRC's Ethical Standard as applied to listed entities and public interest entities, and we have fulfilled our other ethical responsibilities in accordance with these requirements. We believe that the audit evidence we have obtained is sufficient and appropriate to provide a basis for our opinion.

Conclusions relating to going concern

In auditing the financial statements, we have concluded that the Directors' use of the going concern basis of accounting in the preparation of the financial statements is appropriate.

Our audit procedures to evaluate the Directors' assessment of the Group's and the Parent company's ability to continue to adopt the going concern basis of accounting included but were not limited to:

  • Undertaking an initial assessment at the planning stage of the audit to identify events or conditions that may cast significant doubt on the Group's and the Parent company's ability to continue as a going concern;
  • Obtaining an understanding of controls and processes operated by the Group and the Parent company around the preparation, review and approval of the going concern assessment and risks associated with non-compliance with loan covenants;
  • Making enquiries of the Directors to understand the period of assessment considered by them, the assumptions they considered and the implication of those when assessing the Group's and the Parent Company's future financial performance;
  • Reviewing the terms of loan contracts to determine whether forecast covenant calculations were in line with those contracts and to determine whether the maturity profile of the debt included within the projections was accurate;
  • Obtaining and verifying the underlying cash flow projections to Board approved forecasts including assessing Management's controls in assessing the viability of the Group's tenant profile;
  • Evaluating and challenging the appropriateness of the Directors' assumptions in their cash flow forecasts, under both a base case scenario and a reasonable worst-case scenario, by reviewing supporting and contradictory evidence in relation to key assumptions and assessing the Directors' consideration of appropriate sensitivities in the severe but plausible scenario from the base case scenario, including the Group's stretched Loan-to-Value position, investment property valuation and net rental income;
  • Evaluating the minimum committed facility headroom under the base and reasonable worst-case scenarios, and evaluated whether the Directors' conclusion, that sufficient liquidity headroom existed to continue trading operationally throughout a period of at least 12 months from the date of approval of these financial statements, was appropriate;
  • Testing the mathematical integrity of the cash flow forecasts used to support the Director's going concern assessment;
  • Testing the completeness and accuracy of historical data included in the Board approved going concern assessment;
  • Considering the consistency of the Directors' forecasts with other areas of the financial statements and our audit; and
  • Evaluating the appropriateness of the Directors' disclosures in the financial statements on going concern.

Based on the work we have performed, we have not identified any material uncertainties relating to events or conditions that, individually or collectively, may cast significant doubt on the Group's and the Parent Company's ability to continue as a going concern for a period of at least twelve months from when the financial statements are authorised for issue.

Our responsibilities and the responsibilities of the Directors with respect to going concern are described in the relevant sections of this report.

In relation to NewRiver REIT plc's reporting on how it has applied the UK Corporate Governance Code, we have nothing material to add or draw attention to in relation to the directors' statement in the financial statements about whether the Director's considered it appropriate to adopt the going concern basis of accounting.

Key audit matters

Key audit matters are those matters that, in our professional judgment, were of most significance in our audit of the financial statements of the current period and include the most significant assessed risks of material misstatement (whether or not due to fraud) we identified, including those which had the greatest effect on: the overall audit strategy; the allocation of resources in the audit; and directing the efforts of the engagement team. These matters were addressed in the context of our audit of the financial statements as a whole, and in forming our opinion thereon, and we do not provide a separate opinion on these matters.

We summarise below the key audit matters in forming our opinion above, together with an overview of the principal audit procedures performed to address each matter and our key observations arising from those procedures.

These matters, together with our findings, were communicated to those charged with governance through our Audit Completion Report.

Valuation of Investment Properties (Group)

Refer to the Audit Committee's discussion of this Key Audit Matter on page 133, Note 1 Accounting policies 'Investment properties', Note 2 Critical accounting judgements and estimates 'Investment property' and Note 14 Investment Properties.

Investment properties, excluding the right of use asset on investment property of £51.8 million (31 March 2024: £74.9 million), have a carrying value of £887.5 million at 31 March 2025 (31 March 2024: £533.8 million), comprising 84% (31 March 2024: 70%) of the Group's Total Assets.

Key Audit Matter How our scope addressed this matter

Our audit procedures included, but were not limited to:

& Appendix

  • Obtaining an understanding of the controls in place for Management's review of third-party valuations prepared by the Group's external valuers. This included discussions with Management and walkthroughs to assess the design and implementation of these controls.
  • Engaging our own RICS valuation specialists to independently assess the work of the external valuers, including but not limited to:
    • Evaluating the competence, capabilities, independence and objectivity of the Group's external valuers.
  • Obtaining the valuation reports and assessing whether the valuation methodologies were consistent with RICS Valuation – Professional Standards and UK-adopted International Accounting Standards.
  • Challenging key assumptions and estimates, including estimated rental values, yields, tenancy data and comparing these against market benchmarks and published yield data.
  • Considering recent comparable market transactions used by the Group's external valuers to support the valuations.
Key Audit Matter How our scope addressed this matter
------------------ -- -------------------------------------
  • Attending key discussions with the Group's asset managers and external valuers appointed to challenge and gain an understanding of significant judgments and assumptions applied in the valuation model.
  • Testing the mathematical accuracy of the valuation models.
  • Testing the completeness and accuracy of the data inputs used in the valuation model by inspecting lease contracts and comparing the information in the lease tenancy schedule to data used in the valuation report on a sample basis.
  • Testing the capital expenditure assumptions used by the external valuers by tracing back to verifiable evidence on a sample basis.
  • Reviewing the adequacy of the disclosure in the financial statements, including the valuation methodology, assumptions and fair value hierarchy used.

Our observations

Based on the work performed and evidence obtained, we consider the methodology and assumptions used to value the investment properties to be appropriate.

Valuation of Investment Properties (Group)

continued

Strategic Report

In determining the value of investment properties, the external valuers consider property specific information such as current tenancy agreements and rental income. The external valuers then apply judgmental assumptions to the investment properties such as, but not limited to, estimated rental value ('ERV') and yield, which are influenced by prevailing market conditions and, where appropriate, comparable market transactions to arrive at the final valuation.

As a result of the above factors, the valuation of investment properties is considered to be a Key Audit Matter.

Key Audit Matter How our scope addressed this matter

& Appendix

Glossary & Company Information

Valuation of Investment Properties (Group) continued

The value of investment properties is the key driver of the Group's underlying performance and involves a significant level of judgment in ascertaining the fair value under IFRS 13. The valuation of the investment properties is inherently subjective due to, among other factors, the individual nature of each property, its location and the expected future rentals. The wider challenges currently facing the real estate sector, because of regional and macroeconomic factors, further contributed to the subjectivity in establishing valuations for the year ended 31 March 2025.

The valuations are carried out by external valuers, Colliers, Knight Frank and Kroll. The external valuers are engaged by the Directors and performed their work in accordance with the Royal Institute of Chartered Surveyors ("RICS") Valuation – Professional Standards, the requirements of IAS 40 'Investment property' and IFRS 13 'Fair value measurement'.

Key Audit Matter How our scope addressed this matter
------------------ -------------------------------------

Our audit procedures included, but were not limited to:

  • Obtaining an understanding of the revenue recognition process and related controls. This included discussions with Management and walkthroughs to assess the design and implementation of these controls;
  • Performing tests of controls related to the completeness and accuracy of the tenancy schedules;
  • Performing test of details by assessing a sample of lease agreements / amendments, and agreeing the relevant terms, including passing / headline rent, start date, end date and lease incentives to property manager reports and bank statements;
  • Recalculating rental income for a sample of leases in accordance with IFRS 16, including any related incentive adjustments;
  • Performing substantive analytical procedures to develop an expectation of rental income to be recognised during the year and comparing this to actual results; and
  • Assessing revenue-related journal entries to identify potential indicators of management override of controls.

Our observations

Based on the work performed and evidence obtained, we concluded the risk of material misstatement of the occurrence and accuracy of rental income was reduced to an acceptable level.

Key Audit Matter How our scope addressed this matter

Strategic Report

Acquisition of Capital & Regional plc (C&R) (Group)

Refer to Note 1 in relation to significant estimates and accounting policies.

Refer to Note 17 in relation to the acquisition of C&R.

During the year, the Parent Company acquired the entire issued ordinary share capital of C&R. The consideration for the acquisition was based on a combination of a pre-agreed cash-for-share ratio and share-for-share ratio.

The accounting entries and judgment regarding the accounting treatment for the acquisition, together with the related disclosures is considered a key audit matter given the significant and subjective judgments made by the Directors as to whether the acquisition is accounted for as a business combination or an asset acquisition.

An incorrect judgment with regards to the accounting treatment or incorrect allocation of the discount on acquisition and transaction costs to the identifiable acquired assets could result in a material misstatement of the financial statements.

Our audit procedures included, but were not limited to:

• Obtaining Management's formal assessment of the accounting for the acquisition which included the basis for treating the acquisition as an asset acquisition;

Glossary &

  • Engaging our Accounting Technical Specialists to challenge Management on specific points of interpretation within the accounting requirements of IFRS 3 Business Combinations relating to the treatment of the acquisition, including whether the conditions of the optional concentration test under IFRS 3 Business Combinations applied to the acquisition were met or not, where we also used our RICs qualified valuation specialists;
  • Obtaining and auditing the opening balance sheet for C&R on the date of acquisition;
  • Verifying the consideration paid to the relevant acquisition documentation, including but not limited to the prospectus, the scheme of arrangement, bank statements and other supporting documentation;
  • Recalculating the discount on acquisition and assessing the appropriateness of the discount allocation to the identifiable acquired assets;
  • On a sample basis, agreeing the acquisition costs to supporting documentation and assessing whether the acquisition costs were capitalised correctly in accordance with the accounting requirements of an asset acquisition; and
  • Considering the adequacy of the disclosures made by Management in relation to the acquisition with regards to the requirements of the applicable accounting standard. This included the disclosures relating to the significant judgments in respect of the treatment of the acquisition as an asset acquisition as opposed to a business combination.

Our observations

Based on the work performed we consider Management's accounting and disclosures in this area to be appropriate.

Revenue recognition – Occurrence and accuracy of rental income (Group)

Refer to Note 1 Accounting policies 'Revenue recognition – Property, rental and related income' and Note 4 Revenue 'Rental related income'.

Rental-related income, excluding car park income of £7 million (31 March 2024: £5.4 million), has a carrying value of £53 million at 31 March 2025 (31 March 2024: £46 million), comprising 67% (31 March 2024: 71%) of the Group's Total Revenue.

Rental income is a key driver of the Group's underlying European Public Real Estate Association ('EPRA') performance (refer to Note 12 of the financial statements which includes a reconciliation between IFRS and EPRA earnings). There is a risk that revenue in relation to the rental income may not be accurately recognised as well as the potential to record fictitious revenues.

As a result of the above factors, the occurrence and accuracy of rental-related income is considered to be a Key Audit Matter.

Our application of materiality and an overview
of the scope of our audit

The scope of our audit was influenced by our application of materiality. We set certain quantitative thresholds for materiality. These, together with qualitative considerations, helped us to determine the scope of our audit and the nature, timing and extent of our audit procedures on the individual financial statement line items and disclosures and in evaluating the effect of misstatements, both individually and on the financial statements as a whole. Based on our professional judgement, we determined materiality for the financial statements as a whole as follows:

Group materiality
Overall
materiality
£10.5m
How we
determined it
1% of Group total assets
Rationale for
benchmark
applied
We determined materiality based on total assets given the valuation of
investment properties is the key determinant of the Group's value.
Performance
materiality,
specific
materiality
and specific
performance
materiality
Performance materiality is set to reduce to an appropriately low level
the probability that the aggregate of uncorrected and undetected
misstatements in the financial statements exceeds materiality for the
financial statements as a whole.
Based on this being our first-year audit of the Group, together with
our risk assessments and our assessment of the Group's overall control
environment we set performance materiality at £5.3m, which represents
50% of overall materiality.
We have applied a lower specific materiality threshold of £1.4 million, which
represents 5% of the Group's 2025 EPRA earnings, for testing all balances
impacting EPRA earnings. We set specific performance materiality at £0.7m,
which represents 50% of the specific materiality.
In arriving at this materiality, we have regard to the fact that EPRA earnings
are a secondary financial indicator of the Group (refer to Note 12 of the
financial statements which includes a reconciliation between IFRS and EPRA
earnings). This materiality was used in the audit of operating activities.
Reporting
threshold
We agreed with the Audit Committee that we would report to them
misstatements identified during our audit above £0.3m as well as
misstatements below that amount that, in our view, warranted reporting
for qualitative reasons.
Parent company materiality
Overall materiality £9.3m
How we
determined it
1% of Parent Company total assets
Rationale for
benchmark applied
We determined materiality based on total assets given that NewRiver
REIT plc is a holding company in the Group and the investment in
subsidiaries is the key determinant of the Parent Company's value.
Performance
materiality
Performance materiality is set to reduce to an appropriately low level
the probability that the aggregate of uncorrected and undetected
misstatements in the financial statements exceeds materiality for the
financial statements as a whole.
Based on this being our first-year audit of the Parent Company,
together with our risk assessments and our assessment of the Parent
Company's overall control environment we set performance materiality
at £4.6m, which represents 50% of overall materiality.
Reporting threshold We agreed with the directors that we would report to them
misstatements identified during our audit above £0.3m as well as
misstatements below that amount that, in our view, warranted reporting
for qualitative reasons.

As part of designing our audit, we assessed the risk of material misstatement in the financial statements, whether due to fraud or error, and then designed and performed audit procedures responsive to those risks. In particular, we looked at where the Directors made subjective judgments, such as assumptions on significant accounting estimated.

We tailored the scope of our audit to ensure that we performed sufficient work to be able to give an opinion on the financial statements as a whole. We used the outputs of our risk assessment, our understanding of the Group and the Parent Company, their environment, controls, and critical business processes, to consider qualitative factors to ensure that we obtained sufficient coverage across all financial statement line items.

Our Group audit scope included an audit of the Group and the Parent Company financial statements. Based on our risk assessment, the components that are subjected to a full-scope audit account for 99% of the Group's consolidated total assets, 92% of the Group's consolidated revenue and 99% of the Group's consolidated expenses. These components, including the Parent Company, were audited by the Group audit team. For the residual components, we performed specific procedures, including analytical review, testing of consolidation journals and intercompany eliminations, to respond to any potential risks of material misstatement of the Group financial statements.

At the Parent Company level, the Group audit team also tested the consolidation process and carried out analytical procedures to confirm our conclusion that there were no significant risks of material misstatement of the aggregated financial information.

Strategic Report

& Appendix

Other information

The other information comprises the information included in the Annual Report and Accounts other than the financial statements and our auditor's report thereon. The directors are responsible for the other information. Our opinion on the financial statements does not cover the other information and, except to the extent otherwise explicitly stated in our report, we do not express any form of assurance conclusion thereon.

Our responsibility is to read the other information and, in doing so, consider whether the other information is materially inconsistent with the financial statements or our knowledge obtained in the course of audit or otherwise appears to be materially misstated. If we identify such material inconsistencies or apparent material misstatements, we are required to determine whether this gives rise to a material misstatement in the financial statements themselves. If, based on the work we have performed, we conclude that there is a material misstatement of this other information, we are required to report that fact.

We have nothing to report in this regard.

Opinions on other matters prescribed by the Companies Act 2006

In our opinion, the part of the Directors' remuneration report to be audited has been properly prepared in accordance with the Companies Act 2006.

In our opinion, based on the work undertaken in the course of the audit:

  • the information given in the Strategic report and the Directors' report for the financial year for which the financial statements are prepared is consistent with the financial statements and those reports have been prepared in accordance with applicable legal requirements;
  • the information about internal control and risk management systems in relation to financial reporting processes and about share capital structures, given in compliance with rules 7.2.5 and 7.2.6 in the Disclosure Guidance and Transparency Rules sourcebook made by the Financial Conduct Authority (the FCA Rules), is consistent with the financial statements and has been prepared in accordance with applicable legal requirements; and
  • information about the Parent Company's corporate governance code and practices and about its administrative, management and supervisory bodies and their committees complies with rules 7.2.2, 7.2.3 and 7.2.7 of the FCA Rules.

Matters on which we are required to report by exception

In light of the knowledge and understanding of the Group and the Parent Company and their environment obtained in the course of the audit, we have not identified material misstatements in the:

  • Strategic report or the Directors' report; or
  • information about internal control and risk management systems in relation to financial reporting processes and about share capital structures, given in compliance with rules 7.2.5 and 7.2.6 of the FCA Rules.

& Appendix

We have nothing to report in respect of the following matters in relation to which the Companies Act 2006 requires us to report to you if, in our opinion:

  • adequate accounting records have not been kept by the Parent Company, or returns adequate for our audit have not been received from branches not visited by us; or
  • the Parent Company financial statements and the part of the Directors' remuneration report to be audited are not in agreement with the accounting records and returns; or
  • certain disclosures of Directors' remuneration specified by law are not made; or
  • we have not received all the information and explanations we require for our audit; or
  • a corporate governance statement has not been prepared by the Parent Company.

Corporate governance statement

The Listing Rules require us to review the Directors' statement in relation to going concern, longer-term viability and that part of the Corporate Governance Statement relating to NewRiver REIT plc's compliance with the provisions of the UK Corporate Governance Statement specified for our review.

Based on the work undertaken as part of our audit, we have concluded that each of the following elements of the Corporate Governance Statement is materially consistent with the financial statements or our knowledge obtained during the audit:

  • Directors' statement with regards the appropriateness of adopting the going concern basis of accounting and any material uncertainties identified, set out on page 135;
  • Directors' explanation as to their assessment of the entity's prospects, the period this assessment covers and why the period is appropriate, set out on page 135;
  • Directors' statement on whether they have a reasonable expectation that the Group will be able to continue in operation and meets its liabilities, set out on page 135
  • Directors' statement on fair, balanced and understandable, set out on page 135;
  • Board's confirmation that it has carried out a robust assessment of the e-merging and principal risks, set out on page 101;
  • The section of the annual report that describes the review of effectiveness of risk management and internal control systems, set out on page 98; and;
  • The section describing the work of the audit committee, set out on page 131.

Responsibilities of Directors

As explained more fully in the Directors' responsibilities statement set out on page 160, the Directors are responsible for the preparation of the financial statements and for being satisfied that they give a true and fair view, and for such internal control as the Directors determine is necessary to enable the preparation of financial statements that are free from material misstatement, whether due to fraud or error.

In preparing the financial statements, the Directors are responsible for assessing the Group's and the Parent Company's ability to continue as a going concern, disclosing, as applicable, matters related to going concern and using the going concern basis of accounting unless the Directors either intend to liquidate the Group or the Parent Company or to cease operations, or have no realistic alternative but to do so.

Auditor's responsibilities for the audit of the financial statements

Our objectives are to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements as a whole are free from material misstatement, whether due to fraud or error, and to issue an auditor's report that includes our opinion. Reasonable assurance is a high level of assurance but is not a guarantee that an audit conducted in accordance with ISAs (UK) will always detect a material misstatement when it exists. Misstatements can arise from fraud or error and are considered material if, individually or in the aggregate, they could reasonably be expected to influence the economic decisions of users taken on the basis of these financial statements.

The extent to which our procedures are capable of detecting irregularities, including fraud is detailed below.

Irregularities, including fraud, are instances of non-compliance with laws and regulations. We design procedures in line with our responsibilities, outlined above, to detect material misstatements in respect of irregularities, including fraud.

Based on our understanding of the Group and the Parent Company and their industry, we considered that non-compliance with the following laws and regulations might have a material effect on the financial statements including compliance with Real Estate Investment Trust (REIT) requirements, RICS Valuation – Professional Standards, employment regulation and anti-money laundering regulation.

To help us identify instances of non-compliance with these laws and regulations, and in identifying and assessing the risks of material misstatement in respect to non-compliance, our procedures included, but were not limited to:

& Appendix

  • Gaining an understanding of the legal and regulatory framework applicable to the Group and the Parent Company, the industry in which they operate, and the structure of the Group, and considering the risk of acts by the Group and the Parent Company which were contrary to the applicable laws and regulations, including fraud;
  • Inquiring of the Directors, Management and, where appropriate, those charged with governance, as to whether the Group and the Parent Company are in compliance with laws and regulations, and discussing their policies and procedures regarding compliance with laws and regulations;
  • Inspecting correspondence with relevant licensing or regulatory authorities;
  • Reviewing minutes of meetings of Directors and those charged with governance in the year; and
  • Discussing amongst the engagement team the laws and regulations listed above, and remaining alert to any indications of non-compliance.

We also considered those laws and regulations that have a direct effect on the preparation of the financial statements, such as the Listing Rules, UK Corporate Governance Code, Disclosure Guidance and Transparency Rules, UK Tax legislation, pension legislation and the Companies Act 2006.

In addition, we evaluated the Directors' and Management's incentives and opportunities for fraudulent manipulation of the financial statements, including the risk of management override of controls, and determined that the principal risks related to posting manual journal entries to manipulate financial performance, management bias through judgments and assumptions in significant accounting estimates, in particular in relation to valuation of investment properties, acquisition of C&R, impairment of investment in subsidiaries, revenue recognition (which we pinpointed to the accuracy and occurrence assertions), and significant one-off or unusual transactions.

Our procedures in relation to fraud included but were not limited to:

  • Making enquiries of the Directors and Management on whether they had knowledge of any actual, suspected or alleged fraud;
  • Gaining an understanding of the internal controls established to mitigate risks related to fraud;
  • Discussing amongst the engagement team the risks of fraud;
  • Performing analytical procedures to identify any unusual or unexpected relationships that may indicate risks of material misstatement due to fraud;
  • Reading minutes of meetings of the Directors and those charged with governance;
  • Addressing the risks of fraud through management override of controls by performing journal entry testing; and
  • Assessing whether the judgments made in key sources of estimation uncertainty may be indicative of a potential management bias; and evaluating the business rationale of any significant transactions that are unusual or outside the normal scope of business.

Company Information

NewRiver REIT plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2025 2025 Governance Report Financial Statements ESG Data Sets 168 Glossary & Strategic Report

& Appendix

Auditor's report continued

The primary responsibility for the prevention and detection of irregularities, including fraud, rests with both those charged with governance and management. As with any audit, there remained a risk of non-detection of irregularities, as these may involve collusion, forgery, intentional omissions, misrepresentations or the override of internal controls.

The risks of material misstatement that had the greatest effect on our audit are discussed in the "Key audit matters" section of this report.

A further description of our responsibilities is available on the Financial Reporting Council's website at www.frc.org.uk/auditorsresponsibilities. This description forms part of our auditor's report.

Other matters which we are required to address

Following the recommendation of the Audit Committee, we were appointed by the shareholders on 5 August 2024 to audit the financial statements for the year ending 31 March 2025 and subsequent financial periods. The total uninterrupted engagement period is one year, covering the year ending 31 March 2025.

The non-audit services prohibited by the FRC's Ethical Standard were not provided to the Group or the Parent Company and we remain independent of the Group and the Parent Company in conducting our audit.

Our audit opinion is consistent with our additional report to the Audit Committee.

Use of the audit report

This report is made solely to the Company's members as a body in accordance with Chapter 3 of Part 16 of the Companies Act 2006. Our audit work has been undertaken so that we might state to the Company's members those matters we are required to state to them in an auditor's report and for no other purpose. To the fullest extent permitted by law, we do not accept or assume responsibility to anyone other than the Company and the Company's members as a body for our audit work, for this report, or for the opinions we have formed.

As required by the Financial Conduct Authority Disclosure Guidance and Transparency Rules, these financial statements will form part of the electronic reporting format prepared annual financial report filed on the National Storage Mechanism of the Financial Conduct Authority. This auditor's report provides no assurance over whether the annual financial report has been prepared using the correct electronic reporting format.

Nargis Shaheen Yunis (Senior Statutory Auditor)

for and on behalf of Forvis Mazars LLP Chartered Accountants and Statutory Auditor

30 Old Bailey London EC4M 7AU

Date: 16 June 2025

Company Information

Consolidated Statement of Comprehensive Income

For the year ended 31 March 2025

Year ended 31 March 2025 Year ended 31 March 2024
Notes Operating and
financing
2025
£m
Fair value
adjustments
2025
£m
Total 2025
£m
Operating and
financing 2024
£m
Fair value
adjustments
2024
£m
Total 2024
£m
Revenue 4 90.5 90.5 65.0 65.0
Property operating expenses* 5 (34.3) (34.3) (20.9) (20.9)
Net property income 56.2 56.2 44.1 44.1
Administrative expenses 6 (18.5) (18.5) (12.4) (12.4)
Other income 7 0.4 0.4
Share of profit from joint ventures 15 0.5 0.5
Share of profit from associates 16 0.2 (0.1) 0.1 0.3 0.3
Net property valuation movement 14 2.1 2.1 (13.9) (13.9)
Loss on disposal of joint venture 8 (2.3) (2.3)
Loss on disposal of investment properties 9 (0.9) (0.9) (3.8) (3.8)
Operating profit 37.0 2.0 39.0 26.8 (13.9) 12.9
Finance income 10 5.3 5.3 5.4 5.4
Finance costs 10 (17.6) (17.6) (15.3) (15.3)
Profit for the year before taxation 24.7 2.0 26.7 16.9 (13.9) 3.0
Taxation 11 (3.0) (3.0)
Profit for the year 24.7 (1.0) 23.7 16.9 (13.9) 3.0
Total comprehensive profit for the year 23.7 3.0
There are no items of other comprehensive income for the current or prior
year
Earnings per share
Basic (pence) 12 6.3 1.0
Diluted (pence) 12 6.3 1.0

* Included in property operating expenses is an expected credit loss reversal of £0.3 million (2024: £nil) relating to trade receivables.

The notes on pages 173 to 196 form an integral part of these financial statements.

Consolidated Balance Sheet

As at 31 March 2025

Notes 2025
£m
2024
£m
Non-current assets
Investment properties 14 939.0 608.7
Right of use asset 22 18.1 0.7
Investments in joint ventures 15 0.1
Investments in associates 16 5.3 5.6
Property, plant and equipment 3.8 0.3
Goodwill 17 3.6
Intangible asset 17 0.9
Total non-current assets 970.7 615.4
Current assets
Trade and other receivables 18 22.1 11.4
Cash and cash equivalents 19 61.3 132.8
Total current assets 83.4 144.2
Total assets 1,054.1 759.6
Equity and liabilities
Current liabilities
Trade and other payables 20 53.4 26.3
Lease liability 22 1.8 0.4
Total current liabilities 55.2 26.7
Non-current liabilities
Lease liability 22 71.8 75.2
Borrowings 21 437.0 296.6
Total non-current liabilities 508.8 371.8
Net assets 490.1 361.1
2025 2024
Notes £m £m
Equity
Share capital 23 4.7 3.1
Share premium 23 53.9 4.0
Merger reserve 23 74.3 (2.3)
Investment in own shares 23 (1.4) (3.0)
Retained earnings 23 358.6 359.3
Total equity 490.1 361.1
Net Asset Value (NAV) per share (pence)
Basic 12 103p 116p
Diluted 12 102p 115p
EPRA NTA 12 102p 115p

& Appendix

The notes on pages 173 to 196 form an integral part of these financial statements.

The financial statements on pages 169 to 172 were approved by the Board of Directors on 16 June 2025 and were signed on its behalf by:

Allan Lockhart

Chief Executive Officer

Registered number: 10221027

Will Hobman

Chief Financial Officer

Company Information

NewRiver REIT plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2025 2025 Governance Report Financial Statements ESG Data Sets 171 Glossary & Strategic Report

& Appendix

Consolidated Cash Flow Statement

For the year ended 31 March 2025

Notes 2025
£m
2024
£m
Cash flows from operating activities
Profit for the year before taxation 26.7 3.0
Adjustments for:
Loss on disposal of investment property 9 0.9 3.8
Net valuation movement 14 (2.1) 13.9
Net valuation movement in associates 16 0.1
Share of profit from joint ventures (0.5)
Share of profit from associates 16 (0.2) (0.3)
Loss on disposal of joint venture 2.3
Net interest expense 10 12.3 9.9
Rent free lease incentives (0.6) 0.1
Movement in expected credit loss 5 (0.3)
Capitalisation of legal and letting fees (0.3) (0.3)
Amortisation of intangible assets 0.3
Depreciation on property plant and equipment 1.1 0.3
Share-based payment expense 1.2 1.5
Cash generated from operations before changes in working capital 39.1 33.7
Notes 2025
£m
2024
£m
Changes in working capital
Decrease in trade and other receivables 1.6 1.1
Decrease in payables and other financial liabilities (1.0) (3.1)
Cash generated from operations 39.7 31.7
Interest paid (17.5) (15.1)
Interest income 5.8 5.0
Dividends received from joint ventures 0.9
Dividends received from associates 16 0.4 0.2
Net cash generated from operating activities 28.4 22.7
Cash flows from investing activities
Return of investment from associate (0.1)
Disposal proceeds from joint venture 0.1 21.0
Disposal of investment properties 3.0 8.7
Capital expenditure 14 (9.7) (6.1)
Cash paid for Capital & Regional acquisition, including
transaction costs 17 (81.8)
Cash acquired Capital & Regional acquisition 17 25.8
Acquisition of subsidiaries, net of cash acquired (5.1)
Net cash (used in) / generated from investing activities (67.8) 23.6
Cash flows from financing activities
Repayment of principal portion of lease liability (1.0) (0.4)
Purchase of own shares (3.0)
Loan repayment 25 (58.0)
Equity placing and retail offer, net of issue costs 23 48.7
Dividends paid – ordinary (21.8) (18.7)
Net cash used in financing activities (32.1) (22.1)
Cash and cash equivalents at beginning of the year 132.8 108.6
Net (decrease) / increase in cash and cash equivalents (71.5) 24.2
Cash and cash equivalents at 31 March 61.3 132.8

The notes on pages 173 to 196 form an integral part of these financial statements.

Company Information

Company Information

Consolidated Statement Of Changes In Equity

For the year ended 31 March 2025

Investment in Retained
Share capital Share premium Merger reserve own shares earnings Total
Notes £m £m £m £m £m £m
As at 1 April 2023 3.1 2.4 (2.3) 375.4 378.6
Profit for the year after taxation 3.0 3.0
Total comprehensive profit for the year after taxation 3.0 3.0
Transactions with equity holders
Issue of new shares 1.6 1.6
Purchase of own shares 23 (3.0) (3.0)
Share-based payments 24 1.2 1.2
Dividends paid 13 (20.3) (20.3)
As at 31 March 2024 3.1 4.0 (2.3) (3.0) 359.3 361.1
Profit for the year after taxation 23.7 23.7
Total comprehensive profit for the year after taxation 23.7 23.7
Transactions with equity holders
Issue of new shares 1.8 1.8
Equity placing and retail offer 23 0.6 48.1 48.7
Share-based payments 24 1.6 (0.4) 1.2
Consideration shares 23 1.0 76.6 77.6
Dividends paid 13 (24.0) (24.0)
As at 31 March 2025 4.7 53.9 74.3 (1.4) 358.6 490.1

The notes on pages 173 to 196 form an integral part of these financial statements.

Strategic Report

1. Accounting policies

General information

NewRiver REIT plc (the 'Company') and its subsidiaries (together the 'Group') is a property investment group specialising in commercial real estate in the UK. The Company is registered and domiciled in the UK and the registered office of the Company is 89 Whitfield Street, London, W1T 4DE.

Summary of material accounting policies

The principal accounting policies applied in the preparation of these consolidated financial statements are set out below. These policies have been consistently applied to all years presented.

Basis of preparation

These consolidated financial statements have been prepared on the going concern basis, in accordance with the Disclosure and Transparency Rules of the Financial Conduct Authority, in accordance with UK-adopted International Accounting Standards and within the requirements of the Companies Act 2006.

Going concern

The Group's going concern assessment considers the Group's principal risks, budgets and forecasts and is dependent on a number of factors, including cashflow and liquidity, continued access to borrowing facilities and the ability to continue to operate the Group's debt structure within its financial covenants. Further details are provided in the Viability Statement on page 109. The Group's balance sheet is predominantly unsecured, which means that the majority of its debt is not secured against any of its property assets – a structure that affords significant operational flexibility.

The principal debt currently drawn by the Group is the £300 million unsecured corporate bond which matures in March 2028. This bond has financial covenants that the Group is required to comply with including an LTV covenant of less than 65% and a 12 month historical interest cover ratio of more than 1.5x.

The only other debt currently drawn by the Group is the single facility that we retained following the acquisition of Capital & Regional in December 2024, the £140 million "Mall" facility secured against three of the assets acquired as part of the Capital & Regional transaction with a coupon of 3.45% and which matures in January 2027. As available cash and liquidity both currently and throughout the assessment period (see below) is such that this secured loan can either be repaid in full and/or any requisite cure funded at any point, our Going Concern assessment focuses on the covenants attached to the unsecured corporate bond outlined above.

The going concern assessment is based on an at least 12 month outlook from the date of the approval of these financial statements, using the Group's Board approved budget for FY26, flexed to create a reasonable worst case scenario, which includes the key assumptions listed below.

• Capital values to decrease a further 5% during FY26 and remain flat throughout the remainder of the forecast horizon, in contrast to the modest growth of +0.6% across the portfolio in FY25, but importantly including +0.6% growth in our Core Shopping Centres and +1.7% in our Retail Parks in the six months to 31 March 2025, which represent 94% of our Portfolio looking forwards;

& Appendix

Glossary & Company Information

  • A 15% reduction in net income. This reflects a significant downside given rent collection rates have now stabilised at 98% for FY25 and 99% for FY24 rental billings, back to pre-Covid levels, and occupancy rates have been maintained at a high 96%;
  • No disposal proceeds assumed throughout the forecast period, despite the completion of an average of c.£46 million of disposals in each of the five years ending 31 March 2025, including the disposal of the Abbey Centre in Newtownabbey, which was sold post balance sheet for £59 million, in-line with March 2025 valuation, reducing LTV on a proforma basis to c.38% and creating further headroom not factored into our assessment.

Under this scenario, the Group is forecast to maintain sufficient cash and liquidity resources and remain compliant with its financial covenants over the going concern period. Further stress testing was performed on this scenario which demonstrated that the Group could absorb a further valuation decline of 27% or a further 54% reduction in annual net rental income before breaching applicable debt covenant levels referenced above. The Group maintains sufficient cash and liquidity reserves to continue in operation and pay its liabilities as they fall due throughout the going concern assessment period and as such the Directors conclude a going concern basis of preparation is appropriate.

Cash flow statement

The Group has reported the cash flows from operating activities using the indirect method. The acquisition of properties are presented within investing cash flows and interest paid and interest received is presented within operating cash flows because this most appropriately reflects the Group's business activities.

Preparation of the consolidated financial statements

The consolidated financial statements incorporate the financial statements of the Company and its subsidiaries controlled by the Company, made up to 31 March each year. Control is achieved when the Company is exposed, or has rights, to variable returns from its involvement with the entity and has the ability to affect those returns through its power over the investee.

The consolidated financial statements account for interest in joint ventures and associates using the equity method of accounting per IFRS 11 and IAS 28 respectively. The financial statements for the year ended 31 March 2025 have been prepared on the historical cost basis, except for the revaluation of investment properties.

New accounting policies

Business Combinations

The Group applies the acquisition method to account for business combinations. The cost of the acquisition is measured at the aggregate of the fair values, at the date of completion, of assets given, liabilities incurred or assumed, and equity instruments issued by the Group in exchange for control of the acquired. The acquiree's identifiable assets, liabilities and contingent liabilities that meet the conditions for recognition under IFRS are recognised at their fair value at the acquisition.

Any excess of the purchase price of business combinations over the fair value of the assets, liabilities and contingent liabilities acquired is recognised as goodwill. This is recognised as an asset and is reviewed for impairment at least annually. Any impairment is recognised immediately in the statement of comprehensive income. Where the fair value of the consideration is less than the fair value of the identifiable assets and liabilities then the difference is recognised as a bargain purchase in the statement of comprehensive income.

Under the acquisition accounting method, the identifiable assets, liabilities and contingent liabilities acquired are measured at fair value at the acquisition date. The consideration transferred is measured at fair value and includes the fair value of any contingent consideration. Where properties are acquired through corporate acquisitions, each transaction is considered by management in light of the substance of the acquisition to determine whether the acquisition is a business combination or an asset acquisition.

Asset acquisitions

Management consider whether each acquisition constitutes a business combination or an asset acquisition and have chosen to apply the optional concentration test that, if met, eliminates the need for further assessment. Management have chosen to take the optional concentration test which considers whether substantially all of the fair value of the gross assets acquired is concentrated in a single asset group. The acquired assets and assumed liabilities have been recognised in accordance with the relevant accounting requirements. The costs of the acquisition are allocated to identifiable assets and liabilities based on their relative fair values at the purchase date. Directly attributable acquisition related costs are capitalised as part of the cost of the assets acquired. These costs are presented as part of financing cash flows in the cast flow statement.

New standards and amendments

The Group has adopted the following amendments for the first time in the year ended 31 March 2025:

Amendments

  • Amendment to IAS 1 Non-current liabilities with covenants
  • Amendment to IFRS 16 Leases on sale and leaseback
  • Amendment to IAS 7 and IFRS 7 Supplier finance

Adopting these amendments has not impacted amounts recognised in prior periods or are expected to have a material impact on the current period or future periods based on the Group's current strategy. The accounting policies used are otherwise consistent with those contained in the Group's previous Annual Report and Accounts for the year ended 31 March 2024, unless otherwise stated.

Standards and amendments issued but not yet effective

A number of new amendments have been issued but are not yet effective for the current accounting period.

Effective after 1 April 2025;

  • Amendments to IAS 21 Lack of Exchangeability
  • Amendment to IFRS 9 and IFRS 7 Classification and Measurement of Financial Instruments
  • Annual improvements to IFRS Volume 11
  • Amendment to IFRS 9 and IFRS 7 Contracts Referencing Nature-dependent Electricity
  • IFRS 18, 'Presentation and Disclosure in Financial Statements'
  • IFRS 19, 'Subsidiaries without Public Accountability: Disclosures'

No material impact is expected upon the adoption of these standards.

Revenue recognition

Property, rental and related income

Property, rental and related income from fixed and minimum guaranteed rent reviews is recognised on a straight-line basis over the entire lease term. Where such rental income is recognised ahead of the related cash flow, an adjustment is made to ensure the carrying value of the related property including the accrued rent does not exceed the external valuation. Initial direct costs incurred in negotiating and arranging a new lease are amortised on a straight-line basis over the period from the date of lease commencement to the expiry date of the lease.

Where a rent-free period is included in a lease, this is recognised over the lease term, on a straightline basis, as a reduction of rental income.

Where a lease incentive payment or surrender premiums are paid to enhance the value of a property, these are amortised on a straight-line basis over the period from the date of lease commencement to the expiry date of the lease as a reduction of rental income. It is management's policy to recognise all material lease incentives and lease incentives greater than six months. Upon receipt of a surrender premium for the early determination of a lease, the profit, net of dilapidations and non-recoverable outgoings relating to the lease concerned, is accounted for from the effective date of the modification, being the date at which both parties agree to the modification, considering any prepaid or accrued lease payments relating to the original lease as part of the lease payments for the new lease.

Service charge income is recognised in accordance with IFRS 15. This income stream is recognised in the period which it is earnt and when performance obligations are satisfied e.g. when the service charges are incurred.

IFRS 15 is based on the principle that revenue is recognised when control passes to a customer. The majority of the Group's income is from tenant leases and is therefore outside of the scope of IFRS 15. However, the standard applies to service charge income. Under IFRS 15, the Group needs to consider the agent versus principal guidance. The Group is principal in the transaction if they control the specified goods or services before they are transferred to the customer. In the provision of service charge, the Group has deemed itself to be principal and therefore the consolidated statement of comprehensive income and the consolidated balance sheet reflect service charge income, expenses, trade and other receivables and trade and other payables.

Asset management fees

Management fees are recognised in the consolidated statement of comprehensive income as the services are delivered and performance obligations met. The Group assesses whether the individual elements of service in the agreement are separate performance obligations. Asset management fees are recognised over the period the respective services are provided.

Snozone income

Snozone income is recognised in accordance with IFRS 15. Snozone income is recognised at the point in time when the customer has completed the use of the skiing services provided.

Car park income

Car park income is recognised in accordance with IFRS 15. Car park income is recognised at the point in time when the customer has completed use of their car parking space.

Promote payments

The Group is contractually entitled to receive a promote payment should the returns from a joint venture or associate to the joint venture or associate partner exceed a certain internal rate of return. This payment is only receivable by the Group on disposal of underlying properties held by the joint venture or associate or other termination events. Any entitlements under these arrangements are only accrued for in the financial statements once the Group believes the above performance conditions have been met and there is no risk of the revenue reversing.

IFRS 15

All revenue streams under IFRS 15 allocate transaction price against performance obligations as they are satisfied. With the exception of asset management fees, IFRS 15 revenue streams do not carry variable consideration. There are no significant judgements in applying IFRS 15. There are no significant payment terms on any of the IFRS 15 revenue streams.

Service charge expense

Service charge expenses are recognised in the period in which they are incurred.

Finance income and costs

Finance income and costs excluding fair value derivative movements, are recognised using the effective interest rate method. The effective interest rate method is a method of calculating the amortised cost of a financial asset or financial liability and of allocating the interest income or interest expense over the relevant period. The effective interest rate is the rate that discounts estimated future cash payments or receipts throughout the expected life of the financial instrument, or a shorter period where appropriate, to the net carrying amount of the financial asset or financial liability.

Taxation

Income tax

The current income tax charge is calculated on the basis of the tax laws enacted or substantively enacted at the date of the balance sheet. Tax is recognised in the consolidated statement of comprehensive income.

Deferred tax

Any deferred tax provided is based on the expected manner of realisation or settlement of the carrying amount of assets and liabilities, using tax rates that are expected to apply in the period when the liability is settled or the asset is realised. A deferred tax asset is recognised only to the extent that it is probable that future taxable profits will be available against which the asset can be utilised.

Investment properties

These properties include completed properties that are generating rent or are available for rent. Investment properties comprise freehold and leasehold properties and are first measured at cost (including transaction costs), then revalued to market value at each reporting date by independent professional valuers. Leasehold properties are accounted for as right-of-use assets within investment property under IFRS 16, see Leases accounting policy. Valuation gains and losses in a period are taken to the consolidated statement of comprehensive income. As the Group uses the fair value model, as per IAS 40 Investment Properties, no depreciation is provided. An asset will be classified as held for sale within investment properties, in line with IFRS 5 Non-Current Assets Held for Sale and Discontinued Operations, where the asset is available for immediate sale in its present condition and the sale is highly probable.

Property, plant and equipment

Fixtures and equipment are stated at cost less accumulated depreciation and any recognised impairment loss. Depreciation is recognised over the useful lives of the equipment, using the straight-line method at a rate of between 10% to 25% depending on the useful life.

Depreciation is recognised so as to write off the cost or valuation of assets less their residual values over their useful lives on the following bases:

  • Fixtures and fittings over five years
  • Office equipment over three years

PPE is stated at cost net of depreciation and any provision for impairment. Cost includes the original purchase price of the asset and the costs attributable to bringing the asset to its working condition for its intended use. Depreciation is provided so as to write off the cost of the assets, less their estimated residual values, on a straight-line basis over their expected useful lives, which are given below as a general rule, however as part of the day to day running of the business there may be some assets which fall outside of this, these assets are treated the same and are always depreciated on a straight-line basis over their expected useful lives.

  • Snow equipment over one to five years
  • Computer equipment over two to five years
  • Office equipment over two to five years
  • Operations equipment over two to five years
  • Plant over twenty years

The expected useful lives and depreciation methods are reviewed annually at each reporting date. Subsequent costs incurred after the initial recognition of PPE are capitalised if they meet the recognition criteria. Such costs include expenditures that increase the future economic benefits expected to be obtained from the use of the asset beyond its originally assessed standard of performance. Upon disposal of PPE, any resulting gain or loss is calculated as the difference between the net disposal proceeds and the carrying amount of the asset in the financial statements at the date of disposal. Gains or losses on disposals are recognised in profit or loss in the period in which the disposal occurs.

Joint ventures

Interests in joint ventures are accounted for using the equity method of accounting. The Group's joint ventures are entities over which the Group has joint control with a partner. Investments in joint ventures are carried in the consolidated balance sheet at cost as adjusted by post-acquisition changes in the Group's share of the net assets of the joint venture, less any impairment or share of income adjusted for dividends. In assessing whether a particular entity is controlled, the Group considers all of the contractual terms of the arrangement, whether it has the power to govern the financial and operating policies of the joint venture so as to obtain benefits from its activities, and the existence of any legal disputes or challenges to this joint control in order to conclude whether the Group jointly controls the joint venture.

Associates

Interests in associates are accounted for using the equity method of accounting. The Group's associates are entities over which the Group has significant influence with a partner. Investments in associates are carried in the consolidated balance sheet at cost as adjusted by post-acquisition changes in the Group's share of the net assets of the associates, less any impairment or share of income adjusted for dividends. In assessing whether a particular entity is controlled or has significant influence, the Group considers all of the contractual terms of the arrangement, whether it has the power to govern the financial and operating policies of the associate so as to obtain benefits from its activities.

Leases – as a lessee

At inception, the Group assesses whether a contract is or contains a lease. This assessment involves the exercise of judgement about whether the Group obtains substantially all the economic benefits from the use of that asset, and whether the Group has the right to direct the use of the asset.

The Group recognises a right-of-use ("ROU") asset and the lease liability at the commencement date of the lease. The ROU asset is initially measured based on the present value of lease payments, plus initial direct costs and the cost of obligations to restore the asset, less any incentives received.

Lease payments generally include fixed payments and variable payments that depend on an index (such as an inflation index).

Each lease payment is allocated between the liability and finance cost. The lease payments are discounted using the interest rate implicit in the lease if that rate can be readily determined or if not, the incremental borrowing rate is used. The finance cost is charged to profit or loss over the lease period so as to produce a constant rate of interest on the remaining balance of the liability for each period.

The ROU asset is depreciated over the shorter of the lease term or the useful life of the underlying asset. The ROU asset is subject to testing for impairment if there is an indicator of impairment. ROU assets that are not classified as investment properties are disclosed on the face of the consolidated balance sheet on their own line, and the lease liability included in the headings current and non-current liabilities on the consolidated balance sheet.

The Group remeasures the lease liability (and makes a corresponding adjustment to the related right-of-use asset) whenever:

  • The lease term has changed or there is a significant event or change in circumstances resulting in a change in the assessment of exercise of a purchase option, in which case the lease liability is remeasured by discounting the revised lease payments using a revised discount rate.
  • The lease payments change due to changes in an index or rate or a change in expected payment under a guaranteed residual value, in which cases the lease liability is remeasured by discounting the revised lease payments using an unchanged discount rate (unless the lease payments change is due to a change in a floating interest rate, in which case a revised discount rate is used). When the consideration for a lease is changed, that modification is not accounted for as a separate lease, but the lease liability is remeasured discounted using the revised lease payments and revised discount rate.

Where the ROU asset relates to leases of land or property that meets the definition of investment property under IAS 40 it has been disclosed within the investment property balance. After initial recognition, IAS 40 requires the amount of the recognised lease liability, calculated in accordance with IFRS 16, to be added back to the amount determined under the net valuation model, to arrive at the carrying amount of the investment property under the fair value model. Differences between the ROU asset and associated lease liability are taken to the consolidated statement of comprehensive income.

The Group has elected not to recognise ROU assets and liabilities for leases where the total lease term is less than or equal to 12 months, or for low value leases of less than £3,000. The payments for such leases are recognised in the consolidated statement of comprehensive income on a straight-line basis over the lease term.

Leases – as a lessor

The Group accounts for all leases as operating leases, please see revenue recognition for further details.

Financial instruments

Financial assets

The Group classifies its financial assets as fair value through profit or loss or amortised cost, depending on the purpose for which the asset was acquired and based on the business model test. Financial assets carried at amortised cost include tenant receivables which arise from the provision of goods and services to customers. These are initially recognised at fair value plus transaction costs that are directly attributable to their acquisition or issue and are subsequently carried at amortised cost, less provision for impairment. Impairment provisions for receivables are recognised based on the simplified approach within IFRS 9 using a provision matrix in the determination of the lifetime expected credit losses. The probability of tenant default and subsequent non-payment of the receivable is assessed. If it is determined that the receivable will not be collectable, the gross carrying value of the asset is written off against the associated provision. If in a subsequent year the amount of the impairment loss decreased and the decrease can be related objectively to an event occurring after the impairment was recognised, the previously recognised impairment loss is reversed to the extent that the carrying value of the asset does not exceed its amortised costs at the reversal date. The Group's financial assets measured at amortised cost comprise trade and other receivables and cash and cash equivalents.

Financial assets are derecognised only when the contractual rights to the cash flows from the financial asset expire or the Group transfers substantially all risks and rewards of ownership.

Cash and cash equivalents

Cash and cash equivalents include cash on hand, cash in transit, deposits held on call with financial institutions, other short-term, highly liquid investments with original maturities of three months or less that are readily convertible into known amounts of cash and which are subject to an insignificant risk of change in value.

Financial liabilities

The Group classifies its financial liabilities at amortised cost. A financial liability is derecognised when the obligation under the liability is discharged or cancelled or expires.

All loans and borrowings are classified as other liabilities. Initial recognition is at fair value less directly attributable transaction costs. After initial recognition, interest bearing loans and borrowings are subsequently measured at amortised costs using the effective interest method.

Financial liabilities included in trade and other payables are recognised initially at fair value and subsequently at amortised cost.

The financial instruments classified as financial liabilities at fair value through profit or loss include interest rate swap and cap arrangements. Recognition of the derivative financial instruments takes place when the contracts are entered into. They are recognised at fair value and transaction costs are included directly in finance costs.

The fair value of a non-interest bearing liability is its discounted repayment amount. If the due date of the liability is less than one year, discounting is omitted.

Value added tax

Revenues, expenses and assets are recognised net of the amount of value added tax except:

Where the value added tax incurred on a purchase of assets or services is not recoverable from the taxation authority, in which case the value added tax is recognised as part of the cost of acquisition of the asset or as part of the expense item as applicable; and receivables and payables that are stated with the amount of value added tax included. The net amount of value added tax recoverable from, or payable to, the taxation authority is included as part of receivables or payables in the consolidated balance sheet.

Share capital

Shares are classified as equity when there is no obligation to transfer cash or other assets. The cost of issuing share capital is recognised directly in equity against the proceeds from issuing the shares.

Share-based payments

The cost of equity settled transactions is measured with reference to the fair value at the date at which they were granted. Where vesting performance conditions are non-market based, the fair value excludes the effect of these vesting conditions and an estimate is made at each year end date of the number of instruments expected to vest. The fair value is recognised over the vesting period in the consolidated statement of comprehensive income, with a corresponding increase in equity. Any change to the number of instruments with non-market vesting conditions expected to vest is recognised in the consolidated statement of comprehensive income for that period.

Employee Benefit Trust

The Group operates an Employee Benefit Trust for the exclusive benefit of the Group's employees. The investment in the Company's shares held by the trust is recognised at cost and deducted from equity. No gain or loss is recognised in the consolidated statement of comprehensive income on the purchase, sale, issue or cancellation of the shares held by the trust.

Dividends

Dividends to the Company's shareholders are recognised when they become legally payable. In the case of interim dividends, this is when paid. In the case of final dividends, this is when approved by equity holders.

Foreign currency

Foreign currency transactions

Transactions in foreign currencies are translated into sterling at exchange rates approximating to the exchange rate ruling at the date of the transaction. Monetary assets and liabilities denominated in foreign currencies at the balance sheet date are translated to sterling at the exchange rate ruling at that date and differences arising on translation are recognised in the income statement.

Financial statements of foreign operations

The assets and liabilities of foreign operations, including goodwill and fair value adjustments arising on consolidation, are translated into sterling at the exchange rates ruling at the balance sheet date. The operating income and expenses of foreign operations are translated into sterling at the average exchange rates for the year. Significant transactions, such as property sales, are translated at the foreign exchange rate ruling at the date of each transaction. The principal exchange rate used to translate foreign currency denominated amounts in the balance sheet is the rate at the end of the year: £1 = €1.1951 (2024: No foreign exchange transactions). The principal exchange rate used for the income statement is the average rate since the acquisition of Capital & Regional on 10 December 2024: £1 = €1.1988 (2024: No foreign exchange transactions). Foreign exchange gains and losses from monetary assets and liabilities denominated in foreign currencies are recognised in profit or loss at each reporting date. Non-monetary items are translated at the exchange rate prevailing at the transaction date, with subsequent changes in exchange rates not affecting gains or losses

2. Critical accounting judgements and estimates

The preparation of financial statements requires management to make estimates and judgements affecting the reported amounts of assets and liabilities, of revenues and expenses, and of gains and losses. The key assumptions concerning the future, and other key sources of estimation uncertainty at the end of the reporting period, that have a significant risk of causing a material adjustment to the carrying amounts of assets and liabilities within the next financial year, are discussed below. Estimates and judgements are continually evaluated and are based on historical experience as adjusted for current market conditions and other factors.

Significant judgements

REIT Status

NewRiver is a Real Estate Investment Trust (REIT) and does not pay tax on its property income or gains on property sales, provided that at least 90% of the Group's property income is distributed as a dividend to shareholders, which becomes taxable in their hands. In addition, the Group has to meet certain conditions such as ensuring the property rental business represents more than 75% of total profits and assets. Any potential or proposed changes to the REIT legislation are monitored and discussed with HMRC. It is the Directors judgement that the Group has met the REIT conditions in the year.

Capital & Regional Acquisition

Management consider whether each acquisition constitutes a business combination or an asset acquisition in relation to the acquisition of Capital & Regional in December 2024. Management have chosen to take the optional concentration test to assess whether substantially all of the fair value of the gross assets acquired is concentrated in a single asset group and have determined that the test is met. Therefore the acquired assets and assumed liabilities have been recognised in accordance with the relevant accounting requirements rather than IFRS 3 Business Combinations. The costs of the acquisition are allocated to identifiable assets and liabilities based on their relative fair values at the purchase date. Directly attributable acquisition related costs are capitalised as part of the cost of the assets acquired. These costs are presented as part of financing cash flows in the cast flow statement.

Sources of estimation uncertainty

Investment property

The Group's investment properties are stated at fair value. The assumptions and estimates used to value the properties are detailed in note 14. Small changes in the key estimates, such as yield and the estimated rental value, can have a significant impact on the valuation of the investment properties, and therefore a significant impact on the consolidated balance sheet and key performance measures such as Net Tangible Assets per share.

Rents and ERVs have a direct relationship to valuation, while yield has an inverse relationship. There are interrelationships between all these unobservable inputs as they are determined by market conditions. The existence of an increase in more than one unobservable input could be to magnify the impact on the valuation, see note 14 for sensitivity analysis.

The estimated fair value may differ from the price at which the Group's assets could be sold. Actual realisation of net assets could differ from the valuation used in these financial statements, and the difference could be significant.

Significant transactions:

Management must assess whether the acquisition of property through the purchase of a corporate vehicle should be accounted for as an asset purchase or a business combination under IFRS 3. There is a risk that an inappropriate approach could lead to a misstatement in the financial statements. Management applied judgement to two corporate acquisitions made during the year to 31 March 2025 and determined the following:

• Ellandi

On 3 July 2024, the Group acquired Ellandi Management Limited ('Ellandi'), an asset and development management business focused on UK retail and regeneration (see note 17). It was determined that a business had been acquired and as such the transaction would be accounted for as a business combination under IFRS 3. Business combinations are accounted for using the acquisition method and any excess of the purchase consideration over the fair value of the net assets acquired is recognised as goodwill and if the fair value of the net asset assets is deemed to be higher than the purchase consideration then this is recognised as a bargain purchase.

• Capital & Regional

On 10 December 2024, the Group acquired Capital & Regional plc. it was determined by management that this was an asset acquisition rather than a business combination, see note 17.

3. Segmental reporting

In the prior year (year ended 31 March 2024) the Group had one identifiable segment, owned retail. The Group acquired Ellandi in July 2024 in order to enhance the capital partnerships division of the business. The acquisition added 16 asset management mandates taking the Group's total to 39 asset management mandates. Following on from the acquisition, the Group identified two operating segments, being Owned Retail and Capital Partnerships. The Board reviews the results of these two segments separately and the prior period comparative has been provided under the new basis below. The Owned Retail investments comprise shopping centres, retail parks and high street stores and Capital Partnerships comprise of income earnt through asset management mandates. The Group acquired Capital & Regional plc in December 2024 and identified a new operating segment, Snozone. Although Snozone has one site in Spain, the majority of the Group's operations are in the UK and therefore no geographical segments have been identified.

The relevant revenue and expenses used by the Board are set out below. The results include the Group's share of assets and results from properties held in associates.

The comparative information for the year ended 31 March 2024 have been restated to align with the basis of presentation for the year ended 31 March 2025.

Year ended 31 March 2025
Segment result Owned Retail
£m
Capital
Partnerships
£m
Snozone
£m
Group
£m
Adjustments
£m
IFRS
(Operating
and financing)
£m
Revenue 76.7 2.9 79.6 10.9 90.5
Property operating costs (29.2) (29.2) (5.1) (34.3)
Net property income 47.5 2.9 50.4 5.8 56.2
Administrative expenses (11.6) (11.6) (6.9) (18.5)
Other income 3.7 3.7 (3.7)
Operating profit 35.9 2.9 3.7 42.5 (4.8) 37.7
Net finance costs (11.9) (11.9) (0.4) (12.3)
Taxation (0.1) (0.1) 0.1
Segment result
(Underlying Funds
From Operations)
23.9 2.9 3.7 30.5

For an explanation of the nature of the adjustments in 2025 please refer to page 53.

Year ended 31 March 2024
Segment result Owned Retail
£m
Capital
Partnerships
£m
Snozone
£m
Group
£m
Adjustments
£m
IFRS
(Operating and
financing)
£m
Revenue 64.0 2.5 66.5 (1.5) 65.0
Property operating costs (20.9) (20.9) (20.9)
Net property income 43.1 2.5 45.6 (1.5) 44.1
Administrative expenses (11.0) (11.0) (1.4) (12.4)
Other income 0.4 0.4 0.4
Operating profit 32.5 2.5 35.0 (2.9) 32.1
Net finance costs (10.6) (10.6) 0.7 (9.9)
Segment result
(Underlying Funds
From Operations) 21.9 2.5 24.4

* Adjustments to remove JV & Associates figures and non-cash and non-recurring items, principally sharebased payment charge £(1.5) million and revaluation of derivatives £0.1 million.

Revenue and other income by country

2025
£m
2024
£m
UK 88.1 65.0
Spain 2.4
Revenue 90.5 65.0

Total non-current assets by country

2025
£m
2024
£m
UK 968.2 615.4
Spain 1.5
Non-current assets 969.7 615.4

4. Revenue

2025
£m
2024
£m
Property rental and related income1 59.2 50.7
Surrender premiums and commissions 0.6 0.7
Rental related income 59.8 51.4
Asset management fees2 6.2 2.5
Service charge income 16.1 11.1
Snozone income 8.4
Revenue 90.5 65.0
  1. Included within property rental and related income is car park income of £7.0 million (2024: £5.4 million) which falls under the scope of IFRS 15. The remainder of the income is recognised by IFRS 16

  2. Asset management fees include £0.2 million non-recurring fee income included in costs to unlock in relation to unlocking expected net cost synergies following the acquisition of Capital & Regional e.g. redundancy and head office costs

Asset management fees and service charge income which represents the flow through costs of the day-to-day maintenance of shopping centres fall under the scope of IFRS 15.

5. Property operating expenses

2025
£m
2024
£m
21.7 15.1
1.8 1.7
(0.3)
5.9 4.1
5.2
34.3 20.9

6. Administrative expenses

2025
£m
2024
£m
Wages and salaries 8.9 5.6
Social security costs 1.2 0.9
Other pension costs 0.3 0.1
Staff costs 10.4 6.6
Depreciation1 0.5 0.3
Share-based payments 1.5 1.5
Exceptional costs2 0.7
Amortisation of intangibles3 0.3
Costs to unlock4 1.3
Other administrative expenses 3.8 4.0
Administrative expenses 18.5 12.4
  1. Depreciation is inclusive of £0.2 million (2024: £0.2 million) of right of use asset depreciation

  2. Exceptional costs comprise expenses relating to the acquisition of Ellandi

  3. Amortisation of intangibles relates to the amortisation of the intangible asset recognised on the acquisition of Ellandi

  4. Costs to unlock comprise net costs in relation to unlocking expected net cost synergies following the acquisition of Capital & Regional

Net administrative expenses ratio is calculated as follows:

2025
£m
2024
£m
Administrative expenses 18.5 12.4
Adjust for:
Asset management fees (6.2) (2.5)
Share of joint ventures' and associates administrative expenses 0.1
Share based payments (1.5) (1.5)
Exceptional costs1 (0.7)
Amortisation of intangibles2 (0.3)
Costs to unlock3 (1.1)
Group's share of net administrative expenses 8.7 8.5
Property rental and related income4 61.1 52.3
Other income 0.4
Share of joint ventures' and associates' property income 0.6 1.5
Property rental, other income and related income 61.7 54.2
Net administrative expenses as a % of property income (including share of
joint ventures and associates) 14.1% 15.7%
  1. Exceptional costs comprise expenses relating to the acquisition of Ellandi

  2. Amortisation of intangibles relates to the amortisation of the intangible asset recognised on the acquisition of Ellandi

  3. Costs to unlock comprise net costs in relation to unlocking expected net cost synergies following the acquisition of Capital & Regional e.g. redundancy and head office costs

  4. This balance excludes the amortisation of tenant incentives and letting costs of £1.5 million (2024: £1.5 million) and includes an expected credit loss reversal of £0.4 million (2024: £nil), which excludes the £0.1 million expected credit loss (2024: £nil) forward looking element of the calculation.

Average monthly number of staff

2025 2024
Directors 7 7
Operations and asset managers 39 18
Support functions 40 27
Snozone* 213
Total 299 52

* Adjusted for full time equivalents.

Auditors' remuneration

2025
£m
2024
£m
Audit of the Company and consolidated financial statements 0.8 0.3
Audit of subsidiaries, pursuant to legislation 0.2 0.2
1.0 0.5
Non-audit fees – interim review 0.1 0.1
Total fees 1.1 0.6

Total fees include £0.5 million payable by Capital & Regional pre-acquisition.

In addition to this the joint ventures and associates paid £0.1 million (2024: £0.1 million) in audit fees.

7. Other income

2025
£m
2024
£m
Insurance proceeds 0.4
Other income 0.4

The prior year balance of £0.4 million relates to Covid-19 income disruption following agreement with the insurer.

8. Loss on disposal of a joint venture

Year ended 31 March 2025

There were no disposals of joint ventures in the year ended 31 March 2025

Year ended 31 March 2024

On 27 June 2023, the Group disposed its 50% share in the 'Napier' joint venture which owned Kittybrewster Retail Park in Aberdeen and Glendoe and Telford Retail Parks in Inverness.

Included in the carrying value on disposal were investment properties of £32.2 million, cash of £1.3 million and third party debt of £(12.0) million.

£m
Carrying value at 31 March 2023 23.6
Movement in the period 31 March 2023 to 27 June 2023 (0.3)
Carrying value at 27 June 2023 23.3
Net cash proceeds 21.0
Loss on disposal of a joint venture (2.3)

The total cash consideration for the sale was £64.0 million which included £62.6 million (NewRiver share: £31.3 million) consideration for the value of the JV properties.

The total cash consideration was distributed as follows:

  • £24.0 million used to repay the Napier Joint Venture bank loans;
  • £3.0 million used to repay the shareholder loan owed to NewRiver (recognised as part of the Investment in Joint Venture carrying amount)

After the deduction of the above amounts and the settlement of various costs associated with the disposal, £18.0 million was received by NewRiver. Net proceeds of £21.0 million recognised by NewRiver include the £3.0 million repayment of the shareholder loan.

9. Loss on disposal of investment properties

2025
£m
2024
£m
Gross disposal proceeds 3.8 6.8
Carrying value (3.9) (10.2)
Cost of disposal (0.8) (0.4)
Loss on disposal of investment properties (0.9) (3.8)

10. Finance income and finance costs

2025
£m
2024
£m
Income from loans with joint ventures and associates 0.2 0.2
Income from treasury deposits 5.1 5.2
Finance income 5.3 5.4
Interest on borrowings (14.1) (12.7)
Finance cost on lease liabilities (2.6) (2.6)
Write off of unamortised debt costs (0.9)
Finance costs (17.6) (15.3)

11. Taxation

2025
£m
2024
£m
Deferred taxation charge 3.0
Profit before tax 26.7 3.0
Tax at the current rate of 25% (2024: 25%) 6.7 0.8
Revaluation of property (0.5) 3.5
Movement in unrecognised deferred tax (1.3) 1.1
Non-taxable profit due to REIT regime (2.9) (5.4)
Non-taxable income 1.0
Taxation charge 3.0

Real Estate Investment Trust regime (REIT regime)

The Group is a member of the REIT regime whereby profits from its UK property rental business are tax exempt. The REIT regime only applies to certain property-related profits and has several criteria which have to be met. The main criteria are:

  • the assets of the property rental business must be at least 75% of the Group's assets;
  • the profit from the tax-exempt property rental business must exceed 75% of the Group's total profit, and;
  • at least 90% of the Group's profit from the property rental business must be paid as dividends.

The Group continues to meet these conditions, and management intends that the Group should continue as a REIT for the foreseeable future. The Group has not recognised a deferred tax liability or deferred tax asset. The deferred tax relates to the de-recognition of a deferred tax asset which was acquired during the year. As at 31 March 2025 the Group had unrecognised tax losses of £9.2 million (2024: £9.4 million). The losses have not been recognised as an asset due to uncertainty over the availability of taxable income to utilise the losses. The losses do not expire but are reliant on continuity of ownership and source of trade.

12. Performance measures

A reconciliation of the performance measures to the nearest IFRS measure is below:

2025
£m
2024
£m
Profit for the year after taxation 23.7 3.0
Adjustments
Net valuation movement (2.1) 13.9
Loss on disposal of investment properties 0.9 3.8
Loss on disposal of joint venture 2.3
Write off of unamortised debt costs 0.9
Deferred tax 3.0
Exceptional costs1 0.7
Amortisation of intangibles2 0.3
Costs to unlock3 1.1
Group's share of joint ventures' and associates' adjustments
Revaluation of investment properties 0.1
Revaluation of derivatives (0.1)
Profit on disposal of investment properties (0.2)
EPRA earnings 28.4 22.9
Share-based payment charge 1.5 1.5
Forward looking element of IFRS 94 0.1
Snozone depreciation and amortisation 0.7
Snozone lease liability interest (0.2)
Underlying Funds From Operations (UFFO) 30.5 24.4
  1. Exceptional costs comprise expenses relating to the acquisition of Ellandi

  2. Amortisation of intangibles relates to the amortisation of the intangible asset recognised on the acquisition of Ellandi

  3. Costs to unlock comprise net costs in relation to unlocking expected net cost synergies following the acquisition of Capital & Regional e.g. redundancy and head office costs

  4. Forward looking element of IFRS 9 relates to a provision against debtor balances in relation to invoices in advance for future rental income. These balances are not due in the current year and therefore no income has been recognised in relation to these debtors.

Number of shares

2025 2024
Number of shares No. m No. m
Weighted average number of ordinary shares for the purposes of Basic EPS,
UFFO and EPRA
311.4
376.3
Effect of dilutive potential ordinary shares:
Performance share plan 1.5 1.6
Deferred bonus shares 0.8 0.9
Weighted average number of ordinary shares for the purposes of Diluted EPS 378.6 313.9
2025 2024
IFRS Basic EPS 6.3 1.0
IFRS Diluted EPS 6.3 1.0
EPRA EPS 7.5 7.4
UFFO EPS 8.1 7.8

The below table reconciles the differences between the calculation of basic and EPRA NTA, a non-GAAP measure.

EPRA NTA per share and basic NTA per share:

2025 2024
£m Shares
m
Pence per
share
£m Shares
m
Pence per
share
Net assets 490.1 475.5* 103p 361.1 310.4* 116p
Employee awards
vested not yet exercised 1.2 0.4
Unexercised
employee awards 2.2 2.5
Diluted net assets 490.1 478.9 102p 361.1 313.3 115p
Group's share of associates
deferred tax liability 0.9 0.8
Goodwill (3.6)
Intangible asset (0.9)
Group's share of joint
venture / associates fair
value derivatives (0.1)
EPRA Net Tangible Assets 486.5 478.9 102p 361.8 313.3 115p

* See note 23

13. Dividends

The dividends paid in the year are set out below:

Pence per
Payment date PID Non-PID share £m
Year to March 2024
Ordinary dividends
4 August 2023 3.2 3.2 9.8
16 January 2024 3.4 3.4 10.5
20.3
Year to March 2025
Ordinary dividends
16 August 2024 3.2 3.2 9.8
28 January 2025 3.0 3.0 14.2
24.0

The final dividend of 3.5 pence per share in respect of the year ended 31 March 2025, subject to shareholder approval at the 2025 AGM, will be paid on 8 August 2025 to shareholders on the register as at 20 June 2025. The dividend will be payable as a REIT Property Income Distribution (PID).

Reconciliation to dividends paid in the consolidated cash flow statement

2025
£m
2024
£m
Dividends paid (24.0) (20.3)
Scrip dividend 1.8 1.6
Movement in withholding tax 0.4
Dividends paid in the consolidated cash flow statement (21.8) (18.7)

Property Income Distribution (PID) dividends

Profits distributed out of tax-exempt profits are PID dividends. PID dividends are paid after deduction of withholding tax (currently at 20%), which NewRiver pays directly to HMRC on behalf of the shareholder.

Non-PID dividends

Any non-PID element of dividends will be treated in exactly the same way as dividends from other UK, non-REIT companies.

14. Investment properties

2025
£m
2024
£m
Fair value brought forward 533.8 551.5
Acquisitions* 344.7
Capital expenditure 9.7 5.3
Lease incentives, letting and legal costs 1.0 0.9
Disposals (3.9) (10.2)
Net valuation movement 2.2 (13.7)
Fair value carried forward 887.5 533.8
Right of use asset (investment property) see note 22 51.5 74.9
Fair value carried forward 939.0 608.7

* Acquisitions of £344.7 million comprise six investment properties acquired through the Capital & Regional transaction, see note 17.

The Group's investment properties have been valued at fair value on 31 March 2025 by independent valuers, Colliers International Valuation UK LLP and Knight Frank LLP, on the basis of fair value in accordance with the Current Practice Statements contained in The Royal Institution of Chartered Surveyors Valuation – Professional Standards, (the 'Red Book'). The valuations are performed by appropriately qualified valuers who have relevant and recent experience in the sector.

The Group is exposed to changes in the residual value of properties at the end of current lease agreements. The residual value risk born by the Group is mitigated by active management of its property portfolio with the objective of optimising tenant mix in order to:

  • achieve the longest weighted average lease term possible;
  • minimise vacancy rates across all properties; and
  • minimise the turnover of tenants with high quality credit ratings.

The Group also grants lease incentives to encourage high quality tenants to remain in properties for longer lease terms. In the case of anchor tenants, this also attracts other tenants to the property thereby contributing to overall occupancy levels.

The fair value at 31 March represents the highest and best use.

The properties are categorised as Level 3 in the IFRS 13 fair value hierarchy. There were no transfers of property between Levels 1, 2 and 3. Level 1 inputs are quoted prices (unadjusted) in active markets for identical assets or liabilities that the entity can access at the measurement date. Level 2 inputs are inputs other than quoted prices included within Level 1 that are observable for the asset or liability, either directly or indirectly. Level 3 inputs are unobservable inputs for the asset or liability.

As at 31 March 2025

Property ERV Property rent Property
equivalent
Fair value
£m
Min
£ per sq ft
Max
£ per sq ft
Average
£ per sq ft
Min
£ per sq ft
Max
£ per sq ft
Average
£ per sq ft
yield
Average
%
Retail parks 180.6 9.8 21.0 13.5 6.6 19.0 12.0 6.5
Shopping Centres –
Core
652.0 4.3 32.3 14.5 1.9 32.4 10.9 8.8
Shopping Centres –
Regeneration
24.7 5.1 10.4 10.0 2.9 5.1 3.1 11.5
Shopping Centres –
Work Out
28.0 9.3 16.7 14.5 1.0 3.8 2.0 10.4
High street and other 2.2 3.9 5.6 5.0 1.4 6.2 3.6 11.4
887.5

As at 31 March 2024

Property ERV Property rent Property
equivalent
Fair value
£m
Min
£ per sq ft
Max
£ per sq ft
Average
£ per sq ft
Min
£ per sq ft
Max
£ per sq ft
Average
£ per sq ft
yield
Average
%
Retail parks 132.8 10.6 14.2 11.8 8.3 14.7 10.8 7.0
Shopping Centres –
Core
234.5 4.2 32.0 12.4 4.1 32.3 10.5 9.6
Shopping Centres –
Regeneration
128.9 5.0 18.6 16.0 3.0 13.7 10.5 7.4
Shopping Centres –
Work Out
34.4 5.9 17.5 6.3 1.3 3.3 1.5 12.0
High street and other 3.2 4.0 6.2 5.7 3.9 6.2 4.9 9.2
533.8

Sensitivities of measurement of significant inputs

As set out within significant accounting estimates and judgements in note 2, the Group's property portfolio valuation is open to judgements and is inherently subjective by nature. As a result, the sensitivity analysis below illustrates the impact of changes in key unobservable inputs on the fair value of the Group's properties.

We consider +/-10% for ERV and +/-100bps for NEY to capture the uncertainty in these key valuation assumptions and deem it to be a reasonably possible scenario.

The investments are a portfolio of retail assets in the UK. The valuation was determined using an income capitalisation method, which involves applying a yield to rental income streams. Inputs include yield, current rent and ERV.

The inputs to the valuation include:

  • Rental value total rental value per annum
  • Equivalent yield the net weighted average income return a property will produce based upon the timing of the income received

There were no changes to valuation techniques during the year. Valuation reports are based on both information provided by the Group, for example, current rents and lease terms which is derived from the Group's financial and property management systems and is subject to the Group's overall control environment, and assumptions applied by the valuers, e.g. ERVs and yields. These assumptions are based on market observation and the valuers' professional judgement, which includes a consideration of climate change and a range of other external factors.

2025: Sensitivity impact on valuations of a 10% change in estimated rental value and absolute yield of 100 bps.

Impact on valuations of a
10% change in ERV
Impact on valuations of 100
bps change in yield
Asset Type Retail asset
valuation £m
Increase
10%
£m
Decrease
10%
£m
Increase
1.0%
£m
Decrease
1.0%
£m
Retail parks 180.6 15.6 (15.5) (23.0) 31.8
Shopping Centres – Core 652.0 59.6 (56.7) (75.9) 97.8
Shopping Centres – Regeneration 24.7 1.6 (1.6) (0.7) 0.9
Shopping Centres – Work Out 28.0 2.3 (2.3) (4.0) 4.9
High street and other 2.2 0.4 (0.4) (0.2) 0.3
887.5 79.5 (76.5) (103.8) 135.7

2024: Sensitivity impact on valuations of a 10% change in estimated rental value and absolute yield of 100 bps.

Impact on valuations of
a 10% change in ERV
Impact on valuations of
100 bps change in yield
Asset Type Retail asset
valuation £m
Increase
10%
£m
Decrease
10%
£m
Increase
1.0%
£m
Decrease
1.0%
£m
Retail parks 132.8 10.2 (10.1) (14.6) 19.5
Shopping Centres – Core 234.5 17.7 (16.2) (20.7) 26.2
Shopping Centres – Regeneration 128.9 12.6 (12.3) (15.9) 21.0
Shopping Centres – Work Out 34.4 4.3 (4.3) (4.4) 5.4
High street and other 3.2 0.5 (0.5) (0.4) 0.5
533.8 45.3 (43.4) (56.0) 72.6

Reconciliation to net valuation movement in consolidated statement of comprehensive income

Net valuation movement in investment properties 2025
£m
2024
£m
Net valuation movement in investment properties 2.2 (13.7)
Net valuation movement in right of use asset (0.1) (0.2)
Net valuation movement in consolidated statement of comprehensive income 2.1 (13.9)

Reconciliation to properties at valuation in the portfolio

Note 2025
£m
2024
£m
Investment property 14 887.5 533.8
Properties held in associates 16 10.0 10.0
Properties at valuation 897.5 543.8

15. Investments in joint ventures

As at 31 March 2025 the Group has no joint ventures (31 March 2024: one joint venture).

2025
£m
2024
£m
Opening balance 0.1 23.8
Disposals (23.3)
Group's share of profit after taxation excluding valuation movement 0.5
Net valuation movement
Dividends (0.1) (0.9)
Investment in joint venture 0.1
Name Country of incorporation 2025
% Holding
2024
% Holding
NewRiver Retail Investments LP (NRI LP) Guernsey 50
NewRiver Retail (Napier) Limited (Napier) UK

The Group is the appointed asset manager on behalf of these joint ventures and receives asset management fees, development management fees and performance-related bonuses.

NewRiver Retail Investments LP has a 31 December year end and was wound up in the year ended 31 March 2025. The aggregate amounts recognised in the consolidated balance sheet and consolidated statement of comprehensive income at 31 March are as follows:

2025 2024
Consolidated balance sheet Total
£m
Group's
share £m
Total
£m
Group's share
£m
Non-current assets
Current assets 0.3 0.1
Current liabilities
Liabilities due in more than one year
Net assets 0.3 0.1
Loan to joint venture
Net assets adjusted for loan to joint venture 0.3 0.1

The table above provides summarised financial information for the joint ventures. The information disclosed reflects the amounts presented in the financial statements of the joint ventures. To arrive at the Group's share of these amounts under equity accounting, certain minor adjustments are required to be made.

The Group's share of contingent liabilities in the joint venture is £nil (31 March 2024: £nil).

2025 2024
Consolidated statement of comprehensive income Total
£m
Group's
share £m
Total
£m
Group's share
£m
Revenue 1.4 0.7
Property operating expenses
Net property income 1.4 0.7
Administration expenses (0.1) (0.1)
Net finance costs (0.1) (0.1)
Group's share of joint ventures' profit before
valuation movements
1.2 0.5
Net valuation movement
Profit on disposal of investment property
Profit after taxation 1.2 0.5
Add back net valuation movement
Group's share of joint ventures' profit before
valuation movements
1.2 0.5
NewRiver REIT plc Annual Report and Accounts 2025
2025
Strategic Report Governance Report Financial Statements ESG Data Sets
& Appendix
Glossary &
Company Information
187

16. Investments in associates

The Group has one direct investment in an associate entity in which it has a 10% stake, Sealand S.à.r.l, which owns 100% of NewRiver Retail (Hamilton) Limited and NewRiver (Sprucefield) Limited at 31 March 2025.

2025
£m
2024
£m
Opening balance 5.6 5.5
Dividends (0.4) (0.2)
Group's share of profit after taxation excluding valuation movement 0.2 0.3
Net valuation movement (0.1)
Investment in associates 5.3 5.6
Name Country of incorporation 2025
% Holding
2024
% Holding
NewRiver Retail (Hamilton) Limited (Hamilton) UK 10 10
NewRiver (Sprucefield) Limited (Sprucefield) UK 10 10

The Group is the appointed asset manager on behalf of Sealand S.à.r.l and receives asset management fees, development management fees and performance-related bonuses.

The aggregate amounts recognised in the consolidated balance sheet and consolidated statement of comprehensive income are as follows:

31 March 2025
Total
£m
Group's
share
£m
Total
£m
Group's
share
£m
100.3 10.0 100.0 10.0
8.7 0.8 6.6 0.7
(39.2) (3.9) (36.1) (3.6)
(47.4) (4.7)
2.4
3.2
21.6 5.3 23.1 5.6
(48.2)
21.6
(4.8)
2.1
3.2
31 March 2024
23.1

The Group's share of contingent liabilities in the associates is £nil (31 March 2024: £nil).

Consolidated statement of comprehensive income 2025
Total
£m
2025
Group's
share
£m
2024
Total
£m
2024
Group's
share
£m
Revenue 8.4 0.8 8.4 0.8
Property operating expenses (2.1) (0.2) (0.4)
Net property income 6.3 0.6 8.0 0.8
Administration expenses (0.2) (0.1)
Net finance costs (5.1) (0.5) (4.9) (0.5)
1.0 0.1 3.0 0.3
Net valuation movement (0.5) (0.1) (0.4)
Profit on disposal of investment property 2.0 0.2
Taxation (1.4) (0.1) (0.4)
Profit after taxation 1.1 0.1 2.2 0.3
Add back net valuation movement 0.5 0.1 0.4
Group's share of associates' profit before
valuation movements 1.6 0.2 2.6 0.3

17. Acquisitions

On 10 December 2024 the Company acquired 100% of the share capital of Capital & Regional plc and subsidiaries for total consideration of £150.9 million. The value of net assets acquired was £164.6 million. The acquisition has been accounted for as an asset acquisition and the difference between the consideration paid and the net assets acquired, representing a price discount of £13.7 million, has reduced the cost of investment property acquired.

£m
Cash 73.3
Shares 77.6
Total consideration 150.9
£m
Transaction costs 8.5
Total consideration including transaction costs 159.4
£m
Investment property 344.7
Cash and cash equivalents 25.8
Bank loans (199.0)
Other net assets and liabilities (12.1)
Total net assets 159.4

On 3 July 2024 the Company acquired 100% of the share capital of Ellandi Management Limited (Ellandi) and subsidiaries, an asset and development management business focused on UK retail and regeneration.

As a result of the acquisition, the Group is expected to grow its third party asset management, capital partnership and regeneration business.

The Group also expects to reduce costs through combining the operations of the Group and Ellandi.

The Goodwill of £3.6 million arising from the acquisition consists largely of synergies from integrating the Ellandi asset management platform with the existing NewRiver asset management platform to enhance the knowledge base, data analytical capacity and third party support networks through the combined platform. An intangible asset of £1.2 million in respect of customer relationships was recognised on acquisition. Intangible assets arising on business combinations are initially recognised at fair value. Goodwill is not amortised but is tested at least annually for impairment. Intangible assets arising on business combinations are amortised on a straight line basis to the income statement over their expected useful lives, management consider this to be a three year period. In the year ended 31 March 2025 the Group recognised an amortisation charge to intangible assets of £0.3 million (2024: £nil).

The following table summarises the consideration paid, and the fair value of the assets acquired, and liabilities assumed at acquisition date.

£m
Cash and cash equivalents 1.1
Current assets 2.0
Current liabilities (0.9)
Intangible asset 1.2
Fair value of acquired interest in net assets in subsidiaries 3.4
Total consideration 7.0
Goodwill 3.6
£m
Intangible asset on acquisition 1.2
Less: amortisation (0.3)
Intangible asset as at 31 March 2025 0.9

18. Trade and other receivables

2025
£m
2024
£m
Trade receivables 5.0 1.4
Restricted monetary assets 5.0 4.6
Service charge receivables* 2.6 0.7
Other receivables 0.8 1.0
Prepayments 5.1 1.2
Accrued income 3.6 2.5
22.1 11.4

* Included in service charge receivables is £3.2 million of service charge debtors (2024: £1.5 million) and £0.6 million of bad debt provision (2024: £0.8 million).

Trade receivables are shown net of a loss allowance of £2.4 million (2024: £1.9 million). Other receivables are shown net of a loss allowance of £nil (2024: £0.1 million). The provision for doubtful debts is calculated as an expected credit loss on trade receivables in accordance with IFRS 9. The release to the consolidated statement of comprehensive income in relation to doubtful debts made against tenant debtors was £0.2 million (2024: £0.1 million charge). The Group has calculated the expected credit loss by applying a forward-looking outlook to historical default rates.

The Group monitors rent collection and the ability of tenants to pay rent receivables in order to anticipate synergies from integrating the Ellandi asset management platform with the existing NRR asset management platform to enhance the knowledge base, data analytical capacity and third party support networks through the combined platforms minimise the impact of default by tenants. All outstanding rent receivables are regularly monitored. In order to measure the expected credit losses, trade receivables from tenants have been grouped on a basis of shared credit risk characteristics and an assumption around the tenants' ability to pay their receivable, based on conversations held and our knowledge of their credit history. The expected credit loss rates are based on historical payment profiles of tenant debtors and corresponding historical credit losses.

NewRiver REIT plc Annual Report and Accounts 2025
2025
Strategic Report Governance Report Financial Statements ESG Data Sets
& Appendix
Glossary &
Company Information
189
2025 2024
£m £m
Opening loss allowance at 1 April 1.9 3.0
(Decrease) / increase in loss allowance recognised in the consolidated statement
of comprehensive income during the year in relation to tenant debtors (0.2) 0.1
Loss allowance utilisation 0.7 (1.2)
Closing loss allowance at 31 March 2.4 1.9

The restricted monetary assets relates to cash balances which the Group cannot readily access. They do not meet the definition of cash and cash equivalents and consequently are presented separately from cash in the consolidated balance sheet.

19. Cash and cash equivalents

As at 31 March 2025 and 31 March 2024 cash and cash equivalents comprised of cash held in bank accounts and treasury deposits. There were no restrictions on cash in either the current or prior year.

20. Trade and other payables

2025
£m
2024
£m
Trade payables 1.6 1.3
Service charge liabilities* 15.8 7.2
Other payables 7.9 3.1
Accruals 18.1 9.5
Value Added Taxation 1.8 0.3
Rent received in advance 8.2 4.9
53.4 26.3

* Service charge liabilities include accruals of £1.1 million (2024: £0.6 million), service charge creditors and other creditors of £12.2 million (2024 £3.8 million), Value added taxation of £0.3 million (2024: £0.9 million) and deferred income of £2.2 million (2024: £1.9 million).

21. Borrowings

Maturity of drawn borrowings: 2025
£m
2024
£m
Between one and two years 140.0
Between two and three years 300.0
Between three and four years 300.0
Between four and five years
Less unamortised fees / discount (3.0) (3.4)
437.0 296.6

The fair value of the Group's corporate bond has been estimated on the basis of quoted market prices, representing Level 1 fair value measurement as defined by IFRS 13 Fair Value Measurement. At 31 March 2025 the fair value was £283.2 million (31 March 2024: £275.5 million).

As at 31 March 2025, the fair value of The Mall facility was £133.2 million.

Secured borrowings: Maturity date Facility
£m
Facility
drawn
£m
Unamortised facility
fees / discount
£m
£m
The Mall January 2027 140.0 140.0 (0.6) 139.4
140.0 140.0 (0.6) 139.4
Unsecured borrowings: Maturity date Facility
£m
Facility
drawn
£m
Unamortised facility
fees / discount
£m
£m
Revolving credit facility November 2026 100.0 (0.8) (0.8)
Corporate bond March 2028 300.0 300.0 (1.6) 298.4
400.0 300.0 (2.4) 297.6
Total borrowings 540.0 440.0 (3.0) 437.0

22. Lease commitment arrangements

The Group earns rental income by leasing its investment properties to tenants under noncancellable lease commitments.

The Group holds three types of leases.

  • Head leases: A number of the investment properties owned by the Group are situated on land held through leasehold arrangements, as opposed to the Group owning the freehold (investment property)
  • Office leases: Office space occupied by the Group's head office (property, plant and equipment)
  • Snozone leases in Castleford, Milton Keynes and Madrid sites (property, plant and equipment)

The lease liability and associated ROU asset recognised in the consolidated balance sheet are set out below.

2025
£m
2024
£m
Right of use asset (Investment property) 51.5 74.9
Right of use asset (Property, plant and equipment) 18.1 0.7
Current lease liability 1.8 0.4
Non-current lease liability 71.8 75.2
NewRiver REIT plc Annual Report and Accounts 2025
2025
Strategic Report Governance Report Financial Statements ESG Data Sets
& Appendix
Glossary &
Company Information
190
Right of use assets (Property, plant and equipment) 2025
£m
2024
£m
Cost
Brought forward 1.1 1.1
Additions 18.2
Carried forward 19.3 1.1
Accumulated depreciation
Brought forward (0.4) (0.2)
Charge for the year (0.8) (0.2)
At 31 March 2025/2024 (1.2) (0.4)
Carrying value
Carried forward 18.1 0.7
Right of use asset (Investment property) 2025
£m
2024
£m
Fair value brought forward 74.9 75.8
Acquisitions 5.3
Disposals (3.7)
Revaluation (0.1) (0.9)
Lease modification (24.9)
Fair value carried forward 51.5 74.9

The expense relating to low value assets which have not been recognised under IFRS 16 was £nil (March 2024: £nil) and the expense relating to variable lease payments not included in the measurement of lease liabilities was £nil (March 2024: £nil). The total cash outflow in relation to lease commitments for the year was £3.6 million (March 2024: £2.4 million), £1.0 million (2024: £0.4 million) relates to the repayment of principle lease liabilities and £2.6 million (2024: £2.0 million) relates to the repayment of interest on lease liabilities. Depreciation recognised on ROU assets during the year was £0.8 million (2024: £0.2 million)

Lease liability maturity table

2025
£m
2024
£m
Within one year 1.8 0.4
Between one and two years 2.0 0.8
In the second to fifth year inclusive 1.8 0.6
After five years 68.0 73.8
73.6 75.6

Lease commitments payable by the Group are as follows:

2025
£m
2024
£m
Within one year 5.3 2.9
One to two years 4.6 2.9
Two to five years 13.3 8.8
After five years 1,285.6 247.8
1,308.8 262.4
Effect of discounting (1,235.2) (186.8)
Lease liability 73.6 75.6

At the balance sheet date the Group had contracted with tenants for the following future minimum lease payments on its investment properties:

2025
£m
2024
£m
Within one year 65.3 47.3
Between one and two years 54.8 41.2
In the second to fifth year inclusive 100.4 88.3
After five years 214.5 147.3
435.0 324.1

The Group's weighted average lease length of lease commitments at 31 March 2025 was 5.8 years (March 2024: 5.2 years).

Operating lease obligations exist over the Group's offices, head leases on the Group's retail portfolio and ground rent leases. Investment properties are leased to tenants under operating leases with rentals payable monthly and quarterly. Where considered necessary to reduce credit risk, the Group may obtain bank guarantees for the term of the lease.

23. Share capital and reserves

Share capital

Ordinary shares Number of
shares issued
m's
Price per
share
pence
Total
No of shares
(m)
Held by EBT
No of shares
(m)
Shares in
issue
No of shares
(m)
1 April 2023 311.9 1.4 310.5
Scrip dividends issued 1.0 0.89 312.9 1.4 311.5
Shares issued under employee share
schemes 1.2 312.9 0.2 312.7
Purchase of own shares (3.4) 312.9 3.6 309.3
Shares issued under employee share
schemes 0.3 312.9 3.3 309.6
Scrip dividends issued 0.8 0.82 313.7 3.3 310.4
31 March 2024 313.7 3.3 310.4
Scrip dividends issued 1.8 0.77 315.5 3.3 312.2
Shares issued under employee share
schemes 0.2 315.5 3.1 312.4
Equity placing and retail offer* 62.7 0.80 378.2 3.1 375.1
Shares issued under employee share
schemes 0.7 378.2 2.4 375.8
Allotment of consideration shares** 98.3 0.79 476.5 2.4 474.1
Shares issued under employee share
schemes 0.8 476.5 1.6 474.9
Scrip dividends issued 0.6 0.73 477.1 1.6 475.5
31 March 2025 477.1 1.6 475.5

* In September 2024, the Group raised £48.9 million of net proceeds for the issue of 62.7 million shares. The share premium, representing the amount received over the nominal value of shares, was £48.1 million. These newly issued shares carry the same rights as the existing share capital.

** The Company issued 98.3 million ordinary shares as consideration for the acquisition of Capital & Regional on 10 December 2024. The share premium, representing the amount received over the nominal value of shares, was £76.6 million. These newly issued shares carry the same rights as the existing share capital.

All shares issued and authorised are fully paid up.

Merger reserve

The merger reserve arose as a result of a group reorganisation in 2016 and represents the nominal amount of share capital that was issued to shareholders of NewRiver Retail Limited.

In December 2024 the Company acquired Capital & Regional. Some of the consideration was paid in equity shares of the Company. The difference between the nominal value of the shares issued and the cost of the net asset acquired was recorded in the merger reserve.

Share premium

Share premium represents amounts subscribed for a share in excess of nominal value less directly attributable issue costs.

Retained earnings

Retained earnings consist of the accumulated net comprehensive profit of the Group, less dividends paid from distributable reserves, and transfers from equity issues where those equity issues generated distributable reserves.

Scrip dividend shares

Shares issued in respect of elections to participate in the Scrip Dividend scheme in respect of dividends declared in the year, the value of these was £1.8 million (2024: £1.6 million). The Scrip Dividend Scheme was re-approved on 26 July 2023. The scheme provides shareholders of NewRiver Ordinary shares with the opportunity, at the shareholders election and where offered by the Company, to elect to receive dividends as New Ordinary shares in the Company instead of their cash dividend, with no dealing charges or stamp duty incurred.

Shares held in Employee Benefit Trust (EBT)

As part of the group reorganisation in 2016, the Company established an EBT which is registered in Jersey. The EBT, at its discretion, may transfer shares held by it to directors and employees of the Company and its subsidiaries. The maximum number of ordinary shares that may be held by the EBT may not exceed 5% of the Company's issued share capital. It is intended that the EBT will not hold more ordinary shares than are required in order to satisfy share options granted under employee share incentive plans.

As at 31 March 2025 there are 1,624,929 ordinary shares held by EBT (2024: 3,317,218).

24. Share-based payments

The Group has two share schemes for employees:

  • Performance Share Scheme
  • Deferred bonus scheme

Performance Share Scheme

Zero priced share options have been issued to senior management and executive directors under the Performance Share Scheme since 2013. The options vest to the extent that performance conditions are met over a three or five-year period. At the end of the period there may be a further vesting condition that the employee or director remains an employee of the Group. Further details on the scheme and the performance conditions are provided in the Remuneration Report. The charge for the year recognised in the consolidated statement of comprehensive income was £0.8 million (March 2024: £0.7 million). The average share price on the date the awards were exercised in the year was 80.3 pence per share.

Financial
year issued
Fair value
at date
of grant
Outstanding
at start
of year
millions
Granted
millions
Number
Exercised
millions
Lapsed/
Cancelled
millions
Outstanding
at end
of year
millions
Number
exercisable
millions
Average
remaining
life (years)
2021 0.37 0.4 (0.1) 0.3
2022 0.19 3.2 0.2 (1.0) (1.6) 0.8
2023 0.64 2.9 0.3 3.2 0.4
2024 0.66 2.8 0.2 3.0 1.3
2025 0.40 3.2 3.2 2.2
9.3 3.9 (1.1) (1.6) 10.5

Deferred Bonus Scheme

Zero priced share options have been issued to senior management and executive directors under the Deferred Bonus Scheme since 2016. The options vest based on the employee or director remaining in the employment of the Group for a defined period (usually two years). The charge for the year recognised in the consolidated statement of comprehensive income for this scheme was £0.7 million (March 2024: £0.5 million).

Financial
year issued
Share price
at date
of grant
Outstanding
at start
of year
millions
Granted
millions
Number
Exercised
millions
Lapsed/
Cancelled
millions
Outstanding
at end
of year
millions
Number
exercisable
millions
Average
remaining
life (years)
2018 1.77 0.1 0.1
2019 1.78 0.1 0.1
2020 0.63
2021 0.78
2022 0.73
2023 0.85 0.7 0.7
2024 0.89 0.7 0.1 0.8 0.3
2025 0.89 0.6 0.6 1.2
1.6 0.7 2.3

Fair value

The fair value of the share options has been calculated based on a Monte Carlo Pricing Model which simulates the below market related conditions and compares them against those of the Comparator Group:

2025 2024
Share price 0.82 0.89
Exercise price Nil Nil
Expected volatility 26.4% 34%
Risk free rate 4.900% 4.980%
Expected dividends* 0% 0%

* based on quoted property sector average.

Expected volatility is determined by calculating the two year volatility of the Group and the Total Shareholder Return Comparator Group. The risk free interest rate is the implied yield on zero coupon government bonds with a remaining term equal to the expected term of the Awards from the Grant Date.

The Group's activities expose it to a variety of financial risks in relation to the financial instruments it uses: market risk including cash flow interest rate risk, credit risk and liquidity risk. The financial risks relate to the following financial instruments: trade receivables, cash and cash equivalents, trade and other payables, borrowings and derivative financial instruments.

Risk management parameters are established by the Board on a project-by-project basis. Reports are provided to the Board quarterly and also when authorised changes are required.

Financial instruments

2025
£m
2024
£m
Financial assets
Financial assets at amortised cost
Trade and other receivables 14.1 7.7
Cash and cash equivalents 61.3 132.8
Total financial assets and maximum exposure to credit risk 75.4 140.5
Financial liabilities
At amortised cost
Borrowings (437.0) (296.6)
Lease liabilities (73.6) (75.6)
Payables and accruals (40.9) (18.1)
(551.5) (390.3)
(476.1) (249.8)

The fair value of the financial assets and liabilities at amortised cost are considered to be the same as their carrying value, with the exception of certain fixed rate borrowings, see note 21 for further details. None of the financial instruments above are held at fair value

Market risk

Currency risk

The Group is not subject to material foreign currency risk as nearly all transactions are in Pounds Sterling, other than a small operation in Spain which operates in Euros.

Interest rate risk

At 31 March 2025 the Group has no interest rate risk as it has no drawn debt that is subject to variable interest rates and no open derivatives in controlled entities.

There would be no impact on finance costs to the Group, in the year or in the prior year, if interest rates increase or decrease as the Group has no drawn variable rate debt.

Credit risk

Strategic Report

The Group's principal financial assets are cash, trade receivables and other receivables.

Credit risk, being the risk that a counterparty will default on its contractual obligations resulting in financial loss to the Group, is primarily attributable to loans and trade and other receivables, which are principally amounts due from tenants. The Group manages its credit risk through policies to ensure that rental contracts are made with tenants meeting appropriate balance sheet covenants, supplemented by rental deposits or bank guarantees from international banks. The Group may suffer a void period where no rents are received. The quality of the tenant is assessed based on an extensive tenant covenant review scorecard prior to acquisition of the property. The assessment of the tenant credit worthiness is also monitored on an ongoing basis. Credit risk is assisted by the vast majority of occupational leases requiring that tenants pay rentals in advance. The Group monitors rent collection in order to anticipate and minimise the impact of default by tenants. All outstanding rent receivables are regularly monitored. In order to measure the expected credit losses, trade receivables from tenants have been grouped by shared credit risk characteristics and an assumption around the tenants' ability to pay their receivable, based on conversations held and our knowledge of their credit history. The expected loss rates are based on historical payment profiles of tenant debtors and corresponding historical credit losses. These historical loss rates are then adjusted to reflect the likelihood that tenants will pay. The Group's policy is to write off tenant debtors when the tenant is in administration or has vacated the unit.

& Appendix

Ageing of past due gross trade receivables and the carrying amount net of loss allowances is set out below:

2025 Gross
amount
£m
2025 Loss
allowance
£m
2025
% applied
2025
Carrying
amount
£m
2024 Gross
amount
£m
2024 Loss
allowance
£m
2024 %
applied
2024
Carrying
amount
£m
0-30 days 1.4 0.5 36% 0.9 1.2 0.4 36% 0.8
30-60 days 0.2 0.1 50% 0.1 0.3 0.1 33% 0.2
60-90 days 0.2 0.1 50% 0.1 0.1 0.1 100%
90-120 days 0.1 0.1 100% 0.3 0.1 33% 0.2
Over 120 days 0.8 0.7 88% 0.1 1.4 1.2 86% 0.2
2.7 1.5 1.2 3.3 1.9 1.4

The Group's total expected credit loss in relation to trade receivables, other receivables and accrued income is £2.4 million (2024: £2.3 million). The Group recognises an expected credit loss allowance on trade receivables of £1.5 million (2024: £1.9 million) as noted in the above table.

NewRiver REIT plc Annual Report and Accounts 2025
2025
Strategic Report Governance Report Financial Statements ESG Data Sets
& Appendix
Glossary &
Company Information
194

The Group categorises trade debtors in varying degrees of risk, as detailed below:

2025
£m
2024
£m
Risk level
Very high 0.8 1.4
High 0.1 0.3
Medium 0.4 0.4
Low 1.4 1.2
Gross carrying amount before loss allowance 2.7 3.3
Loss allowance (1.5) (1.9)
Carrying amount 1.2 1.4

The Group monitors its counterparty exposures on cash and short-term deposits weekly. The Group monitors the counterparty credit rating of the institutions that hold its cash and deposits and spread the exposure across several banks.

Liquidity risk

The Group manages its liquidity risk by maintaining sufficient cash balances and committed credit facilities. The Board reviews the credit facilities in place on a regular basis. Cash flow reports are issued weekly to management and are reviewed quarterly by the Board. A summary table with maturity of financial liabilities is presented below:

2025 £m Less than
one year
One to
two years
Two to
five years
More than
five years
Total
Borrowings (140.0) (300.0) (440.0)
Interest on borrowings (15.4) (14.2) (9.7) (39.3)
Lease liabilities (5.3) (4.6) (13.3) (1,285.6) (1,308.8)
Payables and accruals (40.9) (40.9)
(61.6) (158.8) (323.0) (1,285.6) (1,829.0)
2024 £m
Borrowings (300.0) (300.0)
Interest on borrowings (10.5) (10.5) (20.2) (41.2)
Lease liabilities (2.9) (2.9) (8.8) (247.8) (262.4)
Payables and accruals (18.1) (18.1)
(31.5) (13.4) (329.0) (247.8) (621.7)
Reconciliation of movement in the Group's share of net debt in the year 2025
£m
2024
£m
Group's share of net debt at the beginning of year 167.3 201.3
Cash flow
Net decrease / (increase) in cash and cash equivalents
71.5 (24.2)
New bank loans acquired (non-cash movement) 199.0
Bank loans repaid – principal (59.0)
Bank loans repaid – settlement of associated derivatives 1.0
Bank loans repaid – write off of unamortised fees (non cash movement) (0.9)
Change in bank loan fees to be amortised (non-cash movement) 0.4 (0.1)
Group's share of joint ventures' and associates' cash flow
Net (increase) / decrease in cash and cash equivalents (0.4) 2.2
Bank loans repaid (11.9)
New bank loans 0.3
Group's share of net debt 379.2 167.3
Being:
Group borrowings 437.0 296.6
Group's share of joint ventures' and associates' borrowings 3.9
4.3
Group cash
Group's share of joint venture and associate cash
(61.3)
(0.8)
(132.8)
(0.4)
Group's share of net debt 379.2 167.3
Changes in liabilities arising from financing activities 2025
£m
2024
£m
Liabilities arising from financing activities at the beginning of the year 239.4 264.8
Cash flow
Net decrease / (increase) in cash and cash equivalents 71.5 (24.2)
New bank loans acquired (non-cash movement) 199.0
Bank loans repaid (59.0)
Bank loans repaid – settlement of associated derivatives 1.0
Bank loans repaid – write off of unamortised fees (non cash movement) (0.9)
Repayment of principal portion of lease liability (1.0) (0.4)
Disposal (non-cash movement) (3.7) (0.7)
Lease modifications (non-cash movement) (24.9)
Leases acquired on acquisition of Capital & Regional (non-cash movement) 27.5
Change in bank loan fees to be amortised (non-cash movement) 0.4 (0.1)
Liabilitites arising from financing activities 449.3 239.4
Being:
Borrowings 437.0 296.6
Cash (61.3) (132.8)
Lease liabilities 73.6 75.6
Liabilities arising from financing activities 449.3 239.4

Capital risk management

The Group's objectives when managing capital are to safeguard the Group's ability to continue as a going concern, to provide returns to shareholders and to maintain an optimal capital structure to reduce the cost of capital. The Group is not subject to any external capital requirements. As detailed in note 11, the Group is a REIT and to qualify as a REIT the Group must distribute 90% of its taxable income from its property business.

To maintain or adjust the capital structure, the Group may adjust the amount of dividends paid to shareholders, return capital to shareholders, issue new shares or sell assets. Consistent with others in the industry, the Group monitors capital on the basis of its gearing ratio. This ratio is calculated as net debt divided by equity. Net debt is calculated as total borrowings, less cash and cash equivalents on a proportionately consolidated basis.

Between 31 March 2024 and 31 March 2025, the Group's proportionally consolidated LTV increased from 30.8% to 42.3% and the gearing ratio from 45.4% to 76.7% mainly as a result of the Capital & Regional acquisition. The Group continually monitors LTV and will continue to monitor LTV closely, factoring in disposal activity and possible further valuation declines as disclosed in Note 1. The Group has remained compliant with all of its banking covenants during the year as discussed in Note 1.

Net debt to equity ratio 2025
£m
2024
£m
Borrowings 437.0 296.6
Cash and cash equivalents (61.3) (132.8)
Net debt 375.7 163.8
Equity attributable to equity holders of the parent 490.1 361.1
Net debt to equity ratio ('Balance sheet gearing') 76.7% 45.4%
Share of joint ventures' and associates' borrowings 4.3 3.9
Share of joint ventures' and associates' cash and cash equivalents (0.8) (0.4)
Group's share of net debt 379.2 167.3
Carrying value of investment property 887.5 533.8
Share of joint ventures' and associates carrying value of investment properties 10.0 10.0
Group's share of carrying value of investment properties 897.5 543.8
Net debt to property value ratio ('Loan to value') 42.3% 30.8%

Reconciliation of financial liabilities

Reconciliation of financial liabilities Lease
liabilities
£m
Borrowings
£m
Total
£m
As at 1 April 2024 75.6 296.6 372.2
Decrease through financing cash flows
New borrowings 140.0 140.0
Repayment of principal portion of lease liability (1.0) (1.0)
Lease modifications (24.9) (24.9)
Leases acquired on acquisition of Capital & Regional 27.6 27.6
Disposal (3.7) (3.7)
Loan amortisation 0.4 0.4
As at 31 March 2025 73.6 437.0 510.6
Lease
liabilities
Borrowings Total
Reconciliation of financial liabilities £m £m £m
As at 1 April 2023 76.7 296.7 373.4
Decrease through financing cash flows
Repayment of principal portion of lease liability (0.4) (0.4)
Disposal (0.7) (0.7)
Loan amortisation (0.1) (0.1)
As at 31 March 2024 75.6 296.6 372.2

26. Contingencies and commitments

The Group has no material contingent liabilities (31 March 2024: None). The Group was contractually committed to £2.8 million of capital expenditure to construct or develop investment property as at 31 March 2025 (2024: £0.7 million).

27. Related party transactions

Transactions between the Company and its subsidiaries have been eliminated on consolidation and are not disclosed in this note.

During the year the Company paid £1.5 million (2024: £0.8 million) in professional legal fees to CMS Cameron McKenna Nabarro Olswang LLP for property services at commercial market rates. Allan Lockhart, CEO of NewRiver, has a personal relationship with one of the Partners at CMS who along with other Partners provides these legal services. There was £0.2 million outstanding at 31 March 2025 (2024: £nil).

The Group has loans with associates of £3.2 million (31 March 2024: £3.2 million).

Management fees are charged to joint ventures and associates for asset management, investment advisory, project management and accounting services.

Total fees charged were:

2025
£m
2024
£m
NewRiver Retail (Hamilton) Limited 0.2 0.2
NewRiver (Sprucefield) Limited 0.2 0.2

As at 31 March 2025, an amount of £0.6 million (2024: £0.3 million) was due to the Group relating to management fees.

During the year, the Group recognised £0.2 million of interest from joint ventures and associates (2024: £0.2 million) and as at 31 March 2025 the amount owing to the Group was £nil (2024: £0.2 million).

Key management personnel

The remuneration of key management personnel (comprising of the Executive Directors, Non-Executive Directors and Executive Committee) of the Group is set out below in aggregate for each of the categories specified in IAS 24 'Related Party Disclosures.'

2025 2024
£m £m
Short-term employee benefits 3.7 2.9
Share-based payments 0.9 0.9
Other – including post-employment benefits 0.1 0.1
4.7 3.9

All transfer of resources, services or obligations between the Company and these parties have been disclosed, regardless of whether a price is charged. We are unaware of any other related party transactions between related parties.

Related party relationships and transactions have been accounted for and disclosed in accordance with the requirements of IFRSs or other requirements, for example, the Companies Act 2006.

28. Post balance sheet events

On May 22 2025, the Group completed the disposal of Jersey Property Unit Trust, New River Retail Property Unit Trust No. 6, which owns the Abbey Centre, Newtownabbey. The gross proceeds of £58.8 million were in line with the net book value of the property.

There were no other significant events occurring after the reporting period, but before the financial statements were authorised for issue.

Company Balance Sheet

As at 31 March 2025

2025 2024
Notes £m £m
(restated)
Non-current assets
Investment in subsidiaries
B
487.1 311.2
Amounts owed from subsidiary undertakings
D
219.4 211.9
Total non-current assets 706.5 523.1
Current assets
Amounts owed from subsidiary undertakings
D
195.9 171.0
Other receivables 1.6 1.4
Cash and cash equivalents 32.8 115.9
Total current assets 230.3 288.3
Total assets 936.8 811.4
Equity and liabilities
Current liabilities
Trade creditors 0.1
Accruals 2.7 2.1
Amounts owed to subsidiary undertakings 165.5 159.1
Total current liabilities
E
168.2 161.3
Non-current liabilities
Borrowings
F
297.2 296.6
Total non-current liabilities 297.2 296.6
Net assets 471.4 353.5
Equity
Share capital 4.7 3.1
Share premium 53.9 4.0
Merger reserve 112.2 35.6
Investment in own shares (1.4) (3.0)
Retained earnings 302.0 313.8
Total equity 471.4 353.5

The notes on pages 199 to 203 form an integral part of the Company financial statements. The Company has applied the exemption in s408 of the Companies Act for omitting the income statement of the parent company. The profit for the year after taxation was £13.8 million (31 March 2024: £20.3 million).

The financial statements were approved by the Board of Directors on 16 June 2025 and were signed on its behalf by:

Allan Lockhart Chief Executive Officer Will Hobman Chief Financial Officer

Registered number: 10221027

Company Statement of Changes In Equity

For the year ended 31 March 2025

Notes Share
capital
£m
Share
premium
£m
Merger
reserve
£m
Purchase of
own shares
£m
Retained
earnings
£m
Total
£m
As at 1 April 2023 (as previously stated) 3.1 2.4 27.6 332.5 365.6
Restated (10.7) (10.7)
As at 1 April 2023 (restated) 3.1 2.4 27.6 321.8 354.9
Profit after taxation 20.3 20.3
Transfer to merger reserve 8.0 (8.0)
Equity issue 1.6 1.6
Purchase of own shares (3.0) (3.0)
Dividends paid (20.3) (20.3)
As at 31 March 2024 (restated) 3.1 4.0 35.6 (3.0) 313.8 353.5
Profit after taxation 13.8 13.8
Consideration shares 1.0 76.6 77.6
Share based payments 1.6 (1.6)
Equity placing and retail offer 0.6 48.1 48.7
Issue of new shares 1.8 1.8
Dividends paid (24.0) (24.0)
As at 31 March 2025 4.7 53.9 112.2 (1.4) 302.0 471.4

The notes on pages 199 to 203 form an integral part of these financial statements. There was no other income in the year therefore the profit after taxation is the Company's total comprehensive profit for the year.

Notes to the company financial statements

A. Accounting policies

Basis of accounting

The Company's separate financial statements for the year ended 31 March 2025 are prepared in accordance with Financial Reporting Standard 101 (FRS 101) "Reduced Disclosure Framework" as issued by the Financial Reporting Council and within the requirements of the Companies Act 2006. The financial statements are presented in pounds Sterling. These financial statements have been prepared under the historical cost convention.

For the Company's going concern assessment, refer to note 1 of the consolidated financial statements.

Changes to accounting policies

The Company has adopted the new accounting standards as set out in the accounting policies section of the Group financial statements. Adopting these new standards and amendments has not had a material impact on the Company in the current or prior years. Refer to note 1.

Disclosure exemptions

The Company has taken advantage of all disclosure exemptions allowed by FRS 101. These financial statements do not include:

  • The requirements of paragraphs 10(d), 10(f), 16, 38A, 38B, 38C, 38D, 40A, 40B, 40C, 40D, 111 and 134 to 136 of IAS 1.
  • the requirements of IAS 7 Statement of Cash Flows;
  • the requirements of paragraphs 45(b) and 46 to 52 of IFRS 2 Share-based Payment;
  • the requirements of paragraphs 30 and 31 of IAS 8 Accounting Policies, Changes in Accounting Estimates and Errors;
  • the requirements of IFRS 7 Financial Instruments: disclosures;
  • the requirements in IAS 24 Related Party Disclosures to disclose related party transactions between two or more members of the Group.

The above disclosure exemptions have been adopted because equivalent disclosures are included in the consolidated Group accounts into which the Company is consolidated.

Investment in subsidiaries

Investments in subsidiary undertakings are stated at cost less provision for cumulative impairments. Where an impairment has been recognised in previous periods, and the conditions that caused the impairment are no longer present, the impairment charge previously recognised will be reversed, up to the cost of the original investment value.

Financial instruments

Financial assets

The Company classifies its financial assets on the basis of their contractual cash flow characteristics and the results of the business model assessment under IFRS 9. Financial assets carried amortised cost are initially recognised at fair value plus transaction costs that are directly attributable to their acquisition or issue and are subsequently carried at amortised cost, less provision for impairment. Impairment provisions for receivables are recognised based on IFRS 9 in the determination of the expected credit losses. If it is determined that a receivable will not be collectable, the gross carrying value of the asset is written off against the associated provision. If in a subsequent year the amount of the impairment loss decreased and the decrease can be related objectively to an event occurring after the impairment was recognised, the previously recognised impairment loss is reversed to the extent that the carrying value of the asset does not exceed its amortised costs at the reversal date. Financial assets at amortised cost consist of loans and receivables. The Company determines the classification of its financial assets at initial recognition. The Company's financial assets consist of cash, and loans and receivables.

Financial assets are derecognised only when the contractual rights to the cash flows from the financial asset expire or the Group transfers substantially all risks and rewards of ownership.

Financial liabilities

Financial liabilities are classified as other liabilities. A financial liability is derecognised when the obligation under the liability is discharged or cancelled or expires.

All loans and borrowings are classified as other liabilities. Initial recognition is at fair value less directly attributable transaction costs. After initial recognition, interest bearing loans and borrowings are subsequently measured at amortised cost using the effective interest method.

Financial liabilities included in trade and other payables are recognised initially at fair value and subsequently at amortised cost.

The financial instruments classified as financial liabilities at fair value through profit or loss include interest rate swap and cap arrangements. Recognition of the derivative financial instruments takes place when the contracts are entered into. They are recognised at fair value and transaction costs are included directly in finance costs.

The fair values of derivative financial liabilities are determined as follows:

Interest rate swaps and caps are measured using the midpoint of the yield curve prevailing on the reporting date. The valuations do not include accrued interest from the previous settlement date to the reporting date. The fair value represents the net present value of the difference between the contracted rate and the valuation rate when applied to the projected balances for the period from the reporting date to the contracted expiry dates.

The fair value of a non-interest bearing liability is its discounted repayment amount. If the due date of the liability is less than one year, discounting is omitted.

Share capital

Shares are classified as equity when there is no obligation to transfer cash or other assets.

Dividends

Dividends to the Company's shareholders are recognised when they become legally payable. In the case of interim dividends, this is when paid. In the case of final dividends, this is when approved by equity holders at a general meeting. Dividend information is provided in note 13 to the consolidated financial statements.

Merger reserve

The merger reserve resulted from the acquisition of NewRiver Retail Limited and represents the difference between the value of the net assets acquired of £524 million and the nominal value of the shares issued, adjusted for subsequent impairments and impairment reversals in NewRiver Retail Limited following the creation of the merger reserve in 2016.

In December 2024 the Company acquired Capital and Regional. Some of the consideration was paid in equity shares of the Company. The difference between the nominal value of the shares issued and the cost of the investment was recorded in the merger reserve.

Employee benefit trust

The employee benefit trust is included in the parent company financial statements.

Critical estimates

The preparation of financial statements requires the use of certain critical accounting estimates. It also requires the Directors to exercise judgement in the process of applying the Company's accounting policies. Changes in assumptions may have a significant impact on the financial statements in the period the assumptions changed. The Directors believe that the underlying assumptions are appropriate. The only critical estimates, assumptions and judgements relate to the determination of the carrying value of the investment in the Company's subsidiary undertakings. The nature, facts and circumstance of the investment are taken into account on assessing whether there are any indications of impairment.

Impairment of investment in subsidiaries

The carrying value of the Company's investment in subsidiaries is disclosed in note B. The Company assesses annually whether there is an indication of impairment of the investments in subsidiaries. An impairment is recognised when the recoverable amount of the investments is below their carrying amount. The recoverable amount is the higher of the value of use of investments and their fair value less costs of disposal. The fair value is generally estimated based on the current valuation of investment properties held by subsidiaries. If valuations of investment properties, excluding the newly acquired Capital & Regional investment properties, declined by 10%, the impairment in investment in subsidiaries would be £51.9 million (2024: £52.9 million).

Prior year restatement

In prior years the Company did not include the cost of disposal in the assessment of the recoverable amount. Therefore there is a prior year adjustment of £10.7 million to the opening balance of investment in subsidiaries on 1 April 2023 date to appropriately reflect the application of IAS36, thereby meaning there was a reduction of retained earnings for the same amount.

B. Investment in subsidiaries

All subsidiaries are held indirectly except the companies marked* in the below listing.

Name Country of
incorporation
Activity Proportion of
ownership interest Class of share
C-store REIT Limited UK Dormant company 100% Ordinary Shares
Capital & Regional
(Europe Holding 5) Limited1 Jersey Holding company 100% Ordinary Shares
Capital & Regional (Jersey)
Limited1 Jersey Dormant company 100% Ordinary Shares
Capital & Regional (Mall GP)
Limited UK Holding company 100% Ordinary Shares
Capital & Regional (Projects)
Limited UK Dormant company 100% Ordinary Shares
Capital & Regional
(Shopping Centres) Limited1 Jersey Holding company 100% Ordinary Shares
Capital & Regional
Earnings Limited UK Holding company 100% Ordinary Shares
Capital & Regional
Holdings Limited UK Holding company 100% Ordinary Shares
Capital & Regional plc* UK Holding company 100% Ordinary Shares
Capital & Regional Ilford Limited1 Jersey Holding company 100% Ordinary Shares
Real estate
C&R Ilford Limited Partnership UK investments 100% Ordinary Shares
C&R Ilford Nominee 1 Limited UK Dormant 100% Ordinary Shares
C&R Ilford Nominee 2 Limited UK Dormant 100% Ordinary Shares
C&R Ilford (General Partner) Real estate
Limited UK investments 100% Ordinary Shares
Capital & Regional Property Property
Management Limited UK management 100% Ordinary Shares
Real estate
C&R Retail 1 Limited UK investments 100% Ordinary Shares
Capital & Regional (UK Retail)
Limited UK Holding company 100% Ordinary Shares
Real estate
Ellandi LLP UK investments 100% Ordinary Shares
Real estate
EML Sub No 2 Limited UK investments 100% Ordinary Shares
Convenience Store REIT Limited UK Dormant company 100% Ordinary Shares
Green-Sinfield Limited UK Dormant 100% Ordinary Shares
NewRiver REIT plc Annual Report and Accounts 2025
2025
Strategic Report Governance Report Financial Statements ESG Data Sets Glossary & 201

Notes to the company financial statements continued

Name Country of
incorporation
Activity Proportion of
ownership interest Class of share
Name Country of
incorporation
Activity Proportion of
ownership interest Class of share
Lancaster Court (Hove) Limited UK Dormant 100% Ordinary Shares NewRiver Retail Real estate
Lower Grosvenor Place London (Darlington) Limited UK investments 100% Ordinary Shares
One Limited UK Dormant 100% Ordinary Shares Real estate
Mall Nominee One Limited UK Dormant 100% Ordinary Shares NewRiver Grays S.a.r.l* Luxembourg investments 100% Ordinary Shares
Mall Nominee Two Limited UK Dormant 100% Ordinary Shares NewRiver (Grays) UK Limited* UK Dormant 100% Ordinary Shares
Property NewRiver Retail (GP3) Limited UK General partner 100% Ordinary Shares
Mall People Limited UK management 100% Ordinary Shares NewRiver Retail (Leylands Road)
Mall Ventures Limited UK Dormant 100% Ordinary Shares Limited UK Dormant 100% Ordinary Shares
Real estate NewRiver Retail (Market Real estate
Marlowes Hemel Limited1 Jersey investments 100% Ordinary Shares Deeping No. 1) Limited Guernsey investments 100% Ordinary Shares
MB Roding (Guernsey) Ltd) Guernsey Dormant 100% Ordinary Shares NewRiver Retail Real estate
Real estate (Morecambe) Limited UK investments 100% Ordinary Shares
NewRiver Capital Limited* UK investments 100% Ordinary Shares NewRiver Retail (Nominee No.3)
Real estate Limited UK Dormant company 100% Ordinary Shares
NewRiver Capital Partnerships UK investments 100% Ordinary Shares Real estate
NewRiver Retail (Burgess Hill) NewRiver Retail (Paisley) Limited UK investments 100% Ordinary Shares
Limited UK Dormant company 100% Ordinary Shares Real estate
Real estate NewRiver Retail (Penge) Limited UK investments 100% Ordinary Shares
NewRiver (Darnall) Limited UK investments 100% Ordinary Shares NewRiver Retail (Portfolio No. 1) Real estate
NewRiver Finance Company Real estate Limited Guernsey investments 100% Ordinary Shares
Limited UK investments 100% Ordinary Shares NewRiver Retail (Portfolio No. 2) Real estate
NewRiver REIT (UK) Limited UK Asset management 100% Ordinary Shares Limited Guernsey investments 100% Ordinary Shares
NewRiver Retail (Bexleyheath) Group holding NewRiver Retail (Portfolio No. 3)
Limited
UK Holding company 100% Ordinary Shares
Holdings Limited UK company 100% Ordinary Shares
NewRiver Retail (Bexleyheath) Real estate NewRiver Retail (Portfolio No. 3)
Limited Partnership
UK Real estate
investments
100% Partnership
Limited Jersey investments 100% Ordinary Shares NewRiver Retail (Portfolio No. 4) Real estate
NewRiver Retail Limited UK investments 100% Ordinary Shares
(Broadway Square) UK Limited UK Dormant 100% Ordinary Shares NewRiver Retail (Portfolio No. 5) Real estate
NewRiver Retail (Bexleyheath) Limited UK investments 100% Ordinary Shares
UK Limited UK Dormant 100% Ordinary Shares NewRiver Retail (Portfolio No. 6) Real estate
NewRiver Retail
(Boscombe No. 1) Limited
UK Real estate
investments
100% Ordinary Shares Limited UK investments 100% Ordinary Shares
NewRiver Retail Real estate NewRiver Retail (Portfolio No. 8) Real estate
(Broadway Square) Limited Jersey investments 100% Ordinary Shares Limited UK investments 100% Ordinary Shares
Real estate NewRiver Retail (Ramsay Real estate
NewRiver Retail (Cardiff) Limited UK investments 100% Ordinary Shares Development) Limited UK investments 100% Ordinary Shares
NewRiver Retail Real estate NewRiver Retail (Ramsay Real estate
(Carmarthen) Limited UK investments 100% Ordinary Shares Investment) Limited UK investments 100% Ordinary Shares

Company Information

NewRiver REIT plc Annual Report and Accounts 2025
2025
Strategic Report Governance Report Financial Statements ESG Data Sets
& Appendix
Glossary &
Company Information
202

Notes to the company financial statements continued

Name Country of
incorporation
Activity Proportion of
ownership interest Class of share
Name Country of
incorporation
Activity Proportion of
ownership interest Class of share
NewRiver Retail (Skegness) Real estate NewRiver Retail Property Unit Real estate
Limited UK investments 100% Ordinary Shares Trust No. 6 Jersey investments 100% Ordinary units
NewRiver Retail (Wakefield) Real estate NewRiver Retail Property Unit Real estate
Limited UK investments 100% Ordinary Shares Trust No. 7 Jersey investments 100% Ordinary units
NewRiver Retail Real estate Selborne One Limited UK Dormant 100% Ordinary Shares
(Warminster) Limited UK investments 100% Ordinary Shares Selborne Two Limited UK Dormant 100% Ordinary Shares
NewRiver Retail (Wisbech) Real estate Selborne Walthamstow Limited1 Jersey Dormant 100% Ordinary Shares
Limited UK investments 100% Ordinary Shares Seventeen Social Space Limited UK Operation of food hall100% Ordinary Shares
NewRiver Retail Real estate Shopping Centre REIT Limited UK Dormant company 100% Ordinary Shares
(Witham) Limited UK investments 100% Ordinary Shares
NewRiver Retail Real estate Snozone Holdings Limited UK Holding company 100% Ordinary Shares
(Wrexham No.1) Limited Guernsey investments 100% Ordinary Shares Operator of indoor ski
NewRiver Retail (Portfolio No. 10) Real estate Snowzone S.L.U3 Spain slopes 100% Ordinary Shares
Limited UK investments 100% Ordinary Shares Operator of indoor ski
NewRiver Retail Group holding Ocio y Nieve S.L.U Spain slopes 100% Ordinary Shares
Holdings Limited Guernsey company 100% Ordinary Shares Operator of indoor ski
NewRiver Retail Holdings No. 1 Group holding Snozone Leisure Limited UK slopes 100% Ordinary Shares
Limited Guernsey company 100% Ordinary Shares
NewRiver Retail Holdings No. 2 Group holding Snozone Limited UK Holding company 100% Ordinary Shares
Limited Guernsey company 100% Ordinary Shares The Mall (General Partner)
NewRiver Retail Holdings No. 3 Group holding Limited UK Property investment 100% Ordinary Shares
Limited Guernsey company 100% Ordinary Shares The Mall Limited Partnership UK Property investment 100% Ordinary Shares
NewRiver Retail Holdings No. 5 Group holding The Mall REIT Limited UK Dormant 100% Ordinary Shares
Limited Guernsey company 100% Ordinary Shares The Mall Shopping Centres
NewRiver Retail Holdings No. 6 Group holding Limited UK Dormant 100% Ordinary Shares
Limited Guernsey company 100% Ordinary Shares The Mall Walthamstow One
NewRiver Retail Limited* Guernsey Group holding
company
100% Ordinary Shares Limited UK Dormant 100% Ordinary Shares
Real estate The Mall Walthamstow
NewRiver Retail Limited UK investments 100% Ordinary units Two Limited UK Dormant 100% Ordinary Shares
NewRiver Retail Property Unit Real estate Wood Green London Limited1 Jersey Dormant 100% Ordinary Shares
Trust Jersey investments 100% Ordinary units Wood Green One Limited UK Dormant 100% Ordinary Shares
NewRiver Retail Property Unit Real estate Wood Green Two Limited UK Dormant 100% Ordinary Shares
Trust No. 2 Jersey investments 100% Ordinary units Principal associate entities
NewRiver Retail Property Unit Real estate Euro B-Note Holding Limited1 Jersey Finance 39.90 Ordinary Shares
Trust No. 3 Jersey investments 100% Ordinary units 1. Registered office at 47 The Esplanade, St Helier, Jersey JE1 0BD.
NewRiver Retail Property Unit Real estate 2. Registered office at PO Box 186, Royal Chambers, St Julian's Avenue, St Peter Port, Guernsey GY1 4HP.
Trust No. 5 Jersey investments 100% Ordinary units 3. Registered office at Pista de Nieve en el Centro Comercial Madrid Xanadü,, Ctra. A5. Salidas 22 y 25, km 23,
  1. Registered office at Pista de Nieve en el Centro Comercial Madrid Xanadü,, Ctra. A5. Salidas 22 y 25, km 23, Arroyomolinos, Madrid, 28939,

Notes to the company financial statements continued

Unless stated otherwise, all UK incorporated companies have their registered offices at 89 Whitfield Street, London, W1T 4DE. Unless stated otherwise, all Jersey incorporated companies have their registered offices at 13 Castle Street, St Helier, Jersey, Channel Islands, JE4 5UT. Unless stated otherwise, all Guernsey incorporated companies have their registered offices at Floor 2 Trafalgar Court, Les Banques, St Peter Port, GY1 4LY. All Luxembourg incorporated companies have their registered offices at 5, Heienhaff L-1736 Senningerberg.

The Company's investments in joint ventures and associates are detailed in notes 15/16. The registered offices of the companies are:

Guernsey – NewRiver Retail (GP1) Ltd, Floor 2 Trafalgar Court, Les Banques, St Peter Port, GY1 4LY

UK – NewRiver Retail (Sprucefield) Limited, 89 Whitfield Street, London, W1T 4DE

UK – NewRiver Retail (Hamilton) Limited, 89 Whitfield Street, London, W1T 4DE

Reconciliation of the movement in investment in subsidiaries:

2025 2024
£m £m
Opening balance (as previously stated) 311.2 323.9
Restated (10.7)
Opening balance (restated) 313.2
Capital & Regional investment1 159.4
Reversal / (impairment) in subsidiaries 16.5 (2.0)
Investment in subsidiaries 487.1 311.2
  1. Capital & Regional was acquired in December 2024 for £150.9 million, it has therefore only been held for under four months and based on the price paid and the investment property movement in the period, no impairment has been raised.

The Company has recognised a net reversal of impairment of £16.5 million which relates to an impairment of £0.2 million in relation to the Group's joint ventures, offset by a reversal in the impairment of other investments of £16.7 million (2024: £2.0 million impairment) to reflect the increase in the recoverable amount of the Company's investment.

The Company's distributable reserves as at 31 March 2025 were £181.6 million (31 March 2024: £209.9 million).

C. Auditors' remuneration

The auditors' remuneration in respect of the Company is disclosed in note 6 of the consolidated financial statements.

D. Amounts owed from subsidiary undertakings

2025
£m
2024
£m
Non-current – Amounts owed from subsidiary undertakings * 219.4 211.9
Current – Amounts owed from subsidiary undertakings 171.0
195.9
415.3
382.9

* Includes an expected credit loss impairment provision of £0.2 million (2024: £0.3 million)

Non-current amounts owed by subsidiary undertakings have repayment dates beyond 12 months, are unsecured and bear interest that reflects market rates.

Current amounts owed by subsidiaries undertakings are unsecured, interest free and repayable on demand.

E. Current liabilities

2025
£m
2024
£m
Trade creditors 0.1
Accruals 2.7 2.1
Amounts owed to subsidiary undertakings 165.5 159.1
168.2 161.3

Amounts owed to subsidiary undertakings are unsecured, interest free and repayable on demand.

F. Borrowings

All borrowings issued by the Group at 31 March 2025 were issued by the Company. See note 21 of the consolidated financial statements for details.

Glossary & Company Information

Alternative Performance Measures (APMs) Supplementary information (Unaudited)

In addition to information contained in the Group financial statements, Alternative Performance Measures ('APMs'), being financial measures which are not specified under IFRS, are also used by management to assess the Group's performance. These APMs include a number of European Public Real Estate Association ('EPRA') measures, prepared in accordance with the EPRA Best Practice Recommendations reporting framework. We report these because management considers them to improve the transparency and relevance of our published results as well as the comparability with other listed European real estate companies.

The table below identifies the APMs used in this statement and provides the nearest IFRS measure where applicable, and where in this statement an explanation and reconciliation can be found.

APM Nearest IFRS measure Explanation and reconciliation
Profit / (Loss) for the
Underlying Funds From Operations ('UFFO') and UFFO per share period after taxation Note 12 of the Financial Statements
EPRA Net Tangible Assets ('NTA') and EPRA NTA per share Net Assets Note 12 of the Financial Statements
Dividend cover N/A 'Financial Policies' section of the 'Finance Review'
Admin cost ratio N/A Note 6 of the Financial Statements
Interest cover N/A Glossary
Net debt: EBITDA ratio N/A Glossary
EPRA EPS IFRS Basic EPS Note 12 of the Financial Statements
EPRA NIY N/A 'EPRA performance measures' section of this document
EPRA 'topped-up' NIY N/A 'EPRA performance measures' section of this document
EPRA Vacancy Rate N/A 'EPRA performance measures' section of this document
Total Accounting Return N/A Glossary
Total Property Return N/A Glossary
Weighted average cost of debt N/A 'Financial Policies' section of the 'Finance review'
Weighted average debt maturity N/A 'Financial Policies' section of the 'Finance review'
Loan to Value N/A 'Financial Policies' section of the 'Finance review'

EPRA Performance Measures

The information in this section is unaudited and does not form part of the consolidated primary statements of the company or the notes thereto.

Introduction

Below we disclose financial performance measures in accordance with the European Public Real Estate Association ('EPRA') Best Practice Recommendations which are aimed at improving the transparency, consistency and relevance of reporting across European Real Estate companies.

This section sets out the rationale for each performance measure as well as how it is measured. A summary of the performance measures is included in the following tables

FY25 FY24
EPRA Earnings Per Share (EPS) 7.5p 7.4p
EPRA Cost Ratio (including direct vacancy costs) 41.7% 36.9%
EPRA Cost Ratio (excluding direct vacancy costs) 38.9% 33.8%
March 2025 March 2024
EPRA NRV per share 115p 127p
EPRA NTA per share 102p 115p
EPRA NDV per share 107p 123p
EPRA LTV 46.1% 34.1%
EPRA NIY 6.8% 7.1%
EPRA 'topped-up' NIY 7.1% 7.5%
EPRA Vacancy Rate 3.9% 2.1%

EPRA Earnings Per Share: 7.5p

Definition

Earnings from operational activities

Purpose

A key measure of a company's underlying operating results and an indication of the extent to which current dividend payments are supported by earnings

& Appendix

Company Information

FY25
£m
FY24
£m
Earnings per IFRS income statement 23.7 3.0
Adjustments to calculate EPRA Earnings, exclude:
Changes in value of investment properties, development properties held for
investment and other investment interests (2.1) 13.9
Deferred tax 3.0
Profits or losses on disposal of investment properties, development
properties held for investment and other investment interests 0.9 6.1
Adjustments related to non-operating and exceptional items* 3.0
Adjustments to above in respect of joint ventures (unless already included
under proportional consolidation) (0.1) (0.1)
EPRA Earnings 28.4 22.9
Basic number of shares 376.3m 311.4m
EPRA Earnings per Share (EPS) 7.5p 7.4p

* Adjustments related to non-operating and exceptional items include £0.7 million expenses relating to the acquisition of Ellandi, £0.3 million amortisation of the intangible asset recognised on the acquisition of Ellandi, £0.9 million write off of unamortised costs following repayment of three Capital & Regional secured debt facilities totalling £59 million immediately post transaction completion and £1.1 million net costs in relation to unlocking expected net cost synergies following the acquisition of Capital & Regional

NewRiver REIT plc Annual Report and Accounts 2025
2025
Strategic Report Governance Report Financial Statements ESG Data Sets
& Appendix
Glossary &
Company Information
206

Reconciliation of EPRA Earnings to Underlying Funds From Operations (UFFO)

FY25
£m
FY24
£m
EPRA Earnings 28.4 22.9
Share-based payment charge 1.5 1.5
Forward-looking element of IFRS 9 0.1
Snozone amortisation and depreciation 0.7
Snozone lease liability interest (0.2)
Underlying Funds From Operations (UFFO) 30.5 24.4
Basic number of shares 376.3m 311.4m
UFFO per share 8.1p 7.8p

EPRA NRV per share: 115p; EPRA NTA per share: 102p; EPRA NDV per share: 107p

Definition

Net Asset Value adjusted to include properties and other investment interests at fair value and to exclude certain items not expected to crystallise in a long-term investment property business model.

Purpose

Makes adjustments to IFRS NAV to provide stakeholders with the most relevant information on the fair value of the assets and liabilities within a true real estate investment company with a long-term investment strategy.

31 March 2025 EPRA NRV
£m
EPRA NTA
£m
EPRA NDV
£m
IFRS Equity attributable to shareholders 490.1 490.1 490.1
Fair value of financial instruments
Deferred tax in relation to fair value gains of Investment Property 0.9 0.9
Fair value of debt 23.6
Goodwill (3.6)
Intangible asset (0.9)
Purchasers' costs 60.1
EPRA NRV / NTA / NDV 551.1 486.5 513.7
Fully diluted number of shares 478.9 478.9 478.9
EPRA NRV / NTA / NDV per share 115p 102p 107p
31 March 2024 EPRA NRV
£m
EPRA NTA
£m
EPRA NDV
£m
IFRS Equity attributable to shareholders 361.1 361.1 361.1
Fair value of financial instruments (0.1) (0.1)
Deferred tax in relation to fair value gains of Investment Property 0.8 0.8
Fair value of debt 24.5
Purchasers' costs 36.8
EPRA NRV / NTA / NDV 398.6 361.8 385.6
Fully diluted number of shares 313.3m 313.3m 313.3m
EPRA NRV / NTA / NDV per share 127p 115p 123p

EPRA LTV: 46.1%

Definition

EPRA LTV is the ratio of gross debt, net payables less cash and cash equivalents to the aggregate value of properties. LTV is expressed on a proportionally consolidated basis.

Purpose

EPRA LTV introduces a consistent and comparable metric for the real estate sector, with the aim to assess the gearing of the shareholder equity within a real estate investment company.

31 March 2025 Group
£m
Share of
Joint
Ventures
£m
Share of
Associates
£m
Total
£m
Borrowings from financial institutions (4.3) (4.3)
Corporate bond (300.0) (300.0)
Mall facility (140.0) (140.0)
Net (payables) / receivables (31.3) (0.3) (31.6)
Cash and cash equivalents 61.3 0.8 62.1
Net Debt (A) (410.0) (3.8) (413.8)
Investment property at fair value 887.5 10.0 897.5
Total Property Value (B) 887.5 10.0 897.5
EPRA LTV (A/B)* 46.2% 46.1%*

* EPRA LTV reduced to c.42.5% proforma for the £59 million post balance sheet disposal of the Abbey Centre, Newtownabbey

31 March 2024 Group
£m
Share of Joint
Ventures
£m
Share of
Associates
£m
Total
£m
Borrowings from financial institutions (4.0) (4.0)
Corporate bond (300.0) (300.0)
Net (payables) / receivables (14.9) 0.1 (0.1) (14.9)
Cash and cash equivalents 132.8 0.4 133.2
Net Debt (A) (182.1) 0.1 (3.7) (185.7)
Investment property at fair value 533.8 10.0 543.8
Total Property Value (B) 533.8 10.0 543.8
EPRA LTV (A/B) 34.1% 34.1%

EPRA NIY: 6.8%, EPRA 'topped-up' NIY: 7.1%

Definition

The basic EPRA NIY calculates the annualised rental income based on the cash rents passing at the balance sheet date, less non-recoverable property operating expenses, divided by the market value of the property, increased with (estimated) purchasers' costs.

In respect of the 'topped-up' NIY, an adjustment to the EPRA NIY in respect of the expiration of rent-free periods (or other unexpired lease incentives such as discounted rent periods and step rents).

Purpose

A comparable measure for portfolio valuations to assist investors in comparing portfolios.

March 2025
£m
March 2024
£m
Properties at valuation – wholly owned 887.5 533.8
Properties at valuation – share of Joint Ventures & Associates 10.0 10.0
Trading property (including share of Joint Ventures & Associates)
Less: Developments (10.0) (10.0)
Completed property portfolio 887.5 533.8
Allowance for estimated purchasers' costs and capital expenditure 90.8 40.5
Grossed up completed property portfolio valuation B 978.3 574.3
Annualised cash passing rental income 85.0 50.9
Property outgoings (18.5) (10.0)
Annualised net rents A 66.5 40.9
Add: Notional rent expiration of rent free periods or other lease incentives 2.7 2.4
Topped-up net annualised rent C 69.2 43.3
EPRA NIY A/B 6.8% 7.1%
EPRA 'topped-up' NIY C/B 7.1% 7.5%

EPRA Vacancy rate: 3.9%

Definition

Estimated Market Rental Value (ERV) of vacant space divided by ERV of the whole portfolio, excluding development assets.

Purpose

A 'pure' (%) measure of investment property space that is vacant, based on ERV.

March 2025
£m
March 2024
£m
Estimated Rental Value of vacant retail space A 2.9 1.0
Estimated Rental Value of total portfolio retail space B 74.4 47.8
EPRA Vacancy Rate A/B 3.9% 2.1%

The EPRA vacancy rate is based on the ratio of the aggregated estimated market rent for vacant retail units versus aggregated estimated market rent for all retail units in the portfolio, excluding properties under development and any units that are not classified as retail units (e.g. commercialisation activations and car parks). There are no significant distorting factors influencing the EPRA vacancy rate.

EPRA Cost Ratio (including direct vacancy costs): 41.7%

EPRA Cost Ratio (excluding direct vacancy costs): 38.9%

Definition

Administrative & operating costs (including & excluding costs of direct vacancy) divided by gross rental income.

Purpose

A key measure to enable meaningful measurement of the changes in a company's operating costs.

FY25
£m
FY24
£m
Administrative/operating expenses per IFRS 25.9 18.2
Net service charge costs/fees 5.6 4.0
Management fees less actual/estimated profit element (6.2) (2.5)
Share of Joint Ventures and associates expenses
(net of other income)
Exclude (if part of the above):
0.2 0.1
Ground rent costs 0.7 0.4
EPRA Costs (including direct vacancy costs)* A 26.2* 20.2
Direct vacancy costs (1.8) (1.7)
EPRA Costs (excluding direct vacancy costs)* B 24.4* 18.5
Gross Rental Income less ground rents – per IFRS 62.0 53.3
Add: share of Joint Ventures and associates (Gross Rental Income
less ground rents) 0.8 1.5
EPRA Gross Rental Income C 62.8 54.8
EPRA Cost Ratio (including direct vacancy costs)* A/C 41.7%* 36.9%
EPRA Cost Ratio (excluding direct vacancy costs)* B/C 38.9%* 33.8%

* EPRA definition of costs includes £0.7 million exceptional expenses relating to the acquisition of Ellandi, £0.3 million amortisation of the intangible asset recognised on the acquisition of Ellandi and £1.1 million net costs in relation to unlocking expected net cost synergies following the acquisition of Capital & Regional. Excluding these items EPRA Cost Ratio (including direct vacancy costs) and EPRA Cost Ratio (excluding direct vacancy costs) would be 38.4% and 35.5% respectively.

In the current and prior year, employee costs in relation to staff time on development projects have been capitalised into the base cost of relevant development assets.

Reconciliation of EPRA Costs (including direct vacancy costs) to Net Administrative expenses per IFRS

FY25
£m
FY24
£m
EPRA Costs (including direct vacancy costs) A 26.2 20.2
Exclude:
Ground rent costs (0.7) (0.4)
Exceptional costs1 (0.7)
Amortisation of intangibles2 (0.3)
Costs to unlock3 (1.1)
Share of Joint Ventures and associates property expenses
(net of other income)
(0.2)
Other operating income/recharges intended to cover overhead
expenses less any related profits
Net service charge costs (5.6) (4.0)
Operating expenses (excluding service charge cost) (7.4) (5.8)
Tenant incentives (included within income) (0.2) (0.2)
Letting & legal costs (included within income) (1.3) (1.3)
Group's share of net administrative expenses as per IFRS D 8.7 8.5
EPRA Gross Rental Income C 62.6 54.8
Ground rent costs (0.7) (0.4)
Expected credit reversal 0.4 0.1
Surrender premiums and commissions (0.6) (0.7)
Other income 0.4
Property rental, other income and related income as per IFRS E 61.7 54.2
Administrative cost ratio as per IFRS D/E 14.1% 15.7%
  1. Exceptional costs comprise acquisition costs relating to the acquisition of Ellandi

  2. Amortisation of intangibles relates to the amortisation of the intangible asset recognised on the acquisition of Ellandi

  3. Costs to unlock comprise net costs in relation to unlocking expected net cost synergies following the acquisition of Capital & Regional e.g. redundancy and head office costs

Property related capital expenditure and tenant incentives (additional disclosure)

Year ended 31 March 2025 Year ended 31 March 2024
Group
£m
JVs &
Associates
£m
Total
Group
£m
Group
£m
JVs &
Associates
£m
Total
Group
£m
Acquisitions through the
Capital & Regional transaction1 344.7 344.7
Development 0.2 0.2 0.2 0.2
Investment properties
Incremental lettable space 2.2 0.2 2.4 2.8 2.8
Non incremental lettable space 0.5 0.5 1.9 1.9
Capital contributions and tenant
incentives2
1.9 1.9 1.0 1.0
Other material non-allocated
types of expenditure3 5.0 5.0
Capitalised interest
Total property related capital
expenditure and tenant incentives
354.5 0.2 354.7 5.9 5.9
Non-cash components of the
Capital & Regional transaction1 (288.7) (288.7)
Conversion from accrual to cash basis (0.1) (0.1) 0.2 0.2
Total property related capital
expenditure and tenant incentives on
cash basis 65.7 0.2 65.9 6.1 6.1
  1. Acquisitions of £344.7 million (FY24: £nil) in the year comprise six investment properties acquired through the Capital & Regional transaction, funded by £81.8 million cash paid for the acquisition (including transaction costs) net of £(25.8) million cash acquired from the acquisition, with Non cash components of the transaction comprising £(77.6) million Share consideration, £(199.0) million Bank loans and £(12.1) million Other net assets and liabilities – see note 17 for further details

  2. Capital contributions and tenant incentives above includes Tenant incentives of £0.3 million (2024: £0.8 million) paid during the year net of associated amortisation of £(0.2) million (2024: £(0.2) million) recognised in the consolidated statement of comprehensive income

  3. Other material non-allocated types of expenditure of £5.0 million (2024: £nil) above relates to two new 999-year headleases acquired at Bexleyheath providing far great flexibility for re-development

Refurbishment expenditure in respect of major works is capitalised whilst renovation and refurbishment expenditure of a revenue nature is expensed as incurred. Our business model for major works and developments is to use a combination of in-house staff and external advisers. The cost of external advisers is capitalised to the cost of major works and developments and employee costs in relation to in-house staff time on major works and developments are capitalised into the base cost of relevant assets subject to meeting certain criteria related to the degree of time spent on and the nature of specific projects. Staff costs amounting to £0.3 million (2024: £0.5 million) have been capitalised as such during the year.

ESG Appendix continued

ESG Data Sets Appendix (unaudited)

Calendar year 2024

Our Corporate Environmental Performance Measures (NewRiver only)

Corporate Environmental Performance Measures provide insight on the environmental impact of our occupation of our office space.

Corporate emissions arising from our offices increased by 15% in FY25, reflective of the increase in our head count following our acquisition of Ellandi in July 2024. The growth of our team was also reflected in our water consumption and waste generation figures, which increased 20% and 30% respectively. Despite this increase in overall waste generation, we were pleased to achieve a 19% increase in our recycling rate, helping to mitigate the impact of our increased waste volume.

Strategic Report

The most significant change was in employee commuting (not included in below figures but captured in our SECR disclosure), whereby the average emissions per head increased 36%, driven by a 22% increase in distance travelled. NewRiver employees continue to make sustainable travel choices with over 81% of commute miles being via rail services.

All data presented in this disclosure has been verified under ISO 14064-3:2019 by Consult Sustainability.

Absolute Performance (Abs)
EPRA Code Performance Measure Unit(s) of measure % of data estimation FY24 FY25 % Change
Elec-Abs Electricity consumption Annual kWh 0% 29,446 33,892 15%
DH&C-Abs District heating & cooling Annual kWh Our corporate offices are not connected to district heating & cooling
Fuels-Abs Fuel consumption Annual kWh 0%
0
0 0%
Energy-Int Energy intensity kWhelec/m2/yr 0% 77 89 15%
GHG-Dir-Abs Scope 1 emissions Kg CO2e 0% 0 0 0%
Scope 2 emissions (location-based) Kg CO2e 0% 6,097 7,017 15%
GHG-Indir-Abs Scope 2 emissions (market-based) Kg CO2e 0% 0 0 0%
Scope 3 emissions1 Tonnes CO2e 0% 1,540 1,732 12%
GHG-Int Scope 1 and 2 emissions Kg CO2e/ m2/ year 0% 16 18 15%
Water-Abs Water consumption Annual m3 0% 38 45 20%
Water-Int Water intensity M3 consumption/ m2 0% 0.10 0.12 20%
Waste Kg total waste Kg 0% 2,964 3,867 30%
% total waste
Recycling rate2 recycled 0% 60% 71% 19%
  1. Scope 3 emissions as presented above include the emissions associated with our occupation of our corporate offices, and so include water consumption, waste generation, and indirect emissions from our consumption of energy.

  2. Consistent with the approach of our waste contractor, recycling rate calculations include the segregation and separate treatment of food waste and coffee grounds within recycled waste.

& Appendix

Glossary & Company Information

NewRiver REIT plc Annual Report and Accounts 2025 Strategic Report Governance Report Financial Statements ESG Data Sets
& Appendix
Glossary &
Company Information
211
ESG Appendix continued

Our Portfolio Environmental Performance Measures (NewRiver only)

Portfolio Environmental Performance Measures provide insight on the environmental impact of NewRiver's property portfolio over which we have operational control. Please see pages 75, 78 and 80-81 of this report for detailed commentary on the performance trends observed within this dataset. All data presented in this disclosure has been verified under ISO 14064-3:2019 by Consult Sustainability.

EPRA Code Performance Measure Unit(s) of measure % of data estimation Absolute Performance (Abs) Like-for-like Performance (LfL)
FY24 FY25 FY24 FY25 % Change
Elec-Abs, Elec-LfL Electricity consumption Annual MWh 1.4% 8,188 7,213 6,372 6,415 1%
DH&C-Abs & LfL District heating & cooling Annual MWh None of our properties were connected to or benefitted from district heating & cooling
Fuels-Abs,Fuels-LfL Fuel consumption Annual MWh 4.0% 2,708 2,356 2,387 2,224 -7%
Energy-Int Energy intensity kWhelec-eq/m2/yr 62 64 62 64 3%
GHG-Dir-Abs Scope 1 emissions Tonnes CO2e 495 431 437 407 -7%
GHG-Indir-Abs Scope 2 emissions (location-based) Tonnes CO2e Emissions are calculated based on the 1,695 1,494 1,319 1,328 1%
Scope 2 emissions (market-based) Tonnes CO2e 0 0 0 0 0%
Scope 3 emissions Tonnes CO2e conversion of all other data points in
this disclosure table8
574 469 463 424 -8%
Tonnes CO2e/ m2/
GHG-Int Scope 1 and 2 emissions year 0.013 0.014 0.011 0.012 16%
Water-Abs, Water-LfL Water consumption Annual m3 1.1% 65,602 58,363 53,435 57,443 8%
Water-Int Water intensity m3 consumption / m2 0.40 0.42 0.32 0.41 27%
Tonnes total waste Tonnes 1.2% 2,887 2,761 2,615 2,691 3%
Waste-Abs, Tonnes diverted from landfill Tonnes 1.2% 2,887 2,761 2,615 2,691 3%
Waste-LfL Tonnes waste to energy Tonnes 0.7% 1,173 1,321 1,121 1,300 16%
Tonnes recycling Tonnes 1.9% 1,505 1,224 1,458 1,174 -19%
Cert-ToT Type and number of
sustainably certified assets
Total number by
certification/ rating/
labelling scheme
We certified 10 no. assets to the WELL Health-Safety Rating standard, with 9 no. remaining in our
portfolio by the end of the reporting period. This standard does not have levelled ratings within it.
Please also see page 212 for a detailed breakdown of energy performance certificate ratings.
  1. Data coverage and comparability: the figures reported against each performance measure represent 100% of the assets within our Operational Control reporting boundary. Like-for-like figures include only those properties that remained in our portfolio for the full 12 months of both of the above reporting periods. Whilst they are like-for-like in that they relate to the same assets over comparable full 12-month periods, they include consumption from both landlord common areas and vacant & rates mitigation spaces, which vary year-on-year. Because of this high degree of variation, the floor areas for these spaces are not utilised in the intensity metric calculations. The like-for-like increases disclosed above are due to fluctuations arising from these spaces. Like-for-like common area electricity consumption reduced by 2%, while gas consumption remained stable.

  2. Normalisation: Intensity indicators for energy, water and waste are based on relevant floor area (landlord-controlled common parts). Elec-eq is calculated using the latest REEB conversion factor.

  3. Scope 3 emissions relate to the emissions included in our 2040 net-zero target, which are those arising from the directly controlled areas of our assets (i.e., waste, water, and upstream emissions and transmission & distribution losses from energy consumption). We have chosen to include these categories only to provide a clear performance comparison, as all other Scope 3 categories are otherwise difficult to distinguish when collated with "downstream leased assets". FY24 absolute scope 3 emissions were erroneously reported as 581 tonnes in our FY24 report due to a formula error; this has been corrected and re-stated above as 574 tonnes.

  4. Absolute and like-for-like asset-level performance measures include only landlord-procured energy/water. This does not include sub-metered energy procured on behalf of occupiers on inclusive leases, which amounted to 17,965 kWh in 2024 (electricity only), and which is accounted for in the Scope 3 emissions category of "downstream leased assets" reported within our SECR disclosure on page 76.

  5. "Estimation" refers to filling invoice gaps, not to whether invoices are based on "estimated" or "actual" readings. Although a vast majority of the data presented is based on actual consumption, in the instances where there were gaps in energy and water consumption, the average of the months where we had data was applied to the missing months. The same approach was applied to waste generation data, in some cases drawing on the previous year's data where required. % estimations disclosed relate to the current reporting year figures only.

  6. Segmental analysis: As our portfolio is comprised of entirely retail properties within the UK only, we have not undertaken segmental analysis.

  7. Verification: Our environmental performance data has been verified by Consult Sustainability as part of our GHG inventory.

  8. Applies to EPRA Codes GHG-Dir-Abs, GHG-Indir-Abs, GHG-Int.

NewRiver REIT plc | Annual Report and Accounts 2025 Governance Report Financial Statements ESG Data Sets 212 & Appendix Glossary & Company Information Strategic Report

ESG Appendix continued

EPC certificates by Region and Asset Rating (NewRiver + Capital & Regional)

In the below table, the number of certificates across our portfolio is presented by asset rating, A+ through to G, including the Capital & Regional assets. We have provided England & Wales separately to Scotland & Northern Ireland, as MEES is in effect in England & Wales. We have also disclosed the number of units with no/expired EPCs to provide clarity on certification coverage across the portfolio. EPC coverage is currently 72%, down slightly from 77% last year. This is because of the incorporation of our new assets (Capital & Regional portfolio) into our calculations. This also excludes recently sold assets for which we acquired new EPCs for the purposes of sale.

Region A+ A B C D E F G No/ Expired EPC
England & Wales 0 14 354 282 192 58 0 0 280
Scotland & Northern Ireland 0 8 12 30 18 26 19 24 116
Total 0 22 366 312 210 84 19 24 396

Asset Social Performance Measures (NewRiver only)

EPRA Code Performance Measure Unit(s) of Measure Boundary FY24 FY25
H&S-Asset Asset health and safety assessments Percentage of assets Managed
Assets
100% 100%
Asset health and safety compliance Number of incidents
in reporting year
Managed
Assets
0 0
H&S-Comp Development and major
refurbishment project health and
safety compliance
Number of incidents
over past 3 years
Managed
Assets
0
Comty-Eng Community engagement,
impact assessments and
development programmes
Percentage of assets Managed
Assets
100% 100%
NewRiver REIT plc Annual Report and Accounts 2025
NewRiver REIT plc Annual Report and Accounts 2025 Strategic Report Governance Report Financial Statements ESG Data Sets
& Appendix
Glossary &
Company Information
213

ESG Appendix continued

Employee Social Performance Measures (NewRiver only)

EPRA Code Performance Measure Unit(s) of Measure Boundary FY24 FY25
Diversity-Emp Employee gender diversity Percentage of employees, Board diversity NewRiver Board 29% female/71% male 29% female/71% Male
Percentage of employees, All employee gender diversity 50% female/50% male 49% female/ 51% male
77% White/ 13% 79% White/
Employee racial diversity Percentage of employees, All employee racial diversity Asian/4% Caribbean/ 11% Asian/4%
4% Mixed/ 2% Moth Caribbean/6% Mixed
Diversity-Pay1 Gender pay ratio Ratio of gender pay, mean/median 39% Mean, 37% Median 34% Mean, 31% Median
Employee training and development Average hours/employee 46 51
Emp-Training Employee training, subscriptions, surveys,
and online platforms
Total £s invested £179,096 £208,322
Employee health & safety training Average hours/ employee 7 7
Emp-Dev Employee performance appraisals Percentage of employees 100% 100%
Total number of new hires2 Total number NewRiver
direct
8 30
Total number of leavers Total number employees3 5 2
Emp-Turnover Rate of new hires2 Percentage 17% 38%
Rate of employee turnover Percentage 11% 4%
Temporary staff Percentage of employees who are contractors or
temporary staff
0% 0%
Injury rate Per 100,000 hours worked 0 0
H&S-Emp Lost day rate Per 100,000 hours worked 0 0
Absentee rate Days per employee 0 0.5
Fatalities Total number 0 0
Instances of non-compliance with labour standards Total number 0 0
  1. As we have fewer than 250 employees, we are not obliged by The Equality Act 2010 (Gender Pay Gap Information Regulations 2017) to disclose our gender pay information. We calculate gender pay gap based on the difference between the average annual salaries of men and women, excluding bonuses and other benefits.

  2. Includes NewRiver's acquisition of Ellandi as "new hires".

  3. Applies to all EPRA Codes excluding Diversity-Emp.

Glossary

Admin cost ratio: Is the Group's share of net administrative expenses (including its share of JV administrative expenses) divided by the Group's share of property income (including its share of JV property income).

Associate: Is an entity in which the Group holds an interest and is significantly influenced by the Group.

Average debt maturity: Is measured in years when each tranche of gross debt is multiplied by the remaining period to its maturity and the result is divided by total gross debt in issue at the period end. Average debt maturity is expressed on a proportionally consolidated basis.

Balance sheet gearing: Is the balance sheet net debt divided by IFRS net assets.

BRAVO: Is BRAVO Strategies III LLC, with which NewRiver formed a capital partnership in May 2019 to acquire and manage a portfolio of retail assets in the UK.

Book value: Is the amount at which assets and liabilities are reported in the financial statements.

Cost of debt: Is the loan interest and derivative costs at the period end, divided by total debt in issue at the period end. Cost of debt is expressed on a proportionally consolidated basis.

CVA: Is a Company Voluntary Arrangement, a legally binding agreement that allows a company to settle debts by paying only a proportion of the amount that it owes to creditors (such as contracted rent) or to come to some other arrangement with its creditors over the payment of its debts.

Dividend cover: Is Underlying Funds From Operations per share divided by dividend per share declared in the period.

EBITDA: Earnings Before Interest, Tax, Depreciation and Amortisation

EPRA: Is the European Public Real Estate Association.

EPRA earnings: Is the IFRS profit after taxation excluding investment property revaluations, fair value adjustments on derivatives, gains/losses on disposals, deferred tax and adjustments relating to non-operating and exceptional items.

EPRA earnings per share: Is EPRA earnings divided by the weighted average basic number of shares in issue during the period.

EPRA Net Tangible Assets (EPRA NTA): Are the balance sheet net assets excluding the mark to market on effective cash flow hedges and related debt adjustments, deferred taxation on revaluations, goodwill, and diluting for the effect of those shares potentially issuable under employee share schemes.

EPRA NTA per share: Is EPRA NTA divided by the diluted number of shares at the period end.

EPRA LTV: Is the ratio of gross debt, net payables less cash and cash equivalents to the aggregate value of properties. LTV is expressed on a proportionally consolidated basis.

ERV growth: Is the change in ERV over a period on our investment portfolio expressed as a percentage of the ERV at the start of the period. ERV growth is calculated monthly and compounded for the period subject to measurement, as calculated by MSCI Real Estate.

Estimated Rental Value (ERV): Is the external valuers' opinion as to the open market rent which, on the date of valuation, could reasonably be expected to be obtained on a new letting or rent review of a property.

Footfall: Is the annualised number of visitors entering our shopping centre assets.

Gross Asset Value (GAV): Is the total value of all real estate investments owned by the Company.

Group: Is NewRiver REIT plc, the Company and its subsidiaries and its share of joint ventures (accounted for on an equity basis).

Head lease: Is a lease under which the Group holds an investment property.

IFRS: UK-adopted International Accounting Standards.

Income return: Is the income derived from a property as a percentage of the property value.

Interest Cover Ratio: Interest cover is tested at corporate level and is calculated by comparing actual net rental income received versus net cash interest payable on a 12 month look-back basis.

Joint venture: Is an entity in which the Group holds an interest on a long-term basis and is jointly controlled by the Group and one or more ventures under a contractual arrangement whereby decisions on financial and operating policies essential to the operation, performance and financial position of the venture require each joint venture partner's consent.

Leasing events: Are long-term and temporary new lettings, lease renewals and lease variations within investment and joint venture properties.

Like-for-like ERV growth: Is the change in ERV over a period on the standing investment properties expressed as a percentage of the ERV at the start of the period.

Like-for-like footfall: Is the movement in footfall against the same period in the prior period, on properties owned throughout both comparable periods, aggregated at 100% share.

Like-for-like net income: Is the change in net income on properties owned throughout the current and previous periods under review. This growth rate includes revenue recognition and lease accounting adjustments but excludes properties held for development in either period, properties with guaranteed rent reviews and asset management determinations.

Like-for-like valuation growth: Is the percentage change in investment properties (excluding right of use asset), reconciled as below:

Investment properties £m
Investment properties brought forward (excluding right of use asset) (note 14) 533.8
Investment properties held in associates (note 16)
Acquisitions (note 17) 344.7
Capital expenditure 10.0
Disposals (including joint ventures and associates) (6.5)
Total
A
892.0
Investment property as at 31 March 2025
B
897.5
Like-for-like valuation growth
B/A-1
0.6%

Glossary continued

Long-term leasing deals: Are leasing deals with a fixed term certain of at least one year.

Loan to Value (LTV): Is the ratio of gross debt less cash, short-term deposits, liquid investments and unamortised fees to the aggregate value of properties and investments. LTV is expressed on a proportionally consolidated basis.

Mark to market: Is the difference between the book value of an asset or liability and its market value.

MSCI: MSCI Inc produces independent benchmarks of property returns and NewRiver portfolio returns.

Net debt: Net debt is the principal value of gross debt less unamortised fees, net of cash, shortterm deposits and liquid investments.

Net debt: EBITDA Ratio: Net debt: EBITDA is tested at corporate level and is calculated by comparing actual EBITDA received versus the average net debt on a 12 month look-back basis and is expressed on a proportionally consolidated basis.

Net Equivalent Yield (NEY): Is the net weighted average income return a property will produce based upon the timing of the income received. In accordance with usual practice, the equivalent yields (as determined by the external valuers) assume rent received annually in arrears and on values before deducting prospective purchaser's costs.

Net Initial Yield (NIY): Is the current annualised rent, net of costs, expressed as a percentage of capital value, after adding notional purchaser's costs.

Net rental income: Is the rental income receivable in the period after payment of property outgoings. Net rental income will differ from annualised net rents and passing rent due to the effects of income from rent reviews, property outgoings and accounting adjustments for fixed and minimum contracted rent reviews and lease incentives.

NewRiver share: Represents the Group's ownership on a proportionally consolidated basis.

Occupational Cost Ratio (OCR): The OCR is calculated by comparing the Occupational Costs associated with each unit, comprising the Rent payable, Business Rates, Service Charges and Insurance premiums, with the Turnover generated by the store on an annualised basis.

Passing rent: Is the gross rent payable under leases terms.

Portfolio valuation performance: Refers to the measurement of changes in the value of a portfolio of investments over a specified period, based on periodic revaluation of the underlying assets. It captures both realised and unrealised gains or losses, reflecting market movements, valuation adjustments and other factors affecting the fair value of the portfolio.

Pre-let: A lease signed with an occupier prior to the completion of a development.

Pre-sale: A sale exchanged with a purchaser prior to completion of a development.

Property Income Distribution (PID): As a REIT the Group is obliged to distribute 90% of the tax-exempt profits. These dividends, which are referred to as PIDs, are subject to withholding tax at the basic rate of income tax. Certain classes of shareholders may qualify to receive the dividend gross. See our website (www.nrr.co.uk) for details. The Group can also make other normal (non-PID) dividend payments which are taxed in the usual way.

Proportionally consolidated: The aggregation of the financial results of the Reported Group and the Group's share of net assets and net profits within its joint ventures and associates.

Real Estate Investment Trust (REIT): Is a listed property company which qualifies for and has elected into a tax regime, which exempts qualifying UK property rental income and gains on investment property disposals from corporation tax.

Rental value growth: Is the increase in the current rental value, as determined by the Company's valuers, over the 12-month period on a like-for-like basis.

Retail occupancy rate: Is the estimated rental value of let units expressed as a percentage of the total estimated rental value of the portfolio, excluding development units.

Risk-controlled development pipeline: Is the combination of all development projects that the Company is currently pursuing or assessing for feasibility. Our risk-controlled approach means that we will not commit to a new development unless we have pre-let or pre-sold at least 70% by area.

Tenant (or lease) incentives: Are any incentives offered to occupiers to enter into a lease. Typically the incentive will be an initial rent-free period, or a cash contribution to fit-out or similar costs. Under accounting rules, the value of lease incentives given to tenants is amortised through the Income Statement on a straight-line basis to the lease expiry.

Total Accounting Return (TAR): Is the increase or decrease in EPRA NTA per share plus dividends paid in the period, expressed as a percentage of EPRA NTA per share at the beginning of the period.

Total Property Return (TPR): Is calculated as the change in capital value, less any capital expenditure incurred, plus net income, expressed as a percentage of capital employed over the period, as calculated by MSCI Real Estate (formerly IPD). Total property returns are calculated monthly and indexed to provide a return over the relevant period.

Topped-Up Net Initial Yield: Net initial yield adjusted to include notional rent in respect of let properties which are subject to a rent free period at the valuation date.

Underlying Funds From Operations (UFFO): is a measure of the Company's operational profits, which includes other income and excludes one off or non-cash adjustments, such as portfolio valuation movements, profits or losses on the disposal of investment properties, fair value movements on derivatives, Snozone depreciation, amortisation and lease liability interest on PPE, exceptional costs and share-based payment expense.

Weighted average lease expiry (WALE): Is the average lease term remaining to first tenant break, or expiry, across the portfolio weighted by rental income. This is also disclosed assuming all tenant break clauses are exercised at the earliest date, as stated. Excludes short-term licences and residential leases.

Yield on cost: Passing rents expressed as a percentage of the total development cost of a property.

Yield Shift: Is a movement (usually expressed in basis points) in the equivalent yield of a property asset.

Directors

Lynn Fordham (Non-Executive Chair)

Allan Lockhart (Chief Executive Officer)

Will Hobman (Chief Financial Officer)

Alastair Miller (Non-Executive Director)

Dr Karen Miller (Non-Executive Director)

Charlie Parker (Non-Executive Director)

Colin Rutherford (Non-Executive Director)

Kerin Williams (Company Secretary)

Registered office

89 Whitfield Street London W1T 4DE

Company Number

10221027

Brokers

Panmure Liberum Limited Ropemaker Place, Level 12 25 Ropemaker Street London EC2Y 9LY

Jefferies International Limited 100 Bishopsgate London EC2N 4JL

Shore Capital Limited Cassini House 57 St James's Street London SW1A 1LD

This report is printed on paper certified in accordance with the FSC® (Forest Stewardship Council®) and is recyclable and acid-free.

Pureprint Ltd is FSC certified and ISO 14001 certified showing that it is committed to all round excellence and improving environmental performance is an important part of this strategy.

Pureprint Ltd aims to reduce at source the effect its operations have on the environment and is committed to continual improvement, prevention of pollution and compliance with any legislation or industry standards.

Pureprint Ltd is a Carbon/Neutral® Printing Company.

Designed and produced by Black Sun Global www.blacksun-global.com

www.nrr.co.uk

NewRiver REIT plc 89 Whitfield Street London W1T 4DE Tel: +44(0) 20 3328 5800

NewRiver REIT plc Annual Report and Accounts 2025

Talk to a Data Expert

Have a question? We'll get back to you promptly.